1 <?xml version='
1.0' encoding='UTF-
8'
?>
2 <?xml-stylesheet href=
"docbook-css-0.4/driver.css" type=
"text/css"?>
3 <!-- Converted to DocBook by Hans Schou 2004-03-29. Updated and improved
4 by Petter Reinholdtsen 2012 with input from Martin Borg. -->
9 <!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC
"-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.5//EN"
10 "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.5/docbookx.dtd"
13 <!ENTITY translationblock
"">
15 <book id=
"index" lang=
"en">
17 <title>Free Culture
</title>
19 <abbrev>"freeculture"</abbrev>
21 <subtitle>HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN
22 CULTURE AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
</subtitle>
24 <pubdate>2004-
03-
25</pubdate>
26 <releaseinfo>Version
2004-
02-
10</releaseinfo>
30 <firstname>Lawrence
</firstname>
31 <surname>Lessig
</surname>
35 <!-- <subjectset> and cover <mediaobject> Based on example from
36 http://jfearn.fedorapeople.org/en-US/Publican/2.7/html/Users_Guide/chap-Users_Guide-Creating_a_document.html
38 <subjectset scheme=
"libraryofcongress">
40 <subjectterm>Intellectual property
—United States.
</subjectterm>
43 <subjectterm>Mass media
—United States.
</subjectterm>
46 <subjectterm>Technological innovations
—United States.
</subjectterm>
49 <subjectterm>Art
—United States.
</subjectterm>
55 <publishername>The Penguin Press
</publishername>
56 <address><city>New York
</city></address>
61 <holder>Lawrence Lessig
</holder>
67 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cc.png" contentdepth=
"3em" width=
"100%" align=
"center"/>
70 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cc.svg" contentdepth=
"3em" width=
"100%" align=
"center"/>
73 <phrase>Creative Commons, Some rights reserved
</phrase>
79 This version of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is licensed under
80 a Creative Commons license. This license permits non-commercial use of
81 this work, so long as attribution is given. For more information
82 about the license, click the icon above, or visit
83 <ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/
1.0/
</ulink>
88 <title>ABOUT THE AUTHOR
</title>
91 (
<ulink url=
"http://www.lessig.org">http://www.lessig.org
</ulink>),
92 professor of law and a John A. Wilson Distinguished Faculty Scholar
93 at Stanford Law School, is founder of the Stanford Center for Internet
94 and Society and is chairman of the Creative Commons
95 (
<ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org">http://creativecommons.org
</ulink>).
96 The author of The Future of Ideas (Random House,
2001) and Code: And
97 Other Laws of Cyberspace (Basic Books,
1999), Lessig is a member of
98 the boards of the Public Library of Science, the Electronic Frontier
99 Foundation, and Public Knowledge. He was the winner of the Free
100 Software Foundation's Award for the Advancement of Free Software,
101 twice listed in BusinessWeek's
<quote>e.biz
25,
</quote> and named one of Scientific
102 American's
<quote>50 visionaries.
</quote> A graduate of the University of
103 Pennsylvania, Cambridge University, and Yale Law School, Lessig
104 clerked for Judge Richard Posner of the U.S. Seventh Circuit Court of
109 <!-- testing different ways to tag the cover page -->
110 <mediaobject role=
"cover">
111 <imageobject remap=
"lrg" role=
"front-large">
112 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cover.png" format=
"PNG" width=
"444" />
115 <imageobject remap="s" role="front">
116 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
118 <imageobject remap="xs" role="front-small">
119 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
121 <imageobject remap="cs" role="thumbnail">
122 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
127 <biblioid class=
"isbn">1-
59420-
006-
8</biblioid>
130 http://catalog.loc.gov/cgi-bin/Pwebrecon.cgi?v3=1&DB=local&CMD=010a+2003063276&CNT=10+records+per+page
132 <biblioid class=
"libraryofcongress">2003063276</biblioid>
136 <dedication id=
"salespoints">
139 You can buy a copy of this book by clicking on one of the links below:
141 <itemizedlist mark=
"number" spacing=
"compact">
142 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.amazon.com/">Amazon
</ulink></para></listitem>
143 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.barnesandnoble.com/">B
&N
</ulink></para></listitem>
144 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.penguin.com/">Penguin
</ulink></para></listitem>
145 <!-- <ulink url="">Local Bookstore</ulink> -->
148 <!-- PAGE BREAK 2 -->
149 <!-- PAGE BREAK 3 -->
150 <dedication id=
"alsobylessig">
153 ALSO BY LAWRENCE LESSIG
156 The Future of Ideas: The Fate of the Commons in a Connected World
159 Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
162 <!-- PAGE BREAK 4 -->
163 <!-- PAGE BREAK 5 -->
164 <!-- PAGE BREAK 6 -->
167 THE PENGUIN PRESS, a member of Penguin Group (USA) Inc.
375 Hudson Street New
171 Copyright
© Lawrence Lessig. All rights reserved.
174 Excerpt from an editorial titled
<quote>The Coming of Copyright Perpetuity,
</quote>
175 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>, January
16,
2003. Copyright
176 © 2003 by The New York Times Co. Reprinted with permission.
179 Cartoon in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1711"/> by Paul Conrad, copyright Tribune
180 Media Services, Inc. All rights reserved. Reprinted with permission.
183 Diagram in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1761"/> courtesy of the office of FCC
184 Commissioner, Michael J. Copps.
187 Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
191 Free culture : how big media uses technology and the law to lock down
192 culture and control creativity / Lawrence Lessig.
201 ISBN
1-
59420-
006-
8 (hardcover)
205 1. Intellectual property
—United States.
2. Mass media
—United States.
208 3. Technological innovations
—United States.
4. Art
—United States. I. Title.
214 343.7309'
9—dc22
217 This book is printed on acid-free paper.
220 Printed in the United States of America
226 Designed by Marysarah Quinn
234 Without limiting the rights under copyright reserved above, no part of
235 this publication may be reproduced, stored in or introduced into a
236 retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means
237 (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise),
238 without the prior written permission of both the copyright owner and
239 the above publisher of this book.
242 The scanning, uploading, and distribution of this book via the
243 Internet or via any other means without the permission of the
244 publisher is illegal and punishable by law. Please purchase only
245 authorized electronic editions and do not participate in or encourage
246 electronic piracy of copyrighted materials. Your support of the
247 author's rights is appreciated.
251 <!-- PAGE BREAK 7 -->
252 <dedication><title></title>
254 To Eric Eldred
—whose work first drew me to this cause, and for whom
262 <title>List of figures
</title>
269 1 CHAPTER ONE: Creators
270 1 CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
271 1 CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
272 1 CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
277 1 CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
281 1 CHAPTER SIX: Founders
282 1 CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
283 1 CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
284 1 CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
285 1 CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
286 2 Why Hollywood Is Right
290 2 Law and Architecture: Reach
291 2 Architecture and Law: Force
292 2 Market: Concentration
295 1 CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
296 1 CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
297 2 Constraining Creators
298 2 Constraining Innovators
299 2 Corrupting Citizens
301 1 CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
302 1 CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
306 2 Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
307 2 Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
309 2 1. More Formalities
310 3 Registration and Renewal
313 2 3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
314 2 4. Liberate the Music- -Again
315 2 5. Fire Lots of Lawyers 304
321 <!-- PAGE BREAK 11 -->
323 <preface id=
"preface">
324 <title>PREFACE
</title>
325 <indexterm id=
"idxpoguedavid" class='startofrange'
>
326 <primary>Pogue, David
</primary>
329 <emphasis role=
"bold">At the end
</emphasis> of his review of my first
330 book,
<citetitle>Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle>, David
331 Pogue, a brilliant writer and author of countless technical and
332 computer-related texts, wrote this:
336 Unlike actual law, Internet software has no capacity to punish. It
337 doesn't affect people who aren't online (and only a tiny minority
338 of the world population is). And if you don't like the Internet's
339 system, you can always flip off the modem.
<footnote id=
"preface01"><para>
340 David Pogue,
<quote>Don't Just Chat, Do Something,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
30 January
2000.
345 Pogue was skeptical of the core argument of the book
—that
346 software, or
<quote>code,
</quote> functioned as a kind of law
—and his review
347 suggested the happy thought that if life in cyberspace got bad, we
348 could always
<quote>drizzle, drazzle, druzzle, drome
</quote>-like simply flip a
349 switch and be back home. Turn off the modem, unplug the computer, and
350 any troubles that exist in
<emphasis>that
</emphasis> space wouldn't
351 <quote>affect
</quote> us anymore.
354 Pogue might have been right in
1999—I'm skeptical, but maybe.
355 But even if he was right then, the point is not right now:
356 <citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is about the troubles the Internet
357 causes even after the modem is turned
359 off. It is an argument about how the battles that now rage regarding life
360 on-line have fundamentally affected
<quote>people who aren't online.
</quote> There
361 is no switch that will insulate us from the Internet's effect.
363 <indexterm startref=
"idxpoguedavid" class='endofrange'
/>
365 But unlike
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, the argument here is not much
366 about the Internet itself. It is instead about the consequence of the
367 Internet to a part of our tradition that is much more fundamental,
368 and, as hard as this is for a geek-wanna-be to admit, much more
372 That tradition is the way our culture gets made. As I explain in the
373 pages that follow, we come from a tradition of
<quote>free culture
</quote>—not
374 <quote>free
</quote> as in
<quote>free beer
</quote> (to borrow a phrase from the founder of the
375 free software movement
<footnote>
377 Richard M. Stallman,
<citetitle>Free Software, Free Societies
</citetitle> 57 (Joshua Gay, ed.
2002).
378 </para></footnote>), but
<quote>free
</quote> as in
<quote>free speech,
</quote> <quote>free markets,
</quote>
379 <quote>free trade,
</quote> <quote>free enterprise,
</quote> <quote>free will,
</quote> and
<quote>free elections.
</quote> A
380 free culture supports and protects creators and innovators. It does
381 this directly by granting intellectual property rights. But it does so
382 indirectly by limiting the reach of those rights, to guarantee that
383 follow-on creators and innovators remain
<emphasis>as free as
384 possible
</emphasis> from the control of the past. A free culture is
385 not a culture without property, just as a free market is not a market
386 in which everything is free. The opposite of a free culture is a
387 <quote>permission culture
</quote>—a culture in which creators get to create
388 only with the permission of the powerful, or of creators from the
392 If we understood this change, I believe we would resist it. Not
<quote>we
</quote>
393 on the Left or
<quote>you
</quote> on the Right, but we who have no stake in the
394 particular industries of culture that defined the twentieth century.
395 Whether you are on the Left or the Right, if you are in this sense
396 disinterested, then the story I tell here will trouble you. For the
397 changes I describe affect values that both sides of our political
398 culture deem fundamental.
400 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
401 <indexterm><primary>Stevens, Ted
</primary></indexterm>
403 We saw a glimpse of this bipartisan outrage in the early summer of
404 2003. As the FCC considered changes in media ownership rules that
405 would relax limits on media concentration, an extraordinary coalition
406 generated more than
700,
000 letters to the FCC opposing the change.
407 As William Safire described marching
<quote>uncomfortably alongside CodePink
408 Women for Peace and the National Rifle Association, between liberal
409 Olympia Snowe and conservative Ted Stevens,
</quote> he formulated perhaps
410 most simply just what was at stake: the concentration of power. And as
412 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
416 Does that sound unconservative? Not to me. The concentration of
417 power
—political, corporate, media, cultural
—should be anathema to
418 conservatives. The diffusion of power through local control, thereby
419 encouraging individual participation, is the essence of federalism and
420 the greatest expression of democracy.
<footnote><para> William Safire,
421 <quote>The Great Media Gulp,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 May
2003.
422 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
427 This idea is an element of the argument of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle>, though my
428 focus is not just on the concentration of power produced by
429 concentrations in ownership, but more importantly, if because less
430 visibly, on the concentration of power produced by a radical change in
431 the effective scope of the law. The law is changing; that change is
432 altering the way our culture gets made; that change should worry
433 you
—whether or not you care about the Internet, and whether you're on
434 Safire's left or on his right.
437 <emphasis role=
"strong">The inspiration
</emphasis> for the title and for
438 much of the argument of this book comes from the work of Richard
439 Stallman and the Free Software Foundation. Indeed, as I reread
440 Stallman's own work, especially the essays in
<citetitle>Free Software, Free
441 Society
</citetitle>, I realize that all of the theoretical insights I develop here
442 are insights Stallman described decades ago. One could thus well argue
443 that this work is
<quote>merely
</quote> derivative.
446 I accept that criticism, if indeed it is a criticism. The work of a
447 lawyer is always derivative, and I mean to do nothing more in this
448 book than to remind a culture about a tradition that has always been
449 its own. Like Stallman, I defend that tradition on the basis of
450 values. Like Stallman, I believe those are the values of freedom. And
451 like Stallman, I believe those are values of our past that will need
452 to be defended in our future. A free culture has been our past, but it
453 will only be our future if we change the path we are on right now.
456 Like Stallman's arguments for free software, an argument for free
457 culture stumbles on a confusion that is hard to avoid, and even harder
458 to understand. A free culture is not a culture without property; it is not
459 a culture in which artists don't get paid. A culture without property, or
460 in which creators can't get paid, is anarchy, not freedom. Anarchy is not
464 Instead, the free culture that I defend in this book is a balance
465 between anarchy and control. A free culture, like a free market, is
466 filled with property. It is filled with rules of property and contract
467 that get enforced by the state. But just as a free market is perverted
468 if its property becomes feudal, so too can a free culture be queered
469 by extremism in the property rights that define it. That is what I
470 fear about our culture today. It is against that extremism that this
475 <!-- PAGE BREAK 15 -->
477 <!-- PAGE BREAK 16 -->
478 <chapter label=
"0" id=
"c-introduction">
479 <title>INTRODUCTION
</title>
480 <indexterm id='idxairtraffic' class='startofrange'
>
481 <primary>air traffic, land ownership vs.
</primary>
483 <indexterm id='idxlandownership' class='startofrange'
>
484 <primary>land ownership, air traffic and
</primary>
486 <indexterm id='idxproprigtair' class='startofrange'
>
487 <primary>property rights
</primary>
488 <secondary>air traffic vs.
</secondary>
490 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
492 <emphasis role=
"strong">On December
17</emphasis>,
1903, on a windy North Carolina beach for just
493 shy of one hundred seconds, the Wright brothers demonstrated that a
494 heavier-than-air, self-propelled vehicle could fly. The moment was electric
495 and its importance widely understood. Almost immediately, there
496 was an explosion of interest in this newfound technology of manned
497 flight, and a gaggle of innovators began to build upon it.
500 At the time the Wright brothers invented the airplane, American
501 law held that a property owner presumptively owned not just the surface
502 of his land, but all the land below, down to the center of the earth,
503 and all the space above, to
<quote>an indefinite extent, upwards.
</quote><footnote><para>
504 St. George Tucker,
<citetitle>Blackstone's Commentaries
</citetitle> 3 (South Hackensack, N.J.:
505 Rothman Reprints,
1969),
18.
508 years, scholars had puzzled about how best to interpret the idea that
509 rights in land ran to the heavens. Did that mean that you owned the
510 stars? Could you prosecute geese for their willful and regular trespass?
513 Then came airplanes, and for the first time, this principle of American
514 law
—deep within the foundations of our tradition, and acknowledged
515 by the most important legal thinkers of our past
—mattered. If
516 my land reaches to the heavens, what happens when United flies over
517 my field? Do I have the right to banish it from my property? Am I allowed
518 to enter into an exclusive license with Delta Airlines? Could we
519 set up an auction to decide how much these rights are worth?
521 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
522 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
524 In
1945, these questions became a federal case. When North Carolina
525 farmers Thomas Lee and Tinie Causby started losing chickens
526 because of low-flying military aircraft (the terrified chickens apparently
527 flew into the barn walls and died), the Causbys filed a lawsuit saying
528 that the government was trespassing on their land. The airplanes,
529 of course, never touched the surface of the Causbys' land. But if, as
530 Blackstone, Kent, and Coke had said, their land reached to
<quote>an indefinite
531 extent, upwards,
</quote> then the government was trespassing on their
532 property, and the Causbys wanted it to stop.
534 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
535 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
537 The Supreme Court agreed to hear the Causbys' case. Congress had
538 declared the airways public, but if one's property really extended to the
539 heavens, then Congress's declaration could well have been an unconstitutional
540 <quote>taking
</quote> of property without compensation. The Court acknowledged
541 that
<quote>it is ancient doctrine that common law ownership of
542 the land extended to the periphery of the universe.
</quote> But Justice Douglas
543 had no patience for ancient doctrine. In a single paragraph, hundreds of
544 years of property law were erased. As he wrote for the Court,
548 [The] doctrine has no place in the modern world. The air is a
549 public highway, as Congress has declared. Were that not true,
550 every transcontinental flight would subject the operator to countless
551 trespass suits. Common sense revolts at the idea. To recognize
552 such private claims to the airspace would clog these highways,
553 seriously interfere with their control and development in the public
554 interest, and transfer into private ownership that to which only
555 the public has a just claim.
<footnote>
557 United States v. Causby, U.S.
328 (
1946):
256,
261. The Court did find
558 that there could be a
<quote>taking
</quote> if the government's use of its land
559 effectively destroyed the value of the Causbys' land. This example was
560 suggested to me by Keith Aoki's wonderful piece,
<quote>(Intellectual)
561 Property and Sovereignty: Notes Toward a Cultural Geography of
562 Authorship,
</quote> <citetitle>Stanford Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1996):
1293,
1333. See also Paul
563 Goldstein,
<citetitle>Real Property
</citetitle> (Mineola, N.Y.: Foundation Press,
1984),
565 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
566 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
571 <quote>Common sense revolts at the idea.
</quote>
574 This is how the law usually works. Not often this abruptly or
575 impatiently, but eventually, this is how it works. It was Douglas's style not to
576 dither. Other justices would have blathered on for pages to reach the
578 conclusion that Douglas holds in a single line:
<quote>Common sense revolts
579 at the idea.
</quote> But whether it takes pages or a few words, it is the special
580 genius of a common law system, as ours is, that the law adjusts to the
581 technologies of the time. And as it adjusts, it changes. Ideas that were
582 as solid as rock in one age crumble in another.
584 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
585 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
586 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
588 Or at least, this is how things happen when there's no one powerful
589 on the other side of the change. The Causbys were just farmers. And
590 though there were no doubt many like them who were upset by the
591 growing traffic in the air (though one hopes not many chickens flew
592 themselves into walls), the Causbys of the world would find it very
593 hard to unite and stop the idea, and the technology, that the Wright
594 brothers had birthed. The Wright brothers spat airplanes into the
595 technological meme pool; the idea then spread like a virus in a chicken
596 coop; farmers like the Causbys found themselves surrounded by
<quote>what
597 seemed reasonable
</quote> given the technology that the Wrights had produced.
598 They could stand on their farms, dead chickens in hand, and
599 shake their fists at these newfangled technologies all they wanted.
600 They could call their representatives or even file a lawsuit. But in the
601 end, the force of what seems
<quote>obvious
</quote> to everyone else
—the power of
602 <quote>common sense
</quote>—would prevail. Their
<quote>private interest
</quote> would not be
603 allowed to defeat an obvious public gain.
605 <indexterm startref='idxproprigtair' class='endofrange'
/>
606 <indexterm startref='idxlandownership' class='endofrange'
/>
607 <indexterm startref='idxairtraffic' class='endofrange'
/>
608 <indexterm id='idxarmstrongedwin' class='startofrange'
>
609 <primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary>
611 <indexterm><primary>Bell, Alexander Graham
</primary></indexterm>
612 <indexterm><primary>Edison, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
613 <indexterm><primary>Faraday, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
615 <emphasis role='strong'
>Edwin Howard Armstrong
</emphasis> is one of
616 America's forgotten inventor geniuses. He came to the great American
617 inventor scene just after the titans Thomas Edison and Alexander
618 Graham Bell. But his work in the area of radio technology was perhaps
619 the most important of any single inventor in the first fifty years of
620 radio. He was better educated than Michael Faraday, who as a
621 bookbinder's apprentice had discovered electric induction in
1831. But
622 he had the same intuition about how the world of radio worked, and on
623 at least three occasions, Armstrong invented profoundly important
624 technologies that advanced our understanding of radio.
625 <!-- PAGE BREAK 19 -->
628 On the day after Christmas,
1933, four patents were issued to Armstrong
629 for his most significant invention
—FM radio. Until then, consumer radio
630 had been amplitude-modulated (AM) radio. The theorists
631 of the day had said that frequency-modulated (FM) radio could never
632 work. They were right about FM radio in a narrow band of spectrum.
633 But Armstrong discovered that frequency-modulated radio in a wide
634 band of spectrum would deliver an astonishing fidelity of sound, with
635 much less transmitter power and static.
638 On November
5,
1935, he demonstrated the technology at a meeting of
639 the Institute of Radio Engineers at the Empire State Building in New
640 York City. He tuned his radio dial across a range of AM stations,
641 until the radio locked on a broadcast that he had arranged from
642 seventeen miles away. The radio fell totally silent, as if dead, and
643 then with a clarity no one else in that room had ever heard from an
644 electrical device, it produced the sound of an announcer's voice:
645 <quote>This is amateur station W2AG at Yonkers, New York, operating on
646 frequency modulation at two and a half meters.
</quote>
649 The audience was hearing something no one had thought possible:
653 A glass of water was poured before the microphone in Yonkers; it
654 sounded like a glass of water being poured.
… A paper was crumpled
655 and torn; it sounded like paper and not like a crackling forest
656 fire.
… Sousa marches were played from records and a piano solo
657 and guitar number were performed.
… The music was projected with a
658 live-ness rarely if ever heard before from a radio
<quote>music
659 box.
</quote><footnote><para>
660 Lawrence Lessing,
<citetitle>Man of High Fidelity: Edwin Howard Armstrong
</citetitle>
661 (Philadelphia: J. B. Lipincott Company,
1956),
209.
666 As our own common sense tells us, Armstrong had discovered a vastly
667 superior radio technology. But at the time of his invention, Armstrong
668 was working for RCA. RCA was the dominant player in the then dominant
669 AM radio market. By
1935, there were a thousand radio stations across
670 the United States, but the stations in large cities were all owned by
671 a handful of networks.
675 RCA's president, David Sarnoff, a friend of Armstrong's, was eager
676 that Armstrong discover a way to remove static from AM radio. So
677 Sarnoff was quite excited when Armstrong told him he had a device
678 that removed static from
<quote>radio.
</quote> But when Armstrong demonstrated
679 his invention, Sarnoff was not pleased.
680 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
684 I thought Armstrong would invent some kind of a filter to remove
685 static from our AM radio. I didn't think he'd start a
686 revolution
— start up a whole damn new industry to compete with
687 RCA.
<footnote><para> See
<quote>Saints: The Heroes and Geniuses of the
688 Electronic Era,
</quote> First Electronic Church of America, at
689 www.webstationone.com/fecha, available at
691 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
1</ulink>.
695 <indexterm id='idxlessing' class='startofrange'
>
696 <primary>Lessing, Lawrence
</primary>
699 Armstrong's invention threatened RCA's AM empire, so the company
700 launched a campaign to smother FM radio. While FM may have been a
701 superior technology, Sarnoff was a superior tactician. As one author
703 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
707 The forces for FM, largely engineering, could not overcome the weight
708 of strategy devised by the sales, patent, and legal offices to subdue
709 this threat to corporate position. For FM, if allowed to develop
710 unrestrained, posed
… a complete reordering of radio power
711 … and the eventual overthrow of the carefully restricted AM system
712 on which RCA had grown to power.
<footnote><para>Lessing,
226.
717 RCA at first kept the technology in house, insisting that further
718 tests were needed. When, after two years of testing, Armstrong grew
719 impatient, RCA began to use its power with the government to stall
720 FM radio's deployment generally. In
1936, RCA hired the former head
721 of the FCC and assigned him the task of assuring that the FCC assign
722 spectrum in a way that would castrate FM
—principally by moving FM
723 radio to a different band of spectrum. At first, these efforts failed. But
724 when Armstrong and the nation were distracted by World War II,
725 RCA's work began to be more successful. Soon after the war ended, the
726 FCC announced a set of policies that would have one clear effect: FM
727 radio would be crippled. As Lawrence Lessing described it,
729 <!-- PAGE BREAK 21 -->
732 The series of body blows that FM radio received right after the
733 war, in a series of rulings manipulated through the FCC by the
734 big radio interests, were almost incredible in their force and
735 deviousness.
<footnote><para>
740 <indexterm startref='idxlessing' class='endofrange'
/>
741 <indexterm><primary>AT
&T
</primary></indexterm>
743 To make room in the spectrum for RCA's latest gamble, television,
744 FM radio users were to be moved to a totally new spectrum band. The
745 power of FM radio stations was also cut, meaning FM could no longer
746 be used to beam programs from one part of the country to another.
747 (This change was strongly supported by AT
&T, because the loss of
748 FM relaying stations would mean radio stations would have to buy
749 wired links from AT
&T.) The spread of FM radio was thus choked, at
753 Armstrong resisted RCA's efforts. In response, RCA resisted
754 Armstrong's patents. After incorporating FM technology into the
755 emerging standard for television, RCA declared the patents
756 invalid
—baselessly, and almost fifteen years after they were
757 issued. It thus refused to pay him royalties. For six years, Armstrong
758 fought an expensive war of litigation to defend the patents. Finally,
759 just as the patents expired, RCA offered a settlement so low that it
760 would not even cover Armstrong's lawyers' fees. Defeated, broken, and
761 now broke, in
1954 Armstrong wrote a short note to his wife and then
762 stepped out of a thirteenth-story window to his death.
764 <indexterm startref='idxarmstrongedwin' class='endofrange'
/>
766 This is how the law sometimes works. Not often this tragically, and
767 rarely with heroic drama, but sometimes, this is how it works. From
768 the beginning, government and government agencies have been subject to
769 capture. They are more likely captured when a powerful interest is
770 threatened by either a legal or technical change. That powerful
771 interest too often exerts its influence within the government to get
772 the government to protect it. The rhetoric of this protection is of
773 course always public spirited; the reality is something
774 different. Ideas that were as solid as rock in one age, but that, left
775 to themselves, would crumble in
777 another, are sustained through this subtle corruption of our political
778 process. RCA had what the Causbys did not: the power to stifle the
779 effect of technological change.
782 <emphasis role=
"strong">There's no
</emphasis> single inventor of the Internet. Nor is there any good date
783 upon which to mark its birth. Yet in a very short time, the Internet
784 has become part of ordinary American life. According to the Pew
785 Internet and American Life Project,
58 percent of Americans had access
786 to the Internet in
2002, up from
49 percent two years
787 before.
<footnote><para>
788 Amanda Lenhart,
<quote>The Ever-Shifting Internet Population: A New Look at
789 Internet Access and the Digital Divide,
</quote> Pew Internet and American
790 Life Project,
15 April
2003:
6, available at
791 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
2</ulink>.
793 That number could well exceed two thirds of the nation by the end
797 As the Internet has been integrated into ordinary life, it has
798 changed things. Some of these changes are technical
—the Internet has
799 made communication faster, it has lowered the cost of gathering data,
800 and so on. These technical changes are not the focus of this book. They
801 are important. They are not well understood. But they are the sort of
802 thing that would simply go away if we all just switched the Internet off.
803 They don't affect people who don't use the Internet, or at least they
804 don't affect them directly. They are the proper subject of a book about
805 the Internet. But this is not a book about the Internet.
808 Instead, this book is about an effect of the Internet beyond the
809 Internet itself: an effect upon how culture is made. My claim is that
810 the Internet has induced an important and unrecognized change in that
811 process. That change will radically transform a tradition that is as
812 old as the Republic itself. Most, if they recognized this change,
813 would reject it. Yet most don't even see the change that the Internet
817 We can glimpse a sense of this change by distinguishing between
818 commercial and noncommercial culture, and by mapping the law's
819 regulation of each. By
<quote>commercial culture
</quote> I mean that part of our
820 culture that is produced and sold or produced to be sold. By
821 <quote>noncommercial culture
</quote> I mean all the rest. When old men sat around
823 <!-- PAGE BREAK 23 -->
824 street corners telling stories that kids and others consumed, that was
825 noncommercial culture. When Noah Webster published his
<quote>Reader,
</quote> or
826 Joel Barlow his poetry, that was commercial culture.
827 <indexterm><primary>Barlow, Joel
</primary></indexterm>
828 <indexterm><primary>Webster, Noah
</primary></indexterm>
831 At the beginning of our history, and for just about the whole of our
832 tradition, noncommercial culture was essentially unregulated. Of
833 course, if your stories were lewd, or if your song disturbed the
834 peace, then the law might intervene. But the law was never directly
835 concerned with the creation or spread of this form of culture, and it
836 left this culture
<quote>free.
</quote> The ordinary ways in which ordinary
837 individuals shared and transformed their culture
—telling
838 stories, reenacting scenes from plays or TV, participating in fan
839 clubs, sharing music, making tapes
—were left alone by the law.
842 The focus of the law was on commercial creativity. At first slightly,
843 then quite extensively, the law protected the incentives of creators by
844 granting them exclusive rights to their creative work, so that they could
845 sell those exclusive rights in a commercial
846 marketplace.
<footnote>
848 This is not the only purpose of copyright, though it is the overwhelmingly
849 primary purpose of the copyright established in the federal constitution.
850 State copyright law historically protected not just the commercial interest in
851 publication, but also a privacy interest. By granting authors the exclusive
852 right to first publication, state copyright law gave authors the power to
853 control the spread of facts about them. See Samuel D. Warren and Louis
854 D. Brandeis,
<quote>The Right to Privacy,
</quote> Harvard Law Review
4 (
1890):
193,
856 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
858 This is also, of course, an important part of creativity and culture,
859 and it has become an increasingly important part in America. But in no
860 sense was it dominant within our tradition. It was instead just one
861 part, a controlled part, balanced with the free.
864 This rough divide between the free and the controlled has now
865 been erased.
<footnote><para>
866 See Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Prometheus Books,
868 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
870 The Internet has set the stage for this erasure and, pushed by big
871 media, the law has now affected it. For the first time in our
872 tradition, the ordinary ways in which individuals create and share
873 culture fall within the reach of the regulation of the law, which has
874 expanded to draw within its control a vast amount of culture and
875 creativity that it never reached before. The technology that preserved
876 the balance of our history
—between uses of our culture that were
877 free and uses of our culture that were only upon permission
—has
878 been undone. The consequence is that we are less and less a free
879 culture, more and more a permission culture.
881 <!-- PAGE BREAK 24 -->
883 This change gets justified as necessary to protect commercial
884 creativity. And indeed, protectionism is precisely its
885 motivation. But the protectionism that justifies the changes that I
886 will describe below is not the limited and balanced sort that has
887 defined the law in the past. This is not a protectionism to protect
888 artists. It is instead a protectionism to protect certain forms of
889 business. Corporations threatened by the potential of the Internet to
890 change the way both commercial and noncommercial culture are made and
891 shared have united to induce lawmakers to use the law to protect
892 them. It is the story of RCA and Armstrong; it is the dream of the
896 For the Internet has unleashed an extraordinary possibility for many
897 to participate in the process of building and cultivating a culture
898 that reaches far beyond local boundaries. That power has changed the
899 marketplace for making and cultivating culture generally, and that
900 change in turn threatens established content industries. The Internet
901 is thus to the industries that built and distributed content in the
902 twentieth century what FM radio was to AM radio, or what the truck was
903 to the railroad industry of the nineteenth century: the beginning of
904 the end, or at least a substantial transformation. Digital
905 technologies, tied to the Internet, could produce a vastly more
906 competitive and vibrant market for building and cultivating culture;
907 that market could include a much wider and more diverse range of
908 creators; those creators could produce and distribute a much more
909 vibrant range of creativity; and depending upon a few important
910 factors, those creators could earn more on average from this system
911 than creators do today
—all so long as the RCAs of our day don't
912 use the law to protect themselves against this competition.
915 Yet, as I argue in the pages that follow, that is precisely what is
916 happening in our culture today. These modern-day equivalents of the
917 early twentieth-century radio or nineteenth-century railroads are
918 using their power to get the law to protect them against this new,
919 more efficient, more vibrant technology for building culture. They are
920 succeeding in their plan to remake the Internet before the Internet
924 It doesn't seem this way to many. The battles over copyright and the
925 <!-- PAGE BREAK 25 -->
926 Internet seem remote to most. To the few who follow them, they seem
927 mainly about a much simpler brace of questions
—whether
<quote>piracy
</quote> will
928 be permitted, and whether
<quote>property
</quote> will be protected. The
<quote>war
</quote> that
929 has been waged against the technologies of the Internet
—what
930 Motion Picture Association of America (MPAA) president Jack Valenti
931 calls his
<quote>own terrorist war
</quote><footnote><para>
932 Amy Harmon,
<quote>Black Hawk Download: Moving Beyond Music, Pirates
933 Use New Tools to Turn the Net into an Illicit Video Club,
</quote> <citetitle>New York
934 Times
</citetitle>,
17 January
2002.
935 </para></footnote>—has been framed as a battle about the
936 rule of law and respect for property. To know which side to take in this
937 war, most think that we need only decide whether we're for property or
941 If those really were the choices, then I would be with Jack Valenti
942 and the content industry. I, too, am a believer in property, and
943 especially in the importance of what Mr. Valenti nicely calls
944 <quote>creative property.
</quote> I believe that
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong, and that the
945 law, properly tuned, should punish
<quote>piracy,
</quote> whether on or off the
949 But those simple beliefs mask a much more fundamental question
950 and a much more dramatic change. My fear is that unless we come to see
951 this change, the war to rid the world of Internet
<quote>pirates
</quote> will also rid our
952 culture of values that have been integral to our tradition from the start.
955 These values built a tradition that, for at least the first
180 years of
956 our Republic, guaranteed creators the right to build freely upon their
957 past, and protected creators and innovators from either state or private
958 control. The First Amendment protected creators against state control.
959 And as Professor Neil Netanel powerfully argues,
<footnote>
961 Neil W. Netanel,
<quote>Copyright and a Democratic Civil Society,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law
962 Journal
</citetitle> 106 (
1996):
283.
963 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
965 copyright law, properly balanced, protected creators against private
966 control. Our tradition was thus neither Soviet nor the tradition of
967 patrons. It instead carved out a wide berth within which creators
968 could cultivate and extend our culture.
971 Yet the law's response to the Internet, when tied to changes in the
972 technology of the Internet itself, has massively increased the
973 effective regulation of creativity in America. To build upon or
974 critique the culture around us one must ask, Oliver Twist
–like,
975 for permission first. Permission is, of course, often
976 granted
—but it is not often granted to the critical or the
977 independent. We have built a kind of cultural nobility; those within
978 the noble class live easily; those outside it don't. But it is
979 nobility of any form that is alien to our tradition.
981 <!-- PAGE BREAK 26. FIXME: Should "Is it" be "It is" ? -->
983 The story that follows is about this war. Is it not about the
984 <quote>centrality of technology
</quote> to ordinary life. I don't believe in gods,
985 digital or otherwise. Nor is it an effort to demonize any individual
986 or group, for neither do I believe in a devil, corporate or
987 otherwise. It is not a morality tale. Nor is it a call to jihad
991 It is instead an effort to understand a hopelessly destructive war
992 inspired by the technologies of the Internet but reaching far beyond
993 its code. And by understanding this battle, it is an effort to map
994 peace. There is no good reason for the current struggle around
995 Internet technologies to continue. There will be great harm to our
996 tradition and culture if it is allowed to continue unchecked. We must
997 come to understand the source of this war. We must resolve it soon.
999 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1000 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1002 <emphasis role=
"strong">Like the Causbys'
</emphasis> battle, this war is, in part, about
<quote>property.
</quote> The
1003 property of this war is not as tangible as the Causbys', and no
1004 innocent chicken has yet to lose its life. Yet the ideas surrounding
1005 this
<quote>property
</quote> are as obvious to most as the Causbys' claim about the
1006 sacredness of their farm was to them. We are the Causbys. Most of us
1007 take for granted the extraordinarily powerful claims that the owners
1008 of
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> now assert. Most of us, like the Causbys,
1009 treat these claims as obvious. And hence we, like the Causbys, object
1010 when a new technology interferes with this property. It is as plain to
1011 us as it was to them that the new technologies of the Internet are
1012 <quote>trespassing
</quote> upon legitimate claims of
<quote>property.
</quote> It is as plain to
1013 us as it was to them that the law should intervene to stop this
1016 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1017 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1018 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
1020 And thus, when geeks and technologists defend their Armstrong or
1021 Wright brothers technology, most of us are simply unsympathetic.
1022 Common sense does not revolt. Unlike in the case of the unlucky
1023 Causbys, common sense is on the side of the property owners in this
1025 <!--PAGE BREAK 27-->
1026 the lucky Wright brothers, the Internet has not inspired a revolution
1030 My hope is to push this common sense along. I have become increasingly
1031 amazed by the power of this idea of intellectual property and, more
1032 importantly, its power to disable critical thought by policy makers
1033 and citizens. There has never been a time in our history when more of
1034 our
<quote>culture
</quote> was as
<quote>owned
</quote> as it is now. And yet there has never
1035 been a time when the concentration of power to control the
1036 <emphasis>uses
</emphasis> of culture has been as unquestioningly
1037 accepted as it is now.
1040 The puzzle is, Why? Is it because we have come to understand a truth
1041 about the value and importance of absolute property over ideas and
1042 culture? Is it because we have discovered that our tradition of
1043 rejecting such an absolute claim was wrong?
1046 Or is it because the idea of absolute property over ideas and culture
1047 benefits the RCAs of our time and fits our own unreflective intuitions?
1050 Is the radical shift away from our tradition of free culture an instance
1051 of America correcting a mistake from its past, as we did after a bloody
1052 war with slavery, and as we are slowly doing with inequality? Or is the
1053 radical shift away from our tradition of free culture yet another example
1054 of a political system captured by a few powerful special interests?
1057 Does common sense lead to the extremes on this question because common
1058 sense actually believes in these extremes? Or does common sense stand
1059 silent in the face of these extremes because, as with Armstrong versus
1060 RCA, the more powerful side has ensured that it has the more powerful
1063 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1064 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1066 I don't mean to be mysterious. My own views are resolved. I believe it
1067 was right for common sense to revolt against the extremism of the
1068 Causbys. I believe it would be right for common sense to revolt
1069 against the extreme claims made today on behalf of
<quote>intellectual
1070 property.
</quote> What the law demands today is increasingly as silly as a
1071 sheriff arresting an airplane for trespass. But the consequences of
1072 this silliness will be much more profound.
1073 <!-- PAGE BREAK 28 -->
1076 <emphasis role=
"strong">The struggle
</emphasis> that rages just now centers on two ideas:
<quote>piracy
</quote> and
1077 <quote>property.
</quote> My aim in this book's next two parts is to explore these two
1081 My method is not the usual method of an academic. I don't want to
1082 plunge you into a complex argument, buttressed with references to
1083 obscure French theorists
—however natural that is for the weird
1084 sort we academics have become. Instead I begin in each part with a
1085 collection of stories that set a context within which these apparently
1086 simple ideas can be more fully understood.
1089 The two sections set up the core claim of this book: that while the
1090 Internet has indeed produced something fantastic and new, our
1091 government, pushed by big media to respond to this
<quote>something new,
</quote> is
1092 destroying something very old. Rather than understanding the changes
1093 the Internet might permit, and rather than taking time to let
<quote>common
1094 sense
</quote> resolve how best to respond, we are allowing those most
1095 threatened by the changes to use their power to change the
1096 law
—and more importantly, to use their power to change something
1097 fundamental about who we have always been.
1100 We allow this, I believe, not because it is right, and not because
1101 most of us really believe in these changes. We allow it because the
1102 interests most threatened are among the most powerful players in our
1103 depressingly compromised process of making law. This book is the story
1104 of one more consequence of this form of corruption
—a consequence
1105 to which most of us remain oblivious.
1108 <!-- PAGE BREAK 29 -->
1109 <part id=
"c-piracy">
1110 <title><quote>PIRACY
</quote></title>
1112 <!-- PAGE BREAK 30 -->
1113 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield1" class='startofrange'
>
1114 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
1117 <emphasis role=
"strong">Since the inception
</emphasis> of the law regulating creative property, there has
1118 been a war against
<quote>piracy.
</quote> The precise contours of this concept,
1119 <quote>piracy,
</quote> are hard to sketch, but the animating injustice is easy to
1120 capture. As Lord Mansfield wrote in a case that extended the reach of
1121 English copyright law to include sheet music,
1125 A person may use the copy by playing it, but he has no right to
1126 rob the author of the profit, by multiplying copies and disposing
1127 of them for his own use.
<footnote><para>
1129 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777) (Mansfield).
1132 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield1" class='endofrange'
/>
1135 Today we are in the middle of another
<quote>war
</quote> against
<quote>piracy.
</quote> The
1136 Internet has provoked this war. The Internet makes possible the
1137 efficient spread of content. Peer-to-peer (p2p) file sharing is among
1138 the most efficient of the efficient technologies the Internet
1139 enables. Using distributed intelligence, p2p systems facilitate the
1140 easy spread of content in a way unimagined a generation ago.
1141 <!-- PAGE BREAK 31 -->
1144 This efficiency does not respect the traditional lines of copyright.
1145 The network doesn't discriminate between the sharing of copyrighted
1146 and uncopyrighted content. Thus has there been a vast amount of
1147 sharing of copyrighted content. That sharing in turn has excited the
1148 war, as copyright owners fear the sharing will
<quote>rob the author of the
1152 The warriors have turned to the courts, to the legislatures, and
1153 increasingly to technology to defend their
<quote>property
</quote> against this
1154 <quote>piracy.
</quote> A generation of Americans, the warriors warn, is being
1155 raised to believe that
<quote>property
</quote> should be
<quote>free.
</quote> Forget tattoos,
1156 never mind body piercing
—our kids are becoming
1157 <emphasis>thieves
</emphasis>!
1160 There's no doubt that
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong, and that pirates should be
1161 punished. But before we summon the executioners, we should put this
1162 notion of
<quote>piracy
</quote> in some context. For as the concept is increasingly
1163 used, at its core is an extraordinary idea that is almost certainly wrong.
1166 The idea goes something like this:
1170 Creative work has value; whenever I use, or take, or build upon
1171 the creative work of others, I am taking from them something of
1172 value. Whenever I take something of value from someone else, I
1173 should have their permission. The taking of something of value
1174 from someone else without permission is wrong. It is a form of
1178 <indexterm><primary>Dreyfuss, Rochelle
</primary></indexterm>
1179 <indexterm><primary>Girl Schouts
</primary></indexterm>
1180 <indexterm id='idxifvalue' class='startofrange'
>
1181 <primary><quote>if value, then right
</quote> theory
</primary>
1184 This view runs deep within the current debates. It is what NYU law
1185 professor Rochelle Dreyfuss criticizes as the
<quote>if value, then right
</quote>
1186 theory of creative property
<footnote><para>
1188 See Rochelle Dreyfuss,
<quote>Expressive Genericity: Trademarks as Language
1189 in the Pepsi Generation,
</quote> <citetitle>Notre Dame Law Review
</citetitle> 65 (
1990):
397.
1191 —if there is value, then someone must have a
1192 right to that value. It is the perspective that led a composers' rights
1193 organization, ASCAP, to sue the Girl Scouts for failing to pay for the
1194 songs that girls sang around Girl Scout campfires.
<footnote><para>
1196 Lisa Bannon,
<quote>The Birds May Sing, but Campers Can't Unless They Pay
1197 Up,
</quote> <citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
21 August
1996, available at
1198 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
3</ulink>; Jonathan
1199 Zittrain,
<quote>Calling Off the Copyright War: In Battle of Property vs. Free
1200 Speech, No One Wins,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
24 November
2002.
1201 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
1203 There was
<quote>value
</quote> (the songs) so there must have been a
1204 <quote>right
</quote>—even against the Girl Scouts.
1206 <indexterm><primary>ASCAP
</primary></indexterm>
1208 This idea is certainly a possible understanding of how creative
1209 property should work. It might well be a possible design for a system
1210 <!-- PAGE BREAK 32 -->
1211 of law protecting creative property. But the
<quote>if value, then right
</quote>
1212 theory of creative property has never been America's theory of
1213 creative property. It has never taken hold within our law.
1215 <indexterm startref='idxifvalue' class='endofrange'
/>
1217 Instead, in our tradition, intellectual property is an instrument. It
1218 sets the groundwork for a richly creative society but remains
1219 subservient to the value of creativity. The current debate has this
1220 turned around. We have become so concerned with protecting the
1221 instrument that we are losing sight of the value.
1224 The source of this confusion is a distinction that the law no longer
1225 takes care to draw
—the distinction between republishing someone's
1226 work on the one hand and building upon or transforming that work on
1227 the other. Copyright law at its birth had only publishing as its concern;
1228 copyright law today regulates both.
1231 Before the technologies of the Internet, this conflation didn't matter
1232 all that much. The technologies of publishing were expensive; that
1233 meant the vast majority of publishing was commercial. Commercial
1234 entities could bear the burden of the law
—even the burden of the
1235 Byzantine complexity that copyright law has become. It was just one
1236 more expense of doing business.
1238 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1239 <indexterm><primary>Rise of the Creative Class, The (Florida)
</primary></indexterm>
1241 But with the birth of the Internet, this natural limit to the reach of
1242 the law has disappeared. The law controls not just the creativity of
1243 commercial creators but effectively that of anyone. Although that
1244 expansion would not matter much if copyright law regulated only
1245 <quote>copying,
</quote> when the law regulates as broadly and obscurely as it does,
1246 the extension matters a lot. The burden of this law now vastly
1247 outweighs any original benefit
—certainly as it affects
1248 noncommercial creativity, and increasingly as it affects commercial
1249 creativity as well. Thus, as we'll see more clearly in the chapters
1250 below, the law's role is less and less to support creativity, and more
1251 and more to protect certain industries against competition. Just at
1252 the time digital technology could unleash an extraordinary range of
1253 commercial and noncommercial creativity, the law burdens this
1254 creativity with insanely complex and vague rules and with the threat
1255 of obscenely severe penalties. We may
1256 <!-- PAGE BREAK 33 -->
1257 be seeing, as Richard Florida writes, the
<quote>Rise of the Creative
1258 Class.
</quote><footnote>
1261 In
<citetitle>The Rise of the Creative Class
</citetitle> (New York:
1262 Basic Books,
2002), Richard Florida documents a shift in the nature of
1263 labor toward a labor of creativity. His work, however, doesn't
1264 directly address the legal conditions under which that creativity is
1265 enabled or stifled. I certainly agree with him about the importance
1266 and significance of this change, but I also believe the conditions
1267 under which it will be enabled are much more tenuous.
1269 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1270 <indexterm><primary>Rise of the Creative Class, The (Florida)
</primary></indexterm>
1272 Unfortunately, we are also seeing an extraordinary rise of regulation of
1273 this creative class.
1276 These burdens make no sense in our tradition. We should begin by
1277 understanding that tradition a bit more and by placing in their proper
1278 context the current battles about behavior labeled
<quote>piracy.
</quote>
1282 <!-- PAGE BREAK 34 -->
1283 <chapter label=
"1" id=
"creators">
1284 <title>CHAPTER ONE: Creators
</title>
1285 <indexterm id=
"idxanimadedcartoons" class='startofrange'
>
1286 <primary>animated cartoons
</primary>
1289 <emphasis role=
"strong">In
1928</emphasis>, a cartoon character was born. An early Mickey Mouse
1290 made his debut in May of that year, in a silent flop called
<citetitle>Plane Crazy
</citetitle>.
1291 In November, in New York City's Colony Theater, in the first widely
1292 distributed cartoon synchronized with sound,
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle> brought
1293 to life the character that would become Mickey Mouse.
1296 Synchronized sound had been introduced to film a year earlier in the
1297 movie
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle>. That success led Walt Disney to copy the
1298 technique and mix sound with cartoons. No one knew whether it would
1299 work or, if it did work, whether it would win an audience. But when
1300 Disney ran a test in the summer of
1928, the results were unambiguous.
1301 As Disney describes that first experiment,
1305 A couple of my boys could read music, and one of them could play
1306 a mouth organ. We put them in a room where they could not see
1307 the screen and arranged to pipe their sound into the room where
1308 our wives and friends were going to see the picture.
1309 <!-- PAGE BREAK 35 -->
1312 The boys worked from a music and sound-effects score. After several
1313 false starts, sound and action got off with the gun. The mouth
1314 organist played the tune, the rest of us in the sound department
1315 bammed tin pans and blew slide whistles on the beat. The
1316 synchronization was pretty close.
1319 The effect on our little audience was nothing less than electric.
1320 They responded almost instinctively to this union of sound and
1321 motion. I thought they were kidding me. So they put me in the audience
1322 and ran the action again. It was terrible, but it was wonderful! And
1323 it was something new!
<footnote><para>
1325 Leonard Maltin,
<citetitle>Of Mice and Magic: A History of American Animated
1326 Cartoons
</citetitle> (New York: Penguin Books,
1987),
34–35.
1331 Disney's then partner, and one of animation's most extraordinary
1332 talents, Ub Iwerks, put it more strongly:
<quote>I have never been so thrilled
1333 in my life. Nothing since has ever equaled it.
</quote>
1334 <indexterm><primary>Iwerks, Ub
</primary></indexterm>
1337 Disney had created something very new, based upon something relatively
1338 new. Synchronized sound brought life to a form of creativity that had
1339 rarely
—except in Disney's hands
—been anything more than
1340 filler for other films. Throughout animation's early history, it was
1341 Disney's invention that set the standard that others struggled to
1342 match. And quite often, Disney's great genius, his spark of
1343 creativity, was built upon the work of others.
1346 This much is familiar. What you might not know is that
1928 also marks
1347 another important transition. In that year, a comic (as opposed to
1348 cartoon) genius created his last independently produced silent film.
1349 That genius was Buster Keaton. The film was
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>.
1352 Keaton was born into a vaudeville family in
1895. In the era of silent
1353 film, he had mastered using broad physical comedy as a way to spark
1354 uncontrollable laughter from his audience.
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1355 Jr
</citetitle>. was a classic of this form, famous among film buffs for its
1356 incredible stunts. The film was classic Keaton
—wildly popular
1357 and among the best of its genre.
1360 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. appeared before Disney's cartoon Steamboat
1362 <!-- PAGE BREAK 36 -->
1363 The coincidence of titles is not coincidental. Steamboat Willie is a
1364 direct cartoon parody of Steamboat Bill,
<footnote><para>
1366 I am grateful to David Gerstein and his careful history, described at
1367 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
4</ulink>.
1368 According to Dave Smith of the Disney Archives, Disney paid royalties to
1369 use the music for five songs in
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>:
<quote>Steamboat Bill,
</quote> <quote>The
1370 Simpleton
</quote> (Delille),
<quote>Mischief Makers
</quote> (Carbonara),
<quote>Joyful Hurry No.
1</quote>
1371 (Baron), and
<quote>Gawky Rube
</quote> (Lakay). A sixth song,
<quote>The Turkey in the
1372 Straw,
</quote> was already in the public domain. Letter from David Smith to
1373 Harry Surden,
10 July
2003, on file with author.
1375 and both are built upon a common song as a source. It is not just from
1376 the invention of synchronized sound in
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle> that we
1377 get
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>. It is also from Buster Keaton's invention of
1378 Steamboat Bill, Jr., itself inspired by the song
<quote>Steamboat Bill,
</quote>
1379 that we get Steamboat Willie, and then from Steamboat Willie, Mickey
1383 This
<quote>borrowing
</quote> was nothing unique, either for Disney or for the
1384 industry. Disney was always parroting the feature-length mainstream
1385 films of his day.
<footnote><para>
1387 He was also a fan of the public domain. See Chris Sprigman,
<quote>The Mouse
1388 that Ate the Public Domain,
</quote> Findlaw,
5 March
2002, at
1389 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
5</ulink>.
1391 So did many others. Early cartoons are filled with
1392 knockoffs
—slight variations on winning themes; retellings of
1393 ancient stories. The key to success was the brilliance of the
1394 differences. With Disney, it was sound that gave his animation its
1395 spark. Later, it was the quality of his work relative to the
1396 production-line cartoons with which he competed. Yet these additions
1397 were built upon a base that was borrowed. Disney added to the work of
1398 others before him, creating something new out of something just barely
1402 Sometimes this borrowing was slight. Sometimes it was significant.
1403 Think about the fairy tales of the Brothers Grimm. If you're as
1404 oblivious as I was, you're likely to think that these tales are happy,
1405 sweet stories, appropriate for any child at bedtime. In fact, the
1406 Grimm fairy tales are, well, for us, grim. It is a rare and perhaps
1407 overly ambitious parent who would dare to read these bloody,
1408 moralistic stories to his or her child, at bedtime or anytime.
1411 Disney took these stories and retold them in a way that carried them
1412 into a new age. He animated the stories, with both characters and
1413 light. Without removing the elements of fear and danger altogether, he
1414 made funny what was dark and injected a genuine emotion of compassion
1415 where before there was fear. And not just with the work of the
1416 Brothers Grimm. Indeed, the catalog of Disney work drawing upon the
1417 work of others is astonishing when set together:
<citetitle>Snow White
</citetitle>
1418 (
1937),
<citetitle>Fantasia
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Pinocchio
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Dumbo
</citetitle>
1419 (
1941),
<citetitle>Bambi
</citetitle> (
1942),
<citetitle>Song of the South
</citetitle> (
1946),
1420 <citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle> (
1950),
<citetitle>Alice in Wonderland
</citetitle> (
1951),
<citetitle>Robin
1421 Hood
</citetitle> (
1952),
<citetitle>Peter Pan
</citetitle> (
1953),
<citetitle>Lady and the Tramp
</citetitle>
1422 <!-- PAGE BREAK 37 -->
1423 (
1955),
<citetitle>Mulan
</citetitle> (
1998),
<citetitle>Sleeping Beauty
</citetitle> (
1959),
<citetitle>101
1424 Dalmatians
</citetitle> (
1961),
<citetitle>The Sword in the Stone
</citetitle> (
1963), and
1425 <citetitle>The Jungle Book
</citetitle> (
1967)
—not to mention a recent example
1426 that we should perhaps quickly forget,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>
1427 (
2003). In all of these cases, Disney (or Disney, Inc.) ripped
1428 creativity from the culture around him, mixed that creativity with his
1429 own extraordinary talent, and then burned that mix into the soul of
1430 his culture. Rip, mix, and burn.
1432 <indexterm startref=
"idxanimadedcartoons" class='endofrange'
/>
1434 This is a kind of creativity. It is a creativity that we should
1435 remember and celebrate. There are some who would say that there is no
1436 creativity except this kind. We don't need to go that far to recognize
1437 its importance. We could call this
<quote>Disney creativity,
</quote> though that
1438 would be a bit misleading. It is, more precisely,
<quote>Walt Disney
1439 creativity
</quote>—a form of expression and genius that builds upon the
1440 culture around us and makes it something different.
1442 <para> In
1928, the culture that Disney was free to draw upon was
1443 relatively fresh. The public domain in
1928 was not very old and was
1444 therefore quite vibrant. The average term of copyright was just around
1445 thirty years
—for that minority of creative work that was in fact
1446 copyrighted.
<footnote><para>
1448 Until
1976, copyright law granted an author the possibility of two terms: an
1449 initial term and a renewal term. I have calculated the
<quote>average
</quote> term by
1451 the weighted average of total registrations for any particular year,
1452 and the proportion renewing. Thus, if
100 copyrights are registered in year
1453 1, and only
15 are renewed, and the renewal term is
28 years, then the
1455 term is
32.2 years. For the renewal data and other relevant data, see the
1456 Web site associated with this book, available at
1457 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
6</ulink>.
1459 That means that for thirty years, on average, the authors or
1460 copyright holders of a creative work had an
<quote>exclusive right
</quote> to control
1461 certain uses of the work. To use this copyrighted work in limited ways
1462 required the permission of the copyright owner.
1465 At the end of a copyright term, a work passes into the public domain.
1466 No permission is then needed to draw upon or use that work. No
1467 permission and, hence, no lawyers. The public domain is a
<quote>lawyer-free
1468 zone.
</quote> Thus, most of the content from the nineteenth century was free
1469 for Disney to use and build upon in
1928. It was free for
1470 anyone
— whether connected or not, whether rich or not, whether
1471 approved or not
—to use and build upon.
1474 This is the ways things always were
—until quite recently. For most
1475 of our history, the public domain was just over the horizon. From
1476 until
1978, the average copyright term was never more than thirty-two
1477 years, meaning that most culture just a generation and a half old was
1479 <!-- PAGE BREAK 38 -->
1480 free for anyone to build upon without the permission of anyone else.
1481 Today's equivalent would be for creative work from the
1960s and
1970s
1482 to now be free for the next Walt Disney to build upon without
1483 permission. Yet today, the public domain is presumptive only for
1484 content from before the Great Depression.
1487 <emphasis role=
"strong">Of course
</emphasis>, Walt Disney had no monopoly on
<quote>Walt Disney creativity.
</quote>
1488 Nor does America. The norm of free culture has, until recently, and
1489 except within totalitarian nations, been broadly exploited and quite
1493 Consider, for example, a form of creativity that seems strange to many
1494 Americans but that is inescapable within Japanese culture:
<citetitle>manga
</citetitle>, or
1495 comics. The Japanese are fanatics about comics. Some
40 percent of
1496 publications are comics, and
30 percent of publication revenue derives
1497 from comics. They are everywhere in Japanese society, at every
1498 magazine stand, carried by a large proportion of commuters on Japan's
1499 extraordinary system of public transportation.
1502 Americans tend to look down upon this form of culture. That's an
1503 unattractive characteristic of ours. We're likely to misunderstand
1504 much about manga, because few of us have ever read anything close to
1505 the stories that these
<quote>graphic novels
</quote> tell. For the Japanese, manga
1506 cover every aspect of social life. For us, comics are
<quote>men in tights.
</quote>
1507 And anyway, it's not as if the New York subways are filled with
1508 readers of Joyce or even Hemingway. People of different cultures
1509 distract themselves in different ways, the Japanese in this
1510 interestingly different way.
1513 But my purpose here is not to understand manga. It is to describe a
1514 variant on manga that from a lawyer's perspective is quite odd, but
1515 from a Disney perspective is quite familiar.
1518 This is the phenomenon of
<citetitle>doujinshi
</citetitle>. Doujinshi are also comics, but
1519 they are a kind of copycat comic. A rich ethic governs the creation of
1520 doujinshi. It is not doujinshi if it is
<emphasis>just
</emphasis> a
1521 copy; the artist must make a contribution to the art he copies, by
1522 transforming it either subtly or
1523 <!-- PAGE BREAK 39 -->
1524 significantly. A doujinshi comic can thus take a mainstream comic and
1525 develop it differently
—with a different story line. Or the comic can
1526 keep the character in character but change its look slightly. There is no
1527 formula for what makes the doujinshi sufficiently
<quote>different.
</quote> But they
1528 must be different if they are to be considered true doujinshi. Indeed,
1529 there are committees that review doujinshi for inclusion within shows
1530 and reject any copycat comic that is merely a copy.
1533 These copycat comics are not a tiny part of the manga market. They are
1534 huge. More than
33,
000 <quote>circles
</quote> of creators from across Japan produce
1535 these bits of Walt Disney creativity. More than
450,
000 Japanese come
1536 together twice a year, in the largest public gathering in the country,
1537 to exchange and sell them. This market exists in parallel to the
1538 mainstream commercial manga market. In some ways, it obviously
1539 competes with that market, but there is no sustained effort by those
1540 who control the commercial manga market to shut the doujinshi market
1541 down. It flourishes, despite the competition and despite the law.
1544 The most puzzling feature of the doujinshi market, for those trained
1545 in the law, at least, is that it is allowed to exist at all. Under
1546 Japanese copyright law, which in this respect (on paper) mirrors
1547 American copyright law, the doujinshi market is an illegal
1548 one. Doujinshi are plainly
<quote>derivative works.
</quote> There is no general
1549 practice by doujinshi artists of securing the permission of the manga
1550 creators. Instead, the practice is simply to take and modify the
1551 creations of others, as Walt Disney did with
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1552 Jr
</citetitle>. Under both Japanese and American law, that
<quote>taking
</quote> without
1553 the permission of the original copyright owner is illegal. It is an
1554 infringement of the original copyright to make a copy or a derivative
1555 work without the original copyright owner's permission.
1557 <indexterm id=
"idxwinickjudd" class='startofrange'
>
1558 <primary>Winick, Judd
</primary>
1561 Yet this illegal market exists and indeed flourishes in Japan, and in
1562 the view of many, it is precisely because it exists that Japanese manga
1563 flourish. As American graphic novelist Judd Winick said to me,
<quote>The
1564 early days of comics in America are very much like what's going on
1565 in Japan now.
… American comics were born out of copying each
1566 <!-- PAGE BREAK 40 -->
1567 other.
… That's how [the artists] learn to draw
—by going into comic
1568 books and not tracing them, but looking at them and copying them
</quote>
1569 and building from them.
<footnote><para>
1571 For an excellent history, see Scott McCloud,
<citetitle>Reinventing Comics
</citetitle> (New
1572 York: Perennial,
2000).
1575 <indexterm><primary>Superman comics
</primary></indexterm>
1577 American comics now are quite different, Winick explains, in part
1578 because of the legal difficulty of adapting comics the way doujinshi are
1579 allowed. Speaking of Superman, Winick told me,
<quote>there are these rules
1580 and you have to stick to them.
</quote> There are things Superman
<quote>cannot
</quote>
1581 do.
<quote>As a creator, it's frustrating having to stick to some parameters
1582 which are fifty years old.
</quote>
1584 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinickjudd" class='endofrange'
/>
1586 The norm in Japan mitigates this legal difficulty. Some say it is
1587 precisely the benefit accruing to the Japanese manga market that
1588 explains the mitigation. Temple University law professor Salil Mehra,
1589 for example, hypothesizes that the manga market accepts these
1590 technical violations because they spur the manga market to be more
1591 wealthy and productive. Everyone would be worse off if doujinshi were
1592 banned, so the law does not ban doujinshi.
<footnote><para>
1594 See Salil K. Mehra,
<quote>Copyright and Comics in Japan: Does Law Explain
1595 Why All the Comics My Kid Watches Are Japanese Imports?
</quote> <citetitle>Rutgers Law
1596 Review
</citetitle> 55 (
2002):
155,
182.
<quote>[T]here might be a collective economic
1597 rationality that would lead manga and anime artists to forgo bringing
1598 legal actions for infringement. One hypothesis is that all manga
1599 artists may be better off collectively if they set aside their
1600 individual self-interest and decide not to press their legal
1601 rights. This is essentially a prisoner's dilemma solved.
</quote>
1605 The problem with this story, however, as Mehra plainly acknowledges,
1606 is that the mechanism producing this laissez faire response is not
1607 clear. It may well be that the market as a whole is better off if
1608 doujinshi are permitted rather than banned, but that doesn't explain
1609 why individual copyright owners don't sue nonetheless. If the law has
1610 no general exception for doujinshi, and indeed in some cases
1611 individual manga artists have sued doujinshi artists, why is there not
1612 a more general pattern of blocking this
<quote>free taking
</quote> by the doujinshi
1616 I spent four wonderful months in Japan, and I asked this question
1617 as often as I could. Perhaps the best account in the end was offered by
1618 a friend from a major Japanese law firm.
<quote>We don't have enough
1619 lawyers,
</quote> he told me one afternoon. There
<quote>just aren't enough resources
1620 to prosecute cases like this.
</quote>
1623 This is a theme to which we will return: that regulation by law is a
1624 function of both the words on the books and the costs of making those
1625 words have effect. For now, focus on the obvious question that is
1626 begged: Would Japan be better off with more lawyers? Would manga
1627 <!-- PAGE BREAK 41 -->
1628 be richer if doujinshi artists were regularly prosecuted? Would the
1629 Japanese gain something important if they could end this practice of
1630 uncompensated sharing? Does piracy here hurt the victims of the
1631 piracy, or does it help them? Would lawyers fighting this piracy help
1632 their clients or hurt them?
1635 <emphasis role='strong'
>Let's pause
</emphasis> for a moment.
1638 If you're like I was a decade ago, or like most people are when they
1639 first start thinking about these issues, then just about now you should
1640 be puzzled about something you hadn't thought through before.
1643 We live in a world that celebrates
<quote>property.
</quote> I am one of those
1644 celebrants. I believe in the value of property in general, and I also
1645 believe in the value of that weird form of property that lawyers call
1646 <quote>intellectual property.
</quote><footnote><para>
1648 The term
<citetitle>intellectual property
</citetitle> is of relatively recent origin. See
1649 Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
11 (New York: New York
1650 University Press,
2001). See also Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>
1651 (New York: Random House,
2001),
293 n.
26. The term accurately
1652 describes a set of
<quote>property
</quote> rights
—copyright, patents,
1653 trademark, and trade-secret
—but the nature of those rights is
1655 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
1657 A large, diverse society cannot survive without property; a large,
1658 diverse, and modern society cannot flourish without intellectual
1662 But it takes just a second's reflection to realize that there is
1663 plenty of value out there that
<quote>property
</quote> doesn't capture. I don't
1664 mean
<quote>money can't buy you love,
</quote> but rather, value that is plainly
1665 part of a process of production, including commercial as well as
1666 noncommercial production. If Disney animators had stolen a set of
1667 pencils to draw Steamboat Willie, we'd have no hesitation in
1668 condemning that taking as wrong
— even though trivial, even if
1669 unnoticed. Yet there was nothing wrong, at least under the law of the
1670 day, with Disney's taking from Buster Keaton or from the Brothers
1671 Grimm. There was nothing wrong with the taking from Keaton because
1672 Disney's use would have been considered
<quote>fair.
</quote> There was nothing
1673 wrong with the taking from the Grimms because the Grimms' work was in
1677 Thus, even though the things that Disney took
—or more generally,
1678 the things taken by anyone exercising Walt Disney creativity
—are
1679 valuable, our tradition does not treat those takings as wrong. Some
1681 <!-- PAGE BREAK 42 -->
1682 things remain free for the taking within a free culture, and that
1686 The same with the doujinshi culture. If a doujinshi artist broke into
1687 a publisher's office and ran off with a thousand copies of his latest
1688 work
—or even one copy
—without paying, we'd have no hesitation in
1689 saying the artist was wrong. In addition to having trespassed, he would
1690 have stolen something of value. The law bans that stealing in whatever
1691 form, whether large or small.
1694 Yet there is an obvious reluctance, even among Japanese lawyers, to
1695 say that the copycat comic artists are
<quote>stealing.
</quote> This form of Walt
1696 Disney creativity is seen as fair and right, even if lawyers in
1697 particular find it hard to say why.
1700 It's the same with a thousand examples that appear everywhere once you
1701 begin to look. Scientists build upon the work of other scientists
1702 without asking or paying for the privilege. (
<quote>Excuse me, Professor
1703 Einstein, but may I have permission to use your theory of relativity
1704 to show that you were wrong about quantum physics?
</quote>) Acting companies
1705 perform adaptations of the works of Shakespeare without securing
1706 permission from anyone. (Does
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> believe
1707 Shakespeare would be better spread within our culture if there were a
1708 central Shakespeare rights clearinghouse that all productions of
1709 Shakespeare must appeal to first?) And Hollywood goes through cycles
1710 with a certain kind of movie: five asteroid films in the late
1990s;
1711 two volcano disaster films in
1997.
1714 Creators here and everywhere are always and at all times building
1715 upon the creativity that went before and that surrounds them now.
1716 That building is always and everywhere at least partially done without
1717 permission and without compensating the original creator. No society,
1718 free or controlled, has ever demanded that every use be paid for or that
1719 permission for Walt Disney creativity must always be sought. Instead,
1720 every society has left a certain bit of its culture free for the taking
—free
1721 societies more fully than unfree, perhaps, but all societies to some degree.
1722 <!-- PAGE BREAK 43 -->
1725 The hard question is therefore not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> a
1726 culture is free. All cultures are free to some degree. The hard
1727 question instead is
<quote><emphasis>How
</emphasis> free is this culture?
</quote>
1728 How much, and how broadly, is the culture free for others to take and
1729 build upon? Is that freedom limited to party members? To members of
1730 the royal family? To the top ten corporations on the New York Stock
1731 Exchange? Or is that freedom spread broadly? To artists generally,
1732 whether affiliated with the Met or not? To musicians generally,
1733 whether white or not? To filmmakers generally, whether affiliated with
1737 Free cultures are cultures that leave a great deal open for others to
1738 build upon; unfree, or permission, cultures leave much less. Ours was a
1739 free culture. It is becoming much less so.
1742 <!-- PAGE BREAK 44 -->
1744 <chapter label=
"2" id=
"mere-copyists">
1745 <title>CHAPTER TWO:
<quote>Mere Copyists
</quote></title>
1746 <indexterm id=
"idxphotography" class='startofrange'
>
1747 <primary>photography
</primary>
1749 <indexterm><primary>Daguerre, Louis
</primary></indexterm>
1751 <emphasis role='strong'
>In
1839</emphasis>, Louis Daguerre invented
1752 the first practical technology for producing what we would call
1753 <quote>photographs.
</quote> Appropriately enough, they were called
1754 <quote>daguerreotypes.
</quote> The process was complicated and
1755 expensive, and the field was thus limited to professionals and a few
1756 zealous and wealthy amateurs. (There was even an American Daguerre
1757 Association that helped regulate the industry, as do all such
1758 associations, by keeping competition down so as to keep prices up.)
1761 Yet despite high prices, the demand for daguerreotypes was strong.
1762 This pushed inventors to find simpler and cheaper ways to make
1763 <quote>automatic pictures.
</quote> William Talbot soon discovered a process for
1764 making
<quote>negatives.
</quote> But because the negatives were glass, and had to
1765 be kept wet, the process still remained expensive and cumbersome. In
1766 the
1870s, dry plates were developed, making it easier to separate the
1767 taking of a picture from its developing. These were still plates of
1768 glass, and thus it was still not a process within reach of most
1770 <indexterm><primary>Talbot, William
</primary></indexterm>
1772 <indexterm id=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='startofrange'
>
1773 <primary>Eastman, George
</primary>
1776 The technological change that made mass photography possible
1777 didn't happen until
1888, and was the creation of a single man. George
1778 <!-- PAGE BREAK 45 -->
1779 Eastman, himself an amateur photographer, was frustrated by the
1780 technology of photographs made with plates. In a flash of insight (so
1781 to speak), Eastman saw that if the film could be made to be flexible,
1782 it could be held on a single spindle. That roll could then be sent to
1783 a developer, driving the costs of photography down substantially. By
1784 lowering the costs, Eastman expected he could dramatically broaden the
1785 population of photographers.
1788 Eastman developed flexible, emulsion-coated paper film and placed
1789 rolls of it in small, simple cameras: the Kodak. The device was
1790 marketed on the basis of its simplicity.
<quote>You press the button and we
1791 do the rest.
</quote><footnote><para>
1793 Reese V. Jenkins,
<citetitle>Images and Enterprise
</citetitle> (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press,
1975),
112.
1794 </para></footnote> As he described in
<citetitle>The Kodak Primer
</citetitle>:
1795 <indexterm><primary>Kodak Primer, The (Eastman)
</primary></indexterm>
1799 The principle of the Kodak system is the separation of the work that
1800 any person whomsoever can do in making a photograph, from the work
1801 that only an expert can do.
… We furnish anybody, man, woman or
1802 child, who has sufficient intelligence to point a box straight and
1803 press a button, with an instrument which altogether removes from the
1804 practice of photography the necessity for exceptional facilities or,
1805 in fact, any special knowledge of the art. It can be employed without
1806 preliminary study, without a darkroom and without
1807 chemicals.
<footnote>
1810 Brian Coe,
<citetitle>The Birth of Photography
</citetitle> (New York: Taplinger Publishing,
1812 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1817 For $
25, anyone could make pictures. The camera came preloaded
1818 with film, and when it had been used, the camera was returned to an
1819 Eastman factory, where the film was developed. Over time, of course,
1820 the cost of the camera and the ease with which it could be used both
1821 improved. Roll film thus became the basis for the explosive growth of
1822 popular photography. Eastman's camera first went on sale in
1888; one
1823 year later, Kodak was printing more than six thousand negatives a day.
1824 From
1888 through
1909, while industrial production was rising by
4.7
1825 percent, photographic equipment and material sales increased by
11
1826 percent.
<footnote><para>
1829 </para></footnote> Eastman Kodak's sales during the same period experienced
1830 an average annual increase of over
17 percent.
<footnote><para>
1832 Based on a chart in Jenkins, p.
178.
1835 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1838 <!-- PAGE BREAK 46 -->
1839 The real significance of Eastman's invention, however, was not
1840 economic. It was social. Professional photography gave individuals a
1841 glimpse of places they would never otherwise see. Amateur photography
1842 gave them the ability to record their own lives in a way they had
1843 never been able to do before. As author Brian Coe notes,
<quote>For the
1844 first time the snapshot album provided the man on the street with a
1845 permanent record of his family and its activities.
… For the first
1846 time in history there exists an authentic visual record of the
1847 appearance and activities of the common man made without [literary]
1848 interpretation or bias.
</quote><footnote><para>
1854 In this way, the Kodak camera and film were technologies of
1855 expression. The pencil or paintbrush was also a technology of
1856 expression, of course. But it took years of training before they could
1857 be deployed by amateurs in any useful or effective way. With the
1858 Kodak, expression was possible much sooner and more simply. The
1859 barrier to expression was lowered. Snobs would sneer at its
<quote>quality
</quote>;
1860 professionals would discount it as irrelevant. But watch a child study
1861 how best to frame a picture and you get a sense of the experience of
1862 creativity that the Kodak enabled. Democratic tools gave ordinary
1863 people a way to express themselves more easily than any tools could
1867 What was required for this technology to flourish? Obviously,
1868 Eastman's genius was an important part. But also important was the
1869 legal environment within which Eastman's invention grew. For early in
1870 the history of photography, there was a series of judicial decisions
1871 that could well have changed the course of photography substantially.
1872 Courts were asked whether the photographer, amateur or professional,
1873 required permission before he could capture and print whatever image
1874 he wanted. Their answer was no.
<footnote><para>
1876 For illustrative cases, see, for example,
<citetitle>Pavesich
</citetitle>
1877 v.
<citetitle>N.E. Life Ins. Co
</citetitle>.,
50 S.E.
68 (Ga.
1905);
1878 <citetitle>Foster-Milburn Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Chinn
</citetitle>,
123090 S.W.
364,
366
1879 (Ky.
1909);
<citetitle>Corliss
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Walker
</citetitle>,
64 F.
280 (Mass.
1884 The arguments in favor of requiring permission will sound surprisingly
1885 familiar. The photographer was
<quote>taking
</quote> something from the person or
1886 building whose photograph he shot
—pirating something of
1887 value. Some even thought he was taking the target's soul. Just as
1888 Disney was not free to take the pencils that his animators used to
1890 <!-- PAGE BREAK 47 -->
1891 Mickey, so, too, should these photographers not be free to take images
1892 that they thought valuable.
1894 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1896 On the other side was an argument that should be familiar, as well.
1897 Sure, there may be something of value being used. But citizens should
1898 have the right to capture at least those images that stand in public view.
1899 (Louis Brandeis, who would become a Supreme Court Justice, thought
1900 the rule should be different for images from private spaces.
<footnote>
1903 Samuel D. Warren and Louis D. Brandeis,
<quote>The Right to Privacy,
</quote>
1904 <citetitle>Harvard Law Review
</citetitle> 4 (
1890):
193.
1905 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1906 <indexterm><primary>Warren, Samuel D.
</primary></indexterm>
1907 </para></footnote>) It may be that this means that the photographer
1908 gets something for nothing. Just as Disney could take inspiration from
1909 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. or the Brothers Grimm, the photographer should be
1910 free to capture an image without compensating the source.
1912 <indexterm><primary>images, ownership of
</primary></indexterm>
1914 Fortunately for Mr. Eastman, and for photography in general, these
1915 early decisions went in favor of the pirates. In general, no
1916 permission would be required before an image could be captured and
1917 shared with others. Instead, permission was presumed. Freedom was the
1918 default. (The law would eventually craft an exception for famous
1919 people: commercial photographers who snap pictures of famous people
1920 for commercial purposes have more restrictions than the rest of
1921 us. But in the ordinary case, the image can be captured without
1922 clearing the rights to do the capturing.
<footnote><para>
1924 See Melville B. Nimmer,
<quote>The Right of Publicity,
</quote> <citetitle>Law and Contemporary
1925 Problems
</citetitle> 19 (
1954):
203; William L. Prosser,
<quote>Privacy,
</quote> <citetitle>California Law
1926 Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1960)
398–407;
<citetitle>White
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Samsung Electronics America,
1927 Inc
</citetitle>.,
971 F.
2d
1395 (
9th Cir.
1992), cert. denied,
508 U.S.
951
1932 We can only speculate about how photography would have developed had
1933 the law gone the other way. If the presumption had been against the
1934 photographer, then the photographer would have had to demonstrate
1935 permission. Perhaps Eastman Kodak would have had to demonstrate
1936 permission, too, before it developed the film upon which images were
1937 captured. After all, if permission were not granted, then Eastman
1938 Kodak would be benefiting from the
<quote>theft
</quote> committed by the
1939 photographer. Just as Napster benefited from the copyright
1940 infringements committed by Napster users, Kodak would be benefiting
1941 from the
<quote>image-right
</quote> infringement of its photographers. We could
1942 imagine the law then requiring that some form of permission be
1943 demonstrated before a company developed pictures. We could imagine a
1944 system developing to demonstrate that permission.
1948 <!-- PAGE BREAK 48 -->
1949 But though we could imagine this system of permission, it would be
1950 very hard to see how photography could have flourished as it did if
1951 the requirement for permission had been built into the rules that
1952 govern it. Photography would have existed. It would have grown in
1953 importance over time. Professionals would have continued to use the
1954 technology as they did
—since professionals could have more
1955 easily borne the burdens of the permission system. But the spread of
1956 photography to ordinary people would not have occurred. Nothing like
1957 that growth would have been realized. And certainly, nothing like that
1958 growth in a democratic technology of expression would have been
1962 <emphasis role='strong'
>If you drive
</emphasis> through San
1963 Francisco's Presidio, you might see two gaudy yellow school buses
1964 painted over with colorful and striking images, and the logo
1965 <quote>Just Think!
</quote> in place of the name of a school. But
1966 there's little that's
<quote>just
</quote> cerebral in the projects
1967 that these busses enable. These buses are filled with technologies
1968 that teach kids to tinker with film. Not the film of Eastman. Not even
1969 the film of your VCR. Rather the
<quote>film
</quote> of digital
1970 cameras. Just Think! is a project that enables kids to make films, as
1971 a way to understand and critique the filmed culture that they find all
1972 around them. Each year, these busses travel to more than thirty
1973 schools and enable three hundred to five hundred children to learn
1974 something about media by doing something with media. By doing, they
1975 think. By tinkering, they learn.
1977 <indexterm startref=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='endofrange'
/>
1978 <indexterm startref=
"idxphotography" class='endofrange'
/>
1980 These buses are not cheap, but the technology they carry is
1981 increasingly so. The cost of a high-quality digital video system has
1982 fallen dramatically. As one analyst puts it,
<quote>Five years ago, a good
1983 real-time digital video editing system cost $
25,
000. Today you can get
1984 professional quality for $
595.
</quote><footnote><para>
1986 H. Edward Goldberg,
<quote>Essential Presentation Tools: Hardware and
1987 Software You Need to Create Digital Multimedia Presentations,
</quote>
1988 cadalyst, February
2002, available at
1989 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
7</ulink>.
1991 These buses are filled with technology that would have cost hundreds
1992 of thousands just ten years ago. And it is now feasible to imagine not
1993 just buses like this, but classrooms across the country where kids are
1994 learning more and more of something teachers call
<quote>media literacy.
</quote>
1997 <!-- PAGE BREAK 49 -->
1998 <quote>Media literacy,
</quote> as Dave Yanofsky, the executive director of Just
1999 Think!, puts it,
<quote>is the ability
… to understand, analyze, and
2000 deconstruct media images. Its aim is to make [kids] literate about the
2001 way media works, the way it's constructed, the way it's delivered, and
2002 the way people access it.
</quote>
2003 <indexterm><primary>Yanofsky, Dave
</primary></indexterm>
2006 This may seem like an odd way to think about
<quote>literacy.
</quote> For most
2007 people, literacy is about reading and writing. Faulkner and Hemingway
2008 and noticing split infinitives are the things that
<quote>literate
</quote> people know
2011 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
2013 Maybe. But in a world where children see on average
390 hours of
2014 television commercials per year, or between
20,
000 and
45,
000
2015 commercials generally,
<footnote><para>
2017 Judith Van Evra,
<citetitle>Television and Child Development
</citetitle> (Hillsdale, N.J.:
2018 Lawrence Erlbaum Associates,
1990);
<quote>Findings on Family and TV
2019 Study,
</quote> <citetitle>Denver Post
</citetitle>,
25 May
1997, B6.
2021 it is increasingly important to understand the
<quote>grammar
</quote> of media. For
2022 just as there is a grammar for the written word, so, too, is there one
2023 for media. And just as kids learn how to write by writing lots of
2024 terrible prose, kids learn how to write media by constructing lots of
2025 (at least at first) terrible media.
2028 A growing field of academics and activists sees this form of literacy
2029 as crucial to the next generation of culture. For though anyone who
2030 has written understands how difficult writing is
—how difficult
2031 it is to sequence the story, to keep a reader's attention, to craft
2032 language to be understandable
—few of us have any real sense of
2033 how difficult media is. Or more fundamentally, few of us have a sense
2034 of how media works, how it holds an audience or leads it through a
2035 story, how it triggers emotion or builds suspense.
2038 It took filmmaking a generation before it could do these things well.
2039 But even then, the knowledge was in the filming, not in writing about
2040 the film. The skill came from experiencing the making of a film, not
2041 from reading a book about it. One learns to write by writing and then
2042 reflecting upon what one has written. One learns to write with images
2043 by making them and then reflecting upon what one has created.
2045 <indexterm><primary>Crichton, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
2047 This grammar has changed as media has changed. When it was just film,
2048 as Elizabeth Daley, executive director of the University of Southern
2049 California's Annenberg Center for Communication and dean of the
2051 <!-- PAGE BREAK 50 -->
2052 USC School of Cinema-Television, explained to me, the grammar was
2053 about
<quote>the placement of objects, color,
… rhythm, pacing, and
2054 texture.
</quote><footnote>
2057 Interview with Elizabeth Daley and Stephanie Barish,
13 December
2059 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2060 <indexterm><primary>Daley, Elizabeth
</primary></indexterm>
2062 But as computers open up an interactive space where a story is
2063 <quote>played
</quote> as well as experienced, that grammar changes. The simple
2064 control of narrative is lost, and so other techniques are necessary. Author
2065 Michael Crichton had mastered the narrative of science fiction.
2066 But when he tried to design a computer game based on one of his
2067 works, it was a new craft he had to learn. How to lead people through
2068 a game without their feeling they have been led was not obvious, even
2069 to a wildly successful author.
<footnote><para>
2071 See Scott Steinberg,
<quote>Crichton Gets Medieval on PCs,
</quote> E!online,
4
2072 November
2000, available at
2073 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
8</ulink>;
<quote>Timeline,
</quote> 22 November
2000,
2075 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
9</ulink>.
2078 <indexterm><primary>computer games
</primary></indexterm>
2080 This skill is precisely the craft a filmmaker learns. As Daley
2081 describes,
<quote>people are very surprised about how they are led through a
2082 film. [I]t is perfectly constructed to keep you from seeing it, so you
2083 have no idea. If a filmmaker succeeds you do not know how you were
2084 led.
</quote> If you know you were led through a film, the film has failed.
2087 Yet the push for an expanded literacy
—one that goes beyond text
2088 to include audio and visual elements
—is not about making better
2089 film directors. The aim is not to improve the profession of
2090 filmmaking at all. Instead, as Daley explained,
2094 From my perspective, probably the most important digital divide
2095 is not access to a box. It's the ability to be empowered with the
2096 language that that box works in. Otherwise only a very few people
2097 can write with this language, and all the rest of us are reduced to
2102 <quote>Read-only.
</quote> Passive recipients of culture produced elsewhere.
2103 Couch potatoes. Consumers. This is the world of media from the
2107 The twenty-first century could be different. This is the crucial
2108 point: It could be both read and write. Or at least reading and better
2109 understanding the craft of writing. Or best, reading and understanding
2110 the tools that enable the writing to lead or mislead. The aim of any
2112 <!-- PAGE BREAK 51 -->
2113 and this literacy in particular, is to
<quote>empower people to choose the
2114 appropriate language for what they need to create or
2115 express.
</quote><footnote>
2118 Interview with Daley and Barish.
2119 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2120 </para></footnote> It is to enable students
<quote>to communicate in the
2121 language of the twenty-first century.
</quote><footnote><para>
2126 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2128 As with any language, this language comes more easily to some than to
2129 others. It doesn't necessarily come more easily to those who excel in
2130 written language. Daley and Stephanie Barish, director of the
2131 Institute for Multimedia Literacy at the Annenberg Center, describe
2132 one particularly poignant example of a project they ran in a high
2133 school. The high school was a very poor inner-city Los Angeles
2134 school. In all the traditional measures of success, this school was a
2135 failure. But Daley and Barish ran a program that gave kids an
2136 opportunity to use film to express meaning about something the
2137 students know something about
—gun violence.
2140 The class was held on Friday afternoons, and it created a relatively
2141 new problem for the school. While the challenge in most classes was
2142 getting the kids to come, the challenge in this class was keeping them
2143 away. The
<quote>kids were showing up at
6 A.M. and leaving at
5 at night,
</quote>
2144 said Barish. They were working harder than in any other class to do
2145 what education should be about
—learning how to express themselves.
2148 Using whatever
<quote>free web stuff they could find,
</quote> and relatively simple
2149 tools to enable the kids to mix
<quote>image, sound, and text,
</quote> Barish said
2150 this class produced a series of projects that showed something about
2151 gun violence that few would otherwise understand. This was an issue
2152 close to the lives of these students. The project
<quote>gave them a tool
2153 and empowered them to be able to both understand it and talk about
2154 it,
</quote> Barish explained. That tool succeeded in creating
2155 expression
—far more successfully and powerfully than could have
2156 been created using only text.
<quote>If you had said to these students, `you
2157 have to do it in text,' they would've just thrown their hands up and
2158 gone and done something else,
</quote> Barish described, in part, no doubt,
2159 because expressing themselves in text is not something these students
2160 can do well. Yet neither is text a form in which
2161 <emphasis>these
</emphasis> ideas can be expressed well. The power of
2162 this message depended upon its connection to this form of expression.
2166 <!-- PAGE BREAK 52 -->
2167 <quote>But isn't education about teaching kids to write?
</quote> I asked. In part,
2168 of course, it is. But why are we teaching kids to write? Education,
2169 Daley explained, is about giving students a way of
<quote>constructing
2170 meaning.
</quote> To say that that means just writing is like saying teaching
2171 writing is only about teaching kids how to spell. Text is one
2172 part
—and increasingly, not the most powerful part
—of
2173 constructing meaning. As Daley explained in the most moving part of
2178 What you want is to give these students ways of constructing
2179 meaning. If all you give them is text, they're not going to do it.
2180 Because they can't. You know, you've got Johnny who can look at a
2181 video, he can play a video game, he can do graffiti all over your
2182 walls, he can take your car apart, and he can do all sorts of other
2183 things. He just can't read your text. So Johnny comes to school and
2184 you say,
<quote>Johnny, you're illiterate. Nothing you can do matters.
</quote>
2185 Well, Johnny then has two choices: He can dismiss you or he [can]
2186 dismiss himself. If his ego is healthy at all, he's going to dismiss
2187 you. [But i]nstead, if you say,
<quote>Well, with all these things that you
2188 can do, let's talk about this issue. Play for me music that you think
2189 reflects that, or show me images that you think reflect that, or draw
2190 for me something that reflects that.
</quote> Not by giving a kid a video
2191 camera and
… saying,
<quote>Let's go have fun with the video camera and
2192 make a little movie.
</quote> But instead, really help you take these elements
2193 that you understand, that are your language, and construct meaning
2194 about the topic.
…
2197 That empowers enormously. And then what happens, of
2198 course, is eventually, as it has happened in all these classes, they
2199 bump up against the fact,
<quote>I need to explain this and I really need
2200 to write something.
</quote> And as one of the teachers told Stephanie,
2201 they would rewrite a paragraph
5,
6,
7,
8 times, till they got it right.
2204 Because they needed to. There was a reason for doing it. They
2205 needed to say something, as opposed to just jumping through
2206 your hoops. They actually needed to use a language that they
2207 <!-- PAGE BREAK 53 -->
2208 didn't speak very well. But they had come to understand that they
2209 had a lot of power with this language.
2211 <!-- FIXME removed a " from the end of the previous paragraph that did
2212 not match with any start quote. -->
2214 <indexterm><primary>World Trade Center
</primary></indexterm>
2216 <emphasis role='strong'
>When two planes
</emphasis> crashed into the
2217 World Trade Center, another into the Pentagon, and a fourth into a
2218 Pennsylvania field, all media around the world shifted to this
2219 news. Every moment of just about every day for that week, and for
2220 weeks after, television in particular, and media generally, retold the
2221 story of the events we had just witnessed. The telling was a
2222 retelling, because we had seen the events that were described. The
2223 genius of this awful act of terrorism was that the delayed second
2224 attack was perfectly timed to assure that the whole world would be
2228 These retellings had an increasingly familiar feel. There was music
2229 scored for the intermissions, and fancy graphics that flashed across
2230 the screen. There was a formula to interviews. There was
<quote>balance,
</quote>
2231 and seriousness. This was news choreographed in the way we have
2232 increasingly come to expect it,
<quote>news as entertainment,
</quote> even if the
2233 entertainment is tragedy.
2235 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
2236 <indexterm><primary>CBS
</primary></indexterm>
2238 But in addition to this produced news about the
<quote>tragedy of September
2239 11,
</quote> those of us tied to the Internet came to see a very different
2240 production as well. The Internet was filled with accounts of the same
2241 events. Yet these Internet accounts had a very different flavor. Some
2242 people constructed photo pages that captured images from around the
2243 world and presented them as slide shows with text. Some offered open
2244 letters. There were sound recordings. There was anger and frustration.
2245 There were attempts to provide context. There was, in short, an
2246 extraordinary worldwide barn raising, in the sense Mike Godwin uses
2247 the term in his book
<citetitle>Cyber Rights
</citetitle>, around a news event that had
2248 captured the attention of the world. There was ABC and CBS, but there
2249 was also the Internet.
2252 I don't mean simply to praise the Internet
—though I do think the
2253 people who supported this form of speech should be praised. I mean
2254 instead to point to a significance in this form of speech. For like a
2255 Kodak, the Internet enables people to capture images. And like in a
2257 <!-- PAGE BREAK 54 -->
2258 by a student on the
<quote>Just Think!
</quote> bus, the visual images could be mixed
2262 But unlike any technology for simply capturing images, the Internet
2263 allows these creations to be shared with an extraordinary number of
2264 people, practically instantaneously. This is something new in our
2265 tradition
—not just that culture can be captured mechanically,
2266 and obviously not just that events are commented upon critically, but
2267 that this mix of captured images, sound, and commentary can be widely
2268 spread practically instantaneously.
2271 September
11 was not an aberration. It was a beginning. Around the
2272 same time, a form of communication that has grown dramatically was
2273 just beginning to come into public consciousness: the Web-log, or
2274 blog. The blog is a kind of public diary, and within some cultures,
2275 such as in Japan, it functions very much like a diary. In those
2276 cultures, it records private facts in a public way
—it's a kind
2277 of electronic
<citetitle>Jerry Springer
</citetitle>, available anywhere in the world.
2279 <indexterm><primary>blogs (Web-logs)
</primary></indexterm>
2281 But in the United States, blogs have taken on a very different
2282 character. There are some who use the space simply to talk about
2283 their private life. But there are many who use the space to engage in
2284 public discourse. Discussing matters of public import, criticizing
2285 others who are mistaken in their views, criticizing politicians about
2286 the decisions they make, offering solutions to problems we all see:
2287 blogs create the sense of a virtual public meeting, but one in which
2288 we don't all hope to be there at the same time and in which
2289 conversations are not necessarily linked. The best of the blog entries
2290 are relatively short; they point directly to words used by others,
2291 criticizing with or adding to them. They are arguably the most
2292 important form of unchoreographed public discourse that we have.
2295 That's a strong statement. Yet it says as much about our democracy as
2296 it does about blogs. This is the part of America that is most
2297 difficult for those of us who love America to accept: Our democracy
2298 has atrophied. Of course we have elections, and most of the time the
2299 courts allow those elections to count. A relatively small number of
2301 <!-- PAGE BREAK 55 -->
2302 in those elections. The cycle of these elections has become totally
2303 professionalized and routinized. Most of us think this is democracy.
2305 <indexterm><primary>Tocqueville, Alexis de
</primary></indexterm>
2307 But democracy has never just been about elections. Democracy
2308 means rule by the people, but rule means something more than mere
2309 elections. In our tradition, it also means control through reasoned
2310 discourse. This was the idea that captured the imagination of Alexis
2311 de Tocqueville, the nineteenth-century French lawyer who wrote the
2312 most important account of early
<quote>Democracy in America.
</quote> It wasn't
2313 popular elections that fascinated him
—it was the jury, an
2314 institution that gave ordinary people the right to choose life or
2315 death for other citizens. And most fascinating for him was that the
2316 jury didn't just vote about the outcome they would impose. They
2317 deliberated. Members argued about the
<quote>right
</quote> result; they tried to
2318 persuade each other of the
<quote>right
</quote> result, and in criminal cases at
2319 least, they had to agree upon a unanimous result for the process to
2320 come to an end.
<footnote><para>
2322 See, for example, Alexis de Tocqueville,
<citetitle>Democracy in America
</citetitle>,
2323 bk.
1, trans. Henry Reeve (New York: Bantam Books,
2000), ch.
16.
2327 Yet even this institution flags in American life today. And in its
2328 place, there is no systematic effort to enable citizen deliberation. Some
2329 are pushing to create just such an institution.
<footnote><para>
2331 Bruce Ackerman and James Fishkin,
<quote>Deliberation Day,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of
2332 Political Philosophy
</citetitle> 10 (
2) (
2002):
129.
2334 And in some towns in New England, something close to deliberation
2335 remains. But for most of us for most of the time, there is no time or
2336 place for
<quote>democratic deliberation
</quote> to occur.
2339 More bizarrely, there is generally not even permission for it to
2340 occur. We, the most powerful democracy in the world, have developed a
2341 strong norm against talking about politics. It's fine to talk about
2342 politics with people you agree with. But it is rude to argue about
2343 politics with people you disagree with. Political discourse becomes
2344 isolated, and isolated discourse becomes more extreme.
<footnote><para>
2346 Cass Sunstein,
<citetitle>Republic.com
</citetitle> (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
2001),
2347 65–80,
175,
182,
183,
192.
2348 </para></footnote> We say what our friends want to hear, and hear very
2349 little beyond what our friends say.
2351 <indexterm id='idxblogs1' class='startofrange'
>
2352 <primary>blogs (Web-logs)
</primary>
2355 Enter the blog. The blog's very architecture solves one part of this
2356 problem. People post when they want to post, and people read when they
2357 want to read. The most difficult time is synchronous time.
2358 Technologies that enable asynchronous communication, such as e-mail,
2359 increase the opportunity for communication. Blogs allow for public
2361 <!-- PAGE BREAK 56 -->
2362 discourse without the public ever needing to gather in a single public
2366 But beyond architecture, blogs also have solved the problem of
2367 norms. There's no norm (yet) in blog space not to talk about politics.
2368 Indeed, the space is filled with political speech, on both the right and
2369 the left. Some of the most popular sites are conservative or libertarian,
2370 but there are many of all political stripes. And even blogs that are not
2371 political cover political issues when the occasion merits.
2374 The significance of these blogs is tiny now, though not so tiny. The
2375 name Howard Dean may well have faded from the
2004 presidential race
2376 but for blogs. Yet even if the number of readers is small, the reading
2377 is having an effect.
2378 <indexterm><primary>Dean, Howard
</primary></indexterm>
2380 <indexterm><primary>Thurmond, Strom
</primary></indexterm>
2382 One direct effect is on stories that had a different life cycle in the
2383 mainstream media. The Trent Lott affair is an example. When Lott
2384 <quote>misspoke
</quote> at a party for Senator Strom Thurmond, essentially praising
2385 Thurmond's segregationist policies, he calculated correctly that this
2386 story would disappear from the mainstream press within forty-eight
2387 hours. It did. But he didn't calculate its life cycle in blog
2388 space. The bloggers kept researching the story. Over time, more and
2389 more instances of the same
<quote>misspeaking
</quote> emerged. Finally, the story
2390 broke back into the mainstream press. In the end, Lott was forced to
2391 resign as senate majority leader.
<footnote><para>
2393 Noah Shachtman,
<quote>With Incessant Postings, a Pundit Stirs the Pot,
</quote> New
2394 York Times,
16 January
2003, G5.
2396 <indexterm><primary>Lott, Trent
</primary></indexterm>
2399 This different cycle is possible because the same commercial pressures
2400 don't exist with blogs as with other ventures. Television and
2401 newspapers are commercial entities. They must work to keep attention.
2402 If they lose readers, they lose revenue. Like sharks, they must move
2406 But bloggers don't have a similar constraint. They can obsess, they
2407 can focus, they can get serious. If a particular blogger writes a
2408 particularly interesting story, more and more people link to that
2409 story. And as the number of links to a particular story increases, it
2410 rises in the ranks of stories. People read what is popular; what is
2411 popular has been selected by a very democratic process of
2412 peer-generated rankings.
2414 <indexterm id=
"idxwinerdave" class='startofrange'
>
2415 <primary>Winer, Dave
</primary>
2418 There's a second way, as well, in which blogs have a different cycle
2419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 57 -->
2420 from the mainstream press. As Dave Winer, one of the fathers of this
2421 movement and a software author for many decades, told me, another
2422 difference is the absence of a financial
<quote>conflict of interest.
</quote> <quote>I think you
2423 have to take the conflict of interest
</quote> out of journalism, Winer told me.
2424 <quote>An amateur journalist simply doesn't have a conflict of interest, or the
2425 conflict of interest is so easily disclosed that you know you can sort of
2426 get it out of the way.
</quote>
2428 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2429 <indexterm><primary>Iraq war
</primary></indexterm>
2431 These conflicts become more important as media becomes more
2432 concentrated (more on this below). A concentrated media can hide more
2433 from the public than an unconcentrated media can
—as CNN admitted
2434 it did after the Iraq war because it was afraid of the consequences to
2435 its own employees.
<footnote><para>
2437 Telephone interview with David Winer,
16 April
2003.
2439 It also needs to sustain a more coherent account. (In the middle of
2440 the Iraq war, I read a post on the Internet from someone who was at
2441 that time listening to a satellite uplink with a reporter in Iraq. The
2442 New York headquarters was telling the reporter over and over that her
2443 account of the war was too bleak: She needed to offer a more
2444 optimistic story. When she told New York that wasn't warranted, they
2445 told her that
<emphasis>they
</emphasis> were writing
<quote>the story.
</quote>)
2447 <para> Blog space gives amateurs a way to enter the
2448 debate
—<quote>amateur
</quote> not in the sense of inexperienced, but in the
2449 sense of an Olympic athlete, meaning not paid by anyone to give their
2450 reports. It allows for a much broader range of input into a story, as
2451 reporting on the Columbia disaster revealed, when hundreds from across
2452 the southwest United States turned to the Internet to retell what they
2453 had seen.
<footnote><para>
2455 John Schwartz,
<quote>Loss of the Shuttle: The Internet; A Wealth of
2456 Information Online,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
2 February
2003, A28; Staci
2457 D. Kramer,
<quote>Shuttle Disaster Coverage Mixed, but Strong Overall,
</quote>
2458 Online Journalism Review,
2 February
2003, available at
2459 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
10</ulink>.
2461 And it drives readers to read across the range of accounts and
2462 <quote>triangulate,
</quote> as Winer puts it, the truth. Blogs, Winer says, are
2463 <quote>communicating directly with our constituency, and the middle man is
2464 out of it
</quote>—with all the benefits, and costs, that might entail.
2467 Winer is optimistic about the future of journalism infected
2468 with blogs.
<quote>It's going to become an essential skill,
</quote> Winer predicts,
2469 for public figures and increasingly for private figures as well. It's
2470 not clear that
<quote>journalism
</quote> is happy about this
—some journalists
2471 have been told to curtail their blogging.
<footnote>
2474 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2475 <indexterm><primary>Iraq war
</primary></indexterm>
2476 <indexterm><primary>Olafson, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
2477 <indexterm><primary>blogs (Web-logs)
</primary></indexterm>
2478 See Michael Falcone,
<quote>Does an Editor's Pencil Ruin a Web Log?
</quote> <citetitle>New
2479 York Times
</citetitle>,
29 September
2003, C4. (
<quote>Not all news organizations have
2480 been as accepting of employees who blog. Kevin Sites, a CNN
2481 correspondent in Iraq who started a blog about his reporting of the
2482 war on March
9, stopped posting
12 days later at his bosses'
2483 request. Last year Steve Olafson, a
<citetitle>Houston Chronicle
</citetitle> reporter, was
2484 fired for keeping a personal Web log, published under a pseudonym,
2485 that dealt with some of the issues and people he was covering.
</quote>)
2487 But it is clear that we are still in transition.
<quote>A
2489 <!-- PAGE BREAK 58 -->
2490 lot of what we are doing now is warm-up exercises,
</quote> Winer told me.
2491 There is a lot that must mature before this space has its mature effect.
2492 And as the inclusion of content in this space is the least infringing use
2493 of the Internet (meaning infringing on copyright), Winer said,
<quote>we will
2494 be the last thing that gets shut down.
</quote>
2497 This speech affects democracy. Winer thinks that happens because
<quote>you
2498 don't have to work for somebody who controls, [for] a gatekeeper.
</quote>
2499 That is true. But it affects democracy in another way as well. As
2500 more and more citizens express what they think, and defend it in
2501 writing, that will change the way people understand public issues. It
2502 is easy to be wrong and misguided in your head. It is harder when the
2503 product of your mind can be criticized by others. Of course, it is a
2504 rare human who admits that he has been persuaded that he is wrong. But
2505 it is even rarer for a human to ignore when he has been proven wrong.
2506 The writing of ideas, arguments, and criticism improves democracy.
2507 Today there are probably a couple of million blogs where such writing
2508 happens. When there are ten million, there will be something
2509 extraordinary to report.
2511 <indexterm startref='idxblogs1' class='endofrange'
/>
2512 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinerdave" class='endofrange'
/>
2513 <indexterm id=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='startofrange'
>
2514 <primary>Brown, John Seely
</primary>
2516 <indexterm id='idxadvertising1' class='startofrange'
>
2517 <primary>advertising
</primary>
2520 <emphasis role='strong'
>John Seely Brown
</emphasis> is the chief
2521 scientist of the Xerox Corporation. His work, as his Web site
2522 describes it, is
<quote>human learning and
… the creation of
2523 knowledge ecologies for creating
… innovation.
</quote>
2526 Brown thus looks at these technologies of digital creativity a bit
2527 differently from the perspectives I've sketched so far. I'm sure he
2528 would be excited about any technology that might improve
2529 democracy. But his real excitement comes from how these technologies
2533 As Brown believes, we learn by tinkering. When
<quote>a lot of us grew up,
</quote>
2534 he explains, that tinkering was done
<quote>on motorcycle engines, lawnmower
2535 engines, automobiles, radios, and so on.
</quote> But digital technologies
2536 enable a different kind of tinkering
—with abstract ideas though
2537 in concrete form. The kids at Just Think! not only think about how a
2538 commercial portrays a politician; using digital technology, they can
2539 <!-- PAGE BREAK 59 -->
2540 take the commercial apart and manipulate it, tinker with it to see how
2541 it does what it does. Digital technologies launch a kind of bricolage,
2542 or
<quote>free collage,
</quote> as Brown calls it. Many get to add to or transform
2543 the tinkering of many others.
2546 The best large-scale example of this kind of tinkering so far is free
2547 software or open-source software (FS/OSS). FS/OSS is software whose
2548 source code is shared. Anyone can download the technology that makes a
2549 FS/OSS program run. And anyone eager to learn how a particular bit of
2550 FS/OSS technology works can tinker with the code.
2553 This opportunity creates a
<quote>completely new kind of learning platform,
</quote>
2554 as Brown describes.
<quote>As soon as you start doing that, you
…
2555 unleash a free collage on the community, so that other people can
2556 start looking at your code, tinkering with it, trying it out, seeing
2557 if they can improve it.
</quote> Each effort is a kind of
2558 apprenticeship.
<quote>Open source becomes a major apprenticeship platform.
</quote>
2561 In this process,
<quote>the concrete things you tinker with are abstract.
2562 They are code.
</quote> Kids are
<quote>shifting to the ability to tinker in the
2563 abstract, and this tinkering is no longer an isolated activity that
2564 you're doing in your garage. You are tinkering with a community
2565 platform.
… You are tinkering with other people's stuff. The more
2566 you tinker the more you improve.
</quote> The more you improve, the more you
2570 This same thing happens with content, too. And it happens in the same
2571 collaborative way when that content is part of the Web. As Brown puts
2572 it,
<quote>the Web [is] the first medium that truly honors multiple forms of
2573 intelligence.
</quote> Earlier technologies, such as the typewriter or word
2574 processors, helped amplify text. But the Web amplifies much more than
2575 text.
<quote>The Web
… says if you are musical, if you are artistic, if
2576 you are visual, if you are interested in film
… [then] there is a
2577 lot you can start to do on this medium. [It] can now amplify and honor
2578 these multiple forms of intelligence.
</quote>
2580 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising1' class='endofrange'
/>
2581 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2583 Brown is talking about what Elizabeth Daley, Stephanie Barish, and
2584 Just Think! teach: that this tinkering with culture teaches as well
2586 <!-- PAGE BREAK 60 -->
2587 as creates. It develops talents differently, and it builds a different
2588 kind of recognition.
2591 Yet the freedom to tinker with these objects is not guaranteed.
2592 Indeed, as we'll see through the course of this book, that freedom is
2593 increasingly highly contested. While there's no doubt that your father
2594 had the right to tinker with the car engine, there's great doubt that
2595 your child will have the right to tinker with the images she finds all
2596 around. The law and, increasingly, technology interfere with a
2597 freedom that technology, and curiosity, would otherwise ensure.
2600 These restrictions have become the focus of researchers and scholars.
2601 Professor Ed Felten of Princeton (whom we'll see more of in chapter
2602 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>)
2603 has developed a powerful argument in favor of the
<quote>right to
2604 tinker
</quote> as it applies to computer science and to knowledge in
2605 general.
<footnote><para>
2607 See, for example, Edward Felten and Andrew Appel,
<quote>Technological Access
2608 Control Interferes with Noninfringing Scholarship,
</quote> <citetitle>Communications
2609 of the Association for Computer Machinery
</citetitle> 43 (
2000):
9.
2611 But Brown's concern is earlier, or younger, or more fundamental. It is
2612 about the learning that kids can do, or can't do, because of the law.
2615 <quote>This is where education in the twenty-first century is going,
</quote> Brown
2616 explains. We need to
<quote>understand how kids who grow up digital think
2617 and want to learn.
</quote>
2620 <quote>Yet,
</quote> as Brown continued, and as the balance of this book will
2621 evince,
<quote>we are building a legal system that completely suppresses the
2622 natural tendencies of today's digital kids.
… We're building an
2623 architecture that unleashes
60 percent of the brain [and] a legal
2624 system that closes down that part of the brain.
</quote>
2626 <indexterm startref=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='endofrange'
/>
2628 We're building a technology that takes the magic of Kodak, mixes
2629 moving images and sound, and adds a space for commentary and an
2630 opportunity to spread that creativity everywhere. But we're building
2631 the law to close down that technology.
2634 <quote>No way to run a culture,
</quote> as Brewster Kahle, whom we'll meet in
2635 chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"collectors"/>,
2636 quipped to me in a rare moment of despondence.
2638 <!-- PAGE BREAK 61 -->
2640 <chapter label=
"3" id=
"catalogs">
2641 <title>CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
</title>
2642 <indexterm><primary>RPI
</primary><see>Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute (RPI)
</see></indexterm>
2643 <indexterm id=
"idxrensselaer" class='startofrange'
>
2644 <primary>Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute (RPI)
</primary>
2647 <emphasis role='strong'
>In the fall
</emphasis> of
2002, Jesse Jordan
2648 of Oceanside, New York, enrolled as a freshman at Rensselaer
2649 Polytechnic Institute, in Troy, New York. His major at RPI was
2650 information technology. Though he is not a programmer, in October
2651 Jesse decided to begin to tinker with search engine technology that
2652 was available on the RPI network.
2655 RPI is one of America's foremost technological research institutions.
2656 It offers degrees in fields ranging from architecture and engineering
2657 to information sciences. More than
65 percent of its five thousand
2658 undergraduates finished in the top
10 percent of their high school
2659 class. The school is thus a perfect mix of talent and experience to
2660 imagine and then build, a generation for the network age.
2663 RPI's computer network links students, faculty, and administration to
2664 one another. It also links RPI to the Internet. Not everything
2665 available on the RPI network is available on the Internet. But the
2666 network is designed to enable students to get access to the Internet,
2667 as well as more intimate access to other members of the RPI community.
2670 Search engines are a measure of a network's intimacy. Google
2671 <!-- PAGE BREAK 62 -->
2672 brought the Internet much closer to all of us by fantastically
2673 improving the quality of search on the network. Specialty search
2674 engines can do this even better. The idea of
<quote>intranet
</quote> search
2675 engines, search engines that search within the network of a particular
2676 institution, is to provide users of that institution with better
2677 access to material from that institution. Businesses do this all the
2678 time, enabling employees to have access to material that people
2679 outside the business can't get. Universities do it as well.
2682 These engines are enabled by the network technology itself.
2683 Microsoft, for example, has a network file system that makes it very
2684 easy for search engines tuned to that network to query the system for
2685 information about the publicly (within that network) available
2686 content. Jesse's search engine was built to take advantage of this
2687 technology. It used Microsoft's network file system to build an index
2688 of all the files available within the RPI network.
2691 Jesse's wasn't the first search engine built for the RPI network.
2692 Indeed, his engine was a simple modification of engines that others
2693 had built. His single most important improvement over those engines
2694 was to fix a bug within the Microsoft file-sharing system that could
2695 cause a user's computer to crash. With the engines that existed
2696 before, if you tried to access a file through a Windows browser that
2697 was on a computer that was off-line, your computer could crash. Jesse
2698 modified the system a bit to fix that problem, by adding a button that
2699 a user could click to see if the machine holding the file was still
2703 Jesse's engine went on-line in late October. Over the following six
2704 months, he continued to tweak it to improve its functionality. By
2705 March, the system was functioning quite well. Jesse had more than one
2706 million files in his directory, including every type of content that might
2707 be on users' computers.
2710 Thus the index his search engine produced included pictures, which
2711 students could use to put on their own Web sites; copies of notes or
2712 research; copies of information pamphlets; movie clips that students
2713 might have created; university brochures
—basically anything that
2714 <!-- PAGE BREAK 63 -->
2715 users of the RPI network made available in a public folder of their
2719 But the index also included music files. In fact, one quarter of the
2720 files that Jesse's search engine listed were music files. But that
2721 means, of course, that three quarters were not, and
—so that this
2722 point is absolutely clear
—Jesse did nothing to induce people to
2723 put music files in their public folders. He did nothing to target the
2724 search engine to these files. He was a kid tinkering with a
2725 Google-like technology at a university where he was studying
2726 information science, and hence, tinkering was the aim. Unlike Google,
2727 or Microsoft, for that matter, he made no money from this tinkering;
2728 he was not connected to any business that would make any money from
2729 this experiment. He was a kid tinkering with technology in an
2730 environment where tinkering with technology was precisely what he was
2734 On April
3,
2003, Jesse was contacted by the dean of students at
2735 RPI. The dean informed Jesse that the Recording Industry Association
2736 of America, the RIAA, would be filing a lawsuit against him and three
2737 other students whom he didn't even know, two of them at other
2738 universities. A few hours later, Jesse was served with papers from
2739 the suit. As he read these papers and watched the news reports about
2740 them, he was increasingly astonished.
2743 <quote>It was absurd,
</quote> he told me.
<quote>I don't think I did anything
2744 wrong.
… I don't think there's anything wrong with the search
2745 engine that I ran or
… what I had done to it. I mean, I hadn't
2746 modified it in any way that promoted or enhanced the work of
2747 pirates. I just modified the search engine in a way that would make it
2748 easier to use
</quote>—again, a
<emphasis>search engine
</emphasis>,
2749 which Jesse had not himself built, using the Windows filesharing
2750 system, which Jesse had not himself built, to enable members of the
2751 RPI community to get access to content, which Jesse had not himself
2752 created or posted, and the vast majority of which had nothing to do
2755 <indexterm><primary>statutory damages
</primary></indexterm>
2757 But the RIAA branded Jesse a pirate. They claimed he operated a
2758 network and had therefore
<quote>willfully
</quote> violated copyright laws. They
2759 <!-- PAGE BREAK 64 -->
2760 demanded that he pay them the damages for his wrong. For cases of
2761 <quote>willful infringement,
</quote> the Copyright Act specifies something lawyers
2762 call
<quote>statutory damages.
</quote> These damages permit a copyright owner to
2763 claim $
150,
000 per infringement. As the RIAA alleged more than one
2764 hundred specific copyright infringements, they therefore demanded that
2765 Jesse pay them at least $
15,
000,
000.
2767 <indexterm><primary>Princeton University
</primary></indexterm>
2768 <indexterm><primary>Michigan Technical University
</primary></indexterm>
2770 Similar lawsuits were brought against three other students: one other
2771 student at RPI, one at Michigan Technical University, and one at
2772 Princeton. Their situations were similar to Jesse's. Though each case
2773 was different in detail, the bottom line in each was exactly the same:
2774 huge demands for
<quote>damages
</quote> that the RIAA claimed it was entitled to.
2775 If you added up the claims, these four lawsuits were asking courts in
2776 the United States to award the plaintiffs close to $
100
2777 <emphasis>billion
</emphasis>—six times the
2778 <emphasis>total
</emphasis> profit of the film industry in
2779 2001.
<footnote><para>
2782 Tim Goral,
<quote>Recording Industry Goes After Campus P-
2-P Networks:
2783 Suit Alleges $
97.8 Billion in Damages,
</quote> <citetitle>Professional Media Group LCC
</citetitle> 6
2784 (
2003):
5, available at
2003 WL
55179443.
2787 <indexterm startref=
"idxrensselaer" class='endofrange'
/>
2789 Jesse called his parents. They were supportive but a bit frightened.
2790 An uncle was a lawyer. He began negotiations with the RIAA. They
2791 demanded to know how much money Jesse had. Jesse had saved
2792 $
12,
000 from summer jobs and other employment. They demanded
2793 $
12,
000 to dismiss the case.
2795 <indexterm><primary>Oppenheimer, Matt
</primary></indexterm>
2797 The RIAA wanted Jesse to admit to doing something wrong. He
2798 refused. They wanted him to agree to an injunction that would
2799 essentially make it impossible for him to work in many fields of
2800 technology for the rest of his life. He refused. They made him
2801 understand that this process of being sued was not going to be
2802 pleasant. (As Jesse's father recounted to me, the chief lawyer on the
2803 case, Matt Oppenheimer, told Jesse,
<quote>You don't want to pay another
2804 visit to a dentist like me.
</quote>) And throughout, the RIAA insisted it
2805 would not settle the case until it took every penny Jesse had saved.
2808 Jesse's family was outraged at these claims. They wanted to fight.
2809 But Jesse's uncle worked to educate the family about the nature of the
2810 American legal system. Jesse could fight the RIAA. He might even
2811 win. But the cost of fighting a lawsuit like this, Jesse was told, would be
2812 at least $
250,
000. If he won, he would not recover that money. If he
2813 <!-- PAGE BREAK 65 -->
2814 won, he would have a piece of paper saying he had won, and a piece of
2815 paper saying he and his family were bankrupt.
2818 So Jesse faced a mafia-like choice: $
250,
000 and a chance at winning,
2819 or $
12,
000 and a settlement.
2822 <primary>artists
</primary>
2823 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
2826 The recording industry insists this is a matter of law and morality.
2827 Let's put the law aside for a moment and think about the morality.
2828 Where is the morality in a lawsuit like this? What is the virtue in
2829 scapegoatism? The RIAA is an extraordinarily powerful lobby. The
2830 president of the RIAA is reported to make more than $
1 million a year.
2831 Artists, on the other hand, are not well paid. The average recording
2832 artist makes $
45,
900.
<footnote><para>
2834 Occupational Employment Survey, U.S. Dept. of Labor (
2001)
2835 (
27–2042—Musicians and Singers). See also National Endowment for
2836 the Arts,
<citetitle>More Than One in a Blue Moon
</citetitle> (
2000).
2838 There are plenty of ways for the RIAA to affect
2839 and direct policy. So where is the morality in taking money from a
2840 student for running a search engine?
<footnote><para>
2842 Douglas Lichtman makes a related point in
<quote>KaZaA and Punishment,
</quote>
2843 <citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, A24.
2847 On June
23, Jesse wired his savings to the lawyer working for the
2848 RIAA. The case against him was then dismissed. And with this, this
2849 kid who had tinkered a computer into a $
15 million lawsuit became an
2854 I was definitely not an activist [before]. I never really meant to be
2855 an activist.
… [But] I've been pushed into this. In no way did I
2856 ever foresee anything like this, but I think it's just completely
2857 absurd what the RIAA has done.
2861 Jesse's parents betray a certain pride in their reluctant activist. As
2862 his father told me, Jesse
<quote>considers himself very conservative, and so do
2863 I.
… He's not a tree hugger.
… I think it's bizarre that they would
2864 pick on him. But he wants to let people know that they're sending the
2865 wrong message. And he wants to correct the record.
</quote>
2867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 66 -->
2869 <chapter label=
"4" id=
"pirates">
2870 <title>CHAPTER FOUR:
<quote>Pirates
</quote></title>
2871 <indexterm><primary><quote>if value, then right
</quote> theory
</primary></indexterm>
2873 <emphasis role='strong'
>If
<quote>piracy
</quote> means
</emphasis>
2874 using the creative property of others without their
2875 permission
—if
<quote>if value, then right
</quote> is
2876 true
—then the history of the content industry is a history of
2877 piracy. Every important sector of
<quote>big media
</quote>
2878 today
—film, records, radio, and cable TV
—was born of a
2879 kind of piracy so defined. The consistent story is how last
2880 generation's pirates join this generation's country club
—until
2886 The film industry of Hollywood was built by fleeing pirates.
<footnote><para>
2888 I am grateful to Peter DiMauro for pointing me to this extraordinary
2889 history. See also Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
87–93,
2890 which details Edison's
<quote>adventures
</quote> with copyright and patent.
2891 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
2893 Creators and directors migrated from the East Coast to California in
2894 the early twentieth century in part to escape controls that patents
2895 granted the inventor of filmmaking, Thomas Edison. These controls were
2896 exercised through a monopoly
<quote>trust,
</quote> the Motion Pictures Patents
2897 Company, and were based on Thomas Edison's creative
2898 property
—patents. Edison formed the MPPC to exercise the rights
2899 this creative property
2900 <!-- PAGE BREAK 67 -->
2901 gave him, and the MPPC was serious about the control it demanded.
2904 As one commentator tells one part of the story,
2908 A January
1909 deadline was set for all companies to comply with
2909 the license. By February, unlicensed outlaws, who referred to
2910 themselves as independents protested the trust and carried on
2911 business without submitting to the Edison monopoly. In the
2912 summer of
1909 the independent movement was in full-swing,
2913 with producers and theater owners using illegal equipment and
2914 imported film stock to create their own underground market.
2917 With the country experiencing a tremendous expansion in the number of
2918 nickelodeons, the Patents Company reacted to the independent movement
2919 by forming a strong-arm subsidiary known as the General Film Company
2920 to block the entry of non-licensed independents. With coercive tactics
2921 that have become legendary, General Film confiscated unlicensed
2922 equipment, discontinued product supply to theaters which showed
2923 unlicensed films, and effectively monopolized distribution with the
2924 acquisition of all U.S. film exchanges, except for the one owned by
2925 the independent William Fox who defied the Trust even after his
2926 license was revoked.
<footnote><para>
2928 J. A. Aberdeen,
<citetitle>Hollywood Renegades: The Society of Independent Motion
2929 Picture Producers
</citetitle> (Cobblestone Entertainment,
2000) and expanded texts
2930 posted at
<quote>The Edison Movie Monopoly: The Motion Picture Patents
2931 Company vs. the Independent Outlaws,
</quote> available at
2932 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
11</ulink>. For a
2933 discussion of the economic motive behind both these limits and the
2934 limits imposed by Victor on phonographs, see Randal C. Picker,
<quote>From
2935 Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and
2936 the Propertization of Copyright
</quote> (September
2002), University of
2937 Chicago Law School, James M. Olin Program in Law and Economics,
2938 Working Paper No.
159.
2939 <indexterm><primary>broadcast flag
</primary></indexterm>
2941 <indexterm><primary>Fox, William
</primary></indexterm>
2942 <indexterm><primary>General Film Company
</primary></indexterm>
2943 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
2947 The Napsters of those days, the
<quote>independents,
</quote> were companies like
2948 Fox. And no less than today, these independents were vigorously
2949 resisted.
<quote>Shooting was disrupted by machinery stolen, and
2950 `accidents' resulting in loss of negatives, equipment, buildings and
2951 sometimes life and limb frequently occurred.
</quote><footnote><para>
2953 Marc Wanamaker,
<quote>The First Studios,
</quote> <citetitle>The Silents Majority
</citetitle>, archived at
2954 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
12</ulink>.
2956 That led the independents to flee the East
2957 Coast. California was remote enough from Edison's reach that
2958 filmmakers there could pirate his inventions without fear of the
2959 law. And the leaders of Hollywood filmmaking, Fox most prominently,
2963 Of course, California grew quickly, and the effective enforcement
2964 of federal law eventually spread west. But because patents grant the
2965 patent holder a truly
<quote>limited
</quote> monopoly (just seventeen years at that
2967 <!-- PAGE BREAK 68 -->
2968 time), by the time enough federal marshals appeared, the patents had
2969 expired. A new industry had been born, in part from the piracy of
2970 Edison's creative property.
2973 <section id=
"recordedmusic">
2974 <title>Recorded Music
</title>
2976 The record industry was born of another kind of piracy, though to see
2977 how requires a bit of detail about the way the law regulates music.
2979 <indexterm id=
"idxfourneauxhenri" class='startofrange'
>
2980 <primary>Fourneaux, Henri
</primary>
2982 <indexterm><primary>Russel, Phil
</primary></indexterm>
2984 At the time that Edison and Henri Fourneaux invented machines
2985 for reproducing music (Edison the phonograph, Fourneaux the player
2986 piano), the law gave composers the exclusive right to control copies of
2987 their music and the exclusive right to control public performances of
2988 their music. In other words, in
1900, if I wanted a copy of Phil Russel's
2989 1899 hit
<quote>Happy Mose,
</quote> the law said I would have to pay for the right
2990 to get a copy of the musical score, and I would also have to pay for the
2991 right to perform it publicly.
2993 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2995 But what if I wanted to record
<quote>Happy Mose,
</quote> using Edison's phonograph
2996 or Fourneaux's player piano? Here the law stumbled. It was clear
2997 enough that I would have to buy any copy of the musical score that I
2998 performed in making this recording. And it was clear enough that I
2999 would have to pay for any public performance of the work I was
3000 recording. But it wasn't totally clear that I would have to pay for a
3001 <quote>public performance
</quote> if I recorded the song in my own house (even
3002 today, you don't owe the Beatles anything if you sing their songs in
3003 the shower), or if I recorded the song from memory (copies in your
3004 brain are not
—yet
— regulated by copyright law). So if I
3005 simply sang the song into a recording device in the privacy of my own
3006 home, it wasn't clear that I owed the composer anything. And more
3007 importantly, it wasn't clear whether I owed the composer anything if I
3008 then made copies of those recordings. Because of this gap in the law,
3009 then, I could effectively pirate someone else's song without paying
3010 its composer anything.
3012 <indexterm startref=
"idxfourneauxhenri" class='endofrange'
/>
3014 The composers (and publishers) were none too happy about
3015 <!-- PAGE BREAK 69 -->
3016 this capacity to pirate. As South Dakota senator Alfred Kittredge
3018 <indexterm><primary>Kittredge, Alfred
</primary></indexterm>
3022 Imagine the injustice of the thing. A composer writes a song or an
3023 opera. A publisher buys at great expense the rights to the same and
3024 copyrights it. Along come the phonographic companies and companies who
3025 cut music rolls and deliberately steal the work of the brain of the
3026 composer and publisher without any regard for [their]
3027 rights.
<footnote><para>
3029 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright: Hearings on
3030 S.
6330 and H.R.
19853 Before the ( Joint) Committees on Patents,
59th
3031 Cong.
59,
1st sess. (
1906) (statement of Senator Alfred B. Kittredge,
3032 of South Dakota, chairman), reprinted in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
3033 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and Abe Goldman, eds. (South
3034 Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
3035 <indexterm><primary>Kittredge, Alfred
</primary></indexterm>
3039 <indexterm><primary>Sousa, John Philip
</primary></indexterm>
3041 The innovators who developed the technology to record other
3042 people's works were
<quote>sponging upon the toil, the work, the talent, and
3043 genius of American composers,
</quote><footnote><para>
3045 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
223
3046 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
3048 and the
<quote>music publishing industry
</quote>
3049 was thereby
<quote>at the complete mercy of this one pirate.
</quote><footnote><para>
3051 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
226
3052 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
3055 Sousa put it, in as direct a way as possible,
<quote>When they make money
3056 out of my pieces, I want a share of it.
</quote><footnote><para>
3058 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
23
3059 (statement of John Philip Sousa, composer).
3063 These arguments have familiar echoes in the wars of our day. So, too,
3064 do the arguments on the other side. The innovators who developed the
3065 player piano argued that
<quote>it is perfectly demonstrable that the
3066 introduction of automatic music players has not deprived any composer
3067 of anything he had before their introduction.
</quote> Rather, the machines
3068 increased the sales of sheet music.
<footnote><para>
3071 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
283–84
3072 (statement of Albert Walker, representative of the Auto-Music
3073 Perforating Company of New York).
3074 </para></footnote> In any case, the innovators argued, the job of
3075 Congress was
<quote>to consider first the interest of [the public], whom
3076 they represent, and whose servants they are.
</quote> <quote>All talk about
3077 `theft,'
</quote> the general counsel of the American Graphophone Company
3078 wrote,
<quote>is the merest claptrap, for there exists no property in ideas
3079 musical, literary or artistic, except as defined by
3080 statute.
</quote><footnote><para>
3082 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
376 (prepared
3083 memorandum of Philip Mauro, general patent counsel of the American
3084 Graphophone Company Association).
3086 <indexterm><primary>American Graphophone Company
</primary></indexterm>
3089 The law soon resolved this battle in favor of the composer
3090 <emphasis>and
</emphasis> the recording artist. Congress amended the
3091 law to make sure that composers would be paid for the
<quote>mechanical
3092 reproductions
</quote> of their music. But rather than simply granting the
3093 composer complete control over the right to make mechanical
3094 reproductions, Congress gave recording artists a right to record the
3095 music, at a price set by Congress, once the composer allowed it to be
3096 recorded once. This is the part of
3098 <!-- PAGE BREAK 70 -->
3099 copyright law that makes cover songs possible. Once a composer
3100 authorizes a recording of his song, others are free to record the same
3101 song, so long as they pay the original composer a fee set by the law.
3104 American law ordinarily calls this a
<quote>compulsory license,
</quote> but I will
3105 refer to it as a
<quote>statutory license.
</quote> A statutory license is a license
3106 whose key terms are set by law. After Congress's amendment of the
3107 Copyright Act in
1909, record companies were free to distribute copies
3108 of recordings so long as they paid the composer (or copyright holder)
3109 the fee set by the statute.
3112 This is an exception within the law of copyright. When John Grisham
3113 writes a novel, a publisher is free to publish that novel only if
3114 Grisham gives the publisher permission. Grisham, in turn, is free to
3115 charge whatever he wants for that permission. The price to publish
3116 Grisham is thus set by Grisham, and copyright law ordinarily says you
3117 have no permission to use Grisham's work except with permission of
3119 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
3122 But the law governing recordings gives recording artists less. And
3123 thus, in effect, the law
<emphasis>subsidizes
</emphasis> the recording
3124 industry through a kind of piracy
—by giving recording artists a
3125 weaker right than it otherwise gives creative authors. The Beatles
3126 have less control over their creative work than Grisham does. And the
3127 beneficiaries of this less control are the recording industry and the
3128 public. The recording industry gets something of value for less than
3129 it otherwise would pay; the public gets access to a much wider range
3130 of musical creativity. Indeed, Congress was quite explicit about its
3131 reasons for granting this right. Its fear was the monopoly power of
3132 rights holders, and that that power would stifle follow-on
3133 creativity.
<footnote><para>
3136 Copyright Law Revision: Hearings on S.
2499, S.
2900, H.R.
243, and
3137 H.R.
11794 Before the ( Joint) Committee on Patents,
60th Cong.,
1st
3138 sess.,
217 (
1908) (statement of Senator Reed Smoot, chairman), reprinted
3139 in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
1909 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and
3140 Abe Goldman, eds. (South Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
3142 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
3145 While the recording industry has been quite coy about this recently,
3146 historically it has been quite a supporter of the statutory license for
3147 records. As a
1967 report from the House Committee on the Judiciary
3152 the record producers argued vigorously that the compulsory
3153 <!-- PAGE BREAK 71 -->
3154 license system must be retained. They asserted that the record
3155 industry is a half-billion-dollar business of great economic
3156 importance in the United States and throughout the world; records
3157 today are the principal means of disseminating music, and this creates
3158 special problems, since performers need unhampered access to musical
3159 material on nondiscriminatory terms. Historically, the record
3160 producers pointed out, there were no recording rights before
1909 and
3161 the
1909 statute adopted the compulsory license as a deliberate
3162 anti-monopoly condition on the grant of these rights. They argue that
3163 the result has been an outpouring of recorded music, with the public
3164 being given lower prices, improved quality, and a greater
3165 choice.
<footnote><para>
3167 Copyright Law Revision: Report to Accompany H.R.
2512, House Committee
3168 on the Judiciary,
90th Cong.,
1st sess., House Document no.
83, (
8
3169 March
1967). I am grateful to Glenn Brown for drawing my attention to
3170 this report.
</para></footnote>
3174 By limiting the rights musicians have, by partially pirating their
3175 creative work, the record producers, and the public, benefit.
3178 <section id=
"radio">
3179 <title>Radio
</title>
3180 <indexterm id='idxartistspayments1' class='startofrange'
>
3181 <primary>artists
</primary>
3182 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
3185 Radio was also born of piracy.
3188 When a radio station plays a record on the air, that constitutes a
3189 <quote>public performance
</quote> of the composer's work.
<footnote><para>
3191 See
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, sections
106 and
110. At the beginning,
3192 record companies printed
<quote>Not Licensed for Radio Broadcast
</quote> and other
3193 messages purporting to restrict the ability to play a record on a
3194 radio station. Judge Learned Hand rejected the argument that a
3195 warning attached to a record might restrict the rights of the radio
3196 station. See
<citetitle>RCA Manufacturing Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Whiteman
</citetitle>,
114 F.
2d
86 (
2nd
3197 Cir.
1940). See also Randal C. Picker,
<quote>From Edison to the Broadcast
3198 Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and the Propertization of
3199 Copyright,
</quote> <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
281.
3200 <indexterm><primary>Hand, Learned
</primary></indexterm>
3201 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
3203 As I described above, the law gives the composer (or copyright holder)
3204 an exclusive right to public performances of his work. The radio
3205 station thus owes the composer money for that performance.
3208 But when the radio station plays a record, it is not only performing a
3209 copy of the
<emphasis>composer's
</emphasis> work. The radio station is
3210 also performing a copy of the
<emphasis>recording artist's
</emphasis>
3211 work. It's one thing to have
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> sung on the radio by the
3212 local children's choir; it's quite another to have it sung by the
3213 Rolling Stones or Lyle Lovett. The recording artist is adding to the
3214 value of the composition performed on the radio station. And if the
3215 law were perfectly consistent, the radio station would have to pay the
3216 recording artist for his work, just as it pays the composer of the
3218 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
3220 <!-- PAGE BREAK 72 -->
3223 But it doesn't. Under the law governing radio performances, the radio
3224 station does not have to pay the recording artist. The radio station
3225 need only pay the composer. The radio station thus gets a bit of
3226 something for nothing. It gets to perform the recording artist's work
3227 for free, even if it must pay the composer something for the privilege
3228 of playing the song.
3230 <indexterm id=
"idxmadonna" class='startofrange'
>
3231 <primary>Madonna
</primary>
3234 This difference can be huge. Imagine you compose a piece of music.
3235 Imagine it is your first. You own the exclusive right to authorize
3236 public performances of that music. So if Madonna wants to sing your
3237 song in public, she has to get your permission.
3240 Imagine she does sing your song, and imagine she likes it a lot. She
3241 then decides to make a recording of your song, and it becomes a top
3242 hit. Under our law, every time a radio station plays your song, you
3243 get some money. But Madonna gets nothing, save the indirect effect on
3244 the sale of her CDs. The public performance of her recording is not a
3245 <quote>protected
</quote> right. The radio station thus gets to
3246 <emphasis>pirate
</emphasis> the value of Madonna's work without paying
3249 <indexterm startref=
"idxmadonna" class='endofrange'
/>
3251 No doubt, one might argue that, on balance, the recording artists
3252 benefit. On average, the promotion they get is worth more than the
3253 performance rights they give up. Maybe. But even if so, the law
3254 ordinarily gives the creator the right to make this choice. By making
3255 the choice for him or her, the law gives the radio station the right
3256 to take something for nothing.
3258 <indexterm startref='idxartistspayments1' class='endofrange'
/>
3260 <section id=
"cabletv">
3261 <title>Cable TV
</title>
3264 Cable TV was also born of a kind of piracy.
3267 When cable entrepreneurs first started wiring communities with cable
3268 television in
1948, most refused to pay broadcasters for the content
3269 that they echoed to their customers. Even when the cable companies
3270 started selling access to television broadcasts, they refused to pay
3271 <!-- PAGE BREAK 73 -->
3272 for what they sold. Cable companies were thus Napsterizing
3273 broadcasters' content, but more egregiously than anything Napster ever
3274 did
— Napster never charged for the content it enabled others to
3277 <indexterm><primary>Anello, Douglas
</primary></indexterm>
3278 <indexterm><primary>Burdick, Quentin
</primary></indexterm>
3279 <indexterm><primary>Hyde, Rosel H.
</primary></indexterm>
3281 Broadcasters and copyright owners were quick to attack this theft.
3282 Rosel Hyde, chairman of the FCC, viewed the practice as a kind of
3283 <quote>unfair and potentially destructive competition.
</quote><footnote><para>
3285 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV: Hearing on S.
1006 Before the
3286 Subcommittee on Patents, Trademarks, and Copyrights of the Senate
3287 Committee on the Judiciary,
89th Cong.,
2nd sess.,
78 (
1966)
3288 (statement of Rosel H. Hyde, chairman of the Federal Communications
3290 <indexterm><primary>Hyde, Rosel H.
</primary></indexterm>
3292 There may have been a
<quote>public interest
</quote> in spreading the reach of cable
3293 TV, but as Douglas Anello, general counsel to the National Association
3294 of Broadcasters, asked Senator Quentin Burdick during testimony,
<quote>Does public
3295 interest dictate that you use somebody else's property?
</quote><footnote><para>
3297 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
116 (statement of Douglas A. Anello,
3298 general counsel of the National Association of Broadcasters).
3300 As another broadcaster put it,
3304 The extraordinary thing about the CATV business is that it is the
3305 only business I know of where the product that is being sold is not
3306 paid for.
<footnote><para>
3308 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
126 (statement of Ernest W. Jennes,
3309 general counsel of the Association of Maximum Service Telecasters, Inc.).
3314 Again, the demand of the copyright holders seemed reasonable enough:
3318 All we are asking for is a very simple thing, that people who now
3319 take our property for nothing pay for it. We are trying to stop
3320 piracy and I don't think there is any lesser word to describe it. I
3321 think there are harsher words which would fit it.
<footnote><para>
3323 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
169 (joint statement of Arthur B.
3324 Krim, president of United Artists Corp., and John Sinn, president of
3325 United Artists Television, Inc.).
3329 <indexterm><primary>Heston, Charlton
</primary></indexterm>
3331 These were
<quote>free-ride[rs],
</quote> Screen Actor's Guild president Charlton
3332 Heston said, who were
<quote>depriving actors of
3333 compensation.
</quote><footnote><para>
3335 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
209 (statement of Charlton Heston,
3336 president of the Screen Actors Guild).
3337 <indexterm><primary>Heston, Charlton
</primary></indexterm>
3342 But again, there was another side to the debate. As Assistant Attorney
3343 General Edwin Zimmerman put it,
3347 Our point here is that unlike the problem of whether you have any
3348 copyright protection at all, the problem here is whether copyright
3349 holders who are already compensated, who already have a monopoly,
3350 should be permitted to extend that monopoly.
… The
3352 <!-- PAGE BREAK 74 -->
3353 question here is how much compensation they should have and
3354 how far back they should carry their right to compensation.
<footnote><para>
3356 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
216 (statement of Edwin M.
3357 Zimmerman, acting assistant attorney general).
3358 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3360 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3364 Copyright owners took the cable companies to court. Twice the Supreme
3365 Court held that the cable companies owed the copyright owners nothing.
3368 It took Congress almost thirty years before it resolved the question
3369 of whether cable companies had to pay for the content they
<quote>pirated.
</quote>
3370 In the end, Congress resolved this question in the same way that it
3371 resolved the question about record players and player pianos. Yes,
3372 cable companies would have to pay for the content that they broadcast;
3373 but the price they would have to pay was not set by the copyright
3374 owner. The price was set by law, so that the broadcasters couldn't
3375 exercise veto power over the emerging technologies of cable. Cable
3376 companies thus built their empire in part upon a
<quote>piracy
</quote> of the value
3377 created by broadcasters' content.
3380 <emphasis role='strong'
>These separate stories
</emphasis> sing a
3381 common theme. If
<quote>piracy
</quote> means using value from someone
3382 else's creative property without permission from that creator
—as
3383 it is increasingly described today
<footnote><para>
3385 See, for example, National Music Publisher's Association,
<citetitle>The Engine
3386 of Free Expression: Copyright on the Internet
—The Myth of Free
3387 Information
</citetitle>, available at
3388 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
13</ulink>.
<quote>The
3389 threat of piracy
—the use of someone else's creative work without
3390 permission or compensation
—has grown with the Internet.
</quote>
3392 — then
<emphasis>every
</emphasis> industry affected by copyright
3393 today is the product and beneficiary of a certain kind of
3394 piracy. Film, records, radio, cable TV.
… The list is long and
3395 could well be expanded. Every generation welcomes the pirates from the
3396 last. Every generation
—until now.
3398 <!-- PAGE BREAK 75 -->
3401 <chapter label=
"5" id=
"piracy">
3402 <title>CHAPTER FIVE:
<quote>Piracy
</quote></title>
3404 <emphasis role='strong'
>There is piracy
</emphasis> of copyrighted
3405 material. Lots of it. This piracy comes in many forms. The most
3406 significant is commercial piracy, the unauthorized taking of other
3407 people's content within a commercial context. Despite the many
3408 justifications that are offered in its defense, this taking is
3409 wrong. No one should condone it, and the law should stop it.
3412 But as well as copy-shop piracy, there is another kind of
<quote>taking
</quote>
3413 that is more directly related to the Internet. That taking, too, seems
3414 wrong to many, and it is wrong much of the time. Before we paint this
3415 taking
<quote>piracy,
</quote> however, we should understand its nature a bit more.
3416 For the harm of this taking is significantly more ambiguous than
3417 outright copying, and the law should account for that ambiguity, as it
3418 has so often done in the past.
3419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 76 -->
3421 <section id=
"piracy-i">
3422 <title>Piracy I
</title>
3423 <indexterm><primary>Asia, commercial piracy in
</primary></indexterm>
3425 All across the world, but especially in Asia and Eastern Europe, there
3426 are businesses that do nothing but take others people's copyrighted
3427 content, copy it, and sell it
—all without the permission of a copyright
3428 owner. The recording industry estimates that it loses about $
4.6 billion
3429 every year to physical piracy
<footnote><para>
3431 See IFPI (International Federation of the Phonographic Industry),
<citetitle>The
3432 Recording Industry Commercial Piracy Report
2003</citetitle>, July
2003, available
3433 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
14</ulink>. See
3434 also Ben Hunt,
<quote>Companies Warned on Music Piracy Risk,
</quote> <citetitle>Financial
3435 Times
</citetitle>,
14 February
2003,
11.
3437 (that works out to one in three CDs sold worldwide). The MPAA
3438 estimates that it loses $
3 billion annually worldwide to piracy.
3441 This is piracy plain and simple. Nothing in the argument of this
3442 book, nor in the argument that most people make when talking about
3443 the subject of this book, should draw into doubt this simple point:
3444 This piracy is wrong.
3447 Which is not to say that excuses and justifications couldn't be made
3448 for it. We could, for example, remind ourselves that for the first one
3449 hundred years of the American Republic, America did not honor foreign
3450 copyrights. We were born, in this sense, a pirate nation. It might
3451 therefore seem hypocritical for us to insist so strongly that other
3452 developing nations treat as wrong what we, for the first hundred years
3453 of our existence, treated as right.
3456 That excuse isn't terribly strong. Technically, our law did not ban
3457 the taking of foreign works. It explicitly limited itself to American
3458 works. Thus the American publishers who published foreign works
3459 without the permission of foreign authors were not violating any rule.
3460 The copy shops in Asia, by contrast, are violating Asian law. Asian
3461 law does protect foreign copyrights, and the actions of the copy shops
3462 violate that law. So the wrong of piracy that they engage in is not
3463 just a moral wrong, but a legal wrong, and not just an internationally
3464 legal wrong, but a locally legal wrong as well.
3467 True, these local rules have, in effect, been imposed upon these
3468 countries. No country can be part of the world economy and choose
3469 <beginpage pagenum=
"77"/>
3470 not to protect copyright internationally. We may have been born a
3471 pirate nation, but we will not allow any other nation to have a
3475 If a country is to be treated as a sovereign, however, then its laws are
3476 its laws regardless of their source. The international law under which
3477 these nations live gives them some opportunities to escape the burden
3478 of intellectual property law.
<footnote><para>
3480 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism:
3481 <citetitle>Who Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The
3482 New Press,
2003),
10–13,
209. The Trade-Related Aspects of
3483 Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPS) agreement obligates member
3484 nations to create administrative and enforcement mechanisms for
3485 intellectual property rights, a costly proposition for developing
3486 countries. Additionally, patent rights may lead to higher prices for
3487 staple industries such as agriculture. Critics of TRIPS question the
3488 disparity between burdens imposed upon developing countries and
3489 benefits conferred to industrialized nations. TRIPS does permit
3490 governments to use patents for public, noncommercial uses without
3491 first obtaining the patent holder's permission. Developing nations may
3492 be able to use this to gain the benefits of foreign patents at lower
3493 prices. This is a promising strategy for developing nations within the
3495 <indexterm><primary>agricultural patents
</primary></indexterm>
3496 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
3497 </para></footnote> In my view, more developing nations should take
3498 advantage of that opportunity, but when they don't, then their laws
3499 should be respected. And under the laws of these nations, this piracy
3502 <indexterm><primary>Asia, commercial piracy in
</primary></indexterm>
3504 Alternatively, we could try to excuse this piracy by noting that in
3505 any case, it does no harm to the industry. The Chinese who get access
3506 to American CDs at
50 cents a copy are not people who would have
3507 bought those American CDs at $
15 a copy. So no one really has any
3508 less money than they otherwise would have had.
<footnote><para>
3510 For an analysis of the economic impact of copying technology, see Stan
3511 Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002),
3512 144–90.
<quote>In some instances
… the impact of piracy on the
3513 copyright holder's ability to appropriate the value of the work will
3514 be negligible. One obvious instance is the case where the individual
3515 engaging in pirating would not have purchased an original even if
3516 pirating were not an option.
</quote> Ibid.,
149.
3517 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3521 This is often true (though I have friends who have purchased many
3522 thousands of pirated DVDs who certainly have enough money to pay
3523 for the content they have taken), and it does mitigate to some degree
3524 the harm caused by such taking. Extremists in this debate love to say,
3525 <quote>You wouldn't go into Barnes
& Noble and take a book off of the shelf
3526 without paying; why should it be any different with on-line music?
</quote>
3527 The difference is, of course, that when you take a book from Barnes
&
3528 Noble, it has one less book to sell. By contrast, when you take an MP3
3529 from a computer network, there is not one less CD that can be sold.
3530 The physics of piracy of the intangible are different from the physics of
3531 piracy of the tangible.
3534 This argument is still very weak. However, although copyright is a
3535 property right of a very special sort, it
<emphasis>is
</emphasis> a
3536 property right. Like all property rights, the copyright gives the
3537 owner the right to decide the terms under which content is shared. If
3538 the copyright owner doesn't want to sell, she doesn't have to. There
3539 are exceptions: important statutory licenses that apply to copyrighted
3540 content regardless of the wish of the copyright owner. Those licenses
3541 give people the right to
<quote>take
</quote> copyrighted content whether or not the
3542 copyright owner wants to sell. But
3544 <!-- PAGE BREAK 78 -->
3545 where the law does not give people the right to take content, it is
3546 wrong to take that content even if the wrong does no harm. If we have
3547 a property system, and that system is properly balanced to the
3548 technology of a time, then it is wrong to take property without the
3549 permission of a property owner. That is exactly what
<quote>property
</quote> means.
3551 <indexterm><primary>Asia, commercial piracy in
</primary></indexterm>
3553 Finally, we could try to excuse this piracy with the argument that the
3554 piracy actually helps the copyright owner. When the Chinese
<quote>steal
</quote>
3555 Windows, that makes the Chinese dependent on Microsoft. Microsoft
3556 loses the value of the software that was taken. But it gains users who
3557 are used to life in the Microsoft world. Over time, as the nation
3558 grows more wealthy, more and more people will buy software rather than
3559 steal it. And hence over time, because that buying will benefit
3560 Microsoft, Microsoft benefits from the piracy. If instead of pirating
3561 Microsoft Windows, the Chinese used the free GNU/Linux operating
3562 system, then these Chinese users would not eventually be buying
3563 Microsoft. Without piracy, then, Microsoft would lose.
3564 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3565 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3567 <primary>Microsoft
</primary>
3568 <secondary>Windows operating system of
</secondary>
3570 <indexterm><primary>Windows
</primary></indexterm>
3573 This argument, too, is somewhat true. The addiction strategy is a good
3574 one. Many businesses practice it. Some thrive because of it. Law
3575 students, for example, are given free access to the two largest legal
3576 databases. The companies marketing both hope the students will become
3577 so used to their service that they will want to use it and not the
3578 other when they become lawyers (and must pay high subscription fees).
3581 Still, the argument is not terribly persuasive. We don't give the
3582 alcoholic a defense when he steals his first beer, merely because that
3583 will make it more likely that he will buy the next three. Instead, we
3584 ordinarily allow businesses to decide for themselves when it is best
3585 to give their product away. If Microsoft fears the competition of
3586 GNU/Linux, then Microsoft can give its product away, as it did, for
3587 example, with Internet Explorer to fight Netscape. A property right
3588 means giving the property owner the right to say who gets access to
3589 what
—at least ordinarily. And if the law properly balances the
3590 rights of the copyright owner with the rights of access, then
3591 violating the law is still wrong.
3592 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3593 <indexterm><primary>Internet Explorer
</primary></indexterm>
3594 <indexterm><primary>Netscape
</primary></indexterm>
3595 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3598 <!-- PAGE BREAK 79 -->
3599 Thus, while I understand the pull of these justifications for piracy,
3600 and I certainly see the motivation, in my view, in the end, these efforts
3601 at justifying commercial piracy simply don't cut it. This kind of piracy
3602 is rampant and just plain wrong. It doesn't transform the content it
3603 steals; it doesn't transform the market it competes in. It merely gives
3604 someone access to something that the law says he should not have.
3605 Nothing has changed to draw that law into doubt. This form of piracy
3609 But as the examples from the four chapters that introduced this part
3610 suggest, even if some piracy is plainly wrong, not all
<quote>piracy
</quote> is. Or
3611 at least, not all
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong if that term is understood in the
3612 way it is increasingly used today. Many kinds of
<quote>piracy
</quote> are useful
3613 and productive, to produce either new content or new ways of doing
3614 business. Neither our tradition nor any tradition has ever banned all
3615 <quote>piracy
</quote> in that sense of the term.
3618 This doesn't mean that there are no questions raised by the latest
3619 piracy concern, peer-to-peer file sharing. But it does mean that we
3620 need to understand the harm in peer-to-peer sharing a bit more before
3621 we condemn it to the gallows with the charge of piracy.
3624 For (
1) like the original Hollywood, p2p sharing escapes an overly
3625 controlling industry; and (
2) like the original recording industry, it
3626 simply exploits a new way to distribute content; but (
3) unlike cable
3627 TV, no one is selling the content that is shared on p2p services.
3630 These differences distinguish p2p sharing from true piracy. They
3631 should push us to find a way to protect artists while enabling this
3635 <section id=
"piracy-ii">
3636 <title>Piracy II
</title>
3638 The key to the
<quote>piracy
</quote> that the law aims to quash is a use that
<quote>rob[s]
3639 the author of [his] profit.
</quote><footnote><para>
3641 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777).
3643 This means we must determine whether
3644 and how much p2p sharing harms before we know how strongly the
3645 <!-- PAGE BREAK 80 -->
3646 law should seek to either prevent it or find an alternative to assure the
3647 author of his profit.
3649 <indexterm><primary>innovation
</primary></indexterm>
3651 Peer-to-peer sharing was made famous by Napster. But the inventors of
3652 the Napster technology had not made any major technological
3653 innovations. Like every great advance in innovation on the Internet
3654 (and, arguably, off the Internet as well
<footnote><para>
3656 <indexterm><primary>innovation
</primary></indexterm>
3657 See Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
3658 National Bestseller That Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle> (New York:
3659 HarperBusiness,
2000). Professor Christensen examines why companies
3660 that give rise to and dominate a product area are frequently unable to
3661 come up with the most creative, paradigm-shifting uses for their own
3662 products. This job usually falls to outside innovators, who
3663 reassemble existing technology in inventive ways. For a discussion of
3664 Christensen's ideas, see Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
89–92,
139.
3666 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
3667 </para></footnote>), Shawn Fanning and crew had simply
3668 put together components that had been developed independently.
3669 <indexterm><primary>Fanning, Shawn
</primary></indexterm>
3672 The result was spontaneous combustion. Launched in July
1999,
3673 Napster amassed over
10 million users within nine months. After
3674 eighteen months, there were close to
80 million registered users of the
3675 system.
<footnote><para>
3677 See Carolyn Lochhead,
<quote>Silicon Valley Dream, Hollywood Nightmare,
</quote> <citetitle>San
3678 Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24 September
2002, A1;
<quote>Rock 'n' Roll Suicide,
</quote>
3679 <citetitle>New Scientist
</citetitle>,
6 July
2002,
42; Benny Evangelista,
<quote>Napster Names CEO,
3680 Secures New Financing,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
23 May
2003, C1;
3681 <quote>Napster's Wake-Up Call,
</quote> <citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
24 June
2000,
23; John Naughton,
3682 <quote>Hollywood at War with the Internet
</quote> (London)
<citetitle>Times
</citetitle>,
26 July
2002,
18.
3684 Courts quickly shut Napster down, but other services emerged
3685 to take its place. (Kazaa is currently the most popular p2p service. It
3686 boasts over
100 million members.) These services' systems are different
3687 architecturally, though not very different in function: Each enables
3688 users to make content available to any number of other users. With a
3689 p2p system, you can share your favorite songs with your best friend
—
3690 or your
20,
000 best friends.
3693 According to a number of estimates, a huge proportion of Americans
3694 have tasted file-sharing technology. A study by Ipsos-Insight in
3695 September
2002 estimated that
60 million Americans had downloaded
3696 music
—28 percent of Americans older than
12.
<footnote><para>
3699 See Ipsos-Insight,
<citetitle>TEMPO: Keeping Pace with Online Music Distribution
</citetitle>
3700 (September
2002), reporting that
28 percent of Americans aged twelve
3701 and older have downloaded music off of the Internet and
30 percent have
3702 listened to digital music files stored on their computers.
3704 A survey by the NPD group quoted in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>
3705 estimated that
43 million citizens used file-sharing networks to
3706 exchange content in May
2003.
<footnote><para>
3708 Amy Harmon,
<quote>Industry Offers a Carrot in Online Music Fight,
</quote> <citetitle>New
3709 York Times
</citetitle>,
6 June
2003, A1.
3711 The vast majority of these are not kids. Whatever the actual figure, a
3712 massive quantity of content is being
<quote>taken
</quote> on these networks. The
3713 ease and inexpensiveness of file-sharing networks have inspired
3714 millions to enjoy music in a way that they hadn't before.
3717 Some of this enjoying involves copyright infringement. Some of it does
3718 not. And even among the part that is technically copyright
3719 infringement, calculating the actual harm to copyright owners is more
3720 complicated than one might think. So consider
—a bit more
3721 carefully than the polarized voices around this debate usually
3722 do
—the kinds of sharing that file sharing enables, and the kinds
3726 <!-- PAGE BREAK 81 -->
3727 File sharers share different kinds of content. We can divide these
3728 different kinds into four types.
3730 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
3733 There are some who use sharing networks as substitutes for purchasing
3734 content. Thus, when a new Madonna CD is released, rather than buying
3735 the CD, these users simply take it. We might quibble about whether
3736 everyone who takes it would actually have bought it if sharing didn't
3737 make it available for free. Most probably wouldn't have, but clearly
3738 there are some who would. The latter are the target of category A:
3739 users who download instead of purchasing.
3740 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
3744 There are some who use sharing networks to sample music before
3745 purchasing it. Thus, a friend sends another friend an MP3 of an artist
3746 he's not heard of. The other friend then buys CDs by that artist. This
3747 is a kind of targeted advertising, quite likely to succeed. If the
3748 friend recommending the album gains nothing from a bad recommendation,
3749 then one could expect that the recommendations will actually be quite
3750 good. The net effect of this sharing could increase the quantity of
3755 There are many who use sharing networks to get access to copyrighted
3756 content that is no longer sold or that they would not have purchased
3757 because the transaction costs off the Net are too high. This use of
3758 sharing networks is among the most rewarding for many. Songs that were
3759 part of your childhood but have long vanished from the marketplace
3760 magically appear again on the network. (One friend told me that when
3761 she discovered Napster, she spent a solid weekend
<quote>recalling
</quote> old
3762 songs. She was astonished at the range and mix of content that was
3763 available.) For content not sold, this is still technically a
3764 violation of copyright, though because the copyright owner is not
3765 selling the content anymore, the economic harm is zero
—the same
3766 harm that occurs when I sell my collection of
1960s
45-rpm records to
3770 <!-- PAGE BREAK 82 -->
3772 Finally, there are many who use sharing networks to get access
3773 to content that is not copyrighted or that the copyright owner
3778 How do these different types of sharing balance out?
3781 Let's start with some simple but important points. From the
3782 perspective of the law, only type D sharing is clearly legal. From the
3783 perspective of economics, only type A sharing is clearly
3784 harmful.
<footnote><para>
3786 See Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle>,
148–49.
3787 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3789 Type B sharing is illegal but plainly beneficial. Type C sharing is
3790 illegal, yet good for society (since more exposure to music is good)
3791 and harmless to the artist (since the work is not otherwise
3792 available). So how sharing matters on balance is a hard question to
3793 answer
—and certainly much more difficult than the current
3794 rhetoric around the issue suggests.
3797 Whether on balance sharing is harmful depends importantly on how
3798 harmful type A sharing is. Just as Edison complained about Hollywood,
3799 composers complained about piano rolls, recording artists complained
3800 about radio, and broadcasters complained about cable TV, the music
3801 industry complains that type A sharing is a kind of
<quote>theft
</quote> that is
3802 <quote>devastating
</quote> the industry.
3805 While the numbers do suggest that sharing is harmful, how
3806 harmful is harder to reckon. It has long been the recording industry's
3807 practice to blame technology for any drop in sales. The history of
3808 cassette recording is a good example. As a study by Cap Gemini Ernst
3809 & Young put it,
<quote>Rather than exploiting this new, popular
3810 technology, the labels fought it.
</quote><footnote><para>
3812 See Cap Gemini Ernst
& Young,
<citetitle>Technology Evolution and the
3813 Music Industry's Business Model Crisis
</citetitle> (
2003),
3. This report
3814 describes the music industry's effort to stigmatize the budding
3815 practice of cassette taping in the
1970s, including an advertising
3816 campaign featuring a cassette-shape skull and the caption
<quote>Home taping
3817 is killing music.
</quote> At the time digital audio tape became a threat,
3818 the Office of Technical Assessment conducted a survey of consumer
3819 behavior. In
1988,
40 percent of consumers older than ten had taped
3820 music to a cassette format. U.S. Congress, Office of Technology
3821 Assessment,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying: Technology Challenges the Law
</citetitle>,
3822 OTA-CIT-
422 (Washington, D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office,
3823 October
1989),
145–56.
</para></footnote>
3824 The labels claimed that every album taped was an album unsold, and
3825 when record sales fell by
11.4 percent in
1981, the industry claimed
3826 that its point was proved. Technology was the problem, and banning or
3827 regulating technology was the answer.
3830 Yet soon thereafter, and before Congress was given an opportunity
3831 to enact regulation, MTV was launched, and the industry had a record
3832 turnaround.
<quote>In the end,
</quote> Cap Gemini concludes,
<quote>the `crisis'
… was
3833 not the fault of the tapers
—who did not [stop after MTV came into
3834 <!-- PAGE BREAK 83 -->
3835 being]
—but had to a large extent resulted from stagnation in musical
3836 innovation at the major labels.
</quote><footnote><para>
3838 U.S. Congress,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying
</citetitle>,
4.
3842 But just because the industry was wrong before does not mean it is
3843 wrong today. To evaluate the real threat that p2p sharing presents to
3844 the industry in particular, and society in general
—or at least
3845 the society that inherits the tradition that gave us the film
3846 industry, the record industry, the radio industry, cable TV, and the
3847 VCR
—the question is not simply whether type A sharing is
3848 harmful. The question is also
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> harmful type A
3849 sharing is, and how beneficial the other types of sharing are.
3852 We start to answer this question by focusing on the net harm, from the
3853 standpoint of the industry as a whole, that sharing networks cause.
3854 The
<quote>net harm
</quote> to the industry as a whole is the amount by which type
3855 A sharing exceeds type B. If the record companies sold more records
3856 through sampling than they lost through substitution, then sharing
3857 networks would actually benefit music companies on balance. They would
3858 therefore have little
<emphasis>static
</emphasis> reason to resist
3863 Could that be true? Could the industry as a whole be gaining because
3864 of file sharing? Odd as that might sound, the data about CD sales
3865 actually suggest it might be close.
3868 In
2002, the RIAA reported that CD sales had fallen by
8.9 percent,
3869 from
882 million to
803 million units; revenues fell
6.7
3870 percent.
<footnote><para>
3872 See Recording Industry Association of America,
<citetitle>2002 Yearend Statistics
</citetitle>,
3874 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
15</ulink>. A later
3875 report indicates even greater losses. See Recording Industry
3876 Association of America,
<citetitle>Some Facts About Music Piracy
</citetitle>,
25 June
2003,
3877 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
3878 #
16</ulink>:
<quote>In the past four years, unit shipments of recorded music
3879 have fallen by
26 percent from
1.16 billion units in to
860 million
3880 units in
2002 in the United States (based on units shipped). In terms
3881 of sales, revenues are down
14 percent, from $
14.6 billion in to $
12.6
3882 billion last year (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments). The music
3883 industry worldwide has gone from a $
39 billion industry in
2000 down
3884 to a $
32 billion industry in
2002 (based on U.S. dollar value of
3887 This confirms a trend over the past few years. The RIAA blames
3888 Internet piracy for the trend, though there are many other causes that
3889 could account for this drop. SoundScan, for example, reports a more
3890 than
20 percent drop in the number of CDs released since
1999. That no
3891 doubt accounts for some of the decrease in sales. Rising prices could
3892 account for at least some of the loss.
<quote>From
1999 to
2001, the average
3893 price of a CD rose
7.2 percent, from $
13.04 to $
14.19.
</quote><footnote>
3896 Jane Black,
<quote>Big Music's Broken Record,
</quote> BusinessWeek online,
13
3897 February
2003, available at
3898 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
17</ulink>.
3899 <indexterm><primary>Black, Jane
</primary></indexterm>
3902 Competition from other forms of media could also account for some of
3903 the decline. As Jane Black of
<citetitle>BusinessWeek
</citetitle> notes,
<quote>The
3904 soundtrack to the film
<citetitle>High Fidelity
</citetitle> has a list price of
3905 $
18.98. You could get the whole movie [on DVD] for
3906 $
19.99.
</quote><footnote><para>
3913 <!-- PAGE BREAK 84 -->
3914 But let's assume the RIAA is right, and all of the decline in CD sales
3915 is because of Internet sharing. Here's the rub: In the same period
3916 that the RIAA estimates that
803 million CDs were sold, the RIAA
3917 estimates that
2.1 billion CDs were downloaded for free. Thus,
3918 although
2.6 times the total number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3919 free, sales revenue fell by just
6.7 percent.
3922 There are too many different things happening at the same time to
3923 explain these numbers definitively, but one conclusion is unavoidable:
3924 The recording industry constantly asks,
<quote>What's the difference between
3925 downloading a song and stealing a CD?
</quote>—but their own numbers
3926 reveal the difference. If I steal a CD, then there is one less CD to
3927 sell. Every taking is a lost sale. But on the basis of the numbers the
3928 RIAA provides, it is absolutely clear that the same is not true of
3929 downloads. If every download were a lost sale
—if every use of
3930 Kazaa
<quote>rob[bed] the author of [his] profit
</quote>—then the industry
3931 would have suffered a
100 percent drop in sales last year, not a
7
3932 percent drop. If
2.6 times the number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3933 free, and yet sales revenue dropped by just
6.7 percent, then there is
3934 a huge difference between
<quote>downloading a song and stealing a CD.
</quote>
3937 These are the harms
—alleged and perhaps exaggerated but, let's
3938 assume, real. What of the benefits? File sharing may impose costs on
3939 the recording industry. What value does it produce in addition to
3943 One benefit is type C sharing
—making available content that
3944 is technically still under copyright but is no longer commercially
3945 available. This is not a small category of content. There are
3946 millions of tracks that are no longer commercially
3947 available.
<footnote><para>
3949 By one estimate,
75 percent of the music released by the major labels
3950 is no longer in print. See Online Entertainment and Copyright
3951 Law
—Coming Soon to a Digital Device Near You: Hearing Before the
3952 Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
107th Cong.,
1st sess. (
3 April
3953 2001) (prepared statement of the Future of Music Coalition), available
3954 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
18</ulink>.
3956 And while it's conceivable that some of this content is not available
3957 because the artist producing the content doesn't want it to be made
3958 available, the vast majority of it is unavailable solely because the
3959 publisher or the distributor has decided it no longer makes economic
3960 sense
<emphasis>to the company
</emphasis> to make it available.
3963 In real space
—long before the Internet
—the market had a simple
3964 <!-- PAGE BREAK 85 -->
3965 response to this problem: used book and record stores. There are
3966 thousands of used book and used record stores in America
3967 today.
<footnote><para>
3969 While there are not good estimates of the number of used record stores in
3970 existence, in
2002, there were
7,
198 used book dealers in the United States,
3971 an increase of
20 percent since
1993. See Book Hunter Press,
<citetitle>The Quiet
3972 Revolution: The Expansion of the Used Book Market
</citetitle> (
2002), available at
3973 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
19</ulink>. Used records accounted for $
260 million in sales in
2002. See
3975 Association of Recording Merchandisers,
<quote>2002 Annual Survey
3978 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
20</ulink>.
3980 These stores buy content from owners, then sell the content they
3981 buy. And under American copyright law, when they buy and sell this
3982 content,
<emphasis>even if the content is still under
3983 copyright
</emphasis>, the copyright owner doesn't get a dime. Used
3984 book and record stores are commercial entities; their owners make
3985 money from the content they sell; but as with cable companies before
3986 statutory licensing, they don't have to pay the copyright owner for
3987 the content they sell.
3989 <indexterm><primary>Bernstein, Leonard
</primary></indexterm>
3991 <primary>books
</primary>
3992 <secondary>out of print
</secondary>
3995 Type C sharing, then, is very much like used book stores or used
3996 record stores. It is different, of course, because the person making
3997 the content available isn't making money from making the content
3998 available. It is also different, of course, because in real space,
3999 when I sell a record, I don't have it anymore, while in cyberspace,
4000 when someone shares my
1949 recording of Bernstein's
<quote>Two Love Songs,
</quote>
4001 I still have it. That difference would matter economically if the
4002 owner of the copyright were selling the record in competition to my
4003 sharing. But we're talking about the class of content that is not
4004 currently commercially available. The Internet is making it available,
4005 through cooperative sharing, without competing with the market.
4008 It may well be, all things considered, that it would be better if the
4009 copyright owner got something from this trade. But just because it may
4010 well be better, it doesn't follow that it would be good to ban used book
4011 stores. Or put differently, if you think that type C sharing should be
4012 stopped, do you think that libraries and used book stores should be
4015 <indexterm id='idxbooksfreeonline1' class='startofrange'
>
4016 <primary>books
</primary>
4017 <secondary>free on-line releases of
</secondary>
4020 Finally, and perhaps most importantly, file-sharing networks enable
4021 type D sharing to occur
—the sharing of content that copyright owners
4022 want to have shared or for which there is no continuing copyright. This
4023 sharing clearly benefits authors and society. Science fiction author
4024 Cory Doctorow, for example, released his first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
4025 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, both free on-line and in bookstores on the same
4027 <!-- PAGE BREAK 86 -->
4028 day. His (and his publisher's) thinking was that the on-line distribution
4029 would be a great advertisement for the
<quote>real
</quote> book. People would read
4030 part on-line, and then decide whether they liked the book or not. If
4031 they liked it, they would be more likely to buy it. Doctorow's content is
4032 type D content. If sharing networks enable his work to be spread, then
4033 both he and society are better off. (Actually, much better off: It is a
4036 <indexterm startref='idxbooksfreeonline1' class='endofrange'
/>
4038 Likewise for work in the public domain: This sharing benefits society
4039 with no legal harm to authors at all. If efforts to solve the problem
4040 of type A sharing destroy the opportunity for type D sharing, then we
4041 lose something important in order to protect type A content.
4044 The point throughout is this: While the recording industry
4045 understandably says,
<quote>This is how much we've lost,
</quote> we must also ask,
4046 <quote>How much has society gained from p2p sharing? What are the
4047 efficiencies? What is the content that otherwise would be
4048 unavailable?
</quote>
4051 For unlike the piracy I described in the first section of this
4052 chapter, much of the
<quote>piracy
</quote> that file sharing enables is plainly
4053 legal and good. And like the piracy I described in chapter
4054 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"pirates"/>, much of
4055 this piracy is motivated by a new way of spreading content caused by
4056 changes in the technology of distribution. Thus, consistent with the
4057 tradition that gave us Hollywood, radio, the recording industry, and
4058 cable TV, the question we should be asking about file sharing is how
4059 best to preserve its benefits while minimizing (to the extent
4060 possible) the wrongful harm it causes artists. The question is one of
4061 balance. The law should seek that balance, and that balance will be
4062 found only with time.
4065 <quote>But isn't the war just a war against illegal sharing? Isn't the target
4066 just what you call type A sharing?
</quote>
4069 You would think. And we should hope. But so far, it is not. The
4071 of the war purportedly on type A sharing alone has been felt far
4072 beyond that one class of sharing. That much is obvious from the
4074 case itself. When Napster told the district court that it had
4076 a technology to block the transfer of
99.4 percent of identified
4077 <!-- PAGE BREAK 87 -->
4078 infringing material, the district court told counsel for Napster
99.4
4079 percent was not good enough. Napster had to push the infringements
4080 <quote>down to zero.
</quote><footnote><para>
4082 See Transcript of Proceedings, In Re: Napster Copyright Litigation at
34-
4083 35 (N.D. Cal.,
11 July
2001), nos. MDL-
00-
1369 MHP, C
99-
5183
4086 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
21</ulink>. For an
4087 account of the litigation and its toll on Napster, see Joseph Menn,
4088 <citetitle>All the Rave: The Rise and Fall of Shawn Fanning's Napster
</citetitle> (New
4089 York: Crown Business,
2003),
269–82.
4093 If
99.4 percent is not good enough, then this is a war on file-sharing
4094 technologies, not a war on copyright infringement. There is no way to
4095 assure that a p2p system is used
100 percent of the time in compliance
4096 with the law, any more than there is a way to assure that
100 percent of
4097 VCRs or
100 percent of Xerox machines or
100 percent of handguns
4098 are used in compliance with the law. Zero tolerance means zero p2p.
4099 The court's ruling means that we as a society must lose the benefits of
4100 p2p, even for the totally legal and beneficial uses they serve, simply to
4101 assure that there are zero copyright infringements caused by p2p.
4104 Zero tolerance has not been our history. It has not produced the
4105 content industry that we know today. The history of American law has
4106 been a process of balance. As new technologies changed the way content
4107 was distributed, the law adjusted, after some time, to the new
4108 technology. In this adjustment, the law sought to ensure the
4109 legitimate rights of creators while protecting innovation. Sometimes
4110 this has meant more rights for creators. Sometimes less.
4113 <primary>artists
</primary>
4114 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
4117 So, as we've seen, when
<quote>mechanical reproduction
</quote> threatened the
4118 interests of composers, Congress balanced the rights of composers
4119 against the interests of the recording industry. It granted rights to
4120 composers, but also to the recording artists: Composers were to be
4121 paid, but at a price set by Congress. But when radio started
4122 broadcasting the recordings made by these recording artists, and they
4123 complained to Congress that their
<quote>creative property
</quote> was not being
4124 respected (since the radio station did not have to pay them for the
4125 creativity it broadcast), Congress rejected their claim. An indirect
4129 Cable TV followed the pattern of record albums. When the courts
4130 rejected the claim that cable broadcasters had to pay for the content
4131 they rebroadcast, Congress responded by giving broadcasters a right to
4132 compensation, but at a level set by the law. It likewise gave cable
4133 companies the right to the content, so long as they paid the statutory
4138 <!-- PAGE BREAK 88 -->
4139 This compromise, like the compromise affecting records and player
4140 pianos, served two important goals
—indeed, the two central goals
4141 of any copyright legislation. First, the law assured that new
4142 innovators would have the freedom to develop new ways to deliver
4143 content. Second, the law assured that copyright holders would be paid
4144 for the content that was distributed. One fear was that if Congress
4145 simply required cable TV to pay copyright holders whatever they
4146 demanded for their content, then copyright holders associated with
4147 broadcasters would use their power to stifle this new technology,
4148 cable. But if Congress had permitted cable to use broadcasters'
4149 content for free, then it would have unfairly subsidized cable. Thus
4150 Congress chose a path that would assure
4151 <emphasis>compensation
</emphasis> without giving the past
4152 (broadcasters) control over the future (cable).
4154 <indexterm><primary>Betamax
</primary></indexterm>
4156 In the same year that Congress struck this balance, two major
4157 producers and distributors of film content filed a lawsuit against
4158 another technology, the video tape recorder (VTR, or as we refer to
4159 them today, VCRs) that Sony had produced, the Betamax. Disney's and
4160 Universal's claim against Sony was relatively simple: Sony produced a
4161 device, Disney and Universal claimed, that enabled consumers to engage
4162 in copyright infringement. Because the device that Sony built had a
4163 <quote>record
</quote> button, the device could be used to record copyrighted movies
4164 and shows. Sony was therefore benefiting from the copyright
4165 infringement of its customers. It should therefore, Disney and
4166 Universal claimed, be partially liable for that infringement.
4169 There was something to Disney's and Universal's claim. Sony did
4170 decide to design its machine to make it very simple to record television
4171 shows. It could have built the machine to block or inhibit any direct
4172 copying from a television broadcast. Or possibly, it could have built the
4173 machine to copy only if there were a special
<quote>copy me
</quote> signal on the
4174 line. It was clear that there were many television shows that did not
4175 grant anyone permission to copy. Indeed, if anyone had asked, no
4176 doubt the majority of shows would not have authorized copying. And
4177 <!-- PAGE BREAK 89 -->
4178 in the face of this obvious preference, Sony could have designed its
4179 system to minimize the opportunity for copyright infringement. It did
4180 not, and for that, Disney and Universal wanted to hold it responsible
4181 for the architecture it chose.
4184 MPAA president Jack Valenti became the studios' most vocal
4185 champion. Valenti called VCRs
<quote>tapeworms.
</quote> He warned,
<quote>When there are
4186 20,
30,
40 million of these VCRs in the land, we will be invaded by
4187 millions of `tapeworms,' eating away at the very heart and essence of
4188 the most precious asset the copyright owner has, his
4189 copyright.
</quote><footnote><para>
4191 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders): Hearing on
4192 S.
1758 Before the Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
97th Cong.,
1st
4193 and
2nd sess.,
459 (
1982) (testimony of Jack Valenti, president, Motion
4194 Picture Association of America, Inc.).
4196 <quote>One does not have to be trained in sophisticated marketing and
4197 creative judgment,
</quote> he told Congress,
<quote>to understand the devastation
4198 on the after-theater marketplace caused by the hundreds of millions of
4199 tapings that will adversely impact on the future of the creative
4200 community in this country. It is simply a question of basic economics
4201 and plain common sense.
</quote><footnote><para>
4203 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
475.
4205 Indeed, as surveys would later show,
4206 percent of VCR owners had movie libraries of ten videos or more
<footnote><para>
4208 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
480 F. Supp.
429,
4211 — a use the Court would later hold was not
<quote>fair.
</quote> By
4212 <quote>allowing VCR owners to copy freely by the means of an exemption from
4213 copyright infringementwithout creating a mechanism to compensate
4214 copyrightowners,
</quote> Valenti testified, Congress would
<quote>take from the
4215 owners the very essence of their property: the exclusive right to
4216 control who may use their work, that is, who may copy it and thereby
4217 profit from its reproduction.
</quote><footnote><para>
4219 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
485 (testimony
4224 It took eight years for this case to be resolved by the Supreme
4225 Court. In the interim, the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals, which
4226 includes Hollywood in its jurisdiction
—leading Judge Alex
4227 Kozinski, who sits on that court, refers to it as the
<quote>Hollywood
4228 Circuit
</quote>—held that Sony would be liable for the copyright
4229 infringement made possible by its machines. Under the Ninth Circuit's
4230 rule, this totally familiar technology
—which Jack Valenti had
4231 called
<quote>the Boston Strangler of the American film industry
</quote> (worse
4232 yet, it was a
<emphasis>Japanese
</emphasis> Boston Strangler of the
4233 American film industry)
—was an illegal
4234 technology.
<footnote><para>
4236 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
659 F.
2d
963 (
9th Cir.
4239 <indexterm><primary>Kozinski, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
4242 But the Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Ninth Circuit.
4244 <!-- PAGE BREAK 90 -->
4245 And in its reversal, the Court clearly articulated its understanding of
4246 when and whether courts should intervene in such disputes. As the
4251 Sound policy, as well as history, supports our consistent deference
4252 to Congress when major technological innovations alter the
4254 for copyrighted materials. Congress has the constitutional
4256 and the institutional ability to accommodate fully the
4257 varied permutations of competing interests that are inevitably
4259 by such new technology.
<footnote><para>
4261 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
431 (
1984).
4266 Congress was asked to respond to the Supreme Court's decision. But as
4267 with the plea of recording artists about radio broadcasts, Congress
4268 ignored the request. Congress was convinced that American film got
4269 enough, this
<quote>taking
</quote> notwithstanding. If we put these cases
4270 together, a pattern is clear:
4273 <informaltable id=
"t1">
4274 <tgroup cols=
"4" align=
"char">
4278 <entry>WHOSE VALUE WAS
<quote>PIRATED
</quote></entry>
4279 <entry>RESPONSE OF THE COURTS
</entry>
4280 <entry>RESPONSE OF CONGRESS
</entry>
4285 <entry>Recordings
</entry>
4286 <entry>Composers
</entry>
4287 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4288 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4291 <entry>Radio
</entry>
4292 <entry>Recording artists
</entry>
4294 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4297 <entry>Cable TV
</entry>
4298 <entry>Broadcasters
</entry>
4299 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4300 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4304 <entry>Film creators
</entry>
4305 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4306 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4313 In each case throughout our history, a new technology changed the
4314 way content was distributed.
<footnote><para>
4316 These are the most important instances in our history, but there are other
4317 cases as well. The technology of digital audio tape (DAT), for example,
4318 was regulated by Congress to minimize the risk of piracy. The remedy
4319 Congress imposed did burden DAT producers, by taxing tape sales and
4320 controlling the technology of DAT. See Audio Home Recording Act of
4321 1992 (Title
17 of the
<citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>), Pub. L. No.
102-
563,
106 Stat.
4322 4237, codified at
17 U.S.C. §
1001. Again, however, this regulation did not
4323 eliminate the opportunity for free riding in the sense I've described. See
4324 Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
71. See also Picker,
<quote>From Edison to the Broadcast Flag,
</quote>
4325 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
293–96.
4326 <indexterm><primary>broadcast flag
</primary></indexterm>
4327 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
4329 In each case, throughout our history,
4330 that change meant that someone got a
<quote>free ride
</quote> on someone else's
4334 In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of these cases did either the courts or
4335 Congress eliminate all free riding. In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of
4336 these cases did the courts or Congress insist that the law should
4337 assure that the copyright holder get all the value that his copyright
4338 created. In every case, the copyright owners complained of
<quote>piracy.
</quote>
4339 In every case, Congress acted to recognize some of the legitimacy in
4340 the behavior of the
<quote>pirates.
</quote> In each case, Congress allowed some new
4341 technology to benefit from content made before. It balanced the
4343 <!-- PAGE BREAK 91 -->
4346 When you think across these examples, and the other examples that
4347 make up the first four chapters of this section, this balance makes
4348 sense. Was Walt Disney a pirate? Would doujinshi be better if creators
4349 had to ask permission? Should tools that enable others to capture and
4350 spread images as a way to cultivate or criticize our culture be better
4352 Is it really right that building a search engine should expose you
4353 to $
15 million in damages? Would it have been better if Edison had
4354 controlled film? Should every cover band have to hire a lawyer to get
4355 permission to record a song?
4358 We could answer yes to each of these questions, but our tradition
4359 has answered no. In our tradition, as the Supreme Court has stated,
4360 copyright
<quote>has never accorded the copyright owner complete control
4361 over all possible uses of his work.
</quote><footnote><para>
4363 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
4366 Instead, the particular uses that the law regulates have been defined
4367 by balancing the good that comes from granting an exclusive right
4368 against the burdens such an exclusive right creates. And this
4369 balancing has historically been done
<emphasis>after
</emphasis> a
4370 technology has matured, or settled into the mix of technologies that
4371 facilitate the distribution of content.
4374 We should be doing the same thing today. The technology of the
4375 Internet is changing quickly. The way people connect to the Internet
4376 (wires vs. wireless) is changing very quickly. No doubt the network
4377 should not become a tool for
<quote>stealing
</quote> from artists. But neither
4378 should the law become a tool to entrench one particular way in which
4379 artists (or more accurately, distributors) get paid. As I describe in
4380 some detail in the last chapter of this book, we should be securing
4381 income to artists while we allow the market to secure the most
4382 efficient way to promote and distribute content. This will require
4383 changes in the law, at least in the interim. These changes should be
4384 designed to balance the protection of the law against the strong
4385 public interest that innovation continue.
4389 <!-- PAGE BREAK 92 -->
4390 This is especially true when a new technology enables a vastly
4391 superior mode of distribution. And this p2p has done. P2p technologies
4392 can be ideally efficient in moving content across a widely diverse
4393 network. Left to develop, they could make the network vastly more
4394 efficient. Yet these
<quote>potential public benefits,
</quote> as John Schwartz
4395 writes in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>,
<quote>could be delayed in the P2P
4396 fight.
</quote><footnote><para>
4398 John Schwartz,
<quote>New Economy: The Attack on Peer-to-Peer Software
4399 Echoes Past Efforts,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 September
2003, C3.
4403 <emphasis role='strong'
>Yet when anyone
</emphasis> begins to talk
4404 about
<quote>balance,
</quote> the copyright warriors raise a different
4405 argument.
<quote>All this hand waving about balance and
4406 incentives,
</quote> they say,
<quote>misses a fundamental point. Our
4407 content,
</quote> the warriors insist,
<quote>is our
4408 <emphasis>property
</emphasis>. Why should we wait for Congress to
4409 `rebalance' our property rights? Do you have to wait before calling
4410 the police when your car has been stolen? And why should Congress
4411 deliberate at all about the merits of this theft? Do we ask whether
4412 the car thief had a good use for the car before we arrest him?
</quote>
4415 <quote>It is
<emphasis>our property
</emphasis>,
</quote> the warriors
4416 insist.
<quote>And it should be protected just as any other property
4417 is protected.
</quote>
4419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 93 -->
4423 <part id=
"c-property">
4424 <title><quote>PROPERTY
</quote></title>
4428 <!-- PAGE BREAK 94 -->
4429 <emphasis role='strong'
>The copyright warriors
</emphasis> are right: A
4430 copyright is a kind of property. It can be owned and sold, and the law
4431 protects against its theft. Ordinarily, the copyright owner gets to
4432 hold out for any price he wants. Markets reckon the supply and demand
4433 that partially determine the price she can get.
4436 But in ordinary language, to call a copyright a
<quote>property
</quote> right is a
4437 bit misleading, for the property of copyright is an odd kind of
4438 property. Indeed, the very idea of property in any idea or any
4439 expression is very odd. I understand what I am taking when I take the
4440 picnic table you put in your backyard. I am taking a thing, the picnic
4441 table, and after I take it, you don't have it. But what am I taking
4442 when I take the good
<emphasis>idea
</emphasis> you had to put a picnic
4443 table in the backyard
—by, for example, going to Sears, buying a
4444 table, and putting it in my backyard? What is the thing I am taking
4448 The point is not just about the thingness of picnic tables versus
4449 ideas, though that's an important difference. The point instead is that
4450 <!-- PAGE BREAK 95 -->
4451 in the ordinary case
—indeed, in practically every case except for a
4453 range of exceptions
—ideas released to the world are free. I don't
4454 take anything from you when I copy the way you dress
—though I
4455 might seem weird if I did it every day, and especially weird if you are a
4456 woman. Instead, as Thomas Jefferson said (and as is especially true
4457 when I copy the way someone else dresses),
<quote>He who receives an idea
4458 from me, receives instruction himself without lessening mine; as he who
4459 lights his taper at mine, receives light without darkening me.
</quote><footnote><para>
4461 Letter from Thomas Jefferson to Isaac McPherson (
13 August
1813) in
4462 <citetitle>The Writings of Thomas Jefferson
</citetitle>, vol.
6 (Andrew A. Lipscomb and Albert
4463 Ellery Bergh, eds.,
1903),
330,
333–34.
4467 The exceptions to free use are ideas and expressions within the
4468 reach of the law of patent and copyright, and a few other domains that
4469 I won't discuss here. Here the law says you can't take my idea or
4471 without my permission: The law turns the intangible into
4475 But how, and to what extent, and in what form
—the details,
4476 in other words
—matter. To get a good sense of how this practice
4477 of turning the intangible into property emerged, we need to place this
4478 <quote>property
</quote> in its proper context.
<footnote><para>
4480 As the legal realists taught American law, all property rights are
4481 intangible. A property right is simply a right that an individual has
4482 against the world to do or not do certain things that may or may not
4483 attach to a physical object. The right itself is intangible, even if
4484 the object to which it is (metaphorically) attached is tangible. See
4485 Adam Mossoff,
<quote>What Is Property? Putting the Pieces Back Together,
</quote>
4486 <citetitle>Arizona Law Review
</citetitle> 45 (
2003):
373,
429 n.
241.
4490 My strategy in doing this will be the same as my strategy in the
4491 preceding part. I offer four stories to help put the idea of
4492 <quote>copyright material is property
</quote> in context. Where did the idea come
4493 from? What are its limits? How does it function in practice? After
4494 these stories, the significance of this true
4495 statement
—<quote>copyright material is property
</quote>— will be a bit
4496 more clear, and its implications will be revealed as quite different
4497 from the implications that the copyright warriors would have us draw.
4501 <!-- PAGE BREAK 96 -->
4502 <chapter label=
"6" id=
"founders">
4503 <title>CHAPTER SIX: Founders
</title>
4504 <indexterm><primary>Henry V
</primary></indexterm>
4505 <indexterm><primary>Branagh, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
4506 <indexterm id='idxbooksenglishlaw' class='startofrange'
>
4507 <primary>books
</primary>
4508 <secondary>English copyright law developed for
</secondary>
4511 <emphasis role='strong'
>William Shakespeare
</emphasis> wrote
4512 <citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> in
1595. The play was first
4513 published in
1597. It was the eleventh major play that Shakespeare had
4514 written. He would continue to write plays through
1613, and the plays
4515 that he wrote have continued to define Anglo-American culture ever
4516 since. So deeply have the works of a sixteenth-century writer seeped
4517 into our culture that we often don't even recognize their source. I
4518 once overheard someone commenting on Kenneth Branagh's adaptation of
4519 Henry V:
<quote>I liked it, but Shakespeare is so full of
4523 In
1774, almost
180 years after
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> was written, the
4524 <quote>copy-right
</quote> for the work was still thought by many to be the exclusive
4525 right of a single London publisher, Jacob Tonson.
<footnote><para>
4527 <indexterm><primary>Jonson, Ben
</primary></indexterm>
4528 <indexterm><primary>Dryden, John
</primary></indexterm>
4529 Jacob Tonson is typically remembered for his associations with prominent
4530 eighteenth-century literary figures, especially John Dryden, and for his
4531 handsome
<quote>definitive editions
</quote> of classic works. In addition to
<citetitle>Romeo and
4532 Juliet
</citetitle>, he published an astonishing array of works that still remain at the
4533 heart of the English canon, including collected works of Shakespeare, Ben
4534 Jonson, John Milton, and John Dryden. See Keith Walker,
<quote>Jacob Tonson,
4535 Bookseller,
</quote> <citetitle>American Scholar
</citetitle> 61:
3 (
1992):
424–31.
4537 Tonson was the most prominent of a small group of publishers called
4538 the Conger
<footnote><para>
4540 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle> (Nashville:
4541 Vanderbilt University Press,
1968),
151–52.
4543 who controlled bookselling in England during the eighteenth
4544 century. The Conger claimed a perpetual right to control the
<quote>copy
</quote> of
4545 books that they had acquired from authors. That perpetual right meant
4547 <!-- PAGE BREAK 97 -->
4548 one else could publish copies of a book to which they held the
4549 copyright. Prices of the classics were thus kept high; competition to
4550 produce better or cheaper editions was eliminated.
4553 Now, there's something puzzling about the year
1774 to anyone who
4554 knows a little about copyright law. The better-known year in the
4555 history of copyright is
1710, the year that the British Parliament
4556 adopted the first
<quote>copyright
</quote> act. Known as the Statute of Anne, the
4557 act stated that all published works would get a copyright term of
4558 fourteen years, renewable once if the author was alive, and that all
4559 works already published by
1710 would get a single term of twenty-one
4560 additional years.
<footnote><para>
4562 As Siva Vaidhyanathan nicely argues, it is erroneous to call this a
4563 <quote>copyright law.
</quote> See Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
40.
4564 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4565 </para></footnote> Under this law,
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> should have been
4566 free in
1731. So why was there any issue about it still being under
4567 Tonson's control in
1774?
4570 The reason is that the English hadn't yet agreed on what a
<quote>copyright
</quote>
4571 was
—indeed, no one had. At the time the English passed the
4572 Statute of Anne, there was no other legislation governing copyrights.
4573 The last law regulating publishers, the Licensing Act of
1662, had
4574 expired in
1695. That law gave publishers a monopoly over publishing,
4575 as a way to make it easier for the Crown to control what was
4576 published. But after it expired, there was no positive law that said
4577 that the publishers, or
<quote>Stationers,
</quote> had an exclusive right to print
4579 <indexterm><primary>Licensing Act (
1662)
</primary></indexterm>
4582 There was no
<emphasis>positive
</emphasis> law, but that didn't mean
4583 that there was no law. The Anglo-American legal tradition looks to
4584 both the words of legislatures and the words of judges to know the
4585 rules that are to govern how people are to behave. We call the words
4586 from legislatures
<quote>positive law.
</quote> We call the words from judges
4587 <quote>common law.
</quote> The common law sets the background against which
4588 legislatures legislate; the legislature, ordinarily, can trump that
4589 background only if it passes a law to displace it. And so the real
4590 question after the licensing statutes had expired was whether the
4591 common law protected a copyright, independent of any positive law.
4594 This question was important to the publishers, or
<quote>booksellers,
</quote> as
4595 they were called, because there was growing competition from foreign
4596 publishers. The Scottish, in particular, were increasingly publishing
4597 and exporting books to England. That competition reduced the profits
4599 <!-- PAGE BREAK 98 -->
4600 of the Conger, which reacted by demanding that Parliament pass a law
4601 to again give them exclusive control over publishing. That demand
4603 resulted in the Statute of Anne.
4606 The Statute of Anne granted the author or
<quote>proprietor
</quote> of a book an
4607 exclusive right to print that book. In an important limitation,
4608 however, and to the horror of the booksellers, the law gave the
4609 bookseller that right for a limited term. At the end of that term, the
4610 copyright
<quote>expired,
</quote> and the work would then be free and could be
4611 published by anyone. Or so the legislature is thought to have
4615 Now, the thing to puzzle about for a moment is this: Why would
4616 Parliament limit the exclusive right? Not why would they limit it to
4617 the particular limit they set, but why would they limit the right
4618 <emphasis>at all?
</emphasis>
4621 For the booksellers, and the authors whom they represented, had a very
4622 strong claim. Take
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> as an example: That play
4623 was written by Shakespeare. It was his genius that brought it into the
4624 world. He didn't take anybody's property when he created this play
4625 (that's a controversial claim, but never mind), and by his creating
4626 this play, he didn't make it any harder for others to craft a play. So
4627 why is it that the law would ever allow someone else to come along and
4628 take Shakespeare's play without his, or his estate's, permission? What
4629 reason is there to allow someone else to
<quote>steal
</quote> Shakespeare's work?
4632 The answer comes in two parts. We first need to see something special
4633 about the notion of
<quote>copyright
</quote> that existed at the time of the
4634 Statute of Anne. Second, we have to see something important about
4635 <quote>booksellers.
</quote>
4638 First, about copyright. In the last three hundred years, we have come
4639 to apply the concept of
<quote>copyright
</quote> ever more broadly. But in
1710, it
4640 wasn't so much a concept as it was a very particular right. The
4641 copyright was born as a very specific set of restrictions: It forbade
4642 others from reprinting a book. In
1710, the
<quote>copy-right
</quote> was a right
4643 to use a particular machine to replicate a particular work. It did not
4644 go beyond that very narrow right. It did not control any more
4646 <!-- PAGE BREAK 99 -->
4647 a work could be
<emphasis>used
</emphasis>. Today the right includes a
4648 large collection of restrictions on the freedom of others: It grants
4649 the author the exclusive right to copy, the exclusive right to
4650 distribute, the exclusive right to perform, and so on.
4652 <indexterm><primary>Branagh, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
4654 So, for example, even if the copyright to Shakespeare's works were
4655 perpetual, all that would have meant under the original meaning of the
4656 term was that no one could reprint Shakespeare's work without the
4657 permission of the Shakespeare estate. It would not have controlled
4658 anything, for example, about how the work could be performed, whether
4659 the work could be translated, or whether Kenneth Branagh would be
4660 allowed to make his films. The
<quote>copy-right
</quote> was only an exclusive
4661 right to print
—no less, of course, but also no more.
4663 <indexterm><primary>Henry VIII, King of England
</primary></indexterm>
4664 <indexterm><primary>Statute of Monopolies (
1656)
</primary></indexterm>
4666 Even that limited right was viewed with skepticism by the British.
4667 They had had a long and ugly experience with
<quote>exclusive rights,
</quote>
4668 especially
<quote>exclusive rights
</quote> granted by the Crown. The English had
4669 fought a civil war in part about the Crown's practice of handing out
4670 monopolies
—especially monopolies for works that already
4671 existed. King Henry VIII granted a patent to print the Bible and a
4672 monopoly to Darcy to print playing cards. The English Parliament began
4673 to fight back against this power of the Crown. In
1656, it passed the
4674 Statute of Monopolies, limiting monopolies to patents for new
4675 inventions. And by
1710, Parliament was eager to deal with the growing
4676 monopoly in publishing.
4679 Thus the
<quote>copy-right,
</quote> when viewed as a monopoly right, was naturally
4680 viewed as a right that should be limited. (However convincing the
4681 claim that
<quote>it's my property, and I should have it forever,
</quote> try
4682 sounding convincing when uttering,
<quote>It's my monopoly, and I should
4683 have it forever.
</quote>) The state would protect the exclusive right, but
4684 only so long as it benefited society. The British saw the harms from
4685 specialinterest favors; they passed a law to stop them.
4688 Second, about booksellers. It wasn't just that the copyright was a
4689 monopoly. It was also that it was a monopoly held by the booksellers.
4690 Booksellers sound quaint and harmless to us. They were not viewed
4691 as harmless in seventeenth-century England. Members of the Conger
4692 <!-- PAGE BREAK 100 -->
4694 were increasingly seen as monopolists of the worst
4695 kind
—tools of the Crown's repression, selling the liberty of
4696 England to guarantee themselves a monopoly profit. The attacks against
4697 these monopolists were harsh: Milton described them as
<quote>old patentees
4698 and monopolizers in the trade of book-selling
</quote>; they were
<quote>men who do
4699 not therefore labour in an honest profession to which learning is
4700 indetted.
</quote><footnote><para>
4703 Philip Wittenberg,
<citetitle>The Protection and Marketing of Literary
4704 Property
</citetitle> (New York: J. Messner, Inc.,
1937),
31.
4708 Many believed the power the booksellers exercised over the spread of
4709 knowledge was harming that spread, just at the time the Enlightenment
4710 was teaching the importance of education and knowledge spread
4711 generally. The idea that knowledge should be free was a hallmark of
4712 the time, and these powerful commercial interests were interfering
4716 To balance this power, Parliament decided to increase competition
4717 among booksellers, and the simplest way to do that was to spread the
4718 wealth of valuable books. Parliament therefore limited the term of
4719 copyrights, and thereby guaranteed that valuable books would become
4720 open to any publisher to publish after a limited time. Thus the setting
4721 of the term for existing works to just twenty-one years was a
4723 to fight the power of the booksellers. The limitation on terms was
4724 an indirect way to assure competition among publishers, and thus the
4725 construction and spread of culture.
4728 When
1731 (
1710 +
21) came along, however, the booksellers were
4729 getting anxious. They saw the consequences of more competition, and
4730 like every competitor, they didn't like them. At first booksellers simply
4731 ignored the Statute of Anne, continuing to insist on the perpetual right
4732 to control publication. But in
1735 and
1737, they tried to persuade
4733 Parliament to extend their terms. Twenty-one years was not enough,
4734 they said; they needed more time.
4737 Parliament rejected their requests. As one pamphleteer put it, in
4738 words that echo today,
4742 I see no Reason for granting a further Term now, which will not
4743 hold as well for granting it again and again, as often as the Old
4744 <!-- PAGE BREAK 101 -->
4745 ones Expire; so that should this Bill pass, it will in Effect be
4746 establishing a perpetual Monopoly, a Thing deservedly odious in the
4747 Eye of the Law; it will be a great Cramp to Trade, a Discouragement to
4748 Learning, no Benefit to the Authors, but a general Tax on the Publick;
4749 and all this only to increase the private Gain of the
4750 Booksellers.
<footnote><para>
4752 A Letter to a Member of Parliament concerning the Bill now depending
4753 in the House of Commons, for making more effectual an Act in the
4754 Eighth Year of the Reign of Queen Anne, entitled, An Act for the
4755 Encouragement of Learning, by Vesting the Copies of Printed Books in
4756 the Authors or Purchasers of such Copies, during the Times therein
4757 mentioned (London,
1735), in Brief Amici Curiae of Tyler T. Ochoa et
4758 al.,
8,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618).
4763 Having failed in Parliament, the publishers turned to the courts in a
4764 series of cases. Their argument was simple and direct: The Statute of
4765 Anne gave authors certain protections through positive law, but those
4766 protections were not intended as replacements for the common law.
4767 Instead, they were intended simply to supplement the common law.
4768 Under common law, it was already wrong to take another person's
4769 creative
<quote>property
</quote> and use it without his permission. The Statute of
4770 Anne, the booksellers argued, didn't change that. Therefore, just
4771 because the protections of the Statute of Anne expired, that didn't
4772 mean the protections of the common law expired: Under the common law
4773 they had the right to ban the publication of a book, even if its
4774 Statute of Anne copyright had expired. This, they argued, was the only
4775 way to protect authors.
4778 This was a clever argument, and one that had the support of some of
4779 the leading jurists of the day. It also displayed extraordinary
4780 chutzpah. Until then, as law professor Raymond Patterson has put it,
4781 <quote>The publishers
… had as much concern for authors as a cattle
4782 rancher has for cattle.
</quote><footnote><para>
4784 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<quote>Free Speech, Copyright, and Fair Use,
</quote> <citetitle>Vanderbilt
4785 Law Review
</citetitle> 40 (
1987):
28. For a wonderfully compelling account, see
4786 Vaidhyanathan,
37–48.
4787 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4789 The bookseller didn't care squat for the rights of the author. His
4790 concern was the monopoly profit that the author's work gave.
4793 The booksellers' argument was not accepted without a fight.
4794 The hero of this fight was a Scottish bookseller named Alexander
4795 Donaldson.
<footnote><para>
4797 For a compelling account, see David Saunders,
<citetitle>Authorship and Copyright
</citetitle>
4798 (London: Routledge,
1992),
62–69.
4802 Donaldson was an outsider to the London Conger. He began his
4803 career in Edinburgh in
1750. The focus of his business was inexpensive
4804 reprints
<quote>of standard works whose copyright term had expired,
</quote> at least
4805 under the Statute of Anne.
<footnote><para>
4807 Mark Rose,
<citetitle>Authors and Owners
</citetitle> (Cambridge: Harvard University Press,
4809 <indexterm><primary>Rose, Mark
</primary></indexterm>
4811 Donaldson's publishing house prospered
4812 <!-- PAGE BREAK 102 -->
4813 and became
<quote>something of a center for literary Scotsmen.
</quote> <quote>[A]mong
4814 them,
</quote> Professor Mark Rose writes, was
<quote>the young James Boswell
4815 who, together with his friend Andrew Erskine, published an anthology
4816 of contemporary Scottish poems with Donaldson.
</quote><footnote><para>
4820 <indexterm><primary>Boswell, James
</primary></indexterm>
4821 <indexterm><primary>Erskine, Andrew
</primary></indexterm>
4824 When the London booksellers tried to shut down Donaldson's shop in
4825 Scotland, he responded by moving his shop to London, where he sold
4826 inexpensive editions
<quote>of the most popular English books, in defiance
4827 of the supposed common law right of Literary
4828 Property.
</quote><footnote><para>
4830 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle>,
167 (quoting
4833 His books undercut the Conger prices by
30 to
50 percent, and he
4834 rested his right to compete upon the ground that, under the Statute of
4835 Anne, the works he was selling had passed out of protection.
4838 The London booksellers quickly brought suit to block
<quote>piracy
</quote> like
4839 Donaldson's. A number of actions were successful against the
<quote>pirates,
</quote>
4840 the most important early victory being
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Taylor
</citetitle>.
4842 <indexterm><primary>Taylor, Robert
</primary></indexterm>
4844 Millar was a bookseller who in
1729 had purchased the rights to James
4845 Thomson's poem
<quote>The Seasons.
</quote> Millar complied with the requirements of
4846 the Statute of Anne, and therefore received the full protection of the
4847 statute. After the term of copyright ended, Robert Taylor began
4848 printing a competing volume. Millar sued, claiming a perpetual common
4849 law right, the Statute of Anne notwithstanding.
<footnote><para>
4851 Howard B. Abrams,
<quote>The Historic Foundation of American Copyright Law:
4852 Exploding the Myth of Common Law Copyright,
</quote> <citetitle>Wayne Law Review
</citetitle> 29
4856 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield2" class='startofrange'
>
4857 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
4860 Astonishingly to modern lawyers, one of the greatest judges in English
4861 history, Lord Mansfield, agreed with the booksellers. Whatever
4862 protection the Statute of Anne gave booksellers, it did not, he held,
4863 extinguish any common law right. The question was whether the common
4864 law would protect the author against subsequent
<quote>pirates.
</quote>
4865 Mansfield's answer was yes: The common law would bar Taylor from
4866 reprinting Thomson's poem without Millar's permission. That common law
4867 rule thus effectively gave the booksellers a perpetual right to
4868 control the publication of any book assigned to them.
4871 Considered as a matter of abstract justice
—reasoning as if
4872 justice were just a matter of logical deduction from first
4873 principles
—Mansfield's conclusion might make some sense. But
4874 what it ignored was the larger issue that Parliament had struggled
4875 with in
1710: How best to limit
4876 <!-- PAGE BREAK 103 -->
4877 the monopoly power of publishers? Parliament's strategy was to offer a
4878 term for existing works that was long enough to buy peace in
1710, but
4879 short enough to assure that culture would pass into competition within
4880 a reasonable period of time. Within twenty-one years, Parliament
4881 believed, Britain would mature from the controlled culture that the
4882 Crown coveted to the free culture that we inherited.
4884 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield2" class='endofrange'
/>
4886 The fight to defend the limits of the Statute of Anne was not to end
4887 there, however, and it is here that Donaldson enters the mix.
4889 <indexterm><primary>Beckett, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
4891 Millar died soon after his victory, so his case was not appealed. His
4892 estate sold Thomson's poems to a syndicate of printers that included
4893 Thomas Beckett.
<footnote><para>
4897 Donaldson then released an unauthorized edition
4898 of Thomson's works. Beckett, on the strength of the decision in
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle>,
4899 got an injunction against Donaldson. Donaldson appealed the case to
4900 the House of Lords, which functioned much like our own Supreme
4901 Court. In February of
1774, that body had the chance to interpret the
4902 meaning of Parliament's limits from sixty years before.
4905 As few legal cases ever do,
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle> drew an
4906 enormous amount of attention throughout Britain. Donaldson's lawyers
4907 argued that whatever rights may have existed under the common law, the
4908 Statute of Anne terminated those rights. After passage of the Statute
4909 of Anne, the only legal protection for an exclusive right to control
4910 publication came from that statute. Thus, they argued, after the term
4911 specified in the Statute of Anne expired, works that had been
4912 protected by the statute were no longer protected.
4915 The House of Lords was an odd institution. Legal questions were
4916 presented to the House and voted upon first by the
<quote>law lords,
</quote>
4917 members of special legal distinction who functioned much like the
4918 Justices in our Supreme Court. Then, after the law lords voted, the
4919 House of Lords generally voted.
4922 The reports about the law lords' votes are mixed. On some counts,
4923 it looks as if perpetual copyright prevailed. But there is no ambiguity
4924 <!-- PAGE BREAK 104 -->
4925 about how the House of Lords voted as whole. By a two-to-one majority
4926 (
22 to
11) they voted to reject the idea of perpetual copyrights.
4927 Whatever one's understanding of the common law, now a copyright was
4928 fixed for a limited time, after which the work protected by copyright
4929 passed into the public domain.
4932 <quote>The public domain.
</quote> Before the case of
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle>
4933 v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle>, there was no clear idea of a public domain in
4934 England. Before
1774, there was a strong argument that common law
4935 copyrights were perpetual. After
1774, the public domain was
4936 born. For the first time in Anglo-American history, the legal control
4937 over creative works expired, and the greatest works in English
4938 history
—including those of Shakespeare, Bacon, Milton, Johnson,
4939 and Bunyan
—were free of legal restraint.
4940 <indexterm><primary>Bacon, Francis
</primary></indexterm>
4941 <indexterm><primary>Bunyan, John
</primary></indexterm>
4942 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Samuel
</primary></indexterm>
4943 <indexterm><primary>Milton, John
</primary></indexterm>
4944 <indexterm><primary>Shakespeare, William
</primary></indexterm>
4947 It is hard for us to imagine, but this decision by the House of Lords
4948 fueled an extraordinarily popular and political reaction. In Scotland,
4949 where most of the
<quote>pirate publishers
</quote> did their work, people
4950 celebrated the decision in the streets. As the
<citetitle>Edinburgh Advertiser
</citetitle>
4951 reported,
<quote>No private cause has so much engrossed the attention of the
4952 public, and none has been tried before the House of Lords in the
4953 decision of which so many individuals were interested.
</quote> <quote>Great
4954 rejoicing in Edinburgh upon victory over literary property: bonfires
4955 and illuminations.
</quote><footnote><para>
4961 In London, however, at least among publishers, the reaction was
4962 equally strong in the opposite direction. The
<citetitle>Morning Chronicle
</citetitle>
4967 By the above decision
… near
200,
000 pounds worth of what was
4968 honestly purchased at public sale, and which was yesterday thought
4969 property is now reduced to nothing. The Booksellers of London and
4970 Westminster, many of whom sold estates and houses to purchase
4971 Copy-right, are in a manner ruined, and those who after many years
4972 industry thought they had acquired a competency to provide for their
4973 families now find themselves without a shilling to devise to their
4974 successors.
<footnote><para>
4981 <!-- PAGE BREAK 105 -->
4982 <quote>Ruined
</quote> is a bit of an exaggeration. But it is not an exaggeration to
4983 say that the change was profound. The decision of the House of Lords
4984 meant that the booksellers could no longer control how culture in
4985 England would grow and develop. Culture in England was thereafter
4986 <emphasis>free
</emphasis>. Not in the sense that copyrights would not
4987 be respected, for of course, for a limited time after a work was
4988 published, the bookseller had an exclusive right to control the
4989 publication of that book. And not in the sense that books could be
4990 stolen, for even after a copyright expired, you still had to buy the
4991 book from someone. But
<emphasis>free
</emphasis> in the sense that the
4992 culture and its growth would no longer be controlled by a small group
4993 of publishers. As every free market does, this free market of free
4994 culture would grow as the consumers and producers chose. English
4995 culture would develop as the many English readers chose to let it
4996 develop
— chose in the books they bought and wrote; chose in the
4997 memes they repeated and endorsed. Chose in a
<emphasis>competitive
4998 context
</emphasis>, not a context in which the choices about what
4999 culture is available to people and how they get access to it are made
5000 by the few despite the wishes of the many.
5003 At least, this was the rule in a world where the Parliament is
5004 antimonopoly, resistant to the protectionist pleas of publishers. In a
5005 world where the Parliament is more pliant, free culture would be less
5008 <indexterm startref='idxbooksenglishlaw' class='endofrange'
/>
5009 <!-- PAGE BREAK 106 -->
5011 <chapter label=
"7" id=
"recorders">
5012 <title>CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
</title>
5014 <emphasis role='strong'
>Jon Else
</emphasis> is a filmmaker. He is best
5015 known for his documentaries and has been very successful in spreading
5016 his art. He is also a teacher, and as a teacher myself, I envy the
5017 loyalty and admiration that his students feel for him. (I met, by
5018 accident, two of his students at a dinner party. He was their god.)
5021 Else worked on a documentary that I was involved in. At a break,
5022 he told me a story about the freedom to create with film in America
5026 In
1990, Else was working on a documentary about Wagner's Ring
5027 Cycle. The focus was stagehands at the San Francisco Opera.
5028 Stagehands are a particularly funny and colorful element of an opera.
5029 During a show, they hang out below the stage in the grips' lounge and
5030 in the lighting loft. They make a perfect contrast to the art on the
5032 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
5035 During one of the performances, Else was shooting some stagehands
5036 playing checkers. In one corner of the room was a television set.
5037 Playing on the television set, while the stagehands played checkers
5038 and the opera company played Wagner, was
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. As Else judged
5039 <!-- PAGE BREAK 107 -->
5040 it, this touch of cartoon helped capture the flavor of what was special
5044 Years later, when he finally got funding to complete the film, Else
5045 attempted to clear the rights for those few seconds of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>.
5046 For of course, those few seconds are copyrighted; and of course, to use
5047 copyrighted material you need the permission of the copyright owner,
5048 unless
<quote>fair use
</quote> or some other privilege applies.
5051 Else called
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> creator Matt Groening's office to get permission.
5052 Groening approved the shot. The shot was a four-and-a-halfsecond image
5053 on a tiny television set in the corner of the room. How could it hurt?
5054 Groening was happy to have it in the film, but he told Else to contact
5055 Gracie Films, the company that produces the program.
5056 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
5059 Gracie Films was okay with it, too, but they, like Groening, wanted
5060 to be careful. So they told Else to contact Fox, Gracie's parent company.
5061 Else called Fox and told them about the clip in the corner of the one
5062 room shot of the film. Matt Groening had already given permission,
5063 Else said. He was just confirming the permission with Fox.
5064 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
5067 Then, as Else told me,
<quote>two things happened. First we discovered
5068 … that Matt Groening doesn't own his own creation
—or at
5069 least that someone [at Fox] believes he doesn't own his own creation.
</quote>
5070 And second, Fox
<quote>wanted ten thousand dollars as a licensing fee for us
5071 to use this four-point-five seconds of
… entirely unsolicited
5072 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> which was in the corner of the shot.
</quote>
5074 <indexterm><primary>Herrera, Rebecca
</primary></indexterm>
5076 Else was certain there was a mistake. He worked his way up to someone
5077 he thought was a vice president for licensing, Rebecca Herrera. He
5078 explained to her,
<quote>There must be some mistake here.
… We're
5079 asking for your educational rate on this.
</quote> That was the educational
5080 rate, Herrera told Else. A day or so later, Else called again to
5081 confirm what he had been told.
5084 <quote>I wanted to make sure I had my facts straight,
</quote> he told me.
<quote>Yes, you
5085 have your facts straight,
</quote> she said. It would cost $
10,
000 to use the
5086 clip of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> in the corner of a shot in a documentary film
5089 <!-- PAGE BREAK 108 -->
5090 Wagner's Ring Cycle. And then, astonishingly, Herrera told Else,
<quote>And
5091 if you quote me, I'll turn you over to our attorneys.
</quote> As an assistant
5092 to Herrera told Else later on,
<quote>They don't give a shit. They just want
5096 Else didn't have the money to buy the right to replay what was playing
5097 on the television backstage at the San Francisco Opera. To reproduce
5098 this reality was beyond the documentary filmmaker's budget. At the
5099 very last minute before the film was to be released, Else digitally
5100 replaced the shot with a clip from another film that he had worked on,
5101 <citetitle>The Day After Trinity
</citetitle>, from ten years before.
5102 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
5103 <indexterm><primary>Day After Trinity, The
</primary></indexterm>
5106 There's no doubt that someone, whether Matt Groening or Fox, owns the
5107 copyright to
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. That copyright is their property. To use
5108 that copyrighted material thus sometimes requires the permission of
5109 the copyright owner. If the use that Else wanted to make of the
5110 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> copyright were one of the uses restricted by the law, then he
5111 would need to get the permission of the copyright owner before he
5112 could use the work in that way. And in a free market, it is the owner
5113 of the copyright who gets to set the price for any use that the law
5114 says the owner gets to control.
5117 For example,
<quote>public performance
</quote> is a use of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> that the
5118 copyright owner gets to control. If you take a selection of favorite
5119 episodes, rent a movie theater, and charge for tickets to come see
<quote>My
5120 Favorite
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>,
</quote> then you need to get permission from the copyright
5121 owner. And the copyright owner (rightly, in my view) can charge
5122 whatever she wants
—$
10 or $
1,
000,
000. That's her right, as set
5126 But when lawyers hear this story about Jon Else and Fox, their first
5127 thought is
<quote>fair use.
</quote><footnote><para>
5129 For an excellent argument that such use is
<quote>fair use,
</quote> but that
5130 lawyers don't permit recognition that it is
<quote>fair use,
</quote> see Richard
5131 A. Posner with William F. Patry,
<quote>Fair Use and Statutory Reform in the
5132 Wake of
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle></quote> (draft on file with author), University of Chicago
5133 Law School,
5 August
2003.
5135 Else's use of just
4.5 seconds of an indirect shot of a
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>
5136 episode is clearly a fair use of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>—and fair use does
5137 not require the permission of anyone.
5140 <!-- PAGE BREAK 109 -->
5141 So I asked Else why he didn't just rely upon
<quote>fair use.
</quote> Here's his reply:
5145 The
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> fiasco was for me a great lesson in the gulf between what
5146 lawyers find irrelevant in some abstract sense, and what is crushingly
5147 relevant in practice to those of us actually trying to make and
5148 broadcast documentaries. I never had any doubt that it was
<quote>clearly
5149 fair use
</quote> in an absolute legal sense. But I couldn't rely on the
5150 concept in any concrete way. Here's why:
5152 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
5155 Before our films can be broadcast, the network requires that we buy
5156 Errors and Omissions insurance. The carriers require a detailed
5157 <quote>visual cue sheet
</quote> listing the source and licensing status of each
5158 shot in the film. They take a dim view of
<quote>fair use,
</quote> and a claim of
5159 <quote>fair use
</quote> can grind the application process to a halt.
5162 <indexterm><primary><citetitle>Star Wars
</citetitle></primary></indexterm>
5165 I probably never should have asked Matt Groening in the first
5166 place. But I knew (at least from folklore) that Fox had a history of
5167 tracking down and stopping unlicensed
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> usage, just as George
5168 Lucas had a very high profile litigating
<citetitle>Star Wars
</citetitle> usage. So I decided
5169 to play by the book, thinking that we would be granted free or cheap
5170 license to four seconds of
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>. As a documentary producer working
5171 to exhaustion on a shoestring, the last thing I wanted was to risk
5172 legal trouble, even nuisance legal trouble, and even to defend a
5174 <indexterm><primary>Lucas, George
</primary></indexterm>
5178 I did, in fact, speak with one of your colleagues at Stanford Law
5179 School
… who confirmed that it was fair use. He also confirmed
5180 that Fox would
<quote>depose and litigate you to within an inch of your
5181 life,
</quote> regardless of the merits of my claim. He made clear that it
5182 would boil down to who had the bigger legal department and the deeper
5183 pockets, me or them.
5184 <!-- PAGE BREAK 110 -->
5188 The question of fair use usually comes up at the end of the
5189 project, when we are up against a release deadline and out of
5195 In theory, fair use means you need no permission. The theory therefore
5196 supports free culture and insulates against a permission culture. But
5197 in practice, fair use functions very differently. The fuzzy lines of
5198 the law, tied to the extraordinary liability if lines are crossed,
5199 means that the effective fair use for many types of creators is
5200 slight. The law has the right aim; practice has defeated the aim.
5203 This practice shows just how far the law has come from its
5204 eighteenth-century roots. The law was born as a shield to protect
5205 publishers' profits against the unfair competition of a pirate. It has
5206 matured into a sword that interferes with any use, transformative or
5209 <!-- PAGE BREAK 111 -->
5211 <chapter label=
"8" id=
"transformers">
5212 <title>CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
</title>
5213 <indexterm><primary>Allen, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
5214 <indexterm id='idxalbenalex1' class='startofrange'
>
5215 <primary>Alben, Alex
</primary>
5217 <indexterm><primary>Microsoft
</primary></indexterm>
5219 <emphasis role='strong'
>In
1993</emphasis>, Alex Alben was a lawyer
5220 working at Starwave, Inc. Starwave was an innovative company founded
5221 by Microsoft cofounder Paul Allen to develop digital
5222 entertainment. Long before the Internet became popular, Starwave began
5223 investing in new technology for delivering entertainment in
5224 anticipation of the power of networks.
5226 <indexterm id='idxartistsretrospective' class='startofrange'
>
5227 <primary>artists
</primary>
5228 <secondary>retrospective compilations on
</secondary>
5231 Alben had a special interest in new technology. He was intrigued by
5232 the emerging market for CD-ROM technology
—not to distribute
5233 film, but to do things with film that otherwise would be very
5234 difficult. In
1993, he launched an initiative to develop a product to
5235 build retrospectives on the work of particular actors. The first actor
5236 chosen was Clint Eastwood. The idea was to showcase all of the work of
5237 Eastwood, with clips from his films and interviews with figures
5238 important to his career.
5241 At that time, Eastwood had made more than fifty films, as an actor and
5242 as a director. Alben began with a series of interviews with Eastwood,
5243 asking him about his career. Because Starwave produced those
5244 interviews, it was free to include them on the CD.
5247 <!-- PAGE BREAK 112 -->
5248 That alone would not have made a very interesting product, so
5249 Starwave wanted to add content from the movies in Eastwood's career:
5250 posters, scripts, and other material relating to the films Eastwood
5251 made. Most of his career was spent at Warner Brothers, and so it was
5252 relatively easy to get permission for that content.
5255 Then Alben and his team decided to include actual film clips.
<quote>Our
5256 goal was that we were going to have a clip from every one of
5257 Eastwood's films,
</quote> Alben told me. It was here that the problem
5258 arose.
<quote>No one had ever really done this before,
</quote> Alben explained.
<quote>No
5259 one had ever tried to do this in the context of an artistic look at an
5260 actor's career.
</quote>
5263 Alben brought the idea to Michael Slade, the CEO of Starwave.
5264 Slade asked,
<quote>Well, what will it take?
</quote>
5267 Alben replied,
<quote>Well, we're going to have to clear rights from
5268 everyone who appears in these films, and the music and everything
5269 else that we want to use in these film clips.
</quote> Slade said,
<quote>Great! Go
5270 for it.
</quote><footnote>
5273 Technically, the rights that Alben had to clear were mainly those of
5274 publicity
—rights an artist has to control the commercial
5275 exploitation of his image. But these rights, too, burden
<quote>Rip, Mix,
5276 Burn
</quote> creativity, as this chapter evinces.
5278 <primary>artists
</primary>
5279 <secondary>publicity rights on images of
</secondary>
5281 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5285 The problem was that neither Alben nor Slade had any idea what
5286 clearing those rights would mean. Every actor in each of the films
5287 could have a claim to royalties for the reuse of that film. But CD-
5288 ROMs had not been specified in the contracts for the actors, so there
5289 was no clear way to know just what Starwave was to do.
5292 I asked Alben how he dealt with the problem. With an obvious
5293 pride in his resourcefulness that obscured the obvious bizarreness of his
5294 tale, Alben recounted just what they did:
5298 So we very mechanically went about looking up the film clips. We made
5299 some artistic decisions about what film clips to include
—of
5300 course we were going to use the
<quote>Make my day
</quote> clip from
<citetitle>Dirty
5301 Harry
</citetitle>. But you then need to get the guy on the ground who's wiggling
5302 under the gun and you need to get his permission. And then you have
5303 to decide what you are going to pay him.
5306 <!-- PAGE BREAK 113 -->
5307 We decided that it would be fair if we offered them the dayplayer rate
5308 for the right to reuse that performance. We're talking about a clip of
5309 less than a minute, but to reuse that performance in the CD-ROM the
5310 rate at the time was about $
600. So we had to identify the
5311 people
—some of them were hard to identify because in Eastwood
5312 movies you can't tell who's the guy crashing through the
5313 glass
—is it the actor or is it the stuntman? And then we just,
5314 we put together a team, my assistant and some others, and we just
5315 started calling people.
5318 <indexterm><primary>Sutherland, Donald
</primary></indexterm>
5320 Some actors were glad to help
—Donald Sutherland, for example,
5321 followed up himself to be sure that the rights had been cleared.
5322 Others were dumbfounded at their good fortune. Alben would ask,
5323 <quote>Hey, can I pay you $
600 or maybe if you were in two films, you
5324 know, $
1,
200?
</quote> And they would say,
<quote>Are you for real? Hey, I'd love
5325 to get $
1,
200.
</quote> And some of course were a bit difficult (estranged
5326 ex-wives, in particular). But eventually, Alben and his team had
5327 cleared the rights to this retrospective CD-ROM on Clint Eastwood's
5331 It was one
<emphasis>year
</emphasis> later
—<quote>and even then we
5332 weren't sure whether we were totally in the clear.
</quote>
5335 Alben is proud of his work. The project was the first of its kind and
5336 the only time he knew of that a team had undertaken such a massive
5337 project for the purpose of releasing a retrospective.
5341 Everyone thought it would be too hard. Everyone just threw up their
5342 hands and said,
<quote>Oh, my gosh, a film, it's so many copyrights, there's
5343 the music, there's the screenplay, there's the director, there's the
5344 actors.
</quote> But we just broke it down. We just put it into its
5345 constituent parts and said,
<quote>Okay, there's this many actors, this many
5346 directors,
… this many musicians,
</quote> and we just went at it very
5347 systematically and cleared the rights.
5352 <!-- PAGE BREAK 114 -->
5353 And no doubt, the product itself was exceptionally good. Eastwood
5354 loved it, and it sold very well.
5356 <indexterm><primary>Drucker, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
5358 But I pressed Alben about how weird it seems that it would have to
5359 take a year's work simply to clear rights. No doubt Alben had done
5360 this efficiently, but as Peter Drucker has famously quipped,
<quote>There is
5361 nothing so useless as doing efficiently that which should not be done
5362 at all.
</quote><footnote><para>
5364 U.S. Department of Commerce Office of Acquisition Management,
<citetitle>Seven
5365 Steps to Performance-Based Services Acquisition
</citetitle>, available at
5366 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
22</ulink>.
5368 Did it make sense, I asked Alben, that this is the way a new work
5372 For, as he acknowledged,
<quote>very few
… have the time and resources,
5373 and the will to do this,
</quote> and thus, very few such works would ever be
5374 made. Does it make sense, I asked him, from the standpoint of what
5375 anybody really thought they were ever giving rights for originally, that
5376 you would have to go clear rights for these kinds of clips?
5380 I don't think so. When an actor renders a performance in a movie,
5381 he or she gets paid very well.
… And then when
30 seconds of
5382 that performance is used in a new product that is a retrospective
5383 of somebody's career, I don't think that that person
… should be
5384 compensated for that.
5388 Or at least, is this
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> the artist should be
5389 compensated? Would it make sense, I asked, for there to be some kind
5390 of statutory license that someone could pay and be free to make
5391 derivative use of clips like this? Did it really make sense that a
5392 follow-on creator would have to track down every artist, actor,
5393 director, musician, and get explicit permission from each? Wouldn't a
5394 lot more be created if the legal part of the creative process could be
5395 made to be more clean?
5399 Absolutely. I think that if there were some fair-licensing
5400 mechanism
—where you weren't subject to hold-ups and you weren't
5401 subject to estranged former spouses
—you'd see a lot more of this
5402 work, because it wouldn't be so daunting to try to put together a
5403 <!-- PAGE BREAK 115 -->
5404 retrospective of someone's career and meaningfully illustrate it with
5405 lots of media from that person's career. You'd build in a cost as the
5406 producer of one of these things. You'd build in a cost of paying X
5407 dollars to the talent that performed. But it would be a known
5408 cost. That's the thing that trips everybody up and makes this kind of
5409 product hard to get off the ground. If you knew I have a hundred
5410 minutes of film in this product and it's going to cost me X, then you
5411 build your budget around it, and you can get investments and
5412 everything else that you need to produce it. But if you say,
<quote>Oh, I
5413 want a hundred minutes of something and I have no idea what it's going
5414 to cost me, and a certain number of people are going to hold me up for
5415 money,
</quote> then it becomes difficult to put one of these things together.
5419 Alben worked for a big company. His company was backed by some of the
5420 richest investors in the world. He therefore had authority and access
5421 that the average Web designer would not have. So if it took him a
5422 year, how long would it take someone else? And how much creativity is
5423 never made just because the costs of clearing the rights are so high?
5425 <indexterm startref='idxartistsretrospective' class='endofrange'
/>
5427 These costs are the burdens of a kind of regulation. Put on a
5428 Republican hat for a moment, and get angry for a bit. The government
5429 defines the scope of these rights, and the scope defined determines
5430 how much it's going to cost to negotiate them. (Remember the idea that
5431 land runs to the heavens, and imagine the pilot purchasing flythrough
5432 rights as he negotiates to fly from Los Angeles to San Francisco.)
5433 These rights might well have once made sense; but as circumstances
5434 change, they make no sense at all. Or at least, a well-trained,
5435 regulationminimizing Republican should look at the rights and ask,
5436 <quote>Does this still make sense?
</quote>
5438 <indexterm startref='idxalbenalex1' class='endofrange'
/>
5440 I've seen the flash of recognition when people get this point, but only
5441 a few times. The first was at a conference of federal judges in California.
5442 The judges were gathered to discuss the emerging topic of cyber-law. I
5443 was asked to be on the panel. Harvey Saferstein, a well-respected lawyer
5445 <!-- PAGE BREAK 116 -->
5446 from an L.A. firm, introduced the panel with a video that he and a
5447 friend, Robert Fairbank, had produced.
5450 The video was a brilliant collage of film from every period in the
5451 twentieth century, all framed around the idea of a
<citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode.
5452 The execution was perfect, down to the sixty-minute stopwatch. The
5453 judges loved every minute of it.
5455 <indexterm><primary>Nimmer, David
</primary></indexterm>
5457 When the lights came up, I looked over to my copanelist, David
5458 Nimmer, perhaps the leading copyright scholar and practitioner in the
5459 nation. He had an astonished look on his face, as he peered across the
5460 room of over
250 well-entertained judges. Taking an ominous tone, he
5461 began his talk with a question:
<quote>Do you know how many federal laws
5462 were just violated in this room?
</quote>
5464 <indexterm><primary>Boies, David
</primary></indexterm>
5465 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5467 For of course, the two brilliantly talented creators who made this
5468 film hadn't done what Alben did. They hadn't spent a year clearing the
5469 rights to these clips; technically, what they had done violated the
5470 law. Of course, it wasn't as if they or anyone were going to be
5471 prosecuted for this violation (the presence of
250 judges and a gaggle
5472 of federal marshals notwithstanding). But Nimmer was making an
5473 important point: A year before anyone would have heard of the word
5474 Napster, and two years before another member of our panel, David
5475 Boies, would defend Napster before the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals,
5476 Nimmer was trying to get the judges to see that the law would not be
5477 friendly to the capacities that this technology would
5478 enable. Technology means you can now do amazing things easily; but you
5479 couldn't easily do them legally.
5482 We live in a
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> culture enabled by technology. Anyone
5483 building a presentation knows the extraordinary freedom that the cut
5484 and paste architecture of the Internet created
—in a second you can
5485 find just about any image you want; in another second, you can have it
5486 planted in your presentation.
5488 <indexterm><primary>Camp Chaos
</primary></indexterm>
5490 But presentations are just a tiny beginning. Using the Internet and
5491 <!-- PAGE BREAK 117 -->
5492 its archives, musicians are able to string together mixes of sound
5493 never before imagined; filmmakers are able to build movies out of
5494 clips on computers around the world. An extraordinary site in Sweden
5495 takes images of politicians and blends them with music to create
5496 biting political commentary. A site called Camp Chaos has produced
5497 some of the most biting criticism of the record industry that there is
5498 through the mixing of Flash! and music.
5501 All of these creations are technically illegal. Even if the creators
5502 wanted to be
<quote>legal,
</quote> the cost of complying with the law is impossibly
5503 high. Therefore, for the law-abiding sorts, a wealth of creativity is
5504 never made. And for that part that is made, if it doesn't follow the
5505 clearance rules, it doesn't get released.
5508 To some, these stories suggest a solution: Let's alter the mix of
5509 rights so that people are free to build upon our culture. Free to add
5510 or mix as they see fit. We could even make this change without
5511 necessarily requiring that the
<quote>free
</quote> use be free as in
<quote>free beer.
</quote>
5512 Instead, the system could simply make it easy for follow-on creators
5513 to compensate artists without requiring an army of lawyers to come
5514 along: a rule, for example, that says
<quote>the royalty owed the copyright
5515 owner of an unregistered work for the derivative reuse of his work
5516 will be a flat
1 percent of net revenues, to be held in escrow for the
5517 copyright owner.
</quote> Under this rule, the copyright owner could benefit
5518 from some royalty, but he would not have the benefit of a full
5519 property right (meaning the right to name his own price) unless he
5523 Who could possibly object to this? And what reason would there be
5524 for objecting? We're talking about work that is not now being made;
5525 which if made, under this plan, would produce new income for artists.
5526 What reason would anyone have to oppose it?
5529 <emphasis role='strong'
>In February
2003</emphasis>, DreamWorks
5530 studios announced an agreement with Mike Myers, the comic genius of
5531 <citetitle>Saturday Night Live
</citetitle> and
5532 <!-- PAGE BREAK 118 -->
5533 Austin Powers. According to the announcement, Myers and Dream-Works
5534 would work together to form a
<quote>unique filmmaking pact.
</quote> Under the
5535 agreement, DreamWorks
<quote>will acquire the rights to existing motion
5536 picture hits and classics, write new storylines and
—with the use
5537 of stateof-the-art digital technology
—insert Myers and other
5538 actors into the film, thereby creating an entirely new piece of
5539 entertainment.
</quote>
5542 The announcement called this
<quote>film sampling.
</quote> As Myers explained,
5543 <quote>Film Sampling is an exciting way to put an original spin on existing
5544 films and allow audiences to see old movies in a new light. Rap
5545 artists have been doing this for years with music and now we are able
5546 to take that same concept and apply it to film.
</quote> Steven Spielberg is
5547 quoted as saying,
<quote>If anyone can create a way to bring old films to
5548 new audiences, it is Mike.
</quote>
5551 Spielberg is right. Film sampling by Myers will be brilliant. But if
5552 you don't think about it, you might miss the truly astonishing point
5553 about this announcement. As the vast majority of our film heritage
5554 remains under copyright, the real meaning of the DreamWorks
5555 announcement is just this: It is Mike Myers and only Mike Myers who is
5556 free to sample. Any general freedom to build upon the film archive of
5557 our culture, a freedom in other contexts presumed for us all, is now a
5558 privilege reserved for the funny and famous
—and presumably rich.
5561 This privilege becomes reserved for two sorts of reasons. The first
5562 continues the story of the last chapter: the vagueness of
<quote>fair use.
</quote>
5563 Much of
<quote>sampling
</quote> should be considered
<quote>fair use.
</quote> But few would
5564 rely upon so weak a doctrine to create. That leads to the second reason
5565 that the privilege is reserved for the few: The costs of negotiating the
5566 legal rights for the creative reuse of content are astronomically high.
5567 These costs mirror the costs with fair use: You either pay a lawyer to
5568 defend your fair use rights or pay a lawyer to track down permissions
5569 so you don't have to rely upon fair use rights. Either way, the creative
5570 process is a process of paying lawyers
—again a privilege, or perhaps a
5571 curse, reserved for the few.
5573 <!-- PAGE BREAK 119 -->
5575 <chapter label=
"9" id=
"collectors">
5576 <title>CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
</title>
5577 <indexterm id='idxarchivesdigital1' class='startofrange'
>
5578 <primary>archives, digital
</primary>
5581 <emphasis role='strong'
>In April
1996</emphasis>, millions of
5582 <quote>bots
</quote>—computer codes designed to
5583 <quote>spider,
</quote> or automatically search the Internet and copy
5584 content
—began running across the Net. Page by page, these bots
5585 copied Internet-based information onto a small set of computers
5586 located in a basement in San Francisco's Presidio. Once the bots
5587 finished the whole of the Internet, they started again. Over and over
5588 again, once every two months, these bits of code took copies of the
5589 Internet and stored them.
5592 By October
2001, the bots had collected more than five years of
5593 copies. And at a small announcement in Berkeley, California, the
5594 archive that these copies created, the Internet Archive, was opened to
5595 the world. Using a technology called
<quote>the Way Back Machine,
</quote> you could
5596 enter a Web page, and see all of its copies going back to
1996, as
5597 well as when those pages changed.
5599 <indexterm id='idxorwellgeorge' class='startofrange'
>
5600 <primary>Orwell, George
</primary>
5603 This is the thing about the Internet that Orwell would have
5604 appreciated. In the dystopia described in
<citetitle>1984</citetitle>, old newspapers were
5605 constantly updated to assure that the current view of the world,
5606 approved of by the government, was not contradicted by previous news
5610 <!-- PAGE BREAK 120 -->
5611 Thousands of workers constantly reedited the past, meaning there was
5612 no way ever to know whether the story you were reading today was the
5613 story that was printed on the date published on the paper.
5616 It's the same with the Internet. If you go to a Web page today,
5617 there's no way for you to know whether the content you are reading is
5618 the same as the content you read before. The page may seem the same,
5619 but the content could easily be different. The Internet is Orwell's
5620 library
—constantly updated, without any reliable memory.
5622 <indexterm startref='idxorwellgeorge' class='endofrange'
/>
5624 Until the Way Back Machine, at least. With the Way Back Machine, and
5625 the Internet Archive underlying it, you can see what the Internet
5626 was. You have the power to see what you remember. More importantly,
5627 perhaps, you also have the power to find what you don't remember and
5628 what others might prefer you forget.
<footnote><para>
5630 <indexterm><primary>Iraq war
</primary></indexterm>
5631 <indexterm><primary>White House press releases
</primary></indexterm>
5632 The temptations remain, however. Brewster Kahle reports that the White
5633 House changes its own press releases without notice. A May
13,
2003,
5634 press release stated,
<quote>Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended.
</quote> That was
5635 later changed, without notice, to
<quote>Major Combat Operations in Iraq
5636 Have Ended.
</quote> E-mail from Brewster Kahle,
1 December
2003.
5639 <indexterm><primary>history, records of
</primary></indexterm>
5641 <emphasis role='strong'
>We take it
</emphasis> for granted that we can
5642 go back to see what we remember reading. Think about newspapers. If
5643 you wanted to study the reaction of your hometown newspaper to the
5644 race riots in Watts in
1965, or to Bull Connor's water cannon in
1963,
5645 you could go to your public library and look at the newspapers. Those
5646 papers probably exist on microfiche. If you're lucky, they exist in
5647 paper, too. Either way, you are free, using a library, to go back and
5648 remember
—not just what it is convenient to remember, but
5649 remember something close to the truth.
5652 It is said that those who fail to remember history are doomed to
5653 repeat it. That's not quite correct. We
<emphasis>all
</emphasis>
5654 forget history. The key is whether we have a way to go back to
5655 rediscover what we forget. More directly, the key is whether an
5656 objective past can keep us honest. Libraries help do that, by
5657 collecting content and keeping it, for schoolchildren, for
5658 researchers, for grandma. A free society presumes this knowedge.
5661 The Internet was an exception to this presumption. Until the Internet
5662 Archive, there was no way to go back. The Internet was the
5663 quintessentially transitory medium. And yet, as it becomes more
5664 important in forming and reforming society, it becomes more and more
5665 <!-- PAGE BREAK 121 -->
5666 important to maintain in some historical form. It's just bizarre to
5667 think that we have scads of archives of newspapers from tiny towns
5668 around the world, yet there is but one copy of the Internet
—the
5669 one kept by the Internet Archive.
5672 Brewster Kahle is the founder of the Internet Archive. He was a very
5673 successful Internet entrepreneur after he was a successful computer
5674 researcher. In the
1990s, Kahle decided he had had enough business
5675 success. It was time to become a different kind of success. So he
5676 launched a series of projects designed to archive human knowledge. The
5677 Internet Archive was just the first of the projects of this Andrew
5678 Carnegie of the Internet. By December of
2002, the archive had over
10
5679 billion pages, and it was growing at about a billion pages a month.
5681 <indexterm><primary>Vanderbilt University
</primary></indexterm>
5683 The Way Back Machine is the largest archive of human knowledge in
5684 human history. At the end of
2002, it held
<quote>two hundred and thirty
5685 terabytes of material
</quote>—and was
<quote>ten times larger than the
5686 Library of Congress.
</quote> And this was just the first of the archives that
5687 Kahle set out to build. In addition to the Internet Archive, Kahle has
5688 been constructing the Television Archive. Television, it turns out, is
5689 even more ephemeral than the Internet. While much of twentieth-century
5690 culture was constructed through television, only a tiny proportion of
5691 that culture is available for anyone to see today. Three hours of news
5692 are recorded each evening by Vanderbilt University
—thanks to a
5693 specific exemption in the copyright law. That content is indexed, and
5694 is available to scholars for a very low fee.
<quote>But other than that,
5695 [television] is almost unavailable,
</quote> Kahle told me.
<quote>If you were
5696 Barbara Walters you could get access to [the archives], but if you are
5697 just a graduate student?
</quote> As Kahle put it,
5700 <indexterm><primary>Quayle, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
5702 Do you remember when Dan Quayle was interacting with Murphy Brown?
5703 Remember that back and forth surreal experience of a politician
5704 interacting with a fictional television character? If you were a
5705 graduate student wanting to study that, and you wanted to get those
5706 original back and forth exchanges between the two, the
5708 <!-- PAGE BREAK 122 -->
5709 <citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode that came out after it
… it would be almost
5710 impossible.
… Those materials are almost unfindable.
…
5714 Why is that? Why is it that the part of our culture that is recorded
5715 in newspapers remains perpetually accessible, while the part that is
5716 recorded on videotape is not? How is it that we've created a world
5717 where researchers trying to understand the effect of media on
5718 nineteenthcentury America will have an easier time than researchers
5719 trying to understand the effect of media on twentieth-century America?
5722 In part, this is because of the law. Early in American copyright law,
5723 copyright owners were required to deposit copies of their work in
5724 libraries. These copies were intended both to facilitate the spread
5725 of knowledge and to assure that a copy of the work would be around
5726 once the copyright expired, so that others might access and copy the
5730 These rules applied to film as well. But in
1915, the Library
5731 of Congress made an exception for film. Film could be copyrighted so
5732 long as such deposits were made. But the filmmaker was then allowed to
5733 borrow back the deposits
—for an unlimited time at no cost. In
5734 1915 alone, there were more than
5,
475 films deposited and
<quote>borrowed
5735 back.
</quote> Thus, when the copyrights to films expire, there is no copy
5736 held by any library. The copy exists
—if it exists at
5737 all
—in the library archive of the film company.
<footnote><para>
5739 Doug Herrick,
<quote>Toward a National Film Collection: Motion Pictures at
5740 the Library of Congress,
</quote> <citetitle>Film Library Quarterly
</citetitle> 13 nos.
2–3
5741 (
1980):
5; Anthony Slide,
<citetitle>Nitrate Won't Wait: A History of Film
5742 Preservation in the United States
</citetitle> ( Jefferson, N.C.: McFarland
&
5747 The same is generally true about television. Television broadcasts
5748 were originally not copyrighted
—there was no way to capture the
5749 broadcasts, so there was no fear of
<quote>theft.
</quote> But as technology enabled
5750 capturing, broadcasters relied increasingly upon the law. The law
5751 required they make a copy of each broadcast for the work to be
5752 <quote>copyrighted.
</quote> But those copies were simply kept by the
5753 broadcasters. No library had any right to them; the government didn't
5754 demand them. The content of this part of American culture is
5755 practically invisible to anyone who would look.
5758 Kahle was eager to correct this. Before September
11,
2001, he and
5759 <!-- PAGE BREAK 123 -->
5760 his allies had started capturing television. They selected twenty
5761 stations from around the world and hit the Record button. After
5762 September
11, Kahle, working with dozens of others, selected twenty
5763 stations from around the world and, beginning October
11,
2001, made
5764 their coverage during the week of September
11 available free on-line.
5765 Anyone could see how news reports from around the world covered the
5768 <indexterm><primary>Movie Archive
</primary></indexterm>
5770 <primary>archive.org
</primary>
5771 <seealso>Internet Archive
</seealso>
5774 Kahle had the same idea with film. Working with Rick Prelinger, whose
5775 archive of film includes close to
45,
000 <quote>ephemeral films
</quote> (meaning
5776 films other than Hollywood movies, films that were never copyrighted),
5777 Kahle established the Movie Archive. Prelinger let Kahle digitize
5778 1,
300 films in this archive and post those films on the Internet to be
5779 downloaded for free. Prelinger's is a for-profit company. It sells
5780 copies of these films as stock footage. What he has discovered is that
5781 after he made a significant chunk available for free, his stock
5782 footage sales went up dramatically. People could easily find the
5783 material they wanted to use. Some downloaded that material and made
5784 films on their own. Others purchased copies to enable other films to
5785 be made. Either way, the archive enabled access to this important
5786 part of our culture. Want to see a copy of the
<quote>Duck and Cover
</quote> film
5787 that instructed children how to save themselves in the middle of
5788 nuclear attack? Go to archive.org, and you can download the film in a
5789 few minutes
—for free.
5792 Here again, Kahle is providing access to a part of our culture that we
5793 otherwise could not get easily, if at all. It is yet another part of
5794 what defines the twentieth century that we have lost to history. The
5795 law doesn't require these copies to be kept by anyone, or to be
5796 deposited in an archive by anyone. Therefore, there is no simple way
5800 The key here is access, not price. Kahle wants to enable free access
5801 to this content, but he also wants to enable others to sell access to
5802 it. His aim is to ensure competition in access to this important part
5803 of our culture. Not during the commercial life of a bit of creative
5804 property, but during a second life that all creative property
5805 has
—a noncommercial life.
5808 For here is an idea that we should more clearly recognize. Every bit
5809 of creative property goes through different
<quote>lives.
</quote> In its first
5812 <!-- PAGE BREAK 124 -->
5813 creator is lucky, the content is sold. In such cases the commercial
5814 market is successful for the creator. The vast majority of creative
5815 property doesn't enjoy such success, but some clearly does. For that
5816 content, commercial life is extremely important. Without this
5817 commercial market, there would be, many argue, much less creativity.
5820 After the commercial life of creative property has ended, our
5821 tradition has always supported a second life as well. A newspaper
5822 delivers the news every day to the doorsteps of America. The very next
5823 day, it is used to wrap fish or to fill boxes with fragile gifts or to
5824 build an archive of knowledge about our history. In this second life,
5825 the content can continue to inform even if that information is no
5829 <primary>books
</primary>
5830 <secondary>out of print
</secondary>
5833 The same has always been true about books. A book goes out of print
5834 very quickly (the average today is after about a year
<footnote><para>
5837 <primary>books
</primary>
5838 <secondary>out of print
</secondary>
5840 Dave Barns,
<quote>Fledgling Career in Antique Books: Woodstock Landlord,
5841 Bar Owner Starts a New Chapter by Adopting Business,
</quote> <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
5842 5 September
1997, at Metro Lake
1L. Of books published between
1927
5843 and
1946, only
2.2 percent were in print in
2002. R. Anthony Reese,
5844 <quote>The First Sale Doctrine in the Era of Digital Networks,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston
5845 College Law Review
</citetitle> 44 (
2003):
593 n.
51.
5846 </para></footnote>). After
5847 it is out of print, it can be sold in used book stores without the
5848 copyright owner getting anything and stored in libraries, where many
5849 get to read the book, also for free. Used book stores and libraries
5850 are thus the second life of a book. That second life is extremely
5851 important to the spread and stability of culture.
5854 Yet increasingly, any assumption about a stable second life for
5855 creative property does not hold true with the most important
5856 components of popular culture in the twentieth and twenty-first
5857 centuries. For these
—television, movies, music, radio, the
5858 Internet
—there is no guarantee of a second life. For these sorts
5859 of culture, it is as if we've replaced libraries with Barnes
&
5860 Noble superstores. With this culture, what's accessible is nothing but
5861 what a certain limited market demands. Beyond that, culture
5865 <emphasis role='strong'
>For most of
</emphasis> the twentieth century,
5866 it was economics that made this so. It would have been insanely
5867 expensive to collect and make accessible all television and film and
5868 music: The cost of analog copies is extraordinarily high. So even
5869 though the law in principle would have restricted the ability of a
5870 Brewster Kahle to copy culture generally, the
5871 <!-- PAGE BREAK 125 -->
5872 real restriction was economics. The market made it impossibly
5873 difficult to do anything about this ephemeral culture; the law had
5874 little practical effect.
5877 Perhaps the single most important feature of the digital revolution is
5878 that for the first time since the Library of Alexandria, it is
5879 feasible to imagine constructing archives that hold all culture
5880 produced or distributed publicly. Technology makes it possible to
5881 imagine an archive of all books published, and increasingly makes it
5882 possible to imagine an archive of all moving images and sound.
5885 The scale of this potential archive is something we've never imagined
5886 before. The Brewster Kahles of our history have dreamed about it; but
5887 we are for the first time at a point where that dream is possible. As
5892 <primary>books
</primary>
5893 <secondary>total number of
</secondary>
5896 It looks like there's about two to three million recordings of music.
5897 Ever. There are about a hundred thousand theatrical releases of
5898 movies,
… and about one to two million movies [distributed] during
5899 the twentieth century. There are about twenty-six million different
5900 titles of books. All of these would fit on computers that would fit in
5901 this room and be able to be afforded by a small company. So we're at
5902 a turning point in our history. Universal access is the goal. And the
5903 opportunity of leading a different life, based on this, is
5904 … thrilling. It could be one of the things humankind would be most
5905 proud of. Up there with the Library of Alexandria, putting a man on
5906 the moon, and the invention of the printing press.
5910 Kahle is not the only librarian. The Internet Archive is not the only
5911 archive. But Kahle and the Internet Archive suggest what the future of
5912 libraries or archives could be.
<emphasis>When
</emphasis> the
5913 commercial life of creative property ends, I don't know. But it
5914 does. And whenever it does, Kahle and his archive hint at a world
5915 where this knowledge, and culture, remains perpetually available. Some
5916 will draw upon it to understand it;
5917 <!-- PAGE BREAK 126 -->
5918 some to criticize it. Some will use it, as Walt Disney did, to
5919 re-create the past for the future. These technologies promise
5920 something that had become unimaginable for much of our past
—a
5921 future
<emphasis>for
</emphasis> our past. The technology of digital
5922 arts could make the dream of the Library of Alexandria real again.
5925 Technologists have thus removed the economic costs of building such an
5926 archive. But lawyers' costs remain. For as much as we might like to
5927 call these
<quote>archives,
</quote> as warm as the idea of a
<quote>library
</quote> might seem,
5928 the
<quote>content
</quote> that is collected in these digital spaces is also
5929 someone's
<quote>property.
</quote> And the law of property restricts the freedoms
5930 that Kahle and others would exercise.
5932 <indexterm startref='idxarchivesdigital1' class='endofrange'
/>
5933 <!-- PAGE BREAK 127 -->
5935 <chapter label=
"10" id=
"property-i">
5936 <title>CHAPTER TEN:
<quote>Property
</quote></title>
5937 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Lyndon
</primary></indexterm>
5938 <indexterm><primary>Kennedy, John F.
</primary></indexterm>
5940 <emphasis role='strong'
>Jack Valenti
</emphasis> has been the president
5941 of the Motion Picture Association of America since
1966. He first came
5942 to Washington, D.C., with Lyndon Johnson's
5943 administration
—literally. The famous picture of Johnson's
5944 swearing-in on Air Force One after the assassination of President
5945 Kennedy has Valenti in the background. In his almost forty years of
5946 running the MPAA, Valenti has established himself as perhaps the most
5947 prominent and effective lobbyist in Washington.
5950 The MPAA is the American branch of the international Motion Picture
5951 Association. It was formed in
1922 as a trade association whose goal
5952 was to defend American movies against increasing domestic criticism.
5953 The organization now represents not only filmmakers but producers and
5954 distributors of entertainment for television, video, and cable. Its
5955 board is made up of the chairmen and presidents of the seven major
5956 producers and distributors of motion picture and television programs
5957 in the United States: Walt Disney, Sony Pictures Entertainment, MGM,
5958 Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, and
5960 <indexterm><primary>Disney, Inc.
</primary></indexterm>
5961 <indexterm><primary>Sony Pictures Entertainment
</primary></indexterm>
5962 <indexterm><primary>MGM
</primary></indexterm>
5963 <indexterm><primary>Paramount Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5964 <indexterm><primary>Twentieth Century Fox
</primary></indexterm>
5965 <indexterm><primary>Universal Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5966 <indexterm><primary>Warner Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
5969 <!-- PAGE BREAK 128 -->
5970 Valenti is only the third president of the MPAA. No president before
5971 him has had as much influence over that organization, or over
5972 Washington. As a Texan, Valenti has mastered the single most important
5973 political skill of a Southerner
—the ability to appear simple and
5974 slow while hiding a lightning-fast intellect. To this day, Valenti
5975 plays the simple, humble man. But this Harvard MBA, and author of four
5976 books, who finished high school at the age of fifteen and flew more
5977 than fifty combat missions in World War II, is no Mr. Smith. When
5978 Valenti went to Washington, he mastered the city in a quintessentially
5982 In defending artistic liberty and the freedom of speech that our
5983 culture depends upon, the MPAA has done important good. In crafting
5984 the MPAA rating system, it has probably avoided a great deal of
5985 speech-regulating harm. But there is an aspect to the organization's
5986 mission that is both the most radical and the most important. This is
5987 the organization's effort, epitomized in Valenti's every act, to
5988 redefine the meaning of
<quote>creative property.
</quote>
5991 In
1982, Valenti's testimony to Congress captured the strategy
5996 No matter the lengthy arguments made, no matter the charges and the
5997 counter-charges, no matter the tumult and the shouting, reasonable men
5998 and women will keep returning to the fundamental issue, the central
5999 theme which animates this entire debate:
<emphasis>Creative property
6000 owners must be accorded the same rights and protection resident in all
6001 other property owners in the nation
</emphasis>. That is the issue.
6002 That is the question. And that is the rostrum on which this entire
6003 hearing and the debates to follow must rest.
<footnote><para>
6005 Home Recording of Copyrighted Works: Hearings on H.R.
4783, H.R.
6006 4794, H.R.
4808, H.R.
5250, H.R.
5488, and H.R.
5705 Before the
6007 Subcommittee on Courts, Civil Liberties, and the Administration of
6008 Justice of the Committee on the Judiciary of the House of
6009 Representatives,
97th Cong.,
2nd sess. (
1982):
65 (testimony of Jack
6015 The strategy of this rhetoric, like the strategy of most of Valenti's
6016 rhetoric, is brilliant and simple and brilliant because simple. The
6017 <quote>central theme
</quote> to which
<quote>reasonable men and women
</quote> will return is
6019 <!-- PAGE BREAK 129 -->
6020 <quote>Creative property owners must be accorded the same rights and
6021 protections resident in all other property owners in the nation.
</quote>
6022 There are no second-class citizens, Valenti might have
6023 continued. There should be no second-class property owners.
6026 This claim has an obvious and powerful intuitive pull. It is stated
6027 with such clarity as to make the idea as obvious as the notion that we
6028 use elections to pick presidents. But in fact, there is no more
6029 extreme a claim made by
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> who is serious in
6030 this debate than this claim of Valenti's. Jack Valenti, however sweet
6031 and however brilliant, is perhaps the nation's foremost extremist when
6032 it comes to the nature and scope of
<quote>creative property.
</quote> His views
6033 have
<emphasis>no
</emphasis> reasonable connection to our actual legal
6034 tradition, even if the subtle pull of his Texan charm has slowly
6035 redefined that tradition, at least in Washington.
6038 While
<quote>creative property
</quote> is certainly
<quote>property
</quote> in a nerdy and
6039 precise sense that lawyers are trained to understand,
<footnote><para>
6041 Lawyers speak of
<quote>property
</quote> not as an absolute thing, but as a bundle
6042 of rights that are sometimes associated with a particular
6043 object. Thus, my
<quote>property right
</quote> to my car gives me the right to
6044 exclusive use, but not the right to drive at
150 miles an hour. For
6045 the best effort to connect the ordinary meaning of
<quote>property
</quote> to
6046 <quote>lawyer talk,
</quote> see Bruce Ackerman,
<citetitle>Private Property and the
6047 Constitution
</citetitle> (New Haven: Yale University Press,
1977),
26–27.
6048 </para></footnote> it has never been the case, nor should it be, that
6049 <quote>creative property owners
</quote> have been
<quote>accorded the same rights and
6050 protection resident in all other property owners.
</quote> Indeed, if creative
6051 property owners were given the same rights as all other property
6052 owners, that would effect a radical, and radically undesirable, change
6056 Valenti knows this. But he speaks for an industry that cares squat for
6057 our tradition and the values it represents. He speaks for an industry
6058 that is instead fighting to restore the tradition that the British
6059 overturned in
1710. In the world that Valenti's changes would create,
6060 a powerful few would exercise powerful control over how our creative
6061 culture would develop.
6064 I have two purposes in this chapter. The first is to convince you
6065 that, historically, Valenti's claim is absolutely wrong. The second is
6066 to convince you that it would be terribly wrong for us to reject our
6067 history. We have always treated rights in creative property
6068 differently from the rights resident in all other property
6069 owners. They have never been the same. And they should never be the
6070 same, because, however counterintuitive this may seem, to make them
6071 the same would be to
6073 <!-- PAGE BREAK 130 -->
6074 fundamentally weaken the opportunity for new creators to create.
6075 Creativity depends upon the owners of creativity having less than
6079 Organizations such as the MPAA, whose board includes the most powerful
6080 of the old guard, have little interest, their rhetoric
6081 notwithstanding, in assuring that the new can displace them. No
6082 organization does. No person does. (Ask me about tenure, for example.)
6083 But what's good for the MPAA is not necessarily good for America. A
6084 society that defends the ideals of free culture must preserve
6085 precisely the opportunity for new creativity to threaten the old.
6088 <emphasis role='strong'
>To get
</emphasis> just a hint that there is
6089 something fundamentally wrong in Valenti's argument, we need look no
6090 further than the United States Constitution itself.
6093 The framers of our Constitution loved
<quote>property.
</quote> Indeed, so strongly
6094 did they love property that they built into the Constitution an
6095 important requirement. If the government takes your property
—if
6096 it condemns your house, or acquires a slice of land from your
6097 farm
—it is required, under the Fifth Amendment's
<quote>Takings
6098 Clause,
</quote> to pay you
<quote>just compensation
</quote> for that taking. The
6099 Constitution thus guarantees that property is, in a certain sense,
6100 sacred. It cannot
<emphasis>ever
</emphasis> be taken from the property
6101 owner unless the government pays for the privilege.
6104 Yet the very same Constitution speaks very differently about what
6105 Valenti calls
<quote>creative property.
</quote> In the clause granting Congress the
6106 power to create
<quote>creative property,
</quote> the Constitution
6107 <emphasis>requires
</emphasis> that after a
<quote>limited time,
</quote> Congress
6108 take back the rights that it has granted and set the
<quote>creative
6109 property
</quote> free to the public domain. Yet when Congress does this, when
6110 the expiration of a copyright term
<quote>takes
</quote> your copyright and turns it
6111 over to the public domain, Congress does not have any obligation to
6112 pay
<quote>just compensation
</quote> for this
<quote>taking.
</quote> Instead, the same
6113 Constitution that requires compensation for your land
6114 <!-- PAGE BREAK 131 -->
6115 requires that you lose your
<quote>creative property
</quote> right without any
6116 compensation at all.
6119 The Constitution thus on its face states that these two forms of
6120 property are not to be accorded the same rights. They are plainly to
6121 be treated differently. Valenti is therefore not just asking for a
6122 change in our tradition when he argues that creative-property owners
6123 should be accorded the same rights as every other property-right
6124 owner. He is effectively arguing for a change in our Constitution
6128 Arguing for a change in our Constitution is not necessarily wrong.
6129 There was much in our original Constitution that was plainly wrong.
6130 The Constitution of
1789 entrenched slavery; it left senators to be
6131 appointed rather than elected; it made it possible for the electoral
6132 college to produce a tie between the president and his own vice
6133 president (as it did in
1800). The framers were no doubt
6134 extraordinary, but I would be the first to admit that they made big
6135 mistakes. We have since rejected some of those mistakes; no doubt
6136 there could be others that we should reject as well. So my argument is
6137 not simply that because Jefferson did it, we should, too.
6140 Instead, my argument is that because Jefferson did it, we should at
6141 least try to understand
<emphasis>why
</emphasis>. Why did the framers,
6142 fanatical property types that they were, reject the claim that
6143 creative property be given the same rights as all other property? Why
6144 did they require that for creative property there must be a public
6148 To answer this question, we need to get some perspective on the
6149 history of these
<quote>creative property
</quote> rights, and the control that they
6150 enabled. Once we see clearly how differently these rights have been
6151 defined, we will be in a better position to ask the question that
6152 should be at the core of this war: Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis>
6153 creative property should be protected, but how. Not
6154 <emphasis>whether
</emphasis> we will enforce the rights the law gives
6155 to creative-property owners, but what the particular mix of rights
6156 ought to be. Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> artists should be paid,
6157 but whether institutions designed to assure that artists get paid need
6158 also control how culture develops.
6162 <!-- PAGE BREAK 132 -->
6163 To answer these questions, we need a more general way to talk about
6164 how property is protected. More precisely, we need a more general way
6165 than the narrow language of the law allows. In
<citetitle>Code and Other Laws of
6166 Cyberspace
</citetitle>, I used a simple model to capture this more general
6167 perspective. For any particular right or regulation, this model asks
6168 how four different modalities of regulation interact to support or
6169 weaken the right or regulation. I represented it with this diagram:
6171 <figure id=
"fig-1331">
6172 <title>How four different modalities of regulation interact to support or weaken the right or regulation.
</title>
6173 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6176 At the center of this picture is a regulated dot: the individual or
6177 group that is the target of regulation, or the holder of a right. (In
6178 each case throughout, we can describe this either as regulation or as
6179 a right. For simplicity's sake, I will speak only of regulations.)
6180 The ovals represent four ways in which the individual or group might
6181 be regulated
— either constrained or, alternatively, enabled. Law
6182 is the most obvious constraint (to lawyers, at least). It constrains
6183 by threatening punishments after the fact if the rules set in advance
6184 are violated. So if, for example, you willfully infringe Madonna's
6185 copyright by copying a song from her latest CD and posting it on the
6186 Web, you can be punished
6187 <!-- PAGE BREAK 133 -->
6188 with a $
150,
000 fine. The fine is an ex post punishment for violating
6189 an ex ante rule. It is imposed by the state.
6190 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
6192 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6194 Norms are a different kind of constraint. They, too, punish an
6195 individual for violating a rule. But the punishment of a norm is
6196 imposed by a community, not (or not only) by the state. There may be
6197 no law against spitting, but that doesn't mean you won't be punished
6198 if you spit on the ground while standing in line at a movie. The
6199 punishment might not be harsh, though depending upon the community, it
6200 could easily be more harsh than many of the punishments imposed by the
6201 state. The mark of the difference is not the severity of the rule, but
6202 the source of the enforcement.
6204 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6206 The market is a third type of constraint. Its constraint is effected
6207 through conditions: You can do X if you pay Y; you'll be paid M if you
6208 do N. These constraints are obviously not independent of law or
6209 norms
—it is property law that defines what must be bought if it
6210 is to be taken legally; it is norms that say what is appropriately
6211 sold. But given a set of norms, and a background of property and
6212 contract law, the market imposes a simultaneous constraint upon how an
6213 individual or group might behave.
6215 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6217 Finally, and for the moment, perhaps, most mysteriously,
6218 <quote>architecture
</quote>—the physical world as one finds it
—is a
6219 constraint on behavior. A fallen bridge might constrain your ability
6220 to get across a river. Railroad tracks might constrain the ability of
6221 a community to integrate its social life. As with the market,
6222 architecture does not effect its constraint through ex post
6223 punishments. Instead, also as with the market, architecture effects
6224 its constraint through simultaneous conditions. These conditions are
6225 imposed not by courts enforcing contracts, or by police punishing
6226 theft, but by nature, by
<quote>architecture.
</quote> If a
500-pound boulder
6227 blocks your way, it is the law of gravity that enforces this
6228 constraint. If a $
500 airplane ticket stands between you and a flight
6229 to New York, it is the market that enforces this constraint.
6233 <!-- PAGE BREAK 134 -->
6234 So the first point about these four modalities of regulation is
6235 obvious: They interact. Restrictions imposed by one might be
6236 reinforced by another. Or restrictions imposed by one might be
6237 undermined by another.
6240 The second point follows directly: If we want to understand the
6241 effective freedom that anyone has at a given moment to do any
6242 particular thing, we have to consider how these four modalities
6243 interact. Whether or not there are other constraints (there may well
6244 be; my claim is not about comprehensiveness), these four are among the
6245 most significant, and any regulator (whether controlling or freeing)
6246 must consider how these four in particular interact.
6248 <indexterm id=
"idxdrivespeed" class='startofrange'
>
6249 <primary>driving speed, constraints on
</primary>
6251 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6252 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6253 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6255 So, for example, consider the
<quote>freedom
</quote> to drive a car at a high
6256 speed. That freedom is in part restricted by laws: speed limits that
6257 say how fast you can drive in particular places at particular
6258 times. It is in part restricted by architecture: speed bumps, for
6259 example, slow most rational drivers; governors in buses, as another
6260 example, set the maximum rate at which the driver can drive. The
6261 freedom is in part restricted by the market: Fuel efficiency drops as
6262 speed increases, thus the price of gasoline indirectly constrains
6263 speed. And finally, the norms of a community may or may not constrain
6264 the freedom to speed. Drive at
50 mph by a school in your own
6265 neighborhood and you're likely to be punished by the neighbors. The
6266 same norm wouldn't be as effective in a different town, or at night.
6269 The final point about this simple model should also be fairly clear:
6270 While these four modalities are analytically independent, law has a
6271 special role in affecting the three.
<footnote><para>
6273 By describing the way law affects the other three modalities, I don't
6274 mean to suggest that the other three don't affect law. Obviously, they
6275 do. Law's only distinction is that it alone speaks as if it has a
6276 right self-consciously to change the other three. The right of the
6277 other three is more timidly expressed. See Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Code: And
6278 Other Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books,
1999):
90–95;
6279 Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>The New Chicago School,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of Legal Studies
</citetitle>,
6282 The law, in other words, sometimes operates to increase or decrease
6283 the constraint of a particular modality. Thus, the law might be used
6284 to increase taxes on gasoline, so as to increase the incentives to
6285 drive more slowly. The law might be used to mandate more speed bumps,
6286 so as to increase the difficulty of driving rapidly. The law might be
6287 used to fund ads that stigmatize reckless driving. Or the law might be
6288 used to require that other laws be more
6289 <!-- PAGE BREAK 135 -->
6290 strict
—a federal requirement that states decrease the speed
6291 limit, for example
—so as to decrease the attractiveness of fast
6294 <indexterm startref=
"idxdrivespeed" class='endofrange'
/>
6296 <figure id=
"fig-1361">
6297 <title>Law has a special role in affecting the three.
</title>
6298 <graphic fileref=
"images/1361.png"></graphic>
6300 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6302 These constraints can thus change, and they can be changed. To
6303 understand the effective protection of liberty or protection of
6304 property at any particular moment, we must track these changes over
6305 time. A restriction imposed by one modality might be erased by
6306 another. A freedom enabled by one modality might be displaced by
6310 Some people object to this way of talking about
<quote>liberty.
</quote> They object
6311 because their focus when considering the constraints that exist at any
6312 particular moment are constraints imposed exclusively by the
6313 government. For instance, if a storm destroys a bridge, these people
6314 think it is meaningless to say that one's liberty has been
6315 restrained. A bridge has washed out, and it's harder to get from one
6316 place to another. To talk about this as a loss of freedom, they say,
6317 is to confuse the stuff of politics with the vagaries of ordinary
6318 life. I don't mean to deny the value in this narrower view, which
6319 depends upon the context of the inquiry. I do, however, mean to argue
6320 against any insistence that this narrower view is the only proper view
6321 of liberty. As I argued in
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, we come from a
6322 long tradition of political thought with a broader focus than the
6323 narrow question of what the government did when. John Stuart Mill
6324 defended freedom of speech, for example, from the tyranny of narrow
6325 minds, not from the fear of government prosecution; John Stuart Mill,
6326 <citetitle>On Liberty
</citetitle> (Indiana: Hackett Publishing Co.,
6327 1978),
19. John R. Commons famously defended the economic freedom of
6328 labor from constraints imposed by the market; John R. Commons,
<quote>The
6329 Right to Work,
</quote> in Malcom Rutherford and Warren J. Samuels, eds.,
6330 <citetitle>John R. Commons: Selected Essays
</citetitle> (London:
6331 Routledge:
1997),
62. The Americans with Disabilities Act increases
6332 the liberty of people with physical disabilities by changing the
6333 architecture of certain public places, thereby making access to those
6334 places easier;
42 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6335 12101 (
2000). Each of these interventions to change existing
6336 conditions changes the liberty of a particular group. The effect of
6337 those interventions should be accounted for in order to understand the
6338 effective liberty that each of these groups might face.
6339 <indexterm><primary>Americans with Disabilities Act (
1990)
</primary></indexterm>
6340 <indexterm><primary>Commons, John R.
</primary></indexterm>
6341 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6342 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6345 <section id=
"hollywood">
6346 <title>Why Hollywood Is Right
</title>
6348 The most obvious point that this model reveals is just why, or just
6349 how, Hollywood is right. The copyright warriors have rallied Congress
6350 and the courts to defend copyright. This model helps us see why that
6351 rallying makes sense.
6354 Let's say this is the picture of copyright's regulation before the
6357 <figure id=
"fig-1371">
6358 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6359 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6361 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6362 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6364 <!-- PAGE BREAK 136 -->
6365 There is balance between law, norms, market, and architecture. The law
6366 limits the ability to copy and share content, by imposing penalties on
6367 those who copy and share content. Those penalties are reinforced by
6368 technologies that make it hard to copy and share content
6369 (architecture) and expensive to copy and share content
6370 (market). Finally, those penalties are mitigated by norms we all
6371 recognize
—kids, for example, taping other kids' records. These
6372 uses of copyrighted material may well be infringement, but the norms
6373 of our society (before the Internet, at least) had no problem with
6374 this form of infringement.
6377 Enter the Internet, or, more precisely, technologies such as MP3s and
6378 p2p sharing. Now the constraint of architecture changes dramatically,
6379 as does the constraint of the market. And as both the market and
6380 architecture relax the regulation of copyright, norms pile on. The
6381 happy balance (for the warriors, at least) of life before the Internet
6382 becomes an effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
6385 Thus the sense of, and justification for, the warriors' response.
6386 Technology has changed, the warriors say, and the effect of this
6387 change, when ramified through the market and norms, is that a balance
6388 of protection for the copyright owners' rights has been lost. This is
6390 <!-- PAGE BREAK 137 -->
6391 after the fall of Saddam, but this time no government is justifying the
6392 looting that results.
6394 <figure id=
"fig-1381">
6395 <title>effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
</title>
6396 <graphic fileref=
"images/1381.png"></graphic>
6399 Neither this analysis nor the conclusions that follow are new to the
6400 warriors. Indeed, in a
<quote>White Paper
</quote> prepared by the Commerce
6401 Department (one heavily influenced by the copyright warriors) in
1995,
6402 this mix of regulatory modalities had already been identified and the
6403 strategy to respond already mapped. In response to the changes the
6404 Internet had effected, the White Paper argued (
1) Congress should
6405 strengthen intellectual property law, (
2) businesses should adopt
6406 innovative marketing techniques, (
3) technologists should push to
6407 develop code to protect copyrighted material, and (
4) educators should
6408 educate kids to better protect copyright.
6410 <indexterm><primary>steel industry
</primary></indexterm>
6412 This mixed strategy is just what copyright needed
—if it was to
6413 preserve the particular balance that existed before the change induced
6414 by the Internet. And it's just what we should expect the content
6415 industry to push for. It is as American as apple pie to consider the
6416 happy life you have as an entitlement, and to look to the law to
6417 protect it if something comes along to change that happy
6418 life. Homeowners living in a
6420 <!-- PAGE BREAK 138 -->
6421 flood plain have no hesitation appealing to the government to rebuild
6422 (and rebuild again) when a flood (architecture) wipes away their
6423 property (law). Farmers have no hesitation appealing to the government
6424 to bail them out when a virus (architecture) devastates their
6425 crop. Unions have no hesitation appealing to the government to bail
6426 them out when imports (market) wipe out the U.S. steel industry.
6429 Thus, there's nothing wrong or surprising in the content industry's
6430 campaign to protect itself from the harmful consequences of a
6431 technological innovation. And I would be the last person to argue that
6432 the changing technology of the Internet has not had a profound effect
6433 on the content industry's way of doing business, or as John Seely
6434 Brown describes it, its
<quote>architecture of revenue.
</quote>
6436 <indexterm><primary>railroad industry
</primary></indexterm>
6437 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
6439 But just because a particular interest asks for government support, it
6440 doesn't follow that support should be granted. And just because
6441 technology has weakened a particular way of doing business, it doesn't
6442 follow that the government should intervene to support that old way of
6443 doing business. Kodak, for example, has lost perhaps as much as
20
6444 percent of their traditional film market to the emerging technologies
6445 of digital cameras.
<footnote><para>
6447 See Geoffrey Smith,
<quote>Film vs. Digital: Can Kodak Build a Bridge?
</quote>
6448 BusinessWeek online,
2 August
1999, available at
6449 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
23</ulink>. For a more
6450 recent analysis of Kodak's place in the market, see Chana
6451 R. Schoenberger,
<quote>Can Kodak Make Up for Lost Moments?
</quote> Forbes.com,
6
6452 October
2003, available at
6453 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
24</ulink>.
6456 Does anyone believe the government should ban digital cameras just to
6457 support Kodak? Highways have weakened the freight business for
6458 railroads. Does anyone think we should ban trucks from roads
6459 <emphasis>for the purpose of
</emphasis> protecting the railroads?
6460 Closer to the subject of this book, remote channel changers have
6461 weakened the
<quote>stickiness
</quote> of television advertising (if a boring
6462 commercial comes on the TV, the remote makes it easy to surf ), and it
6463 may well be that this change has weakened the television advertising
6464 market. But does anyone believe we should regulate remotes to
6465 reinforce commercial television? (Maybe by limiting them to function
6466 only once a second, or to switch to only ten channels within an hour?)
6468 <indexterm><primary>Brezhnev, Leonid
</primary></indexterm>
6469 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
6471 The obvious answer to these obviously rhetorical questions is no.
6472 In a free society, with a free market, supported by free enterprise and
6473 free trade, the government's role is not to support one way of doing
6474 <!-- PAGE BREAK 139 -->
6475 business against others. Its role is not to pick winners and protect
6476 them against loss. If the government did this generally, then we would
6477 never have any progress. As Microsoft chairman Bill Gates wrote in
6478 1991, in a memo criticizing software patents,
<quote>established companies
6479 have an interest in excluding future competitors.
</quote><footnote><para>
6481 Fred Warshofsky,
<citetitle>The Patent Wars
</citetitle> (New York: Wiley,
1994),
170–71.
6484 startup, established companies also have the means. (Think RCA and
6485 FM radio.) A world in which competitors with new ideas must fight
6486 not only the market but also the government is a world in which
6487 competitors with new ideas will not succeed. It is a world of stasis and
6488 increasingly concentrated stagnation. It is the Soviet Union under
6492 Thus, while it is understandable for industries threatened with new
6493 technologies that change the way they do business to look to the
6494 government for protection, it is the special duty of policy makers to
6495 guarantee that that protection not become a deterrent to progress. It
6496 is the duty of policy makers, in other words, to assure that the
6497 changes they create, in response to the request of those hurt by
6498 changing technology, are changes that preserve the incentives and
6499 opportunities for innovation and change.
6502 In the context of laws regulating speech
—which include,
6503 obviously, copyright law
—that duty is even stronger. When the
6504 industry complaining about changing technologies is asking Congress to
6505 respond in a way that burdens speech and creativity, policy makers
6506 should be especially wary of the request. It is always a bad deal for
6507 the government to get into the business of regulating speech
6508 markets. The risks and dangers of that game are precisely why our
6509 framers created the First Amendment to our Constitution:
<quote>Congress
6510 shall make no law
… abridging the freedom of speech.
</quote> So when
6511 Congress is being asked to pass laws that would
<quote>abridge
</quote> the freedom
6512 of speech, it should ask
— carefully
—whether such
6513 regulation is justified.
6516 My argument just now, however, has nothing to do with whether
6517 <!-- PAGE BREAK 140 -->
6518 the changes that are being pushed by the copyright warriors are
6519 <quote>justified.
</quote> My argument is about their effect. For before we get to
6520 the question of justification, a hard question that depends a great
6521 deal upon your values, we should first ask whether we understand the
6522 effect of the changes the content industry wants.
6525 Here's the metaphor that will capture the argument to follow.
6527 <indexterm id=
"idxddt" class='startofrange'
>
6528 <primary>DDT
</primary>
6531 In
1873, the chemical DDT was first synthesized. In
1948, Swiss
6532 chemist Paul Hermann Müller won the Nobel Prize for his work
6533 demonstrating the insecticidal properties of DDT. By the
1950s, the
6534 insecticide was widely used around the world to kill disease-carrying
6535 pests. It was also used to increase farm production.
6536 <indexterm><primary>Müller, Paul Hermann
</primary></indexterm>
6539 No one doubts that killing disease-carrying pests or increasing crop
6540 production is a good thing. No one doubts that the work of Müller was
6541 important and valuable and probably saved lives, possibly millions.
6543 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6544 <indexterm><primary>Silent Sprint (Carson)
</primary></indexterm>
6546 But in
1962, Rachel Carson published
<citetitle>Silent Spring
</citetitle>, which argued that
6547 DDT, whatever its primary benefits, was also having unintended
6548 environmental consequences. Birds were losing the ability to
6549 reproduce. Whole chains of the ecology were being destroyed.
6552 No one set out to destroy the environment. Paul Müller certainly did
6553 not aim to harm any birds. But the effort to solve one set of problems
6554 produced another set which, in the view of some, was far worse than
6555 the problems that were originally attacked. Or more accurately, the
6556 problems DDT caused were worse than the problems it solved, at least
6557 when considering the other, more environmentally friendly ways to
6558 solve the problems that DDT was meant to solve.
6560 <indexterm><primary>Boyle, James
</primary></indexterm>
6562 It is to this image precisely that Duke University law professor James
6563 Boyle appeals when he argues that we need an
<quote>environmentalism
</quote> for
6564 culture.
<footnote><para>
6566 See, for example, James Boyle,
<quote>A Politics of Intellectual Property:
6567 Environmentalism for the Net?
</quote> <citetitle>Duke Law Journal
</citetitle> 47 (
1997):
87.
6569 His point, and the point I want to develop in the balance of this
6570 chapter, is not that the aims of copyright are flawed. Or that authors
6571 should not be paid for their work. Or that music should be given away
6572 <quote>for free.
</quote> The point is that some of the ways in which we might
6573 protect authors will have unintended consequences for the cultural
6574 environment, much like DDT had for the natural environment. And just
6575 <!-- PAGE BREAK 141 -->
6576 as criticism of DDT is not an endorsement of malaria or an attack on
6577 farmers, so, too, is criticism of one particular set of regulations
6578 protecting copyright not an endorsement of anarchy or an attack on
6579 authors. It is an environment of creativity that we seek, and we
6580 should be aware of our actions' effects on the environment.
6583 My argument, in the balance of this chapter, tries to map exactly
6584 this effect. No doubt the technology of the Internet has had a dramatic
6585 effect on the ability of copyright owners to protect their content. But
6586 there should also be little doubt that when you add together the
6587 changes in copyright law over time, plus the change in technology that
6588 the Internet is undergoing just now, the net effect of these changes will
6589 not be only that copyrighted work is effectively protected. Also, and
6590 generally missed, the net effect of this massive increase in protection
6591 will be devastating to the environment for creativity.
6594 In a line: To kill a gnat, we are spraying DDT with consequences
6595 for free culture that will be far more devastating than that this gnat will
6598 <indexterm startref=
"idxddt" class='endofrange'
/>
6600 <section id=
"beginnings">
6601 <title>Beginnings
</title>
6603 America copied English copyright law. Actually, we copied and improved
6604 English copyright law. Our Constitution makes the purpose of
<quote>creative
6605 property
</quote> rights clear; its express limitations reinforce the English
6606 aim to avoid overly powerful publishers.
6609 The power to establish
<quote>creative property
</quote> rights is granted to
6610 Congress in a way that, for our Constitution, at least, is very
6611 odd. Article I, section
8, clause
8 of our Constitution states that:
6614 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science and
6615 useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors
6616 the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries.
6618 <!-- PAGE BREAK 142 -->
6619 We can call this the
<quote>Progress Clause,
</quote> for notice what this clause
6620 does not say. It does not say Congress has the power to grant
6621 <quote>creative property rights.
</quote> It says that Congress has the power
6622 <emphasis>to promote progress
</emphasis>. The grant of power is its
6623 purpose, and its purpose is a public one, not the purpose of enriching
6624 publishers, nor even primarily the purpose of rewarding authors.
6627 The Progress Clause expressly limits the term of copyrights. As we saw
6628 in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"founders"/>,
6629 the English limited the term of copyright so as to assure that a few
6630 would not exercise disproportionate control over culture by exercising
6631 disproportionate control over publishing. We can assume the framers
6632 followed the English for a similar purpose. Indeed, unlike the
6633 English, the framers reinforced that objective, by requiring that
6634 copyrights extend
<quote>to Authors
</quote> only.
6637 The design of the Progress Clause reflects something about the
6638 Constitution's design in general. To avoid a problem, the framers
6639 built structure. To prevent the concentrated power of publishers, they
6640 built a structure that kept copyrights away from publishers and kept
6641 them short. To prevent the concentrated power of a church, they banned
6642 the federal government from establishing a church. To prevent
6643 concentrating power in the federal government, they built structures
6644 to reinforce the power of the states
—including the Senate, whose
6645 members were at the time selected by the states, and an electoral
6646 college, also selected by the states, to select the president. In each
6647 case, a
<emphasis>structure
</emphasis> built checks and balances into
6648 the constitutional frame, structured to prevent otherwise inevitable
6649 concentrations of power.
6652 I doubt the framers would recognize the regulation we call
<quote>copyright
</quote>
6653 today. The scope of that regulation is far beyond anything they ever
6654 considered. To begin to understand what they did, we need to put our
6655 <quote>copyright
</quote> in context: We need to see how it has changed in the
210
6656 years since they first struck its design.
6659 Some of these changes come from the law: some in light of changes
6660 in technology, and some in light of changes in technology given a
6661 <!-- PAGE BREAK 143 -->
6662 particular concentration of market power. In terms of our model, we
6665 <figure id=
"fig-1441">
6666 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6667 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6672 <figure id=
"fig-1442">
6673 <title><quote>Copyright
</quote> today.
</title>
6674 <graphic fileref=
"images/1442.png"></graphic>
6678 <!-- PAGE BREAK 144 -->
6681 <section id=
"lawduration">
6682 <title>Law: Duration
</title>
6684 When the first Congress enacted laws to protect creative property, it
6685 faced the same uncertainty about the status of creative property that
6686 the English had confronted in
1774. Many states had passed laws
6687 protecting creative property, and some believed that these laws simply
6688 supplemented common law rights that already protected creative
6689 authorship.
<footnote>
6692 William W. Crosskey,
<citetitle>Politics and the Constitution in the History of
6693 the United States
</citetitle> (London: Cambridge University Press,
1953), vol.
1,
6694 485–86:
<quote>extinguish[ing], by plain implication of `the supreme
6695 Law of the Land,'
<emphasis>the perpetual rights which authors had, or
6696 were supposed by some to have, under the Common Law
</emphasis></quote>
6698 <indexterm><primary>Crosskey, William W.
</primary></indexterm>
6700 This meant that there was no guaranteed public domain in the United
6701 States in
1790. If copyrights were protected by the common law, then
6702 there was no simple way to know whether a work published in the United
6703 States was controlled or free. Just as in England, this lingering
6704 uncertainty would make it hard for publishers to rely upon a public
6705 domain to reprint and distribute works.
6708 That uncertainty ended after Congress passed legislation granting
6709 copyrights. Because federal law overrides any contrary state law,
6710 federal protections for copyrighted works displaced any state law
6711 protections. Just as in England the Statute of Anne eventually meant
6712 that the copyrights for all English works expired, a federal statute
6713 meant that any state copyrights expired as well.
6716 In
1790, Congress enacted the first copyright law. It created a
6717 federal copyright and secured that copyright for fourteen years. If
6718 the author was alive at the end of that fourteen years, then he could
6719 opt to renew the copyright for another fourteen years. If he did not
6720 renew the copyright, his work passed into the public domain.
6723 While there were many works created in the United States in the first
6724 ten years of the Republic, only
5 percent of the works were actually
6725 registered under the federal copyright regime. Of all the work created
6726 in the United States both before
1790 and from
1790 through
1800,
95
6727 percent immediately passed into the public domain; the balance would
6728 pass into the pubic domain within twenty-eight years at most, and more
6729 likely within fourteen years.
<footnote><para>
6731 Although
13,
000 titles were published in the United States from
1790
6732 to
1799, only
556 copyright registrations were filed; John Tebbel,
<citetitle>A
6733 History of Book Publishing in the United States
</citetitle>, vol.
1,
<citetitle>The Creation
6734 of an Industry,
1630–1865</citetitle> (New York: Bowker,
1972),
141. Of the
21,
000
6735 imprints recorded before
1790, only twelve were copyrighted under the
6736 1790 act; William J. Maher,
<citetitle>Copyright Term, Retrospective Extension
6737 and the Copyright Law of
1790 in Historical Context
</citetitle>,
7–10 (
2002),
6738 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
6739 #
25</ulink>. Thus, the overwhelming majority of works fell
6740 immediately into the public domain. Even those works that were
6741 copyrighted fell into the public domain quickly, because the term of
6742 copyright was short. The initial term of copyright was fourteen years,
6743 with the option of renewal for an additional fourteen years. Copyright
6744 Act of May
31,
1790, §
1,
1 stat.
124.
</para></footnote>
6747 This system of renewal was a crucial part of the American system
6748 of copyright. It assured that the maximum terms of copyright would be
6749 <!-- PAGE BREAK 145 -->
6750 granted only for works where they were wanted. After the initial term
6751 of fourteen years, if it wasn't worth it to an author to renew his
6752 copyright, then it wasn't worth it to society to insist on the
6756 Fourteen years may not seem long to us, but for the vast majority of
6757 copyright owners at that time, it was long enough: Only a small
6758 minority of them renewed their copyright after fourteen years; the
6759 balance allowed their work to pass into the public
6760 domain.
<footnote><para>
6762 Few copyright holders ever chose to renew their copyrights. For
6763 instance, of the
25,
006 copyrights registered in
1883, only
894 were
6764 renewed in
1910. For a year-by-year analysis of copyright renewal
6765 rates, see Barbara A. Ringer,
<quote>Study No.
31: Renewal of Copyright,
</quote>
6766 <citetitle>Studies on Copyright
</citetitle>, vol.
1 (New York: Practicing Law Institute,
6767 1963),
618. For a more recent and comprehensive analysis, see William
6768 M. Landes and Richard A. Posner,
<quote>Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,
</quote>
6769 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
471,
498–501, and
6770 accompanying figures.
</para></footnote>
6773 <primary>books
</primary>
6774 <secondary>out of print
</secondary>
6777 Even today, this structure would make sense. Most creative work
6778 has an actual commercial life of just a couple of years. Most books fall
6779 out of print after one year.
<footnote><para>
6781 See Ringer, ch.
9, n.
2.
</para></footnote> When that happens, the
6782 used books are traded free of copyright regulation. Thus the books are
6783 no longer
<emphasis>effectively
</emphasis> controlled by
6784 copyright. The only practical commercial use of the books at that time
6785 is to sell the books as used books; that use
—because it does not
6786 involve publication
—is effectively free.
6789 In the first hundred years of the Republic, the term of copyright was
6790 changed once. In
1831, the term was increased from a maximum of
28
6791 years to a maximum of
42 by increasing the initial term of copyright
6792 from
14 years to
28 years. In the next fifty years of the Republic,
6793 the term increased once again. In
1909, Congress extended the renewal
6794 term of
14 years to
28 years, setting a maximum term of
56 years.
6797 Then, beginning in
1962, Congress started a practice that has defined
6798 copyright law since. Eleven times in the last forty years, Congress
6799 has extended the terms of existing copyrights; twice in those forty
6800 years, Congress extended the term of future copyrights. Initially, the
6801 extensions of existing copyrights were short, a mere one to two years.
6802 In
1976, Congress extended all existing copyrights by nineteen years.
6803 And in
1998, in the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Congress
6804 extended the term of existing and future copyrights by twenty years.
6807 The effect of these extensions is simply to toll, or delay, the passing
6808 of works into the public domain. This latest extension means that the
6809 public domain will have been tolled for thirty-nine out of fifty-five
6810 years, or
70 percent of the time since
1962. Thus, in the twenty years
6812 <!-- PAGE BREAK 146 -->
6813 after the Sonny Bono Act, while one million patents will pass into the
6814 public domain, zero copyrights will pass into the public domain by virtue
6815 of the expiration of a copyright term.
6818 The effect of these extensions has been exacerbated by another,
6819 little-noticed change in the copyright law. Remember I said that the
6820 framers established a two-part copyright regime, requiring a copyright
6821 owner to renew his copyright after an initial term. The requirement of
6822 renewal meant that works that no longer needed copyright protection
6823 would pass more quickly into the public domain. The works remaining
6824 under protection would be those that had some continuing commercial
6828 The United States abandoned this sensible system in
1976. For
6829 all works created after
1978, there was only one copyright term
—the
6830 maximum term. For
<quote>natural
</quote> authors, that term was life plus fifty
6831 years. For corporations, the term was seventy-five years. Then, in
1992,
6832 Congress abandoned the renewal requirement for all works created
6833 before
1978. All works still under copyright would be accorded the
6834 maximum term then available. After the Sonny Bono Act, that term
6835 was ninety-five years.
6838 This change meant that American law no longer had an automatic way to
6839 assure that works that were no longer exploited passed into the public
6840 domain. And indeed, after these changes, it is unclear whether it is
6841 even possible to put works into the public domain. The public domain
6842 is orphaned by these changes in copyright law. Despite the requirement
6843 that terms be
<quote>limited,
</quote> we have no evidence that anything will limit
6847 The effect of these changes on the average duration of copyright is
6848 dramatic. In
1973, more than
85 percent of copyright owners failed to
6849 renew their copyright. That meant that the average term of copyright
6850 in
1973 was just
32.2 years. Because of the elimination of the renewal
6851 requirement, the average term of copyright is now the maximum term.
6852 In thirty years, then, the average term has tripled, from
32.2 years to
95
6853 years.
<footnote><para>
6855 These statistics are understated. Between the years
1910 and
1962 (the
6856 first year the renewal term was extended), the average term was never
6857 more than thirty-two years, and averaged thirty years. See Landes and
6858 Posner,
<quote>Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,
</quote> loc. cit.
6861 <!-- PAGE BREAK 147 -->
6863 <section id=
"lawscope">
6864 <title>Law: Scope
</title>
6866 The
<quote>scope
</quote> of a copyright is the range of rights granted by the law.
6867 The scope of American copyright has changed dramatically. Those
6868 changes are not necessarily bad. But we should understand the extent
6869 of the changes if we're to keep this debate in context.
6872 In
1790, that scope was very narrow. Copyright covered only
<quote>maps,
6873 charts, and books.
</quote> That means it didn't cover, for example, music or
6874 architecture. More significantly, the right granted by a copyright gave
6875 the author the exclusive right to
<quote>publish
</quote> copyrighted works. That
6876 means someone else violated the copyright only if he republished the
6877 work without the copyright owner's permission. Finally, the right granted
6878 by a copyright was an exclusive right to that particular book. The right
6879 did not extend to what lawyers call
<quote>derivative works.
</quote> It would not,
6880 therefore, interfere with the right of someone other than the author to
6881 translate a copyrighted book, or to adapt the story to a different form
6882 (such as a drama based on a published book).
6885 This, too, has changed dramatically. While the contours of copyright
6886 today are extremely hard to describe simply, in general terms, the
6887 right covers practically any creative work that is reduced to a
6888 tangible form. It covers music as well as architecture, drama as well
6889 as computer programs. It gives the copyright owner of that creative
6890 work not only the exclusive right to
<quote>publish
</quote> the work, but also the
6891 exclusive right of control over any
<quote>copies
</quote> of that work. And most
6892 significant for our purposes here, the right gives the copyright owner
6893 control over not only his or her particular work, but also any
6894 <quote>derivative work
</quote> that might grow out of the original work. In this
6895 way, the right covers more creative work, protects the creative work
6896 more broadly, and protects works that are based in a significant way
6897 on the initial creative work.
6900 At the same time that the scope of copyright has expanded, procedural
6901 limitations on the right have been relaxed. I've already described the
6902 complete removal of the renewal requirement in
1992. In addition
6903 <!-- PAGE BREAK 148 -->
6904 to the renewal requirement, for most of the history of American
6905 copyright law, there was a requirement that a work be registered
6906 before it could receive the protection of a copyright. There was also
6907 a requirement that any copyrighted work be marked either with that
6908 famous
© or the word
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>. And for most
6909 of the history of American copyright law, there was a requirement that
6910 works be deposited with the government before a copyright could be
6914 The reason for the registration requirement was the sensible
6915 understanding that for most works, no copyright was required. Again,
6916 in the first ten years of the Republic,
95 percent of works eligible
6917 for copyright were never copyrighted. Thus, the rule reflected the
6918 norm: Most works apparently didn't need copyright, so registration
6919 narrowed the regulation of the law to the few that did. The same
6920 reasoning justified the requirement that a work be marked as
6921 copyrighted
—that way it was easy to know whether a copyright was
6922 being claimed. The requirement that works be deposited was to assure
6923 that after the copyright expired, there would be a copy of the work
6924 somewhere so that it could be copied by others without locating the
6928 All of these
<quote>formalities
</quote> were abolished in the American system when
6929 we decided to follow European copyright law. There is no requirement
6930 that you register a work to get a copyright; the copyright now is
6931 automatic; the copyright exists whether or not you mark your work with
6932 a
©; and the copyright exists whether or not you actually make a
6933 copy available for others to copy.
6936 Consider a practical example to understand the scope of these
6940 If, in
1790, you wrote a book and you were one of the
5 percent who
6941 actually copyrighted that book, then the copyright law protected you
6942 against another publisher's taking your book and republishing it
6943 without your permission. The aim of the act was to regulate publishers
6944 so as to prevent that kind of unfair competition. In
1790, there were
6945 174 publishers in the United States.
<footnote><para>
6947 See Thomas Bender and David Sampliner,
<quote>Poets, Pirates, and the
6948 Creation of American Literature,
</quote> 29 <citetitle>New York University Journal of
6949 International Law and Politics
</citetitle> 255 (
1997), and James Gilraeth, ed.,
6950 Federal Copyright Records,
1790–1800 (U.S. G.P.O.,
1987).
6953 The Copyright Act was thus a tiny
6954 regulation of a tiny proportion of a tiny part of the creative market in
6955 the United States
—publishers.
6958 <!-- PAGE BREAK 149 -->
6959 The act left other creators totally unregulated. If I copied your poem
6960 by hand, over and over again, as a way to learn it by heart, my act
6961 was totally unregulated by the
1790 act. If I took your novel and made
6962 a play based upon it, or if I translated it or abridged it, none of
6963 those activities were regulated by the original copyright act. These
6964 creative activities remained free, while the activities of publishers
6968 Today the story is very different: If you write a book, your book is
6969 automatically protected. Indeed, not just your book. Every e-mail,
6970 every note to your spouse, every doodle,
<emphasis>every
</emphasis>
6971 creative act that's reduced to a tangible form
—all of this is
6972 automatically copyrighted. There is no need to register or mark your
6973 work. The protection follows the creation, not the steps you take to
6977 That protection gives you the right (subject to a narrow range of
6978 fair use exceptions) to control how others copy the work, whether they
6979 copy it to republish it or to share an excerpt.
6982 That much is the obvious part. Any system of copyright would
6984 competing publishing. But there's a second part to the copyright of
6985 today that is not at all obvious. This is the protection of
<quote>derivative
6986 rights.
</quote> If you write a book, no one can make a movie out of your
6987 book without permission. No one can translate it without permission.
6988 CliffsNotes can't make an abridgment unless permission is granted. All
6989 of these derivative uses of your original work are controlled by the
6990 copyright holder. The copyright, in other words, is now not just an
6992 right to your writings, but an exclusive right to your writings
6993 and a large proportion of the writings inspired by them.
6996 It is this derivative right that would seem most bizarre to our
6997 framers, though it has become second nature to us. Initially, this
6999 was created to deal with obvious evasions of a narrower
7001 If I write a book, can you change one word and then claim a
7002 copyright in a new and different book? Obviously that would make a
7003 joke of the copyright, so the law was properly expanded to include
7004 those slight modifications as well as the verbatim original work.
7007 <!-- PAGE BREAK 150 -->
7008 In preventing that joke, the law created an astonishing power
7009 within a free culture
—at least, it's astonishing when you
7010 understand that the law applies not just to the commercial publisher
7011 but to anyone with a computer. I understand the wrong in duplicating
7012 and selling someone else's work. But whatever
7013 <emphasis>that
</emphasis> wrong is, transforming someone else's work
7014 is a different wrong. Some view transformation as no wrong at
7015 all
—they believe that our law, as the framers penned it, should
7016 not protect derivative rights at all.
<footnote><para>
7018 Jonathan Zittrain,
<quote>The Copyright Cage,
</quote> <citetitle>Legal
7019 Affairs
</citetitle>, July/August
2003, available at
7020 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
26</ulink>.
7021 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
7023 Whether or not you go that far, it seems
7024 plain that whatever wrong is involved is fundamentally different from
7025 the wrong of direct piracy.
7028 Yet copyright law treats these two different wrongs in the same way. I
7029 can go to court and get an injunction against your pirating my book. I
7030 can go to court and get an injunction against your transformative use
7031 of my book.
<footnote><para>
7033 Professor Rubenfeld has presented a powerful constitutional argument
7034 about the difference that copyright law should draw (from the
7035 perspective of the First Amendment) between mere
<quote>copies
</quote> and
7036 derivative works. See Jed Rubenfeld,
<quote>The Freedom of Imagination:
7037 Copyright's Constitutionality,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law
7038 Journal
</citetitle> 112 (
2002):
1–60 (see especially
7040 <indexterm><primary>Rubenfeld, Jeb
</primary></indexterm>
7042 These two different uses of my creative work are treated the same.
7045 This again may seem right to you. If I wrote a book, then why should
7046 you be able to write a movie that takes my story and makes money from
7047 it without paying me or crediting me? Or if Disney creates a creature
7048 called
<quote>Mickey Mouse,
</quote> why should you be able to make Mickey Mouse
7049 toys and be the one to trade on the value that Disney originally
7053 These are good arguments, and, in general, my point is not that the
7054 derivative right is unjustified. My aim just now is much narrower:
7055 simply to make clear that this expansion is a significant change from
7056 the rights originally granted.
7059 <section id=
"lawreach">
7060 <title>Law and Architecture: Reach
</title>
7062 Whereas originally the law regulated only publishers, the change in
7063 copyright's scope means that the law today regulates publishers, users,
7064 and authors. It regulates them because all three are capable of making
7065 copies, and the core of the regulation of copyright law is copies.
<footnote><para>
7067 This is a simplification of the law, but not much of one. The law
7068 certainly regulates more than
<quote>copies
</quote>—a public performance of a
7069 copyrighted song, for example, is regulated even though performance
7070 per se doesn't make a copy;
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
7071 106(
4). And it certainly sometimes doesn't regulate a
<quote>copy
</quote>;
17
7072 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
112(a). But the presumption under the
7073 existing law (which regulates
<quote>copies;
</quote> 17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
7074 102) is that if there is a copy, there is a right.
7078 <!-- PAGE BREAK 151 -->
7079 <quote>Copies.
</quote> That certainly sounds like the obvious thing for
7080 <emphasis>copy
</emphasis>right law to regulate. But as with Jack
7081 Valenti's argument at the start of this chapter, that
<quote>creative
7082 property
</quote> deserves the
<quote>same rights
</quote> as all other property, it is the
7083 <emphasis>obvious
</emphasis> that we need to be most careful
7084 about. For while it may be obvious that in the world before the
7085 Internet, copies were the obvious trigger for copyright law, upon
7086 reflection, it should be obvious that in the world with the Internet,
7087 copies should
<emphasis>not
</emphasis> be the trigger for copyright
7088 law. More precisely, they should not
<emphasis>always
</emphasis> be
7089 the trigger for copyright law.
7092 This is perhaps the central claim of this book, so let me take this
7093 very slowly so that the point is not easily missed. My claim is that the
7094 Internet should at least force us to rethink the conditions under which
7095 the law of copyright automatically applies,
<footnote><para>
7097 Thus, my argument is not that in each place that copyright law
7098 extends, we should repeal it. It is instead that we should have a good
7099 argument for its extending where it does, and should not determine its
7100 reach on the basis of arbitrary and automatic changes caused by
7103 because it is clear that the
7104 current reach of copyright was never contemplated, much less chosen,
7105 by the legislators who enacted copyright law.
7108 We can see this point abstractly by beginning with this largely
7111 <figure id=
"fig-1521">
7112 <title>All potential uses of a book.
</title>
7113 <graphic fileref=
"images/1521.png"></graphic>
7116 <!-- PAGE BREAK 152 -->
7117 Think about a book in real space, and imagine this circle to represent
7118 all its potential
<emphasis>uses
</emphasis>. Most of these uses are
7119 unregulated by copyright law, because the uses don't create a copy. If
7120 you read a book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you
7121 give someone the book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If
7122 you resell a book, that act is not regulated (copyright law expressly
7123 states that after the first sale of a book, the copyright owner can
7124 impose no further conditions on the disposition of the book). If you
7125 sleep on the book or use it to hold up a lamp or let your puppy chew
7126 it up, those acts are not regulated by copyright law, because those
7127 acts do not make a copy.
7129 <figure id=
"fig-1531">
7130 <title>Examples of unregulated uses of a book.
</title>
7131 <graphic fileref=
"images/1531.png"></graphic>
7134 Obviously, however, some uses of a copyrighted book are regulated
7135 by copyright law. Republishing the book, for example, makes a copy. It
7136 is therefore regulated by copyright law. Indeed, this particular use stands
7137 at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work. It is the
7138 paradigmatic use properly regulated by copyright regulation (see first
7139 diagram on next page).
7142 Finally, there is a tiny sliver of otherwise regulated copying uses
7143 that remain unregulated because the law considers these
<quote>fair uses.
</quote>
7145 <!-- PAGE BREAK 153 -->
7146 <figure id=
"fig-1541">
7147 <title>Republishing stands at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work.
</title>
7148 <graphic fileref=
"images/1541.png"></graphic>
7151 These are uses that themselves involve copying, but which the law
7152 treats as unregulated because public policy demands that they remain
7153 unregulated. You are free to quote from this book, even in a review
7154 that is quite negative, without my permission, even though that
7155 quoting makes a copy. That copy would ordinarily give the copyright
7156 owner the exclusive right to say whether the copy is allowed or not,
7157 but the law denies the owner any exclusive right over such
<quote>fair uses
</quote>
7158 for public policy (and possibly First Amendment) reasons.
7160 <figure id=
"fig-1542">
7161 <title>Unregulated copying considered
<quote>fair uses.
</quote></title>
7162 <graphic fileref=
"images/1542.png"></graphic>
7165 <figure id=
"fig-1551">
7166 <title>Uses that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively regulated.
</title>
7167 <graphic fileref=
"images/1551.png"></graphic>
7170 <!-- PAGE BREAK 154 -->
7171 In real space, then, the possible uses of a book are divided into three
7172 sorts: (
1) unregulated uses, (
2) regulated uses, and (
3) regulated uses that
7173 are nonetheless deemed
<quote>fair
</quote> regardless of the copyright owner's views.
7176 <primary>books
</primary>
7177 <secondary>on Internet
</secondary>
7180 Enter the Internet
—a distributed, digital network where every use
7181 of a copyrighted work produces a copy.
<footnote><para>
7183 I don't mean
<quote>nature
</quote> in the sense that it couldn't be different, but
7184 rather that its present instantiation entails a copy. Optical networks
7185 need not make copies of content they transmit, and a digital network
7186 could be designed to delete anything it copies so that the same number
7189 And because of this single, arbitrary feature of the design of a
7190 digital network, the scope of category
1 changes dramatically. Uses
7191 that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively
7192 regulated. No longer is there a set of presumptively unregulated uses
7193 that define a freedom associated with a copyrighted work. Instead,
7194 each use is now subject to the copyright, because each use also makes
7195 a copy
—category
1 gets sucked into category
2. And those who
7196 would defend the unregulated uses of copyrighted work must look
7197 exclusively to category
3, fair uses, to bear the burden of this
7201 So let's be very specific to make this general point clear. Before the
7202 Internet, if you purchased a book and read it ten times, there would
7203 be no plausible
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>-related argument that
7204 the copyright owner could make to control that use of her
7205 book. Copyright law would have nothing to say about whether you read
7206 the book once, ten times, or every
7207 <!-- PAGE BREAK 155 -->
7208 night before you went to bed. None of those instances of
7209 use
—reading
— could be regulated by copyright law because
7210 none of those uses produced a copy.
7213 <primary>books
</primary>
7214 <secondary>on Internet
</secondary>
7217 But the same book as an e-book is effectively governed by a different
7218 set of rules. Now if the copyright owner says you may read the book
7219 only once or only once a month, then
<emphasis>copyright
7220 law
</emphasis> would aid the copyright owner in exercising this degree
7221 of control, because of the accidental feature of copyright law that
7222 triggers its application upon there being a copy. Now if you read the
7223 book ten times and the license says you may read it only five times,
7224 then whenever you read the book (or any portion of it) beyond the
7225 fifth time, you are making a copy of the book contrary to the
7226 copyright owner's wish.
7229 There are some people who think this makes perfect sense. My aim
7230 just now is not to argue about whether it makes sense or not. My aim
7231 is only to make clear the change. Once you see this point, a few other
7232 points also become clear:
7235 First, making category
1 disappear is not anything any policy maker
7236 ever intended. Congress did not think through the collapse of the
7237 presumptively unregulated uses of copyrighted works. There is no
7238 evidence at all that policy makers had this idea in mind when they
7239 allowed our policy here to shift. Unregulated uses were an important
7240 part of free culture before the Internet.
7243 Second, this shift is especially troubling in the context of
7244 transformative uses of creative content. Again, we can all understand
7245 the wrong in commercial piracy. But the law now purports to regulate
7246 <emphasis>any
</emphasis> transformation you make of creative work
7247 using a machine.
<quote>Copy and paste
</quote> and
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> become
7248 crimes. Tinkering with a story and releasing it to others exposes the
7249 tinkerer to at least a requirement of justification. However
7250 troubling the expansion with respect to copying a particular work, it
7251 is extraordinarily troubling with respect to transformative uses of
7255 Third, this shift from category
1 to category
2 puts an extraordinary
7257 <!-- PAGE BREAK 156 -->
7258 burden on category
3 (
<quote>fair use
</quote>) that fair use never before had to
7259 bear. If a copyright owner now tried to control how many times I
7260 could read a book on-line, the natural response would be to argue that
7261 this is a violation of my fair use rights. But there has never been
7262 any litigation about whether I have a fair use right to read, because
7263 before the Internet, reading did not trigger the application of
7264 copyright law and hence the need for a fair use defense. The right to
7265 read was effectively protected before because reading was not
7269 This point about fair use is totally ignored, even by advocates for
7270 free culture. We have been cornered into arguing that our rights
7271 depend upon fair use
—never even addressing the earlier question
7272 about the expansion in effective regulation. A thin protection
7273 grounded in fair use makes sense when the vast majority of uses are
7274 <emphasis>unregulated
</emphasis>. But when everything becomes
7275 presumptively regulated, then the protections of fair use are not
7278 <indexterm id='idxadvertising2' class='startofrange'
>
7279 <primary>advertising
</primary>
7282 The case of Video Pipeline is a good example. Video Pipeline was
7283 in the business of making
<quote>trailer
</quote> advertisements for movies available
7284 to video stores. The video stores displayed the trailers as a way to sell
7285 videos. Video Pipeline got the trailers from the film distributors, put
7286 the trailers on tape, and sold the tapes to the retail stores.
7289 The company did this for about fifteen years. Then, in
1997, it began
7290 to think about the Internet as another way to distribute these
7291 previews. The idea was to expand their
<quote>selling by sampling
</quote>
7292 technique by giving on-line stores the same ability to enable
7293 <quote>browsing.
</quote> Just as in a bookstore you can read a few pages of a book
7294 before you buy the book, so, too, you would be able to sample a bit
7295 from the movie on-line before you bought it.
7298 In
1998, Video Pipeline informed Disney and other film distributors
7299 that it intended to distribute the trailers through the Internet
7300 (rather than sending the tapes) to distributors of their videos. Two
7301 years later, Disney told Video Pipeline to stop. The owner of Video
7302 <!-- PAGE BREAK 157 -->
7303 Pipeline asked Disney to talk about the matter
—he had built a
7304 business on distributing this content as a way to help sell Disney
7305 films; he had customers who depended upon his delivering this
7306 content. Disney would agree to talk only if Video Pipeline stopped the
7307 distribution immediately. Video Pipeline thought it was within their
7308 <quote>fair use
</quote> rights to distribute the clips as they had. So they filed a
7309 lawsuit to ask the court to declare that these rights were in fact
7313 Disney countersued
—for $
100 million in damages. Those damages
7314 were predicated upon a claim that Video Pipeline had
<quote>willfully
7315 infringed
</quote> on Disney's copyright. When a court makes a finding of
7316 willful infringement, it can award damages not on the basis of the
7317 actual harm to the copyright owner, but on the basis of an amount set
7318 in the statute. Because Video Pipeline had distributed seven hundred
7319 clips of Disney movies to enable video stores to sell copies of those
7320 movies, Disney was now suing Video Pipeline for $
100 million.
7323 Disney has the right to control its property, of course. But the video
7324 stores that were selling Disney's films also had some sort of right to be
7325 able to sell the films that they had bought from Disney. Disney's claim
7326 in court was that the stores were allowed to sell the films and they were
7327 permitted to list the titles of the films they were selling, but they were
7328 not allowed to show clips of the films as a way of selling them without
7329 Disney's permission.
7331 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising2' class='endofrange'
/>
7333 Now, you might think this is a close case, and I think the courts
7334 would consider it a close case. My point here is to map the change
7335 that gives Disney this power. Before the Internet, Disney couldn't
7336 really control how people got access to their content. Once a video
7337 was in the marketplace, the
<quote>first-sale doctrine
</quote> would free the
7338 seller to use the video as he wished, including showing portions of it
7339 in order to engender sales of the entire movie video. But with the
7340 Internet, it becomes possible for Disney to centralize control over
7341 access to this content. Because each use of the Internet produces a
7342 copy, use on the Internet becomes subject to the copyright owner's
7343 control. The technology expands the scope of effective control,
7344 because the technology builds a copy into every transaction.
7346 <indexterm><primary>Barnes
& Noble
</primary></indexterm>
7348 <!-- PAGE BREAK 158 -->
7349 No doubt, a potential is not yet an abuse, and so the potential for
7350 control is not yet the abuse of control. Barnes
& Noble has the
7351 right to say you can't touch a book in their store; property law gives
7352 them that right. But the market effectively protects against that
7353 abuse. If Barnes
& Noble banned browsing, then consumers would
7354 choose other bookstores. Competition protects against the
7355 extremes. And it may well be (my argument so far does not even
7356 question this) that competition would prevent any similar danger when
7357 it comes to copyright. Sure, publishers exercising the rights that
7358 authors have assigned to them might try to regulate how many times you
7359 read a book, or try to stop you from sharing the book with anyone. But
7360 in a competitive market such as the book market, the dangers of this
7361 happening are quite slight.
7364 Again, my aim so far is simply to map the changes that this changed
7365 architecture enables. Enabling technology to enforce the control of
7366 copyright means that the control of copyright is no longer defined by
7367 balanced policy. The control of copyright is simply what private
7368 owners choose. In some contexts, at least, that fact is harmless. But
7369 in some contexts it is a recipe for disaster.
7372 <section id=
"lawforce">
7373 <title>Architecture and Law: Force
</title>
7375 The disappearance of unregulated uses would be change enough, but a
7376 second important change brought about by the Internet magnifies its
7377 significance. This second change does not affect the reach of copyright
7378 regulation; it affects how such regulation is enforced.
7381 In the world before digital technology, it was generally the law that
7382 controlled whether and how someone was regulated by copyright law.
7383 The law, meaning a court, meaning a judge: In the end, it was a human,
7384 trained in the tradition of the law and cognizant of the balances that
7385 tradition embraced, who said whether and how the law would restrict
7388 <indexterm><primary>Casablanca
</primary></indexterm>
7389 <indexterm id=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7390 <primary>Marx Brothers
</primary>
7392 <indexterm id=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7393 <primary>Warner Brothers
</primary>
7396 There's a famous story about a battle between the Marx Brothers
7397 and Warner Brothers. The Marxes intended to make a parody of
7398 <!-- PAGE BREAK 159 -->
7399 <citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>. Warner Brothers objected. They
7400 wrote a nasty letter to the Marxes, warning them that there would be
7401 serious legal consequences if they went forward with their
7402 plan.
<footnote><para>
7404 See David Lange,
<quote>Recognizing the Public Domain,
</quote> <citetitle>Law and
7405 Contemporary Problems
</citetitle> 44 (
1981):
172–73.
7409 This led the Marx Brothers to respond in kind. They warned
7410 Warner Brothers that the Marx Brothers
<quote>were brothers long before
7411 you were.
</quote><footnote><para>
7413 Ibid. See also Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and
7414 Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
1–3.
7415 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
7417 The Marx Brothers therefore owned the word
7418 <citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>, and if Warner Brothers insisted on
7419 trying to control
<citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>, then the Marx
7420 Brothers would insist on control over
<citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>.
7423 An absurd and hollow threat, of course, because Warner Brothers,
7424 like the Marx Brothers, knew that no court would ever enforce such a
7425 silly claim. This extremism was irrelevant to the real freedoms anyone
7426 (including Warner Brothers) enjoyed.
7428 <indexterm id='idxbooksoninternet' class='startofrange'
>
7429 <primary>books
</primary>
7430 <secondary>on Internet
</secondary>
7433 On the Internet, however, there is no check on silly rules, because on
7434 the Internet, increasingly, rules are enforced not by a human but by a
7435 machine: Increasingly, the rules of copyright law, as interpreted by
7436 the copyright owner, get built into the technology that delivers
7437 copyrighted content. It is code, rather than law, that rules. And the
7438 problem with code regulations is that, unlike law, code has no
7439 shame. Code would not get the humor of the Marx Brothers. The
7440 consequence of that is not at all funny.
7442 <indexterm startref=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7443 <indexterm startref=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7445 <indexterm id=
"idxadobeebookreader" class='startofrange'
>
7446 <primary>Adobe eBook Reader
</primary>
7449 Consider the life of my Adobe eBook Reader.
7452 An e-book is a book delivered in electronic form. An Adobe eBook is
7453 not a book that Adobe has published; Adobe simply produces the
7454 software that publishers use to deliver e-books. It provides the
7455 technology, and the publisher delivers the content by using the
7459 On the next page is a picture of an old version of my Adobe eBook
7463 As you can see, I have a small collection of e-books within this
7464 e-book library. Some of these books reproduce content that is in the
7465 public domain:
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, for example, is in
7466 the public domain. Some of them reproduce content that is not in the
7467 public domain: My own book
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>
7468 is not yet within the public domain. Consider
7469 <citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> first. If you click on my e-book
7471 <!-- PAGE BREAK 160 -->
7472 <citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, you'll see a fancy cover, and then
7473 a button at the bottom called Permissions.
7475 <figure id=
"fig-1611">
7476 <title>Picture of an old version of Adobe eBook Reader
</title>
7477 <graphic fileref=
"images/1611.png"></graphic>
7480 If you click on the Permissions button, you'll see a list of the
7481 permissions that the publisher purports to grant with this book.
7483 <figure id=
"fig-1612">
7484 <title>List of the permissions that the publisher purports to grant.
</title>
7485 <graphic fileref=
"images/1612.png"></graphic>
7488 <!-- PAGE BREAK 161 -->
7489 According to my eBook Reader, I have the permission to copy to the
7490 clipboard of the computer ten text selections every ten days. (So far,
7491 I've copied no text to the clipboard.) I also have the permission to
7492 print ten pages from the book every ten days. Lastly, I have the
7493 permission to use the Read Aloud button to hear
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>
7494 read aloud through the computer.
7497 Here's the e-book for another work in the public domain (including the
7498 translation): Aristotle's
<citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>.
7499 <indexterm><primary>Aristotle
</primary></indexterm>
7500 <indexterm><primary><citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>, (Aristotle)
</primary></indexterm>
7502 <figure id=
"fig-1621">
7503 <title>E-book of Aristotle;s
<quote>Politics
</quote></title>
7504 <graphic fileref=
"images/1621.png"></graphic>
7507 According to its permissions, no printing or copying is permitted
7508 at all. But fortunately, you can use the Read Aloud button to hear
7511 <figure id=
"fig-1622">
7512 <title>List of the permissions for Aristotle;s
<quote>Politics
</quote>.
</title>
7513 <graphic fileref=
"images/1622.png"></graphic>
7516 Finally (and most embarrassingly), here are the permissions for the
7517 original e-book version of my last book,
<citetitle>The Future of
7520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 162 -->
7521 <figure id=
"fig-1631">
7522 <title>List of the permissions for
<quote>The Future of Ideas
</quote>.
</title>
7523 <graphic fileref=
"images/1631.png"></graphic>
7526 No copying, no printing, and don't you dare try to listen to this book!
7529 Now, the Adobe eBook Reader calls these controls
7530 <quote>permissions
</quote>— as if the publisher has the power to control how
7531 you use these works. For works under copyright, the copyright owner
7532 certainly does have the power
—up to the limits of the copyright
7533 law. But for work not under copyright, there is no such copyright
7534 power.
<footnote><para>
7536 In principle, a contract might impose a requirement on me. I might,
7537 for example, buy a book from you that includes a contract that says I
7538 will read it only three times, or that I promise to read it three
7539 times. But that obligation (and the limits for creating that
7540 obligation) would come from the contract, not from copyright law, and
7541 the obligations of contract would not necessarily pass to anyone who
7542 subsequently acquired the book.
7544 When my e-book of
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> says I have the
7545 permission to copy only ten text selections into the memory every ten
7546 days, what that really means is that the eBook Reader has enabled the
7547 publisher to control how I use the book on my computer, far beyond the
7548 control that the law would enable.
7551 The control comes instead from the code
—from the technology
7552 within which the e-book
<quote>lives.
</quote> Though the e-book says that these are
7553 permissions, they are not the sort of
<quote>permissions
</quote> that most of us
7554 deal with. When a teenager gets
<quote>permission
</quote> to stay out till
7555 midnight, she knows (unless she's Cinderella) that she can stay out
7556 till
2 A.M., but will suffer a punishment if she's caught. But when
7557 the Adobe eBook Reader says I have the permission to make ten copies
7558 of the text into the computer's memory, that means that after I've
7559 made ten copies, the computer will not make any more. The same with
7560 the printing restrictions: After ten pages, the eBook Reader will not
7561 print any more pages. It's the same with the silly restriction that
7562 says that you can't use the Read Aloud button to read my book
7563 aloud
—it's not that the company will sue you if you do; instead,
7564 if you push the Read Aloud button with my book, the machine simply
7568 <!-- PAGE BREAK 163 -->
7569 These are
<emphasis>controls
</emphasis>, not permissions. Imagine a
7570 world where the Marx Brothers sold word processing software that, when
7571 you tried to type
<quote>Warner Brothers,
</quote> erased
<quote>Brothers
</quote> from the
7573 <indexterm><primary>Marx Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
7576 This is the future of copyright law: not so much copyright
7577 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> as copyright
<emphasis>code
</emphasis>. The
7578 controls over access to content will not be controls that are ratified
7579 by courts; the controls over access to content will be controls that
7580 are coded by programmers. And whereas the controls that are built into
7581 the law are always to be checked by a judge, the controls that are
7582 built into the technology have no similar built-in check.
7585 How significant is this? Isn't it always possible to get around the
7586 controls built into the technology? Software used to be sold with
7587 technologies that limited the ability of users to copy the software,
7588 but those were trivial protections to defeat. Why won't it be trivial
7589 to defeat these protections as well?
7592 We've only scratched the surface of this story. Return to the Adobe
7596 Early in the life of the Adobe eBook Reader, Adobe suffered a public
7597 relations nightmare. Among the books that you could download for free
7598 on the Adobe site was a copy of
<citetitle>Alice's Adventures in
7599 Wonderland
</citetitle>. This wonderful book is in the public
7600 domain. Yet when you clicked on Permissions for that book, you got the
7602 <indexterm><primary>Alice's Adventures in Wonderland (Carroll)
</primary></indexterm>
7604 <figure id=
"fig-1641">
7605 <title>List of the permissions for
<quote>Alice's Adventures in
7606 Wonderland
</quote>.
</title>
7607 <graphic fileref=
"images/1641.png"></graphic>
7609 <beginpage pagenum=
"164"/>
7611 Here was a public domain children's book that you were not allowed to
7612 copy, not allowed to lend, not allowed to give, and, as the
7613 <quote>permissions
</quote> indicated, not allowed to
<quote>read aloud
</quote>!
7616 The public relations nightmare attached to that final permission.
7617 For the text did not say that you were not permitted to use the Read
7618 Aloud button; it said you did not have the permission to read the book
7619 aloud. That led some people to think that Adobe was restricting the
7620 right of parents, for example, to read the book to their children, which
7621 seemed, to say the least, absurd.
7624 Adobe responded quickly that it was absurd to think that it was trying
7625 to restrict the right to read a book aloud. Obviously it was only
7626 restricting the ability to use the Read Aloud button to have the book
7627 read aloud. But the question Adobe never did answer is this: Would
7628 Adobe thus agree that a consumer was free to use software to hack
7629 around the restrictions built into the eBook Reader? If some company
7630 (call it Elcomsoft) developed a program to disable the technological
7631 protection built into an Adobe eBook so that a blind person, say,
7632 could use a computer to read the book aloud, would Adobe agree that
7633 such a use of an eBook Reader was fair? Adobe didn't answer because
7634 the answer, however absurd it might seem, is no.
7637 The point is not to blame Adobe. Indeed, Adobe is among the most
7638 innovative companies developing strategies to balance open access to
7639 content with incentives for companies to innovate. But Adobe's
7640 technology enables control, and Adobe has an incentive to defend this
7641 control. That incentive is understandable, yet what it creates is
7644 <indexterm startref=
"idxadobeebookreader" class='endofrange'
/>
7645 <indexterm startref='idxbooksoninternet' class='endofrange'
/>
7647 To see the point in a particularly absurd context, consider a favorite
7648 story of mine that makes the same point.
7650 <indexterm id=
"idxaibo1" class='startofrange'
>
7651 <primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary>
7653 <indexterm id=
"idxroboticdog1" class='startofrange'
>
7654 <primary>robotic dog
</primary>
7656 <indexterm id=
"idxsonyaibo1" class='startofrange'
>
7657 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7658 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7661 Consider the robotic dog made by Sony named
<quote>Aibo.
</quote> The Aibo
7662 learns tricks, cuddles, and follows you around. It eats only electricity
7663 and that doesn't leave that much of a mess (at least in your house).
7666 The Aibo is expensive and popular. Fans from around the world
7667 have set up clubs to trade stories. One fan in particular set up a Web
7668 site to enable information about the Aibo dog to be shared. This fan set
7669 <beginpage pagenum=
"165"/>
7670 up aibopet.com (and aibohack.com, but that resolves to the same site),
7671 and on that site he provided information about how to teach an Aibo
7672 to do tricks in addition to the ones Sony had taught it.
7675 <quote>Teach
</quote> here has a special meaning. Aibos are just cute computers.
7676 You teach a computer how to do something by programming it
7677 differently. So to say that aibopet.com was giving information about
7678 how to teach the dog to do new tricks is just to say that aibopet.com
7679 was giving information to users of the Aibo pet about how to hack
7680 their computer
<quote>dog
</quote> to make it do new tricks (thus, aibohack.com).
7682 <indexterm><primary>hacks
</primary></indexterm>
7684 If you're not a programmer or don't know many programmers, the word
7685 <citetitle>hack
</citetitle> has a particularly unfriendly
7686 connotation. Nonprogrammers hack bushes or weeds. Nonprogrammers in
7687 horror movies do even worse. But to programmers, or coders, as I call
7688 them,
<citetitle>hack
</citetitle> is a much more positive
7689 term.
<citetitle>Hack
</citetitle> just means code that enables the
7690 program to do something it wasn't originally intended or enabled to
7691 do. If you buy a new printer for an old computer, you might find the
7692 old computer doesn't run, or
<quote>drive,
</quote> the printer. If you discovered
7693 that, you'd later be happy to discover a hack on the Net by someone
7694 who has written a driver to enable the computer to drive the printer
7698 Some hacks are easy. Some are unbelievably hard. Hackers as a
7699 community like to challenge themselves and others with increasingly
7700 difficult tasks. There's a certain respect that goes with the talent to hack
7701 well. There's a well-deserved respect that goes with the talent to hack
7705 The Aibo fan was displaying a bit of both when he hacked the program
7706 and offered to the world a bit of code that would enable the Aibo to
7707 dance jazz. The dog wasn't programmed to dance jazz. It was a clever
7708 bit of tinkering that turned the dog into a more talented creature
7709 than Sony had built.
7711 <indexterm startref=
"idxsonyaibo1" class='endofrange'
/>
7712 <indexterm startref=
"idxroboticdog1" class='endofrange'
/>
7713 <indexterm startref=
"idxaibo1" class='endofrange'
/>
7715 I've told this story in many contexts, both inside and outside the
7716 United States. Once I was asked by a puzzled member of the audience,
7717 is it permissible for a dog to dance jazz in the United States? We
7718 forget that stories about the backcountry still flow across much of
7721 <!-- PAGE BREAK 166 -->
7722 world. So let's just be clear before we continue: It's not a crime
7723 anywhere (anymore) to dance jazz. Nor is it a crime to teach your dog
7724 to dance jazz. Nor should it be a crime (though we don't have a lot to
7725 go on here) to teach your robot dog to dance jazz. Dancing jazz is a
7726 completely legal activity. One imagines that the owner of aibopet.com
7727 thought,
<emphasis>What possible problem could there be with teaching
7728 a robot dog to dance?
</emphasis>
7731 Let's put the dog to sleep for a minute, and turn to a pony show
—
7732 not literally a pony show, but rather a paper that a Princeton academic
7733 named Ed Felten prepared for a conference. This Princeton academic
7734 is well known and respected. He was hired by the government in the
7735 Microsoft case to test Microsoft's claims about what could and could
7736 not be done with its own code. In that trial, he demonstrated both his
7737 brilliance and his coolness. Under heavy badgering by Microsoft
7738 lawyers, Ed Felten stood his ground. He was not about to be bullied
7739 into being silent about something he knew very well.
7742 But Felten's bravery was really tested in April
2001.
<footnote><para>
7744 See Pamela Samuelson,
<quote>Anticircumvention Rules: Threat to Science,
</quote>
7745 <citetitle>Science
</citetitle> 293 (
2001):
2028; Brendan I. Koerner,
<quote>Play Dead: Sony Muzzles
7746 the Techies Who Teach a Robot Dog New Tricks,
</quote> <citetitle>American Prospect
</citetitle>,
7747 January
2002;
<quote>Court Dismisses Computer Scientists' Challenge to
7748 DMCA,
</quote> <citetitle>Intellectual Property Litigation Reporter
</citetitle>,
11 December
2001; Bill
7749 Holland,
<quote>Copyright Act Raising Free-Speech Concerns,
</quote> <citetitle>Billboard
</citetitle>,
7750 May
2001; Janelle Brown,
<quote>Is the RIAA Running Scared?
</quote> Salon.com,
7751 April
2001; Electronic Frontier Foundation,
<quote>Frequently Asked
7752 Questions about
<citetitle>Felten and USENIX
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> Legal Case,
</quote> available at
7753 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
27</ulink>.
7754 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
7756 He and a group of colleagues were working on a paper to be submitted
7757 at conference. The paper was intended to describe the weakness in an
7758 encryption system being developed by the Secure Digital Music
7759 Initiative as a technique to control the distribution of music.
7762 The SDMI coalition had as its goal a technology to enable content
7763 owners to exercise much better control over their content than the
7764 Internet, as it originally stood, granted them. Using encryption, SDMI
7765 hoped to develop a standard that would allow the content owner to say
7766 <quote>this music cannot be copied,
</quote> and have a computer respect that
7767 command. The technology was to be part of a
<quote>trusted system
</quote> of
7768 control that would get content owners to trust the system of the
7772 When SDMI thought it was close to a standard, it set up a competition.
7773 In exchange for providing contestants with the code to an
7774 SDMI-encrypted bit of content, contestants were to try to crack it
7775 and, if they did, report the problems to the consortium.
7778 <!-- PAGE BREAK 167 -->
7779 Felten and his team figured out the encryption system quickly. He and
7780 the team saw the weakness of this system as a type: Many encryption
7781 systems would suffer the same weakness, and Felten and his team
7782 thought it worthwhile to point this out to those who study encryption.
7785 Let's review just what Felten was doing. Again, this is the United
7786 States. We have a principle of free speech. We have this principle not
7787 just because it is the law, but also because it is a really great
7788 idea. A strongly protected tradition of free speech is likely to
7789 encourage a wide range of criticism. That criticism is likely, in
7790 turn, to improve the systems or people or ideas criticized.
7793 What Felten and his colleagues were doing was publishing a paper
7794 describing the weakness in a technology. They were not spreading free
7795 music, or building and deploying this technology. The paper was an
7796 academic essay, unintelligible to most people. But it clearly showed the
7797 weakness in the SDMI system, and why SDMI would not, as presently
7798 constituted, succeed.
7800 <indexterm id=
"idxaibo2" class='startofrange'
>
7801 <primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary>
7803 <indexterm id=
"idxroboticdog2" class='startofrange'
>
7804 <primary>robotic dog
</primary>
7806 <indexterm id=
"idxsonyaibo2" class='startofrange'
>
7807 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7808 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7811 What links these two, aibopet.com and Felten, is the letters they
7812 then received. Aibopet.com received a letter from Sony about the
7813 aibopet.com hack. Though a jazz-dancing dog is perfectly legal, Sony
7818 Your site contains information providing the means to circumvent
7819 AIBO-ware's copy protection protocol constituting a violation of the
7820 anti-circumvention provisions of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act.
7823 <indexterm startref=
"idxsonyaibo2" class='endofrange'
/>
7824 <indexterm startref=
"idxroboticdog2" class='endofrange'
/>
7825 <indexterm startref=
"idxaibo2" class='endofrange'
/>
7827 And though an academic paper describing the weakness in a system
7828 of encryption should also be perfectly legal, Felten received a letter
7829 from an RIAA lawyer that read:
7833 Any disclosure of information gained from participating in the
7834 <!-- PAGE BREAK 168 -->
7835 Public Challenge would be outside the scope of activities permitted by
7836 the Agreement and could subject you and your research team to actions
7837 under the Digital Millennium Copyright Act (
<quote>DMCA
</quote>).
7841 In both cases, this weirdly Orwellian law was invoked to control the
7842 spread of information. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act made
7843 spreading such information an offense.
7846 The DMCA was enacted as a response to copyright owners' first fear
7847 about cyberspace. The fear was that copyright control was effectively
7848 dead; the response was to find technologies that might compensate.
7849 These new technologies would be copyright protection
7850 technologies
— technologies to control the replication and
7851 distribution of copyrighted material. They were designed as
7852 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> to modify the original
7853 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> of the Internet, to reestablish some
7854 protection for copyright owners.
7857 The DMCA was a bit of law intended to back up the protection of this
7858 code designed to protect copyrighted material. It was, we could say,
7859 <emphasis>legal code
</emphasis> intended to buttress
7860 <emphasis>software code
</emphasis> which itself was intended to
7861 support the
<emphasis>legal code of copyright
</emphasis>.
7864 But the DMCA was not designed merely to protect copyrighted works to
7865 the extent copyright law protected them. Its protection, that is, did
7866 not end at the line that copyright law drew. The DMCA regulated
7867 devices that were designed to circumvent copyright protection
7868 measures. It was designed to ban those devices, whether or not the use
7869 of the copyrighted material made possible by that circumvention would
7870 have been a copyright violation.
7872 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7873 <indexterm><primary>robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7875 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7876 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7879 Aibopet.com and Felten make the point. The Aibo hack circumvented a
7880 copyright protection system for the purpose of enabling the dog to
7881 dance jazz. That enablement no doubt involved the use of copyrighted
7882 material. But as aibopet.com's site was noncommercial, and the use did
7883 not enable subsequent copyright infringements, there's no doubt that
7884 aibopet.com's hack was fair use of Sony's copyrighted material. Yet
7885 fair use is not a defense to the DMCA. The question is not whether the
7886 <!-- PAGE BREAK 169 -->
7887 use of the copyrighted material was a copyright violation. The question
7888 is whether a copyright protection system was circumvented.
7891 The threat against Felten was more attenuated, but it followed the
7892 same line of reasoning. By publishing a paper describing how a
7893 copyright protection system could be circumvented, the RIAA lawyer
7894 suggested, Felten himself was distributing a circumvention technology.
7895 Thus, even though he was not himself infringing anyone's copyright,
7896 his academic paper was enabling others to infringe others' copyright.
7898 <indexterm><primary>Rogers, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
7900 The bizarreness of these arguments is captured in a cartoon drawn in
7901 1981 by Paul Conrad. At that time, a court in California had held that
7902 the VCR could be banned because it was a copyright-infringing
7903 technology: It enabled consumers to copy films without the permission
7904 of the copyright owner. No doubt there were uses of the technology
7905 that were legal: Fred Rogers, aka
<quote><citetitle>Mr. Rogers
</citetitle>,
</quote>
7906 for example, had testified in that case that he wanted people to feel
7907 free to tape Mr. Rogers' Neighborhood.
7908 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7912 Some public stations, as well as commercial stations, program the
7913 <quote>Neighborhood
</quote> at hours when some children cannot use it. I think that
7914 it's a real service to families to be able to record such programs and
7915 show them at appropriate times. I have always felt that with the
7916 advent of all of this new technology that allows people to tape the
7917 <quote>Neighborhood
</quote> off-the-air, and I'm speaking for the
<quote>Neighborhood
</quote>
7918 because that's what I produce, that they then become much more active
7919 in the programming of their family's television life. Very frankly, I
7920 am opposed to people being programmed by others. My whole approach in
7921 broadcasting has always been
<quote>You are an important person just the way
7922 you are. You can make healthy decisions.
</quote> Maybe I'm going on too long,
7923 but I just feel that anything that allows a person to be more active
7924 in the control of his or her life, in a healthy way, is
7925 important.
<footnote><para>
7927 <citetitle>Sony Corporation of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
7928 455 fn.
27 (
1984). Rogers never changed his view about the VCR. See
7929 James Lardner,
<citetitle>Fast Forward: Hollywood, the Japanese, and the Onslaught of
7930 the VCR
</citetitle> (New York: W. W. Norton,
1987),
270–71.
7931 <indexterm><primary>Rogers, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
7936 <!-- PAGE BREAK 170 -->
7937 Even though there were uses that were legal, because there were
7938 some uses that were illegal, the court held the companies producing
7939 the VCR responsible.
7942 This led Conrad to draw the cartoon below, which we can adopt to
7944 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7947 No argument I have can top this picture, but let me try to get close.
7950 The anticircumvention provisions of the DMCA target copyright
7951 circumvention technologies. Circumvention technologies can be used for
7952 different ends. They can be used, for example, to enable massive
7953 pirating of copyrighted material
—a bad end. Or they can be used
7954 to enable the use of particular copyrighted materials in ways that
7955 would be considered fair use
—a good end.
7957 <indexterm id='idxhandguns' class='startofrange'
>
7958 <primary>handguns
</primary>
7961 A handgun can be used to shoot a police officer or a child. Most
7962 <!-- PAGE BREAK 171 -->
7963 would agree such a use is bad. Or a handgun can be used for target
7964 practice or to protect against an intruder. At least some would say that
7965 such a use would be good. It, too, is a technology that has both good
7968 <figure id=
"fig-1711">
7969 <title>VCR/handgun cartoon.
</title>
7970 <graphic fileref=
"images/1711.png"></graphic>
7972 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7974 The obvious point of Conrad's cartoon is the weirdness of a world
7975 where guns are legal, despite the harm they can do, while VCRs (and
7976 circumvention technologies) are illegal. Flash:
<emphasis>No one ever
7977 died from copyright circumvention
</emphasis>. Yet the law bans circumvention
7978 technologies absolutely, despite the potential that they might do some
7979 good, but permits guns, despite the obvious and tragic harm they do.
7981 <indexterm startref='idxhandguns' class='endofrange'
/>
7982 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7983 <indexterm><primary>robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7985 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7986 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7989 The Aibo and RIAA examples demonstrate how copyright owners are
7990 changing the balance that copyright law grants. Using code, copyright
7991 owners restrict fair use; using the DMCA, they punish those who would
7992 attempt to evade the restrictions on fair use that they impose through
7993 code. Technology becomes a means by which fair use can be erased; the
7994 law of the DMCA backs up that erasing.
7997 This is how
<emphasis>code
</emphasis> becomes
7998 <emphasis>law
</emphasis>. The controls built into the technology of
7999 copy and access protection become rules the violation of which is also
8000 a violation of the law. In this way, the code extends the
8001 law
—increasing its regulation, even if the subject it regulates
8002 (activities that would otherwise plainly constitute fair use) is
8003 beyond the reach of the law. Code becomes law; code extends the law;
8004 code thus extends the control that copyright owners effect
—at
8005 least for those copyright holders with the lawyers who can write the
8006 nasty letters that Felten and aibopet.com received.
8009 There is one final aspect of the interaction between architecture and
8010 law that contributes to the force of copyright's regulation. This is
8011 the ease with which infringements of the law can be detected. For
8012 contrary to the rhetoric common at the birth of cyberspace that on the
8013 Internet, no one knows you're a dog, increasingly, given changing
8014 technologies deployed on the Internet, it is easy to find the dog who
8015 committed a legal wrong. The technologies of the Internet are open to
8016 snoops as well as sharers, and the snoops are increasingly good at
8017 tracking down the identity of those who violate the rules.
8021 <!-- PAGE BREAK 172 -->
8022 For example, imagine you were part of a
<citetitle>Star Trek
</citetitle> fan club. You
8023 gathered every month to share trivia, and maybe to enact a kind of fan
8024 fiction about the show. One person would play Spock, another, Captain
8025 Kirk. The characters would begin with a plot from a real story, then
8026 simply continue it.
<footnote><para>
8028 For an early and prescient analysis, see Rebecca Tushnet,
<quote>Legal Fictions,
8029 Copyright, Fan Fiction, and a New Common Law,
</quote> <citetitle>Loyola of Los Angeles
8030 Entertainment Law Journal
</citetitle> 17 (
1997):
651.
8034 Before the Internet, this was, in effect, a totally unregulated
8035 activity. No matter what happened inside your club room, you would
8036 never be interfered with by the copyright police. You were free in
8037 that space to do as you wished with this part of our culture. You were
8038 allowed to build on it as you wished without fear of legal control.
8041 But if you moved your club onto the Internet, and made it generally
8042 available for others to join, the story would be very different. Bots
8043 scouring the Net for trademark and copyright infringement would
8044 quickly find your site. Your posting of fan fiction, depending upon
8045 the ownership of the series that you're depicting, could well inspire
8046 a lawyer's threat. And ignoring the lawyer's threat would be extremely
8047 costly indeed. The law of copyright is extremely efficient. The
8048 penalties are severe, and the process is quick.
8051 This change in the effective force of the law is caused by a change
8052 in the ease with which the law can be enforced. That change too shifts
8053 the law's balance radically. It is as if your car transmitted the speed at
8054 which you traveled at every moment that you drove; that would be just
8055 one step before the state started issuing tickets based upon the data you
8056 transmitted. That is, in effect, what is happening here.
8059 <section id=
"marketconcentration">
8060 <title>Market: Concentration
</title>
8062 So copyright's duration has increased dramatically
—tripled in
8063 the past thirty years. And copyright's scope has increased as
8064 well
—from regulating only publishers to now regulating just
8065 about everyone. And copyright's reach has changed, as every action
8066 becomes a copy and hence presumptively regulated. And as technologists
8068 <!-- PAGE BREAK 173 -->
8069 to control the use of content, and as copyright is increasingly
8070 enforced through technology, copyright's force changes, too. Misuse is
8071 easier to find and easier to control. This regulation of the creative
8072 process, which began as a tiny regulation governing a tiny part of the
8073 market for creative work, has become the single most important
8074 regulator of creativity there is. It is a massive expansion in the
8075 scope of the government's control over innovation and creativity; it
8076 would be totally unrecognizable to those who gave birth to copyright's
8080 Still, in my view, all of these changes would not matter much if it
8081 weren't for one more change that we must also consider. This is a
8082 change that is in some sense the most familiar, though its significance
8083 and scope are not well understood. It is the one that creates precisely the
8084 reason to be concerned about all the other changes I have described.
8087 This is the change in the concentration and integration of the media.
8088 In the past twenty years, the nature of media ownership has undergone
8089 a radical alteration, caused by changes in legal rules governing the
8090 media. Before this change happened, the different forms of media were
8091 owned by separate media companies. Now, the media is increasingly
8092 owned by only a few companies. Indeed, after the changes that the FCC
8093 announced in June
2003, most expect that within a few years, we will
8094 live in a world where just three companies control more than percent
8098 These changes are of two sorts: the scope of concentration, and its
8102 Changes in scope are the easier ones to describe. As Senator John
8103 McCain summarized the data produced in the FCC's review of media
8104 ownership,
<quote>five companies control
85 percent of our media sources.
</quote><footnote><para>
8106 FCC Oversight: Hearing Before the Senate Commerce, Science and
8107 Transportation Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
22 May
2003)
8108 (statement of Senator John McCain).
</para></footnote>
8109 The five recording labels of Universal Music Group, BMG, Sony Music
8110 Entertainment, Warner Music Group, and EMI control
84.8 percent of the
8111 U.S. music market.
<footnote><para>
8113 Lynette Holloway,
<quote>Despite a Marketing Blitz, CD Sales Continue to
8114 Slide,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
23 December
2002.
8116 The
<quote>five largest cable companies pipe
8117 programming to
74 percent of the cable subscribers nationwide.
</quote><footnote><para>
8119 Molly Ivins,
<quote>Media Consolidation Must Be Stopped,
</quote> <citetitle>Charleston Gazette
</citetitle>,
8122 <indexterm><primary>BMG
</primary></indexterm>
8123 <indexterm><primary>EMI
</primary></indexterm>
8124 <indexterm><primary>McCain, John
</primary></indexterm>
8125 <indexterm><primary>Universal Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
8126 <indexterm><primary>Warner Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
8129 The story with radio is even more dramatic. Before deregulation,
8130 the nation's largest radio broadcasting conglomerate owned fewer than
8131 <!-- PAGE BREAK 174 -->
8132 seventy-five stations. Today
<emphasis>one
</emphasis> company owns
8133 more than
1,
200 stations. During that period of consolidation, the
8134 total number of radio owners dropped by
34 percent. Today, in most
8135 markets, the two largest broadcasters control
74 percent of that
8136 market's revenues. Overall, just four companies control
90 percent of
8137 the nation's radio advertising revenues.
8140 Newspaper ownership is becoming more concentrated as well. Today,
8141 there are six hundred fewer daily newspapers in the United States than
8142 there were eighty years ago, and ten companies control half of the
8143 nation's circulation. There are twenty major newspaper publishers in
8144 the United States. The top ten film studios receive
99 percent of all
8145 film revenue. The ten largest cable companies account for
85 percent
8146 of all cable revenue. This is a market far from the free press the
8147 framers sought to protect. Indeed, it is a market that is quite well
8148 protected
— by the market.
8151 Concentration in size alone is one thing. The more invidious
8152 change is in the nature of that concentration. As author James Fallows
8153 put it in a recent article about Rupert Murdoch,
8154 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
8158 Murdoch's companies now constitute a production system
8159 unmatched in its integration. They supply content
—Fox movies
8160 … Fox TV shows
… Fox-controlled sports broadcasts, plus
8161 newspapers and books. They sell the content to the public and to
8162 advertisers
—in newspapers, on the broadcast network, on the
8163 cable channels. And they operate the physical distribution system
8164 through which the content reaches the customers. Murdoch's satellite
8165 systems now distribute News Corp. content in Europe and Asia; if
8166 Murdoch becomes DirecTV's largest single owner, that system will serve
8167 the same function in the United States.
<footnote><para>
8169 James Fallows,
<quote>The Age of Murdoch,
</quote> <citetitle>Atlantic Monthly
</citetitle> (September
8171 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
8176 The pattern with Murdoch is the pattern of modern media. Not
8177 just large companies owning many radio stations, but a few companies
8178 owning as many outlets of media as possible. A picture describes this
8179 pattern better than a thousand words could do:
8181 <figure id=
"fig-1761">
8182 <title>Pattern of modern media ownership.
</title>
8183 <graphic fileref=
"images/1761.png"></graphic>
8186 <!-- PAGE BREAK 175 -->
8187 Does this concentration matter? Will it affect what is made, or
8188 what is distributed? Or is it merely a more efficient way to produce and
8192 My view was that concentration wouldn't matter. I thought it was
8193 nothing more than a more efficient financial structure. But now, after
8194 reading and listening to a barrage of creators try to convince me to the
8195 contrary, I am beginning to change my mind.
8198 Here's a representative story that begins to suggest how this
8199 integration may matter.
8201 <indexterm><primary>Lear, Norman
</primary></indexterm>
8202 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
8203 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
8205 In
1969, Norman Lear created a pilot for
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle>. He took
8206 the pilot to ABC. The network didn't like it. It was too edgy, they told
8207 Lear. Make it again. Lear made a second pilot, more edgy than the
8208 first. ABC was exasperated. You're missing the point, they told Lear.
8209 We wanted less edgy, not more.
8212 Rather than comply, Lear simply took the show elsewhere. CBS
8213 was happy to have the series; ABC could not stop Lear from walking.
8214 The copyrights that Lear held assured an independence from network
8215 control.
<footnote><para>
8217 Leonard Hill,
<quote>The Axis of Access,
</quote> remarks before Weidenbaum Center
8218 Forum,
<quote>Entertainment Economics: The Movie Industry,
</quote> St. Louis,
8219 Missouri,
3 April
2003 (transcript of prepared remarks available at
8220 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
28</ulink>;
8221 for the Lear story, not included in the prepared remarks, see
8222 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
29</ulink>).
8227 <!-- PAGE BREAK 176 -->
8228 The network did not control those copyrights because the law forbade
8229 the networks from controlling the content they syndicated. The law
8230 required a separation between the networks and the content producers;
8231 that separation would guarantee Lear freedom. And as late as
1992,
8232 because of these rules, the vast majority of prime time
8233 television
—75 percent of it
—was
<quote>independent
</quote> of the
8237 In
1994, the FCC abandoned the rules that required this independence.
8238 After that change, the networks quickly changed the balance. In
1985,
8239 there were twenty-five independent television production studios; in
8240 2002, only five independent television studios remained.
<quote>In
1992,
8241 only
15 percent of new series were produced for a network by a company
8242 it controlled. Last year, the percentage of shows produced by
8243 controlled companies more than quintupled to
77 percent.
</quote> <quote>In
1992,
16
8244 new series were produced independently of conglomerate control, last
8245 year there was one.
</quote><footnote><para>
8247 NewsCorp./DirecTV Merger and Media Consolidation: Hearings on Media
8248 Ownership Before the Senate Commerce Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st
8249 sess. (
2003) (testimony of Gene Kimmelman on behalf of Consumers Union
8250 and the Consumer Federation of America), available at
8251 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
30</ulink>. Kimmelman
8252 quotes Victoria Riskin, president of Writers Guild of America, West,
8253 in her Remarks at FCC En Banc Hearing, Richmond, Virginia,
27 February
8256 In
2002,
75 percent of prime time television was owned by the networks
8257 that ran it.
<quote>In the ten-year period between
1992 and
2002, the number
8258 of prime time television hours per week produced by network studios
8259 increased over
200%, whereas the number of prime time television hours
8260 per week produced by independent studios decreased
8261 63%.
</quote><footnote><para>
8266 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
8268 Today, another Norman Lear with another
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle> would
8269 find that he had the choice either to make the show less edgy or to be
8270 fired: The content of any show developed for a network is increasingly
8271 owned by the network.
8274 While the number of channels has increased dramatically, the ownership
8275 of those channels has narrowed to an ever smaller and smaller few. As
8276 Barry Diller said to Bill Moyers,
8277 <indexterm><primary>Diller, Barry
</primary></indexterm>
8278 <indexterm><primary>Moyers, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
8282 Well, if you have companies that produce, that finance, that air on
8283 their channel and then distribute worldwide everything that goes
8284 through their controlled distribution system, then what you get is
8285 fewer and fewer actual voices participating in the process. [We
8286 <!-- PAGE BREAK 177 -->
8287 u]sed to have dozens and dozens of thriving independent production
8288 companies producing television programs. Now you have less than a
8289 handful.
<footnote><para>
8291 <quote>Barry Diller Takes on Media Deregulation,
</quote> <citetitle>Now with Bill Moyers
</citetitle>, Bill
8292 Moyers,
25 April
2003, edited transcript available at
8293 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
31</ulink>.
8298 This narrowing has an effect on what is produced. The product of such
8299 large and concentrated networks is increasingly homogenous.
8300 Increasingly safe. Increasingly sterile. The product of news shows
8301 from networks like this is increasingly tailored to the message the
8302 network wants to convey. This is not the communist party, though from
8303 the inside, it must feel a bit like the communist party. No one can
8304 question without risk of consequence
—not necessarily banishment
8305 to Siberia, but punishment nonetheless. Independent, critical,
8306 different views are quashed. This is not the environment for a
8309 <indexterm><primary>Clark, Kim B.
</primary></indexterm>
8311 Economics itself offers a parallel that explains why this integration
8312 affects creativity. Clay Christensen has written about the
<quote>Innovator's
8313 Dilemma
</quote>: the fact that large traditional firms find it rational to ignore
8314 new, breakthrough technologies that compete with their core business.
8315 The same analysis could help explain why large, traditional media
8316 companies would find it rational to ignore new cultural trends.
<footnote><para>
8318 Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The
8319 Revolutionary National Bestseller that Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle>
8320 (Cambridge: Harvard Business School Press,
1997). Christensen
8321 acknowledges that the idea was first suggested by Dean Kim Clark. See
8322 Kim B. Clark,
<quote>The Interaction of Design Hierarchies and Market
8323 Concepts in Technological Evolution,
</quote> <citetitle>Research Policy
</citetitle> 14 (
1985):
8324 235–51. For a more recent study, see Richard Foster and Sarah
8325 Kaplan,
<citetitle>Creative Destruction: Why Companies That Are Built to Last
8326 Underperform the Market
—and How to Successfully Transform Them
</citetitle>
8327 (New York: Currency/Doubleday,
2001).
</para></footnote>
8329 Lumbering giants not only don't, but should not, sprint. Yet if the
8330 field is only open to the giants, there will be far too little
8332 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
8335 I don't think we know enough about the economics of the media
8336 market to say with certainty what concentration and integration will
8337 do. The efficiencies are important, and the effect on culture is hard to
8341 But there is a quintessentially obvious example that does strongly
8342 suggest the concern.
8345 In addition to the copyright wars, we're in the middle of the drug
8346 wars. Government policy is strongly directed against the drug cartels;
8347 criminal and civil courts are filled with the consequences of this battle.
8350 Let me hereby disqualify myself from any possible appointment to
8351 any position in government by saying I believe this war is a profound
8352 mistake. I am not pro drugs. Indeed, I come from a family once
8354 <!-- PAGE BREAK 178 -->
8355 wrecked by drugs
—though the drugs that wrecked my family were
8356 all quite legal. I believe this war is a profound mistake because the
8357 collateral damage from it is so great as to make waging the war
8358 insane. When you add together the burdens on the criminal justice
8359 system, the desperation of generations of kids whose only real
8360 economic opportunities are as drug warriors, the queering of
8361 constitutional protections because of the constant surveillance this
8362 war requires, and, most profoundly, the total destruction of the legal
8363 systems of many South American nations because of the power of the
8364 local drug cartels, I find it impossible to believe that the marginal
8365 benefit in reduced drug consumption by Americans could possibly
8366 outweigh these costs.
8369 You may not be convinced. That's fine. We live in a democracy, and it
8370 is through votes that we are to choose policy. But to do that, we
8371 depend fundamentally upon the press to help inform Americans about
8374 <indexterm id='idxadvertising3' class='startofrange'
>
8375 <primary>advertising
</primary>
8378 Beginning in
1998, the Office of National Drug Control Policy launched
8379 a media campaign as part of the
<quote>war on drugs.
</quote> The campaign produced
8380 scores of short film clips about issues related to illegal drugs. In
8381 one series (the Nick and Norm series) two men are in a bar, discussing
8382 the idea of legalizing drugs as a way to avoid some of the collateral
8383 damage from the war. One advances an argument in favor of drug
8384 legalization. The other responds in a powerful and effective way
8385 against the argument of the first. In the end, the first guy changes
8386 his mind (hey, it's television). The plug at the end is a damning
8387 attack on the pro-legalization campaign.
8390 Fair enough. It's a good ad. Not terribly misleading. It delivers its
8391 message well. It's a fair and reasonable message.
8394 But let's say you think it is a wrong message, and you'd like to run a
8395 countercommercial. Say you want to run a series of ads that try to
8396 demonstrate the extraordinary collateral harm that comes from the drug
8400 Well, obviously, these ads cost lots of money. Assume you raise the
8401 <!-- PAGE BREAK 179 -->
8402 money. Assume a group of concerned citizens donates all the money in
8403 the world to help you get your message out. Can you be sure your
8404 message will be heard then?
8407 No. You cannot. Television stations have a general policy of avoiding
8408 <quote>controversial
</quote> ads. Ads sponsored by the government are deemed
8409 uncontroversial; ads disagreeing with the government are
8410 controversial. This selectivity might be thought inconsistent with
8411 the First Amendment, but the Supreme Court has held that stations have
8412 the right to choose what they run. Thus, the major channels of
8413 commercial media will refuse one side of a crucial debate the
8414 opportunity to present its case. And the courts will defend the
8415 rights of the stations to be this biased.
<footnote><para>
8417 The Marijuana Policy Project, in February
2003, sought to place ads
8418 that directly responded to the Nick and Norm series on stations within
8419 the Washington, D.C., area. Comcast rejected the ads as
<quote>against
8420 [their] policy.
</quote> The local NBC affiliate, WRC, rejected the ads
8421 without reviewing them. The local ABC affiliate, WJOA, originally
8422 agreed to run the ads and accepted payment to do so, but later decided
8423 not to run the ads and returned the collected fees. Interview with
8424 Neal Levine,
15 October
2003. These restrictions are, of course, not
8425 limited to drug policy. See, for example, Nat Ives,
<quote>On the Issue of
8426 an Iraq War, Advocacy Ads Meet with Rejection from TV Networks,
</quote> <citetitle>New
8427 York Times
</citetitle>,
13 March
2003, C4. Outside of election-related air time
8428 there is very little that the FCC or the courts are willing to do to
8429 even the playing field. For a general overview, see Rhonda Brown,
<quote>Ad
8430 Hoc Access: The Regulation of Editorial Advertising on Television and
8431 Radio,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law and Policy Review
</citetitle> 6 (
1988):
449–79, and for a
8432 more recent summary of the stance of the FCC and the courts, see
8433 <citetitle>Radio-Television News Directors Association
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>FCC
</citetitle>,
184 F.
3d
872
8434 (D.C. Cir.
1999). Municipal authorities exercise the same authority as
8435 the networks. In a recent example from San Francisco, the San
8436 Francisco transit authority rejected an ad that criticized its Muni
8437 diesel buses. Phillip Matier and Andrew Ross,
<quote>Antidiesel Group Fuming
8438 After Muni Rejects Ad,
</quote> SFGate.com,
16 June
2003, available at
8439 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
32</ulink>. The ground
8440 was that the criticism was
<quote>too controversial.
</quote>
8441 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
8442 <indexterm><primary>Comcast
</primary></indexterm>
8443 <indexterm><primary>Marijuana Policy Project
</primary></indexterm>
8444 <indexterm><primary>NBC
</primary></indexterm>
8445 <indexterm><primary>WJOA
</primary></indexterm>
8446 <indexterm><primary>WRC
</primary></indexterm>
8447 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
8451 I'd be happy to defend the networks' rights, as well
—if we lived
8452 in a media market that was truly diverse. But concentration in the
8453 media throws that condition into doubt. If a handful of companies
8454 control access to the media, and that handful of companies gets to
8455 decide which political positions it will allow to be promoted on its
8456 channels, then in an obvious and important way, concentration
8457 matters. You might like the positions the handful of companies
8458 selects. But you should not like a world in which a mere few get to
8459 decide which issues the rest of us get to know about.
8461 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising3' class='endofrange'
/>
8463 <section id=
"together">
8464 <title>Together
</title>
8466 There is something innocent and obvious about the claim of the
8467 copyright warriors that the government should
<quote>protect my property.
</quote>
8468 In the abstract, it is obviously true and, ordinarily, totally
8469 harmless. No sane sort who is not an anarchist could disagree.
8472 But when we see how dramatically this
<quote>property
</quote> has changed
—
8473 when we recognize how it might now interact with both technology and
8474 markets to mean that the effective constraint on the liberty to
8475 cultivate our culture is dramatically different
—the claim begins
8478 <!-- PAGE BREAK 180 -->
8479 less innocent and obvious. Given (
1) the power of technology to
8480 supplement the law's control, and (
2) the power of concentrated
8481 markets to weaken the opportunity for dissent, if strictly enforcing
8482 the massively expanded
<quote>property
</quote> rights granted by copyright
8483 fundamentally changes the freedom within this culture to cultivate and
8484 build upon our past, then we have to ask whether this property should
8488 Not starkly. Or absolutely. My point is not that we should abolish
8489 copyright or go back to the eighteenth century. That would be a total
8490 mistake, disastrous for the most important creative enterprises within
8494 But there is a space between zero and one, Internet culture
8495 notwithstanding. And these massive shifts in the effective power of
8496 copyright regulation, tied to increased concentration of the content
8497 industry and resting in the hands of technology that will increasingly
8498 enable control over the use of culture, should drive us to consider
8499 whether another adjustment is called for. Not an adjustment that
8500 increases copyright's power. Not an adjustment that increases its
8501 term. Rather, an adjustment to restore the balance that has
8502 traditionally defined copyright's regulation
—a weakening of that
8503 regulation, to strengthen creativity.
8506 Copyright law has not been a rock of Gibraltar. It's not a set of
8507 constant commitments that, for some mysterious reason, teenagers and
8508 geeks now flout. Instead, copyright power has grown dramatically in a
8509 short period of time, as the technologies of distribution and creation
8510 have changed and as lobbyists have pushed for more control by
8511 copyright holders. Changes in the past in response to changes in
8512 technology suggest that we may well need similar changes in the
8513 future. And these changes have to be
<emphasis>reductions
</emphasis>
8514 in the scope of copyright, in response to the extraordinary increase
8515 in control that technology and the market enable.
8518 For the single point that is lost in this war on pirates is a point that
8519 we see only after surveying the range of these changes. When you add
8520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 181 -->
8521 together the effect of changing law, concentrated markets, and
8522 changing technology, together they produce an astonishing conclusion:
8523 <emphasis>Never in our history have fewer had a legal right to control
8524 more of the development of our culture than now
</emphasis>.
8527 Not when copyrights were perpetual, for when copyrights were
8528 perpetual, they affected only that precise creative work. Not when
8529 only publishers had the tools to publish, for the market then was much
8530 more diverse. Not when there were only three television networks, for
8531 even then, newspapers, film studios, radio stations, and publishers
8532 were independent of the networks.
<emphasis>Never
</emphasis> has
8533 copyright protected such a wide range of rights, against as broad a
8534 range of actors, for a term that was remotely as long. This form of
8535 regulation
—a tiny regulation of a tiny part of the creative
8536 energy of a nation at the founding
—is now a massive regulation
8537 of the overall creative process. Law plus technology plus the market
8538 now interact to turn this historically benign regulation into the most
8539 significant regulation of culture that our free society has
8540 known.
<footnote><para>
8542 Siva Vaidhyanathan captures a similar point in his
<quote>four surrenders
</quote> of
8543 copyright law in the digital age. See Vaidhyanathan,
159–60.
8544 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
8548 <emphasis role='strong'
>This has been
</emphasis> a long chapter. Its
8549 point can now be briefly stated.
8552 At the start of this book, I distinguished between commercial and
8553 noncommercial culture. In the course of this chapter, I have
8554 distinguished between copying a work and transforming it. We can now
8555 combine these two distinctions and draw a clear map of the changes
8556 that copyright law has undergone. In
1790, the law looked like this:
8559 <informaltable id=
"t2">
8560 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8564 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8565 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8570 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8571 <entry>©</entry>
8575 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8584 The act of publishing a map, chart, and book was regulated by
8585 copyright law. Nothing else was. Transformations were free. And as
8586 copyright attached only with registration, and only those who intended
8588 <!-- PAGE BREAK 182 -->
8589 to benefit commercially would register, copying through publishing of
8590 noncommercial work was also free.
8593 By the end of the nineteenth century, the law had changed to this:
8596 <informaltable id=
"t3">
8597 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8601 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8602 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8607 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8608 <entry>©</entry>
8609 <entry>©</entry>
8612 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8621 Derivative works were now regulated by copyright law
—if
8622 published, which again, given the economics of publishing at the time,
8623 means if offered commercially. But noncommercial publishing and
8624 transformation were still essentially free.
8627 In
1909 the law changed to regulate copies, not publishing, and after
8628 this change, the scope of the law was tied to technology. As the
8629 technology of copying became more prevalent, the reach of the law
8630 expanded. Thus by
1975, as photocopying machines became more common,
8631 we could say the law began to look like this:
8634 <informaltable id=
"t4">
8635 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8640 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8645 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8646 <entry>©</entry>
8647 <entry>©</entry>
8650 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8651 <entry>©/Free
</entry>
8659 The law was interpreted to reach noncommercial copying through, say,
8660 copy machines, but still much of copying outside of the commercial
8661 market remained free. But the consequence of the emergence of digital
8662 technologies, especially in the context of a digital network, means
8663 that the law now looks like this:
8666 <informaltable id=
"t5">
8667 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8672 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8677 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8678 <entry>©</entry>
8679 <entry>©</entry>
8682 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8683 <entry>©</entry>
8684 <entry>©</entry>
8691 Every realm is governed by copyright law, whereas before most
8692 creativity was not. The law now regulates the full range of
8694 <!-- PAGE BREAK 183 -->
8695 commercial or not, transformative or not
—with the same rules
8696 designed to regulate commercial publishers.
8699 Obviously, copyright law is not the enemy. The enemy is regulation
8700 that does no good. So the question that we should be asking just now
8701 is whether extending the regulations of copyright law into each of
8702 these domains actually does any good.
8705 I have no doubt that it does good in regulating commercial copying.
8706 But I also have no doubt that it does more harm than good when
8707 regulating (as it regulates just now) noncommercial copying and,
8708 especially, noncommercial transformation. And increasingly, for the
8709 reasons sketched especially in chapters
8710 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"recorders"/> and
8711 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"transformers"/>, one
8712 might well wonder whether it does more harm than good for commercial
8713 transformation. More commercial transformative work would be created
8714 if derivative rights were more sharply restricted.
8717 The issue is therefore not simply whether copyright is property. Of
8718 course copyright is a kind of
<quote>property,
</quote> and of course, as with any
8719 property, the state ought to protect it. But first impressions
8720 notwithstanding, historically, this property right (as with all
8721 property rights
<footnote><para>
8723 It was the single most important contribution of the legal realist
8724 movement to demonstrate that all property rights are always crafted to
8725 balance public and private interests. See Thomas C. Grey,
<quote>The
8726 Disintegration of Property,
</quote> in
<citetitle>Nomos XXII: Property
</citetitle>, J. Roland
8727 Pennock and John W. Chapman, eds. (New York: New York University
8729 <indexterm><primary>legal realist movement
</primary></indexterm>
8731 has been crafted to balance the important need to give authors and
8732 artists incentives with the equally important need to assure access to
8733 creative work. This balance has always been struck in light of new
8734 technologies. And for almost half of our tradition, the
<quote>copyright
</quote>
8735 did not control
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis> the freedom of others to
8736 build upon or transform a creative work. American culture was born
8737 free, and for almost
180 years our country consistently protected a
8738 vibrant and rich free culture.
8740 <indexterm><primary>archives, digital
</primary></indexterm>
8742 We achieved that free culture because our law respected important
8743 limits on the scope of the interests protected by
<quote>property.
</quote> The very
8744 birth of
<quote>copyright
</quote> as a statutory right recognized those limits, by
8745 granting copyright owners protection for a limited time only (the
8746 story of chapter
6). The tradition of
<quote>fair use
</quote> is animated by a
8747 similar concern that is increasingly under strain as the costs of
8748 exercising any fair use right become unavoidably high (the story of
8750 <!-- PAGE BREAK 184 -->
8751 statutory rights where markets might stifle innovation is another
8752 familiar limit on the property right that copyright is (chapter
8753 8). And granting archives and libraries a broad freedom to collect,
8754 claims of property notwithstanding, is a crucial part of guaranteeing
8755 the soul of a culture (chapter
9). Free cultures, like free markets,
8756 are built with property. But the nature of the property that builds a
8757 free culture is very different from the extremist vision that
8758 dominates the debate today.
8761 Free culture is increasingly the casualty in this war on piracy. In
8762 response to a real, if not yet quantified, threat that the
8763 technologies of the Internet present to twentieth-century business
8764 models for producing and distributing culture, the law and technology
8765 are being transformed in a way that will undermine our tradition of
8766 free culture. The property right that is copyright is no longer the
8767 balanced right that it was, or was intended to be. The property right
8768 that is copyright has become unbalanced, tilted toward an extreme. The
8769 opportunity to create and transform becomes weakened in a world in
8770 which creation requires permission and creativity must check with a
8773 <!-- PAGE BREAK 185 -->
8777 <part id=
"c-puzzles">
8778 <title>PUZZLES
</title>
8780 <!-- PAGE BREAK 186 -->
8781 <chapter label=
"11" id=
"chimera">
8782 <title>CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
</title>
8783 <indexterm id=
"idxchimera" class='startofrange'
>
8784 <primary>chimeras
</primary>
8786 <indexterm id=
"idxwells" class='startofrange'
>
8787 <primary>Wells, H. G.
</primary>
8789 <indexterm id=
"idxtcotb" class='startofrange'
>
8790 <primary><quote>Country of the Blind, The
</quote> (Wells)
</primary>
8794 <emphasis role='strong'
>In a well-known
</emphasis> short story by
8795 H. G. Wells, a mountain climber named Nunez trips (literally, down an
8796 ice slope) into an unknown and isolated valley in the Peruvian
8797 Andes.
<footnote><para>
8799 H. G. Wells,
<quote>The Country of the Blind
</quote> (
1904,
1911). See H. G. Wells,
8800 <citetitle>The Country of the Blind and Other Stories
</citetitle>, Michael Sherborne, ed. (New
8801 York: Oxford University Press,
1996).
8803 The valley is extraordinarily beautiful, with
<quote>sweet water, pasture,
8804 an even climate, slopes of rich brown soil with tangles of a shrub
8805 that bore an excellent fruit.
</quote> But the villagers are all blind. Nunez
8806 takes this as an opportunity.
<quote>In the Country of the Blind,
</quote> he tells
8807 himself,
<quote>the One-Eyed Man is King.
</quote> So he resolves to live with the
8808 villagers to explore life as a king.
8811 Things don't go quite as he planned. He tries to explain the idea of
8812 sight to the villagers. They don't understand. He tells them they are
8813 <quote>blind.
</quote> They don't have the word
<citetitle>blind
</citetitle>. They think he's just thick.
8814 Indeed, as they increasingly notice the things he can't do (hear the
8815 sound of grass being stepped on, for example), they increasingly try
8816 to control him. He, in turn, becomes increasingly frustrated.
<quote>`You
8817 don't understand,' he cried, in a voice that was meant to be great and
8818 resolute, and which broke. `You are blind and I can see. Leave me
8822 <!-- PAGE BREAK 187 -->
8823 The villagers don't leave him alone. Nor do they see (so to speak) the
8824 virtue of his special power. Not even the ultimate target of his
8825 affection, a young woman who to him seems
<quote>the most beautiful thing in
8826 the whole of creation,
</quote> understands the beauty of sight. Nunez's
8827 description of what he sees
<quote>seemed to her the most poetical of
8828 fancies, and she listened to his description of the stars and the
8829 mountains and her own sweet white-lit beauty as though it was a guilty
8830 indulgence.
</quote> <quote>She did not believe,
</quote> Wells tells us, and
<quote>she could
8831 only half understand, but she was mysteriously delighted.
</quote>
8834 When Nunez announces his desire to marry his
<quote>mysteriously delighted
</quote>
8835 love, the father and the village object.
<quote>You see, my dear,
</quote> her
8836 father instructs,
<quote>he's an idiot. He has delusions. He can't do
8837 anything right.
</quote> They take Nunez to the village doctor.
8840 After a careful examination, the doctor gives his opinion.
<quote>His brain
8841 is affected,
</quote> he reports.
8844 <quote>What affects it?
</quote> the father asks.
<quote>Those queer things that are
8845 called the eyes
… are diseased
… in such a way as to affect
8849 The doctor continues:
<quote>I think I may say with reasonable certainty
8850 that in order to cure him completely, all that we need to do is a
8851 simple and easy surgical operation
—namely, to remove these
8852 irritant bodies [the eyes].
</quote>
8855 <quote>Thank Heaven for science!
</quote> says the father to the doctor. They inform
8856 Nunez of this condition necessary for him to be allowed his bride.
8857 (You'll have to read the original to learn what happens in the end. I
8858 believe in free culture, but never in giving away the end of a story.)
8861 <emphasis role='strong'
>It sometimes
</emphasis> happens that the eggs
8862 of twins fuse in the mother's womb. That fusion produces a
8863 <quote>chimera.
</quote> A chimera is a single creature with two sets
8864 of DNA. The DNA in the blood, for example, might be different from the
8865 DNA of the skin. This possibility is an underused
8867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 188 -->
8868 plot for murder mysteries.
<quote>But the DNA shows with
100 percent
8869 certainty that she was not the person whose blood was at the
8870 scene.
…</quote>
8872 <indexterm startref=
"idxtcotb" class='endofrange'
/>
8873 <indexterm startref=
"idxwells" class=
"endofrange"/>
8875 Before I had read about chimeras, I would have said they were
8876 impossible. A single person can't have two sets of DNA. The very idea
8877 of DNA is that it is the code of an individual. Yet in fact, not only
8878 can two individuals have the same set of DNA (identical twins), but
8879 one person can have two different sets of DNA (a chimera). Our
8880 understanding of a
<quote>person
</quote> should reflect this reality.
8883 The more I work to understand the current struggle over copyright and
8884 culture, which I've sometimes called unfairly, and sometimes not
8885 unfairly enough,
<quote>the copyright wars,
</quote> the more I think we're dealing
8886 with a chimera. For example, in the battle over the question
<quote>What is
8887 p2p file sharing?
</quote> both sides have it right, and both sides have it
8888 wrong. One side says,
<quote>File sharing is just like two kids taping each
8889 others' records
—the sort of thing we've been doing for the last
8890 thirty years without any question at all.
</quote> That's true, at least in
8891 part. When I tell my best friend to try out a new CD that I've bought,
8892 but rather than just send the CD, I point him to my p2p server, that
8893 is, in all relevant respects, just like what every executive in every
8894 recording company no doubt did as a kid: sharing music.
8897 But the description is also false in part. For when my p2p server is
8898 on a p2p network through which anyone can get access to my music, then
8899 sure, my friends can get access, but it stretches the meaning of
8900 <quote>friends
</quote> beyond recognition to say
<quote>my ten thousand best friends
</quote> can
8901 get access. Whether or not sharing my music with my best friend is
8902 what
<quote>we have always been allowed to do,
</quote> we have not always been
8903 allowed to share music with
<quote>our ten thousand best friends.
</quote>
8906 Likewise, when the other side says,
<quote>File sharing is just like walking
8907 into a Tower Records and taking a CD off the shelf and walking out
8908 with it,
</quote> that's true, at least in part. If, after Lyle Lovett
8909 (finally) releases a new album, rather than buying it, I go to Kazaa
8910 and find a free copy to take, that is very much like stealing a copy
8912 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
8916 <!-- PAGE BREAK 189 -->
8917 But it is not quite stealing from Tower. After all, when I take a CD
8918 from Tower Records, Tower has one less CD to sell. And when I take a
8919 CD from Tower Records, I get a bit of plastic and a cover, and
8920 something to show on my shelves. (And, while we're at it, we could
8921 also note that when I take a CD from Tower Records, the maximum fine
8922 that might be imposed on me, under California law, at least, is
8923 $
1,
000. According to the RIAA, by contrast, if I download a ten-song
8924 CD, I'm liable for $
1,
500,
000 in damages.)
8927 The point is not that it is as neither side describes. The point is
8928 that it is both
—both as the RIAA describes it and as Kazaa
8929 describes it. It is a chimera. And rather than simply denying what the
8930 other side asserts, we need to begin to think about how we should
8931 respond to this chimera. What rules should govern it?
8934 We could respond by simply pretending that it is not a chimera. We
8935 could, with the RIAA, decide that every act of file sharing should be
8936 a felony. We could prosecute families for millions of dollars in
8937 damages just because file sharing occurred on a family computer. And
8938 we can get universities to monitor all computer traffic to make sure
8939 that no computer is used to commit this crime. These responses might
8940 be extreme, but each of them has either been proposed or actually
8941 implemented.
<footnote><para>
8943 <indexterm><primary>ISPs (Internet service providers), user identities revealed by
</primary></indexterm>
8944 For an excellent summary, see the report prepared by GartnerG2 and the
8945 Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School,
8946 <quote>Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> 27 June
2003,
8948 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
8949 #
33</ulink>. Reps. John Conyers Jr. (D-Mich.) and Howard L. Berman
8950 (D-Calif.) have introduced a bill that would treat unauthorized
8951 on-line copying as a felony offense with punishments ranging as high
8952 as five years imprisonment; see Jon Healey,
<quote>House Bill Aims to Up
8953 Stakes on Piracy,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
17 July
2003, available at
8954 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
34</ulink>. Civil
8955 penalties are currently set at $
150,
000 per copied song. For a recent
8956 (and unsuccessful) legal challenge to the RIAA's demand that an ISP
8957 reveal the identity of a user accused of sharing more than
600 songs
8958 through a family computer, see
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Verizon Internet Services (In
8959 re. Verizon Internet Services)
</citetitle>,
240 F. Supp.
2d
24
8960 (D.D.C.
2003). Such a user could face liability ranging as high as $
90
8961 million. Such astronomical figures furnish the RIAA with a powerful
8962 arsenal in its prosecution of file sharers. Settlements ranging from
8963 $
12,
000 to $
17,
500 for four students accused of heavy file sharing on
8964 university networks must have seemed a mere pittance next to the $
98
8965 billion the RIAA could seek should the matter proceed to court. See
8966 Elizabeth Young,
<quote>Downloading Could Lead to Fines,
</quote> redandblack.com,
8967 August
2003, available at
8968 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
35</ulink>. For an
8969 example of the RIAA's targeting of student file sharing, and of the
8970 subpoenas issued to universities to reveal student file-sharer
8971 identities, see James Collins,
<quote>RIAA Steps Up Bid to Force BC, MIT to
8972 Name Students,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
8 August
2003, D3, available at
8973 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
36</ulink>.
8974 <indexterm><primary>Conyers, John, Jr.
</primary></indexterm>
8975 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
8979 <indexterm startref=
"idxchimera" class='endofrange'
/>
8981 Alternatively, we could respond to file sharing the way many kids act
8982 as though we've responded. We could totally legalize it. Let there be
8983 no copyright liability, either civil or criminal, for making
8984 copyrighted content available on the Net. Make file sharing like
8985 gossip: regulated, if at all, by social norms but not by law.
8988 Either response is possible. I think either would be a mistake.
8989 Rather than embrace one of these two extremes, we should embrace
8990 something that recognizes the truth in both. And while I end this book
8991 with a sketch of a system that does just that, my aim in the next
8992 chapter is to show just how awful it would be for us to adopt the
8993 zero-tolerance extreme. I believe
<emphasis>either
</emphasis> extreme
8994 would be worse than a reasonable alternative. But I believe the
8995 zero-tolerance solution would be the worse of the two extremes.
8999 <!-- PAGE BREAK 190 -->
9000 Yet zero tolerance is increasingly our government's policy. In the
9001 middle of the chaos that the Internet has created, an extraordinary
9002 land grab is occurring. The law and technology are being shifted to
9003 give content holders a kind of control over our culture that they have
9004 never had before. And in this extremism, many an opportunity for new
9005 innovation and new creativity will be lost.
9008 I'm not talking about the opportunities for kids to
<quote>steal
</quote> music. My
9009 focus instead is the commercial and cultural innovation that this war
9010 will also kill. We have never seen the power to innovate spread so
9011 broadly among our citizens, and we have just begun to see the
9012 innovation that this power will unleash. Yet the Internet has already
9013 seen the passing of one cycle of innovation around technologies to
9014 distribute content. The law is responsible for this passing. As the
9015 vice president for global public policy at one of these new
9016 innovators, eMusic.com, put it when criticizing the DMCA's added
9017 protection for copyrighted material,
9021 eMusic opposes music piracy. We are a distributor of copyrighted
9022 material, and we want to protect those rights.
9025 But building a technology fortress that locks in the clout of the
9026 major labels is by no means the only way to protect copyright
9027 interests, nor is it necessarily the best. It is simply too early to
9028 answer that question. Market forces operating naturally may very well
9029 produce a totally different industry model.
9032 This is a critical point. The choices that industry sectors make
9033 with respect to these systems will in many ways directly shape the
9034 market for digital media and the manner in which digital media
9035 are distributed. This in turn will directly influence the options
9036 that are available to consumers, both in terms of the ease with
9037 which they will be able to access digital media and the equipment
9038 that they will require to do so. Poor choices made this early in the
9039 game will retard the growth of this market, hurting everyone's
9040 interests.
<footnote><para>
9042 WIPO and the DMCA One Year Later: Assessing Consumer Access to Digital
9043 Entertainment on the Internet and Other Media: Hearing Before the
9044 Subcommittee on Telecommunications, Trade, and Consumer Protection,
9045 House Committee on Commerce,
106th Cong.
29 (
1999) (statement of Peter
9046 Harter, vice president, Global Public Policy and Standards,
9047 EMusic.com), available in LEXIS, Federal Document Clearing House
9048 Congressional Testimony File.
</para></footnote>
9051 <!-- PAGE BREAK 191 -->
9053 In April
2001, eMusic.com was purchased by Vivendi Universal,
9054 one of
<quote>the major labels.
</quote> Its position on these matters has now
9056 <indexterm><primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary></indexterm>
9059 Reversing our tradition of tolerance now will not merely quash
9060 piracy. It will sacrifice values that are important to this culture,
9061 and will kill opportunities that could be extraordinarily valuable.
9064 <!-- PAGE BREAK 192 -->
9066 <chapter label=
"12" id=
"harms">
9067 <title>CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
</title>
9069 <emphasis role='strong'
>To fight
</emphasis> <quote>piracy,
</quote> to
9070 protect
<quote>property,
</quote> the content industry has launched a
9071 war. Lobbying and lots of campaign contributions have now brought the
9072 government into this war. As with any war, this one will have both
9073 direct and collateral damage. As with any war of prohibition, these
9074 damages will be suffered most by our own people.
9077 My aim so far has been to describe the consequences of this war, in
9078 particular, the consequences for
<quote>free culture.
</quote> But my aim now is to
9079 extend this description of consequences into an argument. Is this war
9083 In my view, it is not. There is no good reason why this time, for the
9084 first time, the law should defend the old against the new, just when the
9085 power of the property called
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> is at its greatest in
9088 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
9089 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
9091 Yet
<quote>common sense
</quote> does not see it this way. Common sense is still on
9092 the side of the Causbys and the content industry. The extreme claims
9093 of control in the name of property still resonate; the uncritical
9094 rejection of
<quote>piracy
</quote> still has play.
9096 <indexterm><primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary></indexterm>
9098 <!-- PAGE BREAK 193 -->
9099 There will be many consequences of continuing this war. I want to
9100 describe just three. All three might be said to be unintended. I am quite
9101 confident the third is unintended. I'm less sure about the first two. The
9102 first two protect modern RCAs, but there is no Howard Armstrong in
9103 the wings to fight today's monopolists of culture.
9105 <section id=
"constrain">
9106 <title>Constraining Creators
</title>
9108 In the next ten years we will see an explosion of digital
9109 technologies. These technologies will enable almost anyone to capture
9110 and share content. Capturing and sharing content, of course, is what
9111 humans have done since the dawn of man. It is how we learn and
9112 communicate. But capturing and sharing through digital technology is
9113 different. The fidelity and power are different. You could send an
9114 e-mail telling someone about a joke you saw on Comedy Central, or you
9115 could send the clip. You could write an essay about the
9116 inconsistencies in the arguments of the politician you most love to
9117 hate, or you could make a short film that puts statement against
9118 statement. You could write a poem to express your love, or you could
9119 weave together a string
—a mash-up
— of songs from your
9120 favorite artists in a collage and make it available on the Net.
9123 This digital
<quote>capturing and sharing
</quote> is in part an extension of the
9124 capturing and sharing that has always been integral to our culture,
9125 and in part it is something new. It is continuous with the Kodak, but
9126 it explodes the boundaries of Kodak-like technologies. The technology
9127 of digital
<quote>capturing and sharing
</quote> promises a world of extraordinarily
9128 diverse creativity that can be easily and broadly shared. And as that
9129 creativity is applied to democracy, it will enable a broad range of
9130 citizens to use technology to express and criticize and contribute to
9131 the culture all around.
9134 Technology has thus given us an opportunity to do something with
9135 culture that has only ever been possible for individuals in small groups,
9137 <!-- PAGE BREAK 194 -->
9139 isolated from others. Think about an old man telling a story to a
9140 collection of neighbors in a small town. Now imagine that same
9141 storytelling extended across the globe.
9144 Yet all this is possible only if the activity is presumptively legal. In
9145 the current regime of legal regulation, it is not. Forget file sharing for
9146 a moment. Think about your favorite amazing sites on the Net. Web
9147 sites that offer plot summaries from forgotten television shows; sites
9148 that catalog cartoons from the
1960s; sites that mix images and sound
9149 to criticize politicians or businesses; sites that gather newspaper articles
9150 on remote topics of science or culture. There is a vast amount of creative
9151 work spread across the Internet. But as the law is currently crafted, this
9152 work is presumptively illegal.
9155 That presumption will increasingly chill creativity, as the
9156 examples of extreme penalties for vague infringements continue to
9157 proliferate. It is impossible to get a clear sense of what's allowed
9158 and what's not, and at the same time, the penalties for crossing the
9159 line are astonishingly harsh. The four students who were threatened
9160 by the RIAA ( Jesse Jordan of chapter
3 was just one) were threatened
9161 with a $
98 billion lawsuit for building search engines that permitted
9162 songs to be copied. Yet World-Com
—which defrauded investors of
9163 $
11 billion, resulting in a loss to investors in market capitalization
9164 of over $
200 billion
—received a fine of a mere $
750
9165 million.
<footnote><para>
9167 See Lynne W. Jeter,
<citetitle>Disconnected: Deceit and Betrayal at WorldCom
</citetitle>
9168 (Hoboken, N.J.: John Wiley
& Sons,
2003),
176,
204; for details of
9169 the settlement, see MCI press release,
<quote>MCI Wins U.S. District Court
9170 Approval for SEC Settlement
</quote> (
7 July
2003), available at
9171 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
37</ulink>.
9172 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
9174 And under legislation being pushed in Congress right now, a doctor who
9175 negligently removes the wrong leg in an operation would be liable for
9176 no more than $
250,
000 in damages for pain and
9177 suffering.
<footnote>
9179 <!-- f2. --> The bill, modeled after California's tort reform model, was passed in the
9180 House of Representatives but defeated in a Senate vote in July
2003. For
9181 an overview, see Tanya Albert,
<quote>Measure Stalls in Senate: `We'll Be Back,'
9182 Say Tort Reformers,
</quote> amednews.com,
28 July
2003, available at
9183 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
38</ulink>,
9184 and
<quote>Senate Turns Back Malpractice Caps,
</quote> CBSNews.com,
9 July
2003,
9186 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
39</ulink>. President Bush has continued to urge tort reform in
9188 <indexterm><primary>Bush, George W.
</primary></indexterm>
9190 Can common sense recognize the absurdity in a world where
9191 the maximum fine for downloading two songs off the Internet is more
9192 than the fine for a doctor's negligently butchering a patient?
9193 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
9195 <indexterm><primary>art, underground
</primary></indexterm>
9197 The consequence of this legal uncertainty, tied to these extremely
9198 high penalties, is that an extraordinary amount of creativity will
9199 either never be exercised, or never be exercised in the open. We drive
9200 this creative process underground by branding the modern-day Walt
9201 Disneys
<quote>pirates.
</quote> We make it impossible for businesses to rely upon a
9202 public domain, because the boundaries of the public domain are
9205 <!-- PAGE BREAK 195 -->
9206 be unclear. It never pays to do anything except pay for the right
9207 to create, and hence only those who can pay are allowed to create. As
9208 was the case in the Soviet Union, though for very different reasons,
9209 we will begin to see a world of underground art
—not because the
9210 message is necessarily political, or because the subject is
9211 controversial, but because the very act of creating the art is legally
9212 fraught. Already, exhibits of
<quote>illegal art
</quote> tour the United
9213 States.
<footnote><para>
9216 See Danit Lidor,
<quote>Artists Just Wanna Be Free,
</quote> <citetitle>Wired
</citetitle>,
7 July
9218 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
40</ulink>. For an overview of the exhibition, see
9219 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
41</ulink>.
9221 In what does their
<quote>illegality
</quote> consist?
9222 In the act of mixing the culture around us with an expression that is
9223 critical or reflective.
9225 <indexterm><primary>ISPs (Internet service providers), user identities revealed by
</primary></indexterm>
9227 Part of the reason for this fear of illegality has to do with the
9228 changing law. I described that change in detail in chapter
9229 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>. But an
9230 even bigger part has to do with the increasing ease with which
9231 infractions can be tracked. As users of file-sharing systems
9232 discovered in
2002, it is a trivial matter for copyright owners to get
9233 courts to order Internet service providers to reveal who has what
9234 content. It is as if your cassette tape player transmitted a list of
9235 the songs that you played in the privacy of your own home that anyone
9236 could tune into for whatever reason they chose.
9238 <indexterm><primary>images, ownership of
</primary></indexterm>
9240 Never in our history has a painter had to worry about whether
9241 his painting infringed on someone else's work; but the modern-day
9242 painter, using the tools of Photoshop, sharing content on the Web,
9243 must worry all the time. Images are all around, but the only safe images
9244 to use in the act of creation are those purchased from Corbis or another
9245 image farm. And in purchasing, censoring happens. There is a free
9246 market in pencils; we needn't worry about its effect on creativity. But
9247 there is a highly regulated, monopolized market in cultural icons; the
9248 right to cultivate and transform them is not similarly free.
9251 Lawyers rarely see this because lawyers are rarely empirical. As I
9252 described in chapter
9253 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"recorders"/>, in
9254 response to the story about documentary filmmaker Jon Else, I have
9255 been lectured again and again by lawyers who insist Else's use was
9256 fair use, and hence I am wrong to say that the law regulates such a
9261 <!-- PAGE BREAK 196 -->
9262 But fair use in America simply means the right to hire a lawyer to
9263 defend your right to create. And as lawyers love to forget, our system
9264 for defending rights such as fair use is astonishingly bad
—in
9265 practically every context, but especially here. It costs too much, it
9266 delivers too slowly, and what it delivers often has little connection
9267 to the justice underlying the claim. The legal system may be tolerable
9268 for the very rich. For everyone else, it is an embarrassment to a
9269 tradition that prides itself on the rule of law.
9272 Judges and lawyers can tell themselves that fair use provides adequate
9273 <quote>breathing room
</quote> between regulation by the law and the access the law
9274 should allow. But it is a measure of how out of touch our legal system
9275 has become that anyone actually believes this. The rules that
9276 publishers impose upon writers, the rules that film distributors
9277 impose upon filmmakers, the rules that newspapers impose upon
9278 journalists
— these are the real laws governing creativity. And
9279 these rules have little relationship to the
<quote>law
</quote> with which judges
9283 For in a world that threatens $
150,
000 for a single willful
9284 infringement of a copyright, and which demands tens of thousands of
9285 dollars to even defend against a copyright infringement claim, and
9286 which would never return to the wrongfully accused defendant anything
9287 of the costs she suffered to defend her right to speak
—in that
9288 world, the astonishingly broad regulations that pass under the name
9289 <quote>copyright
</quote> silence speech and creativity. And in that world, it takes
9290 a studied blindness for people to continue to believe they live in a
9291 culture that is free.
9294 As Jed Horovitz, the businessman behind Video Pipeline, said to me,
9298 We're losing [creative] opportunities right and left. Creative people
9299 are being forced not to express themselves. Thoughts are not being
9300 expressed. And while a lot of stuff may [still] be created, it still
9301 won't get distributed. Even if the stuff gets made
… you're not
9302 going to get it distributed in the mainstream media unless
9303 <!-- PAGE BREAK 197 -->
9304 you've got a little note from a lawyer saying,
<quote>This has been
9305 cleared.
</quote> You're not even going to get it on PBS without that kind of
9306 permission. That's the point at which they control it.
9310 <section id=
"innovators">
9311 <title>Constraining Innovators
</title>
9313 The story of the last section was a crunchy-lefty
9314 story
—creativity quashed, artists who can't speak, yada yada
9315 yada. Maybe that doesn't get you going. Maybe you think there's enough
9316 weird art out there, and enough expression that is critical of what
9317 seems to be just about everything. And if you think that, you might
9318 think there's little in this story to worry you.
9321 But there's an aspect of this story that is not lefty in any sense.
9322 Indeed, it is an aspect that could be written by the most extreme
9323 promarket ideologue. And if you're one of these sorts (and a special
9324 one at that,
188 pages into a book like this), then you can see this
9325 other aspect by substituting
<quote>free market
</quote> every place I've spoken of
9326 <quote>free culture.
</quote> The point is the same, even if the interests
9327 affecting culture are more fundamental.
9329 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
9331 The charge I've been making about the regulation of culture is the
9332 same charge free marketers make about regulating markets. Everyone, of
9333 course, concedes that some regulation of markets is necessary
—at
9334 a minimum, we need rules of property and contract, and courts to
9335 enforce both. Likewise, in this culture debate, everyone concedes that
9336 at least some framework of copyright is also required. But both
9337 perspectives vehemently insist that just because some regulation is
9338 good, it doesn't follow that more regulation is better. And both
9339 perspectives are constantly attuned to the ways in which regulation
9340 simply enables the powerful industries of today to protect themselves
9341 against the competitors of tomorrow.
9343 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9345 This is the single most dramatic effect of the shift in regulatory
9346 <!-- PAGE BREAK 198 -->
9347 strategy that I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select:
9348 labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>. The consequence of this massive
9349 threat of liability tied to the murky boundaries of copyright law is
9350 that innovators who want to innovate in this space can safely innovate
9351 only if they have the sign-off from last generation's dominant
9352 industries. That lesson has been taught through a series of cases
9353 that were designed and executed to teach venture capitalists a
9354 lesson. That lesson
—what former Napster CEO Hank Barry calls a
9355 <quote>nuclear pall
</quote> that has fallen over the Valley
—has been learned.
9358 Consider one example to make the point, a story whose beginning
9359 I told in
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle> and which has progressed in a way that
9360 even I (pessimist extraordinaire) would never have predicted.
9362 <indexterm><primary>Roberts, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
9364 In
1997, Michael Roberts launched a company called MP3.com. MP3.com
9365 was keen to remake the music business. Their goal was not just to
9366 facilitate new ways to get access to content. Their goal was also to
9367 facilitate new ways to create content. Unlike the major labels,
9368 MP3.com offered creators a venue to distribute their creativity,
9369 without demanding an exclusive engagement from the creators.
9372 To make this system work, however, MP3.com needed a reliable way to
9373 recommend music to its users. The idea behind this alternative was to
9374 leverage the revealed preferences of music listeners to recommend new
9375 artists. If you like Lyle Lovett, you're likely to enjoy Bonnie
9377 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
9380 This idea required a simple way to gather data about user preferences.
9381 MP3.com came up with an extraordinarily clever way to gather this
9382 preference data. In January
2000, the company launched a service
9383 called my.mp3.com. Using software provided by MP3.com, a user would
9384 sign into an account and then insert into her computer a CD. The
9385 software would identify the CD, and then give the user access to that
9386 content. So, for example, if you inserted a CD by Jill Sobule, then
9387 wherever you were
—at work or at home
—you could get access
9388 to that music once you signed into your account. The system was
9389 therefore a kind of music-lockbox.
9392 No doubt some could use this system to illegally copy content. But
9393 that opportunity existed with or without MP3.com. The aim of the
9395 <!-- PAGE BREAK 199 -->
9396 my.mp3.com service was to give users access to their own content, and
9397 as a by-product, by seeing the content they already owned, to discover
9398 the kind of content the users liked.
9401 To make this system function, however, MP3.com needed to copy
50,
000
9402 CDs to a server. (In principle, it could have been the user who
9403 uploaded the music, but that would have taken a great deal of time,
9404 and would have produced a product of questionable quality.) It
9405 therefore purchased
50,
000 CDs from a store, and started the process
9406 of making copies of those CDs. Again, it would not serve the content
9407 from those copies to anyone except those who authenticated that they
9408 had a copy of the CD they wanted to access. So while this was
50,
000
9409 copies, it was
50,
000 copies directed at giving customers something
9410 they had already bought.
9412 <indexterm id=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='startofrange'
>
9413 <primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary>
9416 Nine days after MP3.com launched its service, the five major labels,
9417 headed by the RIAA, brought a lawsuit against MP3.com. MP3.com settled
9418 with four of the five. Nine months later, a federal judge found
9419 MP3.com to have been guilty of willful infringement with respect to
9420 the fifth. Applying the law as it is, the judge imposed a fine against
9421 MP3.com of $
118 million. MP3.com then settled with the remaining
9422 plaintiff, Vivendi Universal, paying over $
54 million. Vivendi
9423 purchased MP3.com just about a year later.
9426 That part of the story I have told before. Now consider its conclusion.
9429 After Vivendi purchased MP3.com, Vivendi turned around and filed a
9430 malpractice lawsuit against the lawyers who had advised it that they
9431 had a good faith claim that the service they wanted to offer would be
9432 considered legal under copyright law. This lawsuit alleged that it
9433 should have been obvious that the courts would find this behavior
9434 illegal; therefore, this lawsuit sought to punish any lawyer who had
9435 dared to suggest that the law was less restrictive than the labels
9439 The clear purpose of this lawsuit (which was settled for an
9440 unspecified amount shortly after the story was no longer covered in
9441 the press) was to send an unequivocal message to lawyers advising
9443 <!-- PAGE BREAK 200 -->
9444 space: It is not just your clients who might suffer if the content
9445 industry directs its guns against them. It is also you. So those of
9446 you who believe the law should be less restrictive should realize that
9447 such a view of the law will cost you and your firm dearly.
9449 <indexterm startref=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='endofrange'
/>
9450 <indexterm><primary>Hummer, John
</primary></indexterm>
9451 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9452 <indexterm><primary>Hummer Winblad
</primary></indexterm>
9454 This strategy is not just limited to the lawyers. In April
2003,
9455 Universal and EMI brought a lawsuit against Hummer Winblad, the
9456 venture capital firm (VC) that had funded Napster at a certain stage of
9457 its development, its cofounder ( John Hummer), and general partner
9458 (Hank Barry).
<footnote><para>
9460 See Joseph Menn,
<quote>Universal, EMI Sue Napster Investor,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles
9461 Times
</citetitle>,
23 April
2003. For a parallel argument about the effects on
9462 innovation in the distribution of music, see Janelle Brown,
<quote>The Music
9463 Revolution Will Not Be Digitized,
</quote> Salon.com,
1 June
2001, available
9464 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
42</ulink>.
9465 See also Jon Healey,
<quote>Online Music Services Besieged,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles
9466 Times
</citetitle>,
28 May
2001.
9468 The claim here, as well, was that the VC should have recognized the
9469 right of the content industry to control how the industry should
9470 develop. They should be held personally liable for funding a company
9471 whose business turned out to be beyond the law. Here again, the aim of
9472 the lawsuit is transparent: Any VC now recognizes that if you fund a
9473 company whose business is not approved of by the dinosaurs, you are at
9474 risk not just in the marketplace, but in the courtroom as well. Your
9475 investment buys you not only a company, it also buys you a lawsuit.
9476 So extreme has the environment become that even car manufacturers are
9477 afraid of technologies that touch content. In an article in
9478 <citetitle>Business
2.0</citetitle>, Rafe Needleman describes a
9479 discussion with BMW:
9480 <indexterm><primary>EMI
</primary></indexterm>
9481 <indexterm><primary>Universal Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
9484 <indexterm><primary>BMW
</primary></indexterm>
9486 I asked why, with all the storage capacity and computer power in
9487 the car, there was no way to play MP3 files. I was told that BMW
9488 engineers in Germany had rigged a new vehicle to play MP3s via
9489 the car's built-in sound system, but that the company's marketing
9490 and legal departments weren't comfortable with pushing this
9491 forward for release stateside. Even today, no new cars are sold in the
9492 United States with bona fide MP3 players.
… <footnote>
9495 Rafe Needleman,
<quote>Driving in Cars with MP3s,
</quote> <citetitle>Business
2.0</citetitle>,
16 June
9497 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
43</ulink>. I am grateful
9498 to Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli for this example.
9499 <indexterm><primary>Needleman, Rafe
</primary></indexterm>
9504 This is the world of the mafia
—filled with
<quote>your money or your
9505 life
</quote> offers, governed in the end not by courts but by the threats
9506 that the law empowers copyright holders to exercise. It is a system
9507 that will obviously and necessarily stifle new innovation. It is hard
9508 enough to start a company. It is impossibly hard if that company is
9509 constantly threatened by litigation.
9513 <!-- PAGE BREAK 201 -->
9514 The point is not that businesses should have a right to start illegal
9515 enterprises. The point is the definition of
<quote>illegal.
</quote> The law is a
9516 mess of uncertainty. We have no good way to know how it should apply
9517 to new technologies. Yet by reversing our tradition of judicial
9518 deference, and by embracing the astonishingly high penalties that
9519 copyright law imposes, that uncertainty now yields a reality which is
9520 far more conservative than is right. If the law imposed the death
9521 penalty for parking tickets, we'd not only have fewer parking tickets,
9522 we'd also have much less driving. The same principle applies to
9523 innovation. If innovation is constantly checked by this uncertain and
9524 unlimited liability, we will have much less vibrant innovation and
9525 much less creativity.
9527 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
9529 The point is directly parallel to the crunchy-lefty point about fair
9530 use. Whatever the
<quote>real
</quote> law is, realism about the effect of law in
9531 both contexts is the same. This wildly punitive system of regulation
9532 will systematically stifle creativity and innovation. It will protect
9533 some industries and some creators, but it will harm industry and
9534 creativity generally. Free market and free culture depend upon vibrant
9535 competition. Yet the effect of the law today is to stifle just this
9536 kind of competition. The effect is to produce an overregulated
9537 culture, just as the effect of too much control in the market is to
9538 produce an overregulatedregulated market.
9541 The building of a permission culture, rather than a free culture, is
9542 the first important way in which the changes I have described will
9543 burden innovation. A permission culture means a lawyer's
9544 culture
—a culture in which the ability to create requires a call
9545 to your lawyer. Again, I am not antilawyer, at least when they're kept
9546 in their proper place. I am certainly not antilaw. But our profession
9547 has lost the sense of its limits. And leaders in our profession have
9548 lost an appreciation of the high costs that our profession imposes
9549 upon others. The inefficiency of the law is an embarrassment to our
9550 tradition. And while I believe our profession should therefore do
9551 everything it can to make the law more efficient, it should at least
9552 do everything it can to limit the reach of the
9553 <!-- PAGE BREAK 202 -->
9554 law where the law is not doing any good. The transaction costs buried
9555 within a permission culture are enough to bury a wide range of
9556 creativity. Someone needs to do a lot of justifying to justify that
9560 <emphasis role='strong'
>The uncertainty
</emphasis> of the law is one
9561 burden on innovation. There is a second burden that operates more
9562 directly. This is the effort by many in the content industry to use
9563 the law to directly regulate the technology of the Internet so that it
9564 better protects their content.
9567 The motivation for this response is obvious. The Internet enables the
9568 efficient spread of content. That efficiency is a feature of the
9569 Internet's design. But from the perspective of the content industry,
9570 this feature is a
<quote>bug.
</quote> The efficient spread of content means that
9571 content distributors have a harder time controlling the distribution
9572 of content. One obvious response to this efficiency is thus to make
9573 the Internet less efficient. If the Internet enables
<quote>piracy,
</quote> then,
9574 this response says, we should break the kneecaps of the Internet.
9576 <indexterm><primary>broadcast flag
</primary></indexterm>
9578 The examples of this form of legislation are many. At the urging of
9579 the content industry, some in Congress have threatened legislation that
9580 would require computers to determine whether the content they access
9581 is protected or not, and to disable the spread of protected content.
<footnote><para>
9582 <!-- f6. --> <quote>Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> GartnerG2 and
9583 the Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School
9584 (
2003),
33–35, available at
9585 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9587 Congress has already launched proceedings to explore a mandatory
9588 <quote>broadcast flag
</quote> that would be required on any device capable of
9589 transmitting digital video (i.e., a computer), and that would disable
9590 the copying of any content that is marked with a broadcast flag. Other
9591 members of Congress have proposed immunizing content providers from
9592 liability for technology they might deploy that would hunt down
9593 copyright violators and disable their machines.
<footnote><para>
9595 GartnerG2,
26–27.
9599 In one sense, these solutions seem sensible. If the problem is the
9600 code, why not regulate the code to remove the problem. But any
9601 regulation of technical infrastructure will always be tuned to the
9602 particular technology of the day. It will impose significant burdens
9604 <!-- PAGE BREAK 203 -->
9605 the technology, but will likely be eclipsed by advances around exactly
9609 In March
2002, a broad coalition of technology companies, led by
9610 Intel, tried to get Congress to see the harm that such legislation
9611 would impose.
<footnote><para>
9613 See David McGuire,
<quote>Tech Execs Square Off Over Piracy,
</quote> Newsbytes,
9614 February
2002 (Entertainment).
9616 Their argument was obviously not that copyright should not be
9617 protected. Instead, they argued, any protection should not do more
9619 <indexterm><primary>Intel
</primary></indexterm>
9622 <emphasis role='strong'
>There is one
</emphasis> more obvious way in
9623 which this war has harmed innovation
—again, a story that will be
9624 quite familiar to the free market crowd.
9627 Copyright may be property, but like all property, it is also a form
9628 of regulation. It is a regulation that benefits some and harms others.
9629 When done right, it benefits creators and harms leeches. When done
9630 wrong, it is regulation the powerful use to defeat competitors.
9633 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
9634 linkend=
"property-i"/>, despite this feature of copyright as
9635 regulation, and subject to important qualifications outlined by
9636 Jessica Litman in her book
<citetitle>Digital
9637 Copyright
</citetitle>,
<footnote><para>
9639 Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (Amherst,
9640 N.Y.: Prometheus Books,
2001).
9641 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
9643 overall this history of copyright is not bad. As chapter
10 details,
9644 when new technologies have come along, Congress has struck a balance
9645 to assure that the new is protected from the old. Compulsory, or
9646 statutory, licenses have been one part of that strategy. Free use (as
9647 in the case of the VCR) has been another.
9650 But that pattern of deference to new technologies has now changed
9651 with the rise of the Internet. Rather than striking a balance between
9652 the claims of a new technology and the legitimate rights of content
9653 creators, both the courts and Congress have imposed legal restrictions
9654 that will have the effect of smothering the new to benefit the old.
9657 The response by the courts has been fairly universal.
<footnote><para>
9659 <indexterm><primary>Grokster, Ltd.
</primary></indexterm>
9660 The only circuit court exception is found in
<citetitle>Recording Industry
9661 Association of America (RIAA)
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Diamond Multimedia Systems
</citetitle>,
180 F.
3d
9662 1072 (
9th Cir.
1999). There the court of appeals for the Ninth Circuit
9663 reasoned that makers of a portable MP3 player were not liable for
9664 contributory copyright infringement for a device that is unable to
9665 record or redistribute music (a device whose only copying function is
9666 to render portable a music file already stored on a user's hard
9667 drive). At the district court level, the only exception is found in
9668 <citetitle>Metro-Goldwyn-Mayer Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Grokster, Ltd
</citetitle>.,
259 F. Supp.
2d
9669 1029 (C.D. Cal.,
2003), where the court found the link between the
9670 distributor and any given user's conduct too attenuated to make the
9671 distributor liable for contributory or vicarious infringement
9674 It has been mirrored in the responses threatened and actually
9675 implemented by Congress. I won't catalog all of those responses
9676 here.
<footnote><para>
9678 <indexterm><primary>Tauzin, Billy
</primary></indexterm>
9679 For example, in July
2002, Representative Howard Berman introduced the
9680 Peer-to-Peer Piracy Prevention Act (H.R.
5211), which would immunize
9681 copyright holders from liability for damage done to computers when the
9682 copyright holders use technology to stop copyright infringement. In
9683 August
2002, Representative Billy Tauzin introduced a bill to mandate
9684 that technologies capable of rebroadcasting digital copies of films
9685 broadcast on TV (i.e., computers) respect a
<quote>broadcast flag
</quote> that
9686 would disable copying of that content. And in March of the same year,
9687 Senator Fritz Hollings introduced the Consumer Broadband and Digital
9688 Television Promotion Act, which mandated copyright protection
9689 technology in all digital media devices. See GartnerG2,
<quote>Copyright and
9690 Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> 27 June
2003,
33–34,
9692 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9693 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
9694 <indexterm><primary>Hollings, Fritz
</primary></indexterm>
9695 <indexterm><primary>broadcast flag
</primary></indexterm>
9697 But there is one example that captures the flavor of them all. This is
9698 the story of the demise of Internet radio.
9701 <primary>artists
</primary>
9702 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
9706 <!-- PAGE BREAK 204 -->
9707 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
9708 linkend=
"pirates"/>, when a radio station plays a song, the recording
9709 artist doesn't get paid for that
<quote>radio performance
</quote> unless he or she
9710 is also the composer. So, for example if Marilyn Monroe had recorded a
9711 version of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote>—to memorialize her famous
9712 performance before President Kennedy at Madison Square Garden
—
9713 then whenever that recording was played on the radio, the current
9714 copyright owners of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> would get some money, whereas
9715 Marilyn Monroe would not.
9716 <indexterm><primary>Kennedy, John F.
</primary></indexterm>
9719 The reasoning behind this balance struck by Congress makes some
9720 sense. The justification was that radio was a kind of advertising. The
9721 recording artist thus benefited because by playing her music, the
9722 radio station was making it more likely that her records would be
9723 purchased. Thus, the recording artist got something, even if only
9724 indirectly. Probably this reasoning had less to do with the result
9725 than with the power of radio stations: Their lobbyists were quite good
9726 at stopping any efforts to get Congress to require compensation to the
9730 Enter Internet radio. Like regular radio, Internet radio is a
9731 technology to stream content from a broadcaster to a listener. The
9732 broadcast travels across the Internet, not across the ether of radio
9733 spectrum. Thus, I can
<quote>tune in
</quote> to an Internet radio station in
9734 Berlin while sitting in San Francisco, even though there's no way for
9735 me to tune in to a regular radio station much beyond the San Francisco
9739 This feature of the architecture of Internet radio means that there
9740 are potentially an unlimited number of radio stations that a user
9741 could tune in to using her computer, whereas under the existing
9742 architecture for broadcast radio, there is an obvious limit to the
9743 number of broadcasters and clear broadcast frequencies. Internet radio
9744 could therefore be more competitive than regular radio; it could
9745 provide a wider range of selections. And because the potential
9746 audience for Internet radio is the whole world, niche stations could
9747 easily develop and market their content to a relatively large number
9748 of users worldwide. According to some estimates, more than eighty
9749 million users worldwide have tuned in to this new form of radio.
9751 <indexterm><primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary></indexterm>
9754 <!-- PAGE BREAK 205 -->
9755 Internet radio is thus to radio what FM was to AM. It is an
9756 improvement potentially vastly more significant than the FM
9757 improvement over AM, since not only is the technology better, so, too,
9758 is the competition. Indeed, there is a direct parallel between the
9759 fight to establish FM radio and the fight to protect Internet
9760 radio. As one author describes Howard Armstrong's struggle to enable
9765 An almost unlimited number of FM stations was possible in the
9766 shortwaves, thus ending the unnatural restrictions imposed on radio in
9767 the crowded longwaves. If FM were freely developed, the number of
9768 stations would be limited only by economics and competition rather
9769 than by technical restrictions.
… Armstrong likened the situation
9770 that had grown up in radio to that following the invention of the
9771 printing press, when governments and ruling interests attempted to
9772 control this new instrument of mass communications by imposing
9773 restrictive licenses on it. This tyranny was broken only when it
9774 became possible for men freely to acquire printing presses and freely
9775 to run them. FM in this sense was as great an invention as the
9776 printing presses, for it gave radio the opportunity to strike off its
9777 shackles.
<footnote><para>
9784 This potential for FM radio was never realized
—not
9785 because Armstrong was wrong about the technology, but because he
9786 underestimated the power of
<quote>vested interests, habits, customs and
9787 legislation
</quote><footnote><para>
9791 to retard the growth of this competing technology.
9794 Now the very same claim could be made about Internet radio. For
9795 again, there is no technical limitation that could restrict the number of
9796 Internet radio stations. The only restrictions on Internet radio are
9797 those imposed by the law. Copyright law is one such law. So the first
9798 question we should ask is, what copyright rules would govern Internet
9801 <indexterm id='idxartistspayments2' class='startofrange'
>
9802 <primary>artists
</primary>
9803 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
9806 But here the power of the lobbyists is reversed. Internet radio is a
9807 new industry. The recording artists, on the other hand, have a very
9809 <!-- PAGE BREAK 206 -->
9810 powerful lobby, the RIAA. Thus when Congress considered the phenomenon
9811 of Internet radio in
1995, the lobbyists had primed Congress to adopt
9812 a different rule for Internet radio than the rule that applies to
9813 terrestrial radio. While terrestrial radio does not have to pay our
9814 hypothetical Marilyn Monroe when it plays her hypothetical recording
9815 of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> on the air,
<emphasis>Internet radio
9816 does
</emphasis>. Not only is the law not neutral toward Internet
9817 radio
—the law actually burdens Internet radio more than it
9818 burdens terrestrial radio.
9821 This financial burden is not slight. As Harvard law professor
9822 William Fisher estimates, if an Internet radio station distributed adfree
9823 popular music to (on average) ten thousand listeners, twenty-four
9824 hours a day, the total artist fees that radio station would owe would be
9825 over $
1 million a year.
<footnote>
9828 This example was derived from fees set by the original Copyright
9829 Arbitration Royalty Panel (CARP) proceedings, and is drawn from an
9830 example offered by Professor William Fisher. Conference Proceedings,
9831 iLaw (Stanford),
3 July
2003, on file with author. Professors Fisher
9832 and Zittrain submitted testimony in the CARP proceeding that was
9833 ultimately rejected. See Jonathan Zittrain, Digital Performance Right
9834 in Sound Recordings and Ephemeral Recordings, Docket No.
2000-
9, CARP
9835 DTRA
1 and
2, available at
9836 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
45</ulink>.
9837 For an excellent analysis making a similar point, see Randal
9838 C. Picker,
<quote>Copyright as Entry Policy: The Case of Digital
9839 Distribution,
</quote> <citetitle>Antitrust Bulletin
</citetitle> (Summer/Fall
2002):
461:
<quote>This was
9840 not confusion, these are just old-fashioned entry barriers. Analog
9841 radio stations are protected from digital entrants, reducing entry in
9842 radio and diversity. Yes, this is done in the name of getting
9843 royalties to copyright holders, but, absent the play of powerful
9844 interests, that could have been done in a media-neutral way.
</quote>
9845 <indexterm><primary>CARP (Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel)
</primary></indexterm>
9846 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
9848 A regular radio station broadcasting the same content would pay no
9851 <indexterm startref='idxartistspayments2' class='endofrange'
/>
9853 The burden is not financial only. Under the original rules that were
9854 proposed, an Internet radio station (but not a terrestrial radio
9855 station) would have to collect the following data from
<emphasis>every
9856 listening transaction
</emphasis>:
9858 <!-- PAGE BREAK 207 -->
9859 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
9861 name of the service;
9864 channel of the program (AM/FM stations use station ID);
9867 type of program (archived/looped/live);
9870 date of transmission;
9873 time of transmission;
9876 time zone of origination of transmission;
9879 numeric designation of the place of the sound recording within the program;
9882 duration of transmission (to nearest second);
9885 sound recording title;
9888 ISRC code of the recording;
9891 release year of the album per copyright notice and in the case of compilation albums, the release year of the album and copy- right date of the track;
9894 featured recording artist;
9903 UPC code of the retail album;
9909 copyright owner information;
9912 musical genre of the channel or program (station format);
9915 name of the service or entity;
9921 date and time that the user logged in (in the user's time zone);
9924 date and time that the user logged out (in the user's time zone);
9927 time zone where the signal was received (user);
9930 unique user identifier;
9933 the country in which the user received the transmissions.
9938 The Librarian of Congress eventually suspended these reporting
9939 requirements, pending further study. And he also changed the original
9940 rates set by the arbitration panel charged with setting rates. But the
9941 basic difference between Internet radio and terrestrial radio remains:
9942 Internet radio has to pay a
<emphasis>type of copyright fee
</emphasis>
9943 that terrestrial radio does not.
9946 Why? What justifies this difference? Was there any study of the
9947 economic consequences from Internet radio that would justify these
9948 differences? Was the motive to protect artists against piracy?
9950 <indexterm><primary>Real Networks
</primary></indexterm>
9951 <indexterm id='idxalbenalex2' class='startofrange'
>
9952 <primary>Alben, Alex
</primary>
9955 In a rare bit of candor, one RIAA expert admitted what seemed obvious
9956 to everyone at the time. As Alex Alben, vice president for Public
9957 Policy at Real Networks, told me,
9961 The RIAA, which was representing the record labels, presented
9962 some testimony about what they thought a willing buyer would
9963 pay to a willing seller, and it was much higher. It was ten times
9964 higher than what radio stations pay to perform the same songs for
9965 the same period of time. And so the attorneys representing the
9966 webcasters asked the RIAA,
… <quote>How do you come up with a
9968 <!-- PAGE BREAK 208 -->
9969 rate that's so much higher? Why is it worth more than radio? Because
9970 here we have hundreds of thousands of webcasters who want to pay, and
9971 that should establish the market rate, and if you set the rate so
9972 high, you're going to drive the small webcasters out of
9973 business.
…</quote>
9976 <primary>artists
</primary>
9977 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
9980 And the RIAA experts said,
<quote>Well, we don't really model this as an
9981 industry with thousands of webcasters,
<emphasis>we think it should be
9982 an industry with, you know, five or seven big players who can pay a
9983 high rate and it's a stable, predictable market
</emphasis>.
</quote> (Emphasis
9987 <indexterm startref='idxalbenalex2' class='endofrange'
/>
9989 Translation: The aim is to use the law to eliminate competition, so
9990 that this platform of potentially immense competition, which would
9991 cause the diversity and range of content available to explode, would not
9992 cause pain to the dinosaurs of old. There is no one, on either the right
9993 or the left, who should endorse this use of the law. And yet there is
9994 practically no one, on either the right or the left, who is doing anything
9995 effective to prevent it.
9998 <section id=
"corruptingcitizens">
9999 <title>Corrupting Citizens
</title>
10001 Overregulation stifles creativity. It smothers innovation. It gives
10003 a veto over the future. It wastes the extraordinary opportunity
10004 for a democratic creativity that digital technology enables.
10007 In addition to these important harms, there is one more that was
10008 important to our forebears, but seems forgotten today. Overregulation
10009 corrupts citizens and weakens the rule of law.
10012 The war that is being waged today is a war of prohibition. As with
10013 every war of prohibition, it is targeted against the behavior of a very
10014 large number of citizens. According to
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>,
43 million
10015 Americans downloaded music in May
2002.
<footnote><para>
10016 <!-- f15. --> Mike Graziano and Lee Rainie,
<quote>The Music Downloading Deluge,
</quote> Pew
10017 Internet and American Life Project (
24 April
2001), available at
10018 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
46</ulink>.
10019 The Pew Internet and American Life Project reported that
37 million
10020 Americans had downloaded music files from the Internet by early
2001.
10022 According to the RIAA,
10023 the behavior of those
43 million Americans is a felony. We thus have a
10024 set of rules that transform
20 percent of America into criminals. As the
10026 <!-- PAGE BREAK 209 -->
10027 RIAA launches lawsuits against not only the Napsters and Kazaas of
10028 the world, but against students building search engines, and
10030 against ordinary users downloading content, the technologies for
10031 sharing will advance to further protect and hide illegal use. It is an arms
10032 race or a civil war, with the extremes of one side inviting a more
10034 response by the other.
10037 The content industry's tactics exploit the failings of the American
10038 legal system. When the RIAA brought suit against Jesse Jordan, it
10039 knew that in Jordan it had found a scapegoat, not a defendant. The
10040 threat of having to pay either all the money in the world in damages
10041 ($
15,
000,
000) or almost all the money in the world to defend against
10042 paying all the money in the world in damages ($
250,
000 in legal fees)
10043 led Jordan to choose to pay all the money he had in the world
10044 ($
12,
000) to make the suit go away. The same strategy animates the
10045 RIAA's suits against individual users. In September
2003, the RIAA
10046 sued
261 individuals
—including a twelve-year-old girl living in public
10047 housing and a seventy-year-old man who had no idea what file sharing
10048 was.
<footnote><para>
10050 Alex Pham,
<quote>The Labels Strike Back: N.Y. Girl Settles RIAA Case,
</quote> <citetitle>Los
10051 Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, Business.
10053 As these scapegoats discovered, it will always cost more to defend
10054 against these suits than it would cost to simply settle. (The twelve
10055 year old, for example, like Jesse Jordan, paid her life savings of $
2,
000
10056 to settle the case.) Our law is an awful system for defending rights. It
10057 is an embarrassment to our tradition. And the consequence of our law
10058 as it is, is that those with the power can use the law to quash any rights
10062 Wars of prohibition are nothing new in America. This one is just
10063 something more extreme than anything we've seen before. We
10064 experimented with alcohol prohibition, at a time when the per capita
10065 consumption of alcohol was
1.5 gallons per capita per year. The war
10066 against drinking initially reduced that consumption to just
30 percent
10067 of its preprohibition levels, but by the end of prohibition,
10068 consumption was up to
70 percent of the preprohibition
10069 level. Americans were drinking just about as much, but now, a vast
10070 number were criminals.
<footnote><para>
10072 Jeffrey A. Miron and Jeffrey Zwiebel,
<quote>Alcohol Consumption During
10073 Prohibition,
</quote> <citetitle>American Economic Review
</citetitle> 81, no.
2 (
1991):
242.
10076 <!-- PAGE BREAK 210 -->
10077 launched a war on drugs aimed at reducing the consumption of regulated
10078 narcotics that
7 percent (or
16 million) Americans now use.
<footnote><para>
10080 National Drug Control Policy: Hearing Before the House Government
10081 Reform Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
5 March
2003) (statement of
10082 John P. Walters, director of National Drug Control Policy).
10084 That is a drop from the high (so to speak) in
1979 of
14 percent of
10085 the population. We regulate automobiles to the point where the vast
10086 majority of Americans violate the law every day. We run such a complex
10087 tax system that a majority of cash businesses regularly
10088 cheat.
<footnote><para>
10090 See James Andreoni, Brian Erard, and Jonathon Feinstein,
<quote>Tax
10091 Compliance,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of Economic Literature
</citetitle> 36 (
1998):
818 (survey of
10092 compliance literature).
10094 We pride ourselves on our
<quote>free society,
</quote> but an endless array of
10095 ordinary behavior is regulated within our society. And as a result, a
10096 huge proportion of Americans regularly violate at least some law.
10097 <indexterm><primary>alcohol prohibition
</primary></indexterm>
10100 This state of affairs is not without consequence. It is a particularly
10101 salient issue for teachers like me, whose job it is to teach law
10102 students about the importance of
<quote>ethics.
</quote> As my colleague Charlie
10103 Nesson told a class at Stanford, each year law schools admit thousands
10104 of students who have illegally downloaded music, illegally consumed
10105 alcohol and sometimes drugs, illegally worked without paying taxes,
10106 illegally driven cars. These are kids for whom behaving illegally is
10107 increasingly the norm. And then we, as law professors, are supposed to
10108 teach them how to behave ethically
—how to say no to bribes, or
10109 keep client funds separate, or honor a demand to disclose a document
10110 that will mean that your case is over. Generations of
10111 Americans
—more significantly in some parts of America than in
10112 others, but still, everywhere in America today
—can't live their
10113 lives both normally and legally, since
<quote>normally
</quote> entails a certain
10114 degree of illegality.
10115 <indexterm><primary>law schools
</primary></indexterm>
10118 The response to this general illegality is either to enforce the law
10119 more severely or to change the law. We, as a society, have to learn
10120 how to make that choice more rationally. Whether a law makes sense
10121 depends, in part, at least, upon whether the costs of the law, both
10122 intended and collateral, outweigh the benefits. If the costs, intended
10123 and collateral, do outweigh the benefits, then the law ought to be
10124 changed. Alternatively, if the costs of the existing system are much
10125 greater than the costs of an alternative, then we have a good reason
10126 to consider the alternative.
10130 <!-- PAGE BREAK 211 -->
10131 My point is not the idiotic one: Just because people violate a law, we
10132 should therefore repeal it. Obviously, we could reduce murder statistics
10133 dramatically by legalizing murder on Wednesdays and Fridays. But
10134 that wouldn't make any sense, since murder is wrong every day of the
10135 week. A society is right to ban murder always and everywhere.
10138 My point is instead one that democracies understood for generations,
10139 but that we recently have learned to forget. The rule of law depends
10140 upon people obeying the law. The more often, and more repeatedly, we
10141 as citizens experience violating the law, the less we respect the
10142 law. Obviously, in most cases, the important issue is the law, not
10143 respect for the law. I don't care whether the rapist respects the law
10144 or not; I want to catch and incarcerate the rapist. But I do care
10145 whether my students respect the law. And I do care if the rules of law
10146 sow increasing disrespect because of the extreme of regulation they
10147 impose. Twenty million Americans have come of age since the Internet
10148 introduced this different idea of
<quote>sharing.
</quote> We need to be able to
10149 call these twenty million Americans
<quote>citizens,
</quote> not
<quote>felons.
</quote>
10152 When at least forty-three million citizens download content from the
10153 Internet, and when they use tools to combine that content in ways
10154 unauthorized by copyright holders, the first question we should be
10155 asking is not how best to involve the FBI. The first question should
10156 be whether this particular prohibition is really necessary in order to
10157 achieve the proper ends that copyright law serves. Is there another
10158 way to assure that artists get paid without transforming forty-three
10159 million Americans into felons? Does it make sense if there are other
10160 ways to assure that artists get paid without transforming America into
10161 a nation of felons?
10164 This abstract point can be made more clear with a particular example.
10167 We all own CDs. Many of us still own phonograph records. These pieces
10168 of plastic encode music that in a certain sense we have bought. The
10169 law protects our right to buy and sell that plastic: It is not a
10170 copyright infringement for me to sell all my classical records at a
10173 <!-- PAGE BREAK 212 -->
10174 record store and buy jazz records to replace them. That
<quote>use
</quote> of the
10175 recordings is free.
10178 But as the MP3 craze has demonstrated, there is another use of
10179 phonograph records that is effectively free. Because these recordings
10180 were made without copy-protection technologies, I am
<quote>free
</quote> to copy,
10181 or
<quote>rip,
</quote> music from my records onto a computer hard disk. Indeed,
10182 Apple Corporation went so far as to suggest that
<quote>freedom
</quote> was a
10183 right: In a series of commercials, Apple endorsed the
<quote>Rip, Mix, Burn
</quote>
10184 capacities of digital technologies.
10186 <indexterm><primary>Adromeda
</primary></indexterm>
10188 This
<quote>use
</quote> of my records is certainly valuable. I have begun a large
10189 process at home of ripping all of my and my wife's CDs, and storing
10190 them in one archive. Then, using Apple's iTunes, or a wonderful
10191 program called Andromeda, we can build different play lists of our
10192 music: Bach, Baroque, Love Songs, Love Songs of Significant
10193 Others
—the potential is endless. And by reducing the costs of
10194 mixing play lists, these technologies help build a creativity with
10195 play lists that is itself independently valuable. Compilations of
10196 songs are creative and meaningful in their own right.
10199 This use is enabled by unprotected media
—either CDs or records.
10200 But unprotected media also enable file sharing. File sharing threatens
10201 (or so the content industry believes) the ability of creators to earn
10202 a fair return from their creativity. And thus, many are beginning to
10203 experiment with technologies to eliminate unprotected media. These
10204 technologies, for example, would enable CDs that could not be
10205 ripped. Or they might enable spy programs to identify ripped content
10206 on people's machines.
10209 If these technologies took off, then the building of large archives of
10210 your own music would become quite difficult. You might hang in hacker
10211 circles, and get technology to disable the technologies that protect
10212 the content. Trading in those technologies is illegal, but maybe that
10213 doesn't bother you much. In any case, for the vast majority of people,
10214 these protection technologies would effectively destroy the archiving
10216 <!-- PAGE BREAK 213 -->
10217 use of CDs. The technology, in other words, would force us all back to
10218 the world where we either listened to music by manipulating pieces of
10219 plastic or were part of a massively complex
<quote>digital rights
10220 management
</quote> system.
10223 If the only way to assure that artists get paid were the elimination
10224 of the ability to freely move content, then these technologies to
10225 interfere with the freedom to move content would be justifiable. But
10226 what if there were another way to assure that artists are paid,
10227 without locking down any content? What if, in other words, a different
10228 system could assure compensation to artists while also preserving the
10229 freedom to move content easily?
10232 My point just now is not to prove that there is such a system. I offer
10233 a version of such a system in the last chapter of this book. For now,
10234 the only point is the relatively uncontroversial one: If a different
10235 system achieved the same legitimate objectives that the existing
10236 copyright system achieved, but left consumers and creators much more
10237 free, then we'd have a very good reason to pursue this
10238 alternative
—namely, freedom. The choice, in other words, would
10239 not be between property and piracy; the choice would be between
10240 different property systems and the freedoms each allowed.
10243 I believe there is a way to assure that artists are paid without
10244 turning forty-three million Americans into felons. But the salient
10245 feature of this alternative is that it would lead to a very different
10246 market for producing and distributing creativity. The dominant few,
10247 who today control the vast majority of the distribution of content in
10248 the world, would no longer exercise this extreme of control. Rather,
10249 they would go the way of the horse-drawn buggy.
10252 Except that this generation's buggy manufacturers have already saddled
10253 Congress, and are riding the law to protect themselves against this
10254 new form of competition. For them the choice is between fortythree
10255 million Americans as criminals and their own survival.
10258 It is understandable why they choose as they do. It is not
10259 understandable why we as a democracy continue to choose as we do. Jack
10261 <!-- PAGE BREAK 214 -->
10263 Valenti is charming; but not so charming as to justify giving up a
10264 tradition as deep and important as our tradition of free culture.
10266 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
10267 <indexterm id='idxisps' class='startofrange'
>
10268 <primary>ISPs (Internet service providers), user identities revealed by
</primary>
10271 <emphasis role='strong'
>There's one more
</emphasis> aspect to this
10272 corruption that is particularly important to civil liberties, and
10273 follows directly from any war of prohibition. As Electronic Frontier
10274 Foundation attorney Fred von Lohmann describes, this is the
10275 <quote>collateral damage
</quote> that
<quote>arises whenever you turn
10276 a very large percentage of the population into criminals.
</quote> This
10277 is the collateral damage to civil liberties generally.
10280 <quote>If you can treat someone as a putative lawbreaker,
</quote> von Lohmann
10282 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
10286 then all of a sudden a lot of basic civil liberty protections
10287 evaporate to one degree or another.
… If you're a copyright
10288 infringer, how can you hope to have any privacy rights? If you're a
10289 copyright infringer, how can you hope to be secure against seizures of
10290 your computer? How can you hope to continue to receive Internet
10291 access?
… Our sensibilities change as soon as we think,
<quote>Oh, well,
10292 but that person's a criminal, a lawbreaker.
</quote> Well, what this campaign
10293 against file sharing has done is turn a remarkable percentage of the
10294 American Internet-using population into
<quote>lawbreakers.
</quote>
10298 And the consequence of this transformation of the American public
10299 into criminals is that it becomes trivial, as a matter of due process, to
10300 effectively erase much of the privacy most would presume.
10303 Users of the Internet began to see this generally in
2003 as the RIAA
10304 launched its campaign to force Internet service providers to turn over
10305 the names of customers who the RIAA believed were violating copyright
10306 law. Verizon fought that demand and lost. With a simple request to a
10307 judge, and without any notice to the customer at all, the identity of
10308 an Internet user is revealed.
10311 <!-- PAGE BREAK 215 -->
10312 The RIAA then expanded this campaign, by announcing a general strategy
10313 to sue individual users of the Internet who are alleged to have
10314 downloaded copyrighted music from file-sharing systems. But as we've
10315 seen, the potential damages from these suits are astronomical: If a
10316 family's computer is used to download a single CD's worth of music,
10317 the family could be liable for $
2 million in damages. That didn't stop
10318 the RIAA from suing a number of these families, just as they had sued
10319 Jesse Jordan.
<footnote><para>
10321 See Frank Ahrens,
<quote>RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised Targets; Single
10322 Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among Defendants,
</quote>
10323 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Chris Cobbs,
<quote>Worried Parents
10324 Pull Plug on File `Stealing'; With the Music Industry Cracking Down on
10325 File Swapping, Parents are Yanking Software from Home PCs to Avoid
10326 Being Sued,
</quote> <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
30 August
2003, C1; Jefferson
10327 Graham,
<quote>Recording Industry Sues Parents,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
15 September
10328 2003,
4D; John Schwartz,
<quote>She Says She's No Music Pirate. No Snoop
10329 Fan, Either,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
25 September
2003, C1; Margo Varadi,
<quote>Is
10330 Brianna a Criminal?
</quote> <citetitle>Toronto Star
</citetitle>,
18 September
2003, P7.
10335 Even this understates the espionage that is being waged by the
10336 RIAA. A report from CNN late last summer described a strategy the
10337 RIAA had adopted to track Napster users.
<footnote><para>
10339 See
<quote>Revealed: How RIAA Tracks Downloaders: Music Industry Discloses
10340 Some Methods Used,
</quote> CNN.com, available at
10341 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
47</ulink>.
10343 Using a sophisticated hashing algorithm, the RIAA took what is in
10344 effect a fingerprint of every song in the Napster catalog. Any copy of
10345 one of those MP3s will have the same
<quote>fingerprint.
</quote>
10348 So imagine the following not-implausible scenario: Imagine a
10349 friend gives a CD to your daughter
—a collection of songs just
10350 like the cassettes you used to make as a kid. You don't know, and
10351 neither does your daughter, where these songs came from. But she
10352 copies these songs onto her computer. She then takes her computer to
10353 college and connects it to a college network, and if the college
10354 network is
<quote>cooperating
</quote> with the RIAA's espionage, and she hasn't
10355 properly protected her content from the network (do you know how to do
10356 that yourself ?), then the RIAA will be able to identify your daughter
10357 as a
<quote>criminal.
</quote> And under the rules that universities are beginning
10358 to deploy,
<footnote><para>
10360 See Jeff Adler,
<quote>Cambridge: On Campus, Pirates Are Not Penitent,
</quote>
10361 <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
18 May
2003, City Weekly,
1; Frank Ahrens,
<quote>Four
10362 Students Sued over Music Sites; Industry Group Targets File Sharing at
10363 Colleges,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
4 April
2003, E1; Elizabeth Armstrong,
10364 <quote>Students `Rip, Mix, Burn' at Their Own Risk,
</quote> <citetitle>Christian Science
10365 Monitor
</citetitle>,
2 September
2003,
20; Robert Becker and Angela Rozas,
<quote>Music
10366 Pirate Hunt Turns to Loyola; Two Students Names Are Handed Over;
10367 Lawsuit Possible,
</quote> <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
16 July
2003,
1C; Beth Cox,
<quote>RIAA
10368 Trains Antipiracy Guns on Universities,
</quote> <citetitle>Internet News
</citetitle>,
30 January
10369 2003, available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
10370 #
48</ulink>; Benny Evangelista,
<quote>Download Warning
101: Freshman
10371 Orientation This Fall to Include Record Industry Warnings Against File
10372 Sharing,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
11 August
2003, E11;
<quote>Raid, Letters
10373 Are Weapons at Universities,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
26 September
2000,
3D.
10375 your daughter can lose the right to use the university's computer
10376 network. She can, in some cases, be expelled.
10378 <indexterm startref='idxisps' class='endofrange'
/>
10380 Now, of course, she'll have the right to defend herself. You can hire
10381 a lawyer for her (at $
300 per hour, if you're lucky), and she can
10382 plead that she didn't know anything about the source of the songs or
10383 that they came from Napster. And it may well be that the university
10384 believes her. But the university might not believe her. It might treat
10385 this
<quote>contraband
</quote> as presumptive of guilt. And as any number of
10388 <!-- PAGE BREAK 216 -->
10389 have already learned, our presumptions about innocence disappear in
10390 the middle of wars of prohibition. This war is no different.
10392 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
10396 So when we're talking about numbers like forty to sixty million
10397 Americans that are essentially copyright infringers, you create a
10398 situation where the civil liberties of those people are very much in
10399 peril in a general matter. [I don't] think [there is any] analog where
10400 you could randomly choose any person off the street and be confident
10401 that they were committing an unlawful act that could put them on the
10402 hook for potential felony liability or hundreds of millions of dollars
10403 of civil liability. Certainly we all speed, but speeding isn't the
10404 kind of an act for which we routinely forfeit civil liberties. Some
10405 people use drugs, and I think that's the closest analog, [but] many
10406 have noted that the war against drugs has eroded all of our civil
10407 liberties because it's treated so many Americans as criminals. Well, I
10408 think it's fair to say that file sharing is an order of magnitude
10409 larger number of Americans than drug use.
… If forty to sixty
10410 million Americans have become lawbreakers, then we're really on a
10411 slippery slope to lose a lot of civil liberties for all forty to sixty
10416 When forty to sixty million Americans are considered
<quote>criminals
</quote> under
10417 the law, and when the law could achieve the same objective
—
10418 securing rights to authors
—without these millions being
10419 considered
<quote>criminals,
</quote> who is the villain? Americans or the law?
10420 Which is American, a constant war on our own people or a concerted
10421 effort through our democracy to change our law?
10424 <!-- PAGE BREAK 217 -->
10428 <part id=
"c-balances">
10429 <title>BALANCES
</title>
10432 <!-- PAGE BREAK 218 -->
10434 <emphasis role='strong'
>So here's
</emphasis> the picture: You're
10435 standing at the side of the road. Your car is on fire. You are angry
10436 and upset because in part you helped start the fire. Now you don't
10437 know how to put it out. Next to you is a bucket, filled with
10438 gasoline. Obviously, gasoline won't put the fire out.
10441 As you ponder the mess, someone else comes along. In a panic, she
10442 grabs the bucket. Before you have a chance to tell her to
10443 stop
—or before she understands just why she should
10444 stop
—the bucket is in the air. The gasoline is about to hit the
10445 blazing car. And the fire that gasoline will ignite is about to ignite
10449 <emphasis role='strong'
>A war
</emphasis> about copyright rages all
10450 around
—and we're all focusing on the wrong thing. No doubt,
10451 current technologies threaten existing businesses. No doubt they may
10452 threaten artists. But technologies change. The industry and
10453 technologists have plenty of ways to use technology to protect
10454 themselves against the current threats of the Internet. This is a fire
10455 that if let alone would burn itself out.
10458 <!-- PAGE BREAK 219 -->
10459 Yet policy makers are not willing to leave this fire to itself. Primed
10460 with plenty of lobbyists' money, they are keen to intervene to
10461 eliminate the problem they perceive. But the problem they perceive is
10462 not the real threat this culture faces. For while we watch this small
10463 fire in the corner, there is a massive change in the way culture is
10464 made that is happening all around.
10467 Somehow we have to find a way to turn attention to this more important
10468 and fundamental issue. Somehow we have to find a way to avoid pouring
10469 gasoline onto this fire.
10472 We have not found that way yet. Instead, we seem trapped in a simpler,
10473 binary view. However much many people push to frame this debate more
10474 broadly, it is the simple, binary view that remains. We rubberneck to
10475 look at the fire when we should be keeping our eyes on the road.
10478 This challenge has been my life these last few years. It has also been
10479 my failure. In the two chapters that follow, I describe one small
10480 brace of efforts, so far failed, to find a way to refocus this
10481 debate. We must understand these failures if we're to understand what
10482 success will require.
10486 <!-- PAGE BREAK 220 -->
10487 <chapter label=
"13" id=
"eldred">
10488 <title>CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
</title>
10489 <indexterm id=
"idxhawthornenathaniel" class='startofrange'
>
10490 <primary>Hawthorne, Nathaniel
</primary>
10493 <emphasis role='strong'
>In
1995</emphasis>, a father was frustrated
10494 that his daughters didn't seem to like Hawthorne. No doubt there was
10495 more than one such father, but at least one did something about
10496 it. Eric Eldred, a retired computer programmer living in New
10497 Hampshire, decided to put Hawthorne on the Web. An electronic version,
10498 Eldred thought, with links to pictures and explanatory text, would
10499 make this nineteenth-century author's work come alive.
10502 It didn't work
—at least for his daughters. They didn't find
10503 Hawthorne any more interesting than before. But Eldred's experiment
10504 gave birth to a hobby, and his hobby begat a cause: Eldred would build
10505 a library of public domain works by scanning these works and making
10506 them available for free.
10509 Eldred's library was not simply a copy of certain public domain
10510 works, though even a copy would have been of great value to people
10511 across the world who can't get access to printed versions of these
10512 works. Instead, Eldred was producing derivative works from these
10513 public domain works. Just as Disney turned Grimm into stories more
10514 <!-- PAGE BREAK 221 -->
10515 accessible to the twentieth century, Eldred transformed Hawthorne, and
10516 many others, into a form more accessible
—technically
10517 accessible
—today.
10520 Eldred's freedom to do this with Hawthorne's work grew from the same
10521 source as Disney's. Hawthorne's
<citetitle>Scarlet Letter
</citetitle> had passed into the
10522 public domain in
1907. It was free for anyone to take without the
10523 permission of the Hawthorne estate or anyone else. Some, such as Dover
10524 Press and Penguin Classics, take works from the public domain and
10525 produce printed editions, which they sell in bookstores across the
10526 country. Others, such as Disney, take these stories and turn them into
10527 animated cartoons, sometimes successfully (
<citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle>), sometimes not
10528 (
<citetitle>The Hunchback of Notre Dame
</citetitle>,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>). These are all
10529 commercial publications of public domain works.
10531 <indexterm startref=
"idxhawthornenathaniel" class='endofrange'
/>
10533 The Internet created the possibility of noncommercial publications of
10534 public domain works. Eldred's is just one example. There are literally
10535 thousands of others. Hundreds of thousands from across the world have
10536 discovered this platform of expression and now use it to share works
10537 that are, by law, free for the taking. This has produced what we might
10538 call the
<quote>noncommercial publishing industry,
</quote> which before the
10539 Internet was limited to people with large egos or with political or
10540 social causes. But with the Internet, it includes a wide range of
10541 individuals and groups dedicated to spreading culture
10542 generally.
<footnote><para>
10544 There's a parallel here with pornography that is a bit hard to
10545 describe, but it's a strong one. One phenomenon that the Internet
10546 created was a world of noncommercial pornographers
—people who
10547 were distributing porn but were not making money directly or
10548 indirectly from that distribution. Such a class didn't exist before
10549 the Internet came into being because the costs of distributing porn
10550 were so high. Yet this new class of distributors got special attention
10551 in the Supreme Court, when the Court struck down the Communications
10552 Decency Act of
1996. It was partly because of the burden on
10553 noncommercial speakers that the statute was found to exceed Congress's
10554 power. The same point could have been made about noncommercial
10555 publishers after the advent of the Internet. The Eric Eldreds of the
10556 world before the Internet were extremely few. Yet one would think it
10557 at least as important to protect the Eldreds of the world as to
10558 protect noncommercial pornographers.
</para></footnote>
10561 As I said, Eldred lives in New Hampshire. In
1998, Robert Frost's
10562 collection of poems
<citetitle>New Hampshire
</citetitle> was slated to
10563 pass into the public domain. Eldred wanted to post that collection in
10564 his free public library. But Congress got in the way. As I described
10565 in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
10566 linkend=
"property-i"/>, in
1998, for the eleventh time in forty years,
10567 Congress extended the terms of existing copyrights
—this time by
10568 twenty years. Eldred would not be free to add any works more recent
10569 than
1923 to his collection until
2019. Indeed, no copyrighted work
10570 would pass into the public domain until that year (and not even then,
10571 if Congress extends the term again). By contrast, in the same period,
10572 more than
1 million patents will pass into the public domain.
10574 <indexterm><primary>Bono, Mary
</primary></indexterm>
10575 <indexterm><primary>Bono, Sonny
</primary></indexterm>
10578 <!-- PAGE BREAK 222 -->
10579 This was the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act
10580 (CTEA), enacted in memory of the congressman and former musician
10581 Sonny Bono, who, his widow, Mary Bono, says, believed that
10582 <quote>copyrights should be forever.
</quote><footnote><para>
10584 <indexterm><primary>Bono, Mary
</primary></indexterm>
10585 <indexterm><primary>Bono, Sonny
</primary></indexterm>
10586 The full text is:
<quote>Sonny [Bono] wanted the term of copyright
10587 protection to last forever. I am informed by staff that such a change
10588 would violate the Constitution. I invite all of you to work with me to
10589 strengthen our copyright laws in all of the ways available to us. As
10590 you know, there is also Jack Valenti's proposal for a term to last
10591 forever less one day. Perhaps the Committee may look at that next
10592 Congress,
</quote> 144 Cong. Rec. H9946,
9951-
2 (October
7,
1998).
10597 Eldred decided to fight this law. He first resolved to fight it through
10598 civil disobedience. In a series of interviews, Eldred announced that he
10599 would publish as planned, CTEA notwithstanding. But because of a
10600 second law passed in
1998, the NET (No Electronic Theft) Act, his act
10601 of publishing would make Eldred a felon
—whether or not anyone
10602 complained. This was a dangerous strategy for a disabled programmer
10606 It was here that I became involved in Eldred's battle. I was a
10608 scholar whose first passion was constitutional
10610 And though constitutional law courses never focus upon the
10611 Progress Clause of the Constitution, it had always struck me as
10613 different. As you know, the Constitution says,
10617 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science
…
10618 by securing for limited Times to Authors
… exclusive Right to
10619 their
… Writings.
…
10623 As I've described, this clause is unique within the power-granting
10624 clause of Article I, section
8 of our Constitution. Every other clause
10625 granting power to Congress simply says Congress has the power to do
10626 something
—for example, to regulate
<quote>commerce among the several
10627 states
</quote> or
<quote>declare War.
</quote> But here, the
<quote>something
</quote> is something quite
10628 specific
—to
<quote>promote
… Progress
</quote>—through means that
10629 are also specific
— by
<quote>securing
</quote> <quote>exclusive Rights
</quote> (i.e.,
10630 copyrights)
<quote>for limited Times.
</quote>
10633 In the past forty years, Congress has gotten into the practice of
10634 extending existing terms of copyright protection. What puzzled me
10635 about this was, if Congress has the power to extend existing terms,
10636 then the Constitution's requirement that terms be
<quote>limited
</quote> will have
10637 <!-- PAGE BREAK 223 -->
10638 no practical effect. If every time a copyright is about to expire,
10639 Congress has the power to extend its term, then Congress can achieve
10640 what the Constitution plainly forbids
—perpetual terms
<quote>on the
10641 installment plan,
</quote> as Professor Peter Jaszi so nicely put it.
10642 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
10645 As an academic, my first response was to hit the books. I remember
10646 sitting late at the office, scouring on-line databases for any serious
10647 consideration of the question. No one had ever challenged Congress's
10648 practice of extending existing terms. That failure may in part be why
10649 Congress seemed so untroubled in its habit. That, and the fact that
10650 the practice had become so lucrative for Congress. Congress knows that
10651 copyright owners will be willing to pay a great deal of money to see
10652 their copyright terms extended. And so Congress is quite happy to keep
10653 this gravy train going.
10656 For this is the core of the corruption in our present system of
10657 government.
<quote>Corruption
</quote> not in the sense that representatives are
10658 bribed. Rather,
<quote>corruption
</quote> in the sense that the system induces the
10659 beneficiaries of Congress's acts to raise and give money to Congress
10660 to induce it to act. There's only so much time; there's only so much
10661 Congress can do. Why not limit its actions to those things it must
10662 do
—and those things that pay? Extending copyright terms pays.
10665 If that's not obvious to you, consider the following: Say you're one
10666 of the very few lucky copyright owners whose copyright continues to
10667 make money one hundred years after it was created. The Estate of
10668 Robert Frost is a good example. Frost died in
1963. His poetry
10669 continues to be extraordinarily valuable. Thus the Robert Frost estate
10670 benefits greatly from any extension of copyright, since no publisher
10671 would pay the estate any money if the poems Frost wrote could be
10672 published by anyone for free.
10675 So imagine the Robert Frost estate is earning $
100,
000 a year from
10676 three of Frost's poems. And imagine the copyright for those poems
10677 is about to expire. You sit on the board of the Robert Frost estate.
10678 Your financial adviser comes to your board meeting with a very grim
10682 <quote>Next year,
</quote> the adviser announces,
<quote>our copyrights in works A, B,
10684 <!-- PAGE BREAK 224 -->
10685 and C will expire. That means that after next year, we will no longer be
10686 receiving the annual royalty check of $
100,
000 from the publishers of
10687 those works.
</quote>
10690 <quote>There's a proposal in Congress, however,
</quote> she continues,
<quote>that
10691 could change this. A few congressmen are floating a bill to extend the
10692 terms of copyright by twenty years. That bill would be extraordinarily
10693 valuable to us. So we should hope this bill passes.
</quote>
10696 <quote>Hope?
</quote> a fellow board member says.
<quote>Can't we be doing something
10700 <quote>Well, obviously, yes,
</quote> the adviser responds.
<quote>We could contribute
10701 to the campaigns of a number of representatives to try to assure that
10702 they support the bill.
</quote>
10705 You hate politics. You hate contributing to campaigns. So you want
10706 to know whether this disgusting practice is worth it.
<quote>How much
10707 would we get if this extension were passed?
</quote> you ask the adviser.
<quote>How
10708 much is it worth?
</quote>
10711 <quote>Well,
</quote> the adviser says,
<quote>if you're confident that you will continue
10712 to get at least $
100,
000 a year from these copyrights, and you use the
10713 `discount rate' that we use to evaluate estate investments (
6 percent),
10714 then this law would be worth $
1,
146,
000 to the estate.
</quote>
10717 You're a bit shocked by the number, but you quickly come to the
10718 correct conclusion:
10721 <quote>So you're saying it would be worth it for us to pay more than
10722 $
1,
000,
000 in campaign contributions if we were confident those
10724 would assure that the bill was passed?
</quote>
10727 <quote>Absolutely,
</quote> the adviser responds.
<quote>It is worth it to you to
10729 up to the `present value' of the income you expect from these
10730 copyrights. Which for us means over $
1,
000,
000.
</quote>
10733 You quickly get the point
—you as the member of the board and, I
10734 trust, you the reader. Each time copyrights are about to expire, every
10735 beneficiary in the position of the Robert Frost estate faces the same
10736 choice: If they can contribute to get a law passed to extend copyrights,
10737 <!-- PAGE BREAK 225 -->
10738 they will benefit greatly from that extension. And so each time
10740 are about to expire, there is a massive amount of lobbying to get
10741 the copyright term extended.
10744 Thus a congressional perpetual motion machine: So long as legislation
10745 can be bought (albeit indirectly), there will be all the incentive in
10746 the world to buy further extensions of copyright.
10749 In the lobbying that led to the passage of the Sonny Bono
10751 Term Extension Act, this
<quote>theory
</quote> about incentives was proved
10752 real. Ten of the thirteen original sponsors of the act in the House
10753 received the maximum contribution from Disney's political action
10754 committee; in the Senate, eight of the twelve sponsors received
10755 contributions.
<footnote><para>
10756 <!-- f3. --> Associated Press,
<quote>Disney Lobbying for Copyright Extension No Mickey
10757 Mouse Effort; Congress OKs Bill Granting Creators
20 More Years,
</quote>
10758 <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
17 October
1998,
22.
10760 The RIAA and the MPAA are estimated to have spent over
10761 $
1.5 million lobbying in the
1998 election cycle. They paid out more
10762 than $
200,
000 in campaign contributions.
<footnote><para>
10763 <!-- f4. --> See Nick Brown,
<quote>Fair Use No More?: Copyright in the Information
10764 Age,
</quote> available at
10765 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
49</ulink>.
10767 Disney is estimated to have
10768 contributed more than $
800,
000 to reelection campaigns in the
10769 cycle.
<footnote><para>
10771 Alan K. Ota,
<quote>Disney in Washington: The Mouse That Roars,
</quote>
10772 <citetitle>Congressional Quarterly This Week
</citetitle>,
8 August
1990, available at
10773 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
50</ulink>.
10778 <emphasis role='strong'
>Constitutional law
</emphasis> is not oblivious
10779 to the obvious. Or at least, it need not be. So when I was considering
10780 Eldred's complaint, this reality about the never-ending incentives to
10781 increase the copyright term was central to my thinking. In my view, a
10782 pragmatic court committed to interpreting and applying the
10783 Constitution of our framers would see that if Congress has the power
10784 to extend existing terms, then there would be no effective
10785 constitutional requirement that terms be
<quote>limited.
</quote> If
10786 they could extend it once, they would extend it again and again and
10790 It was also my judgment that
<emphasis>this
</emphasis> Supreme Court
10791 would not allow Congress to extend existing terms. As anyone close to
10792 the Supreme Court's work knows, this Court has increasingly restricted
10793 the power of Congress when it has viewed Congress's actions as
10794 exceeding the power granted to it by the Constitution. Among
10795 constitutional scholars, the most famous example of this trend was the
10798 <!-- PAGE BREAK 226 -->
10799 decision in
1995 to strike down a law that banned the possession of
10803 Since
1937, the Supreme Court had interpreted Congress's granted
10804 powers very broadly; so, while the Constitution grants Congress the
10805 power to regulate only
<quote>commerce among the several states
</quote> (aka
10807 commerce
</quote>), the Supreme Court had interpreted that power to
10808 include the power to regulate any activity that merely affected
10813 As the economy grew, this standard increasingly meant that there was
10814 no limit to Congress's power to regulate, since just about every
10815 activity, when considered on a national scale, affects interstate
10816 commerce. A Constitution designed to limit Congress's power was
10817 instead interpreted to impose no limit.
10819 <indexterm><primary>Rehnquist, William H.
</primary></indexterm>
10821 The Supreme Court, under Chief Justice Rehnquist's command, changed
10822 that in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The government had
10823 argued that possessing guns near schools affected interstate
10824 commerce. Guns near schools increase crime, crime lowers property
10825 values, and so on. In the oral argument, the Chief Justice asked the
10826 government whether there was any activity that would not affect
10827 interstate commerce under the reasoning the government advanced. The
10828 government said there was not; if Congress says an activity affects
10829 interstate commerce, then that activity affects interstate
10830 commerce. The Supreme Court, the government said, was not in the
10831 position to second-guess Congress.
10834 <quote>We pause to consider the implications of the government's arguments,
</quote>
10835 the Chief Justice wrote.
<footnote><para>
10836 <!-- f6. --> <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>,
514 U.S.
549,
564 (
1995).
10838 If anything Congress says is interstate commerce must therefore be
10839 considered interstate commerce, then there would be no limit to
10840 Congress's power. The decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> was reaffirmed five years
10841 later in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>.
<footnote><para>
10843 <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>,
529 U.S.
598 (
2000).
10847 If a principle were at work here, then it should apply to the Progress
10848 Clause as much as the Commerce Clause.
<footnote><para>
10850 If it is a principle about enumerated powers, then the principle
10851 carries from one enumerated power to another. The animating point in
10852 the context of the Commerce Clause was that the interpretation offered
10853 by the government would allow the government unending power to
10854 regulate commerce
—the limitation to interstate commerce
10855 notwithstanding. The same point is true in the context of the
10856 Copyright Clause. Here, too, the government's interpretation would
10857 allow the government unending power to regulate copyrights
—the
10858 limitation to
<quote>limited times
</quote> notwithstanding.
10860 And if it is applied to the Progress Clause, the principle should
10861 yield the conclusion that Congress
10862 <!-- PAGE BREAK 227 -->
10863 can't extend an existing term. If Congress could extend an existing
10864 term, then there would be no
<quote>stopping point
</quote> to Congress's power over
10865 terms, though the Constitution expressly states that there is such a
10866 limit. Thus, the same principle applied to the power to grant
10867 copyrights should entail that Congress is not allowed to extend the
10868 term of existing copyrights.
10871 <emphasis>If
</emphasis>, that is, the principle announced in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
10872 stood for a principle. Many believed the decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> stood for
10873 politics
—a conservative Supreme Court, which believed in states'
10874 rights, using its power over Congress to advance its own personal
10875 political preferences. But I rejected that view of the Supreme Court's
10876 decision. Indeed, shortly after the decision, I wrote an article
10877 demonstrating the
<quote>fidelity
</quote> in such an interpretation of the
10878 Constitution. The idea that the Supreme Court decides cases based upon
10879 its politics struck me as extraordinarily boring. I was not going to
10880 devote my life to teaching constitutional law if these nine Justices
10881 were going to be petty politicians.
10884 <emphasis role='strong'
>Now let's pause
</emphasis> for a moment to
10885 make sure we understand what the argument in
10886 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was not about. By insisting on the
10887 Constitution's limits to copyright, obviously Eldred was not endorsing
10888 piracy. Indeed, in an obvious sense, he was fighting a kind of
10889 piracy
—piracy of the public domain. When Robert Frost wrote his
10890 work and when Walt Disney created Mickey Mouse, the maximum copyright
10891 term was just fifty-six years. Because of interim changes, Frost and
10892 Disney had already enjoyed a seventy-five-year monopoly for their
10893 work. They had gotten the benefit of the bargain that the Constitution
10894 envisions: In exchange for a monopoly protected for fifty-six years,
10895 they created new work. But now these entities were using their
10896 power
—expressed through the power of lobbyists' money
—to
10897 get another twenty-year dollop of monopoly. That twenty-year dollop
10898 would be taken from the public domain. Eric Eldred was fighting a
10899 piracy that affects us all.
10902 Some people view the public domain with contempt. In their brief
10904 <!-- PAGE BREAK 228 -->
10905 before the Supreme Court, the Nashville Songwriters Association
10906 wrote that the public domain is nothing more than
<quote>legal piracy.
</quote><footnote><para>
10908 Brief of the Nashville Songwriters Association,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
10909 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618), n
.10, available
10910 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
51</ulink>.
10912 But it is not piracy when the law allows it; and in our constitutional
10913 system, our law requires it. Some may not like the Constitution's
10914 requirements, but that doesn't make the Constitution a pirate's
10916 <indexterm><primary>Nashville Songwriters Association
</primary></indexterm>
10919 As we've seen, our constitutional system requires limits on
10921 as a way to assure that copyright holders do not too heavily
10923 the development and distribution of our culture. Yet, as Eric
10924 Eldred discovered, we have set up a system that assures that copyright
10925 terms will be repeatedly extended, and extended, and extended. We
10926 have created the perfect storm for the public domain. Copyrights have
10927 not expired, and will not expire, so long as Congress is free to be
10928 bought to extend them again.
10931 <emphasis role='strong'
>It is valuable
</emphasis> copyrights that are
10932 responsible for terms being extended. Mickey Mouse and
10933 <quote>Rhapsody in Blue.
</quote> These works are too valuable for
10934 copyright owners to ignore. But the real harm to our society from
10935 copyright extensions is not that Mickey Mouse remains Disney's.
10936 Forget Mickey Mouse. Forget Robert Frost. Forget all the works from
10937 the
1920s and
1930s that have continuing commercial value. The real
10938 harm of term extension comes not from these famous works. The real
10939 harm is to the works that are not famous, not commercially exploited,
10940 and no longer available as a result.
10943 If you look at the work created in the first twenty years (
1923 to
10944 1942) affected by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act,
10945 2 percent of that work has any continuing commercial value. It was the
10946 copyright holders for that
2 percent who pushed the CTEA through.
10947 But the law and its effect were not limited to that
2 percent. The law
10948 extended the terms of copyright generally.
<footnote><para>
10949 <!-- f10. --> The figure of
2 percent is an extrapolation from the study by the
10951 Research Service, in light of the estimated renewal ranges. See Brief
10952 of Petitioners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
7, available at
10953 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
52</ulink>.
10958 Think practically about the consequence of this
10959 extension
—practically,
10960 as a businessperson, and not as a lawyer eager for more legal
10962 <!-- PAGE BREAK 229 -->
10963 work. In
1930,
10,
047 books were published. In
2000,
174 of those
10964 books were still in print. Let's say you were Brewster Kahle, and you
10965 wanted to make available to the world in your iArchive project the
10967 9,
873. What would you have to do?
10969 <indexterm><primary>archives, digital
</primary></indexterm>
10971 Well, first, you'd have to determine which of the
9,
873 books were
10972 still under copyright. That requires going to a library (these data are
10973 not on-line) and paging through tomes of books, cross-checking the
10974 titles and authors of the
9,
873 books with the copyright registration
10975 and renewal records for works published in
1930. That will produce a
10976 list of books still under copyright.
10979 Then for the books still under copyright, you would need to locate
10980 the current copyright owners. How would you do that?
10983 Most people think that there must be a list of these copyright
10985 somewhere. Practical people think this way. How could there be
10986 thousands and thousands of government monopolies without there
10987 being at least a list?
10990 But there is no list. There may be a name from
1930, and then in
10991 1959, of the person who registered the copyright. But just think
10993 about how impossibly difficult it would be to track down
10995 of such records
—especially since the person who registered is
10996 not necessarily the current owner. And we're just talking about
1930!
10999 <quote>But there isn't a list of who owns property generally,
</quote> the
11000 apologists for the system respond.
<quote>Why should there be a list of
11001 copyright owners?
</quote>
11004 Well, actually, if you think about it, there
<emphasis>are
</emphasis>
11005 plenty of lists of who owns what property. Think about deeds on
11006 houses, or titles to cars. And where there isn't a list, the code of
11007 real space is pretty good at suggesting who the owner of a bit of
11008 property is. (A swing set in your backyard is probably yours.) So
11009 formally or informally, we have a pretty good way to know who owns
11010 what tangible property.
11013 So: You walk down a street and see a house. You can know who
11014 owns the house by looking it up in the courthouse registry. If you see
11015 a car, there is ordinarily a license plate that will link the owner to the
11017 <!-- PAGE BREAK 230 -->
11018 car. If you see a bunch of children's toys sitting on the front lawn of a
11019 house, it's fairly easy to determine who owns the toys. And if you
11021 to see a baseball lying in a gutter on the side of the road, look
11022 around for a second for some kids playing ball. If you don't see any
11023 kids, then okay: Here's a bit of property whose owner we can't easily
11024 determine. It is the exception that proves the rule: that we ordinarily
11025 know quite well who owns what property.
11028 Compare this story to intangible property. You go into a library.
11029 The library owns the books. But who owns the copyrights? As I've
11031 described, there's no list of copyright owners. There are authors'
11032 names, of course, but their copyrights could have been assigned, or
11033 passed down in an estate like Grandma's old jewelry. To know who
11034 owns what, you would have to hire a private detective. The bottom
11035 line: The owner cannot easily be located. And in a regime like ours, in
11036 which it is a felony to use such property without the property owner's
11037 permission, the property isn't going to be used.
11040 The consequence with respect to old books is that they won't be
11041 digitized, and hence will simply rot away on shelves. But the
11043 for other creative works is much more dire.
11045 <indexterm id='idxageemichael' class='startofrange'
>
11046 <primary>Agee, Michael
</primary>
11048 <indexterm><primary>Hal Roach Studios
</primary></indexterm>
11049 <indexterm><primary>Laurel and Hardy Films
</primary></indexterm>
11051 Consider the story of Michael Agee, chairman of Hal Roach Studios,
11052 which owns the copyrights for the Laurel and Hardy films. Agee is a
11053 direct beneficiary of the Bono Act. The Laurel and Hardy films were
11054 made between
1921 and
1951. Only one of these films,
<citetitle>The Lucky Dog
</citetitle>, is
11055 currently out of copyright. But for the CTEA, films made after
1923
11056 would have begun entering the public domain. Because Agee controls the
11057 exclusive rights for these popular films, he makes a great deal of
11058 money. According to one estimate,
<quote>Roach has sold about
60,
000
11059 videocassettes and
50,
000 DVDs of the duo's silent
11060 films.
</quote><footnote><para>
11062 See David G. Savage,
<quote>High Court Scene of Showdown on Copyright Law,
</quote>
11063 <citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
6 October
2002; David Streitfeld,
<quote>Classic Movies,
11064 Songs, Books at Stake; Supreme Court Hears Arguments Today on Striking
11065 Down Copyright Extension,
</quote> <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
9 October
2002.
11068 <indexterm><primary>Lucky Dog, The
</primary></indexterm>
11071 Yet Agee opposed the CTEA. His reasons demonstrate a rare virtue in
11072 this culture: selflessness. He argued in a brief before the Supreme
11073 Court that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act will, if left
11074 standing, destroy a whole generation of American film.
11077 His argument is straightforward. A tiny fraction of this work has
11079 <!-- PAGE BREAK 231 -->
11080 any continuing commercial value. The rest
—to the extent it
11081 survives at all
—sits in vaults gathering dust. It may be that
11082 some of this work not now commercially valuable will be deemed to be
11083 valuable by the owners of the vaults. For this to occur, however, the
11084 commercial benefit from the work must exceed the costs of making the
11085 work available for distribution.
11088 We can't know the benefits, but we do know a lot about the costs.
11089 For most of the history of film, the costs of restoring film were very
11090 high; digital technology has lowered these costs substantially. While
11091 it cost more than $
10,
000 to restore a ninety-minute black-and-white
11092 film in
1993, it can now cost as little as $
100 to digitize one hour of
11093 mm film.
<footnote><para>
11095 Brief of Hal Roach Studios and Michael Agee as Amicus Curiae
11096 Supporting the Petitoners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
11097 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
12. See also Brief of Amicus Curiae
11098 filed on behalf of Petitioners by the Internet Archive,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
11099 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, available at
11100 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
53</ulink>.
11105 Restoration technology is not the only cost, nor the most
11107 Lawyers, too, are a cost, and increasingly, a very important one. In
11108 addition to preserving the film, a distributor needs to secure the rights.
11109 And to secure the rights for a film that is under copyright, you need to
11110 locate the copyright owner.
11113 Or more accurately,
<emphasis>owners
</emphasis>. As we've seen, there
11114 isn't only a single copyright associated with a film; there are
11115 many. There isn't a single person whom you can contact about those
11116 copyrights; there are as many as can hold the rights, which turns out
11117 to be an extremely large number. Thus the costs of clearing the rights
11118 to these films is exceptionally high.
11121 <quote>But can't you just restore the film, distribute it, and then pay the
11122 copyright owner when she shows up?
</quote> Sure, if you want to commit a
11123 felony. And even if you're not worried about committing a felony, when
11124 she does show up, she'll have the right to sue you for all the profits you
11125 have made. So, if you're successful, you can be fairly confident you'll be
11126 getting a call from someone's lawyer. And if you're not successful, you
11127 won't make enough to cover the costs of your own lawyer. Either way,
11128 you have to talk to a lawyer. And as is too often the case, saying you have
11129 to talk to a lawyer is the same as saying you won't make any money.
11132 For some films, the benefit of releasing the film may well exceed
11134 <!-- PAGE BREAK 232 -->
11135 these costs. But for the vast majority of them, there is no way the
11137 would outweigh the legal costs. Thus, for the vast majority of old
11138 films, Agee argued, the film will not be restored and distributed until
11139 the copyright expires.
11141 <indexterm startref='idxageemichael' class='endofrange'
/>
11143 But by the time the copyright for these films expires, the film will
11144 have expired. These films were produced on nitrate-based stock, and
11145 nitrate stock dissolves over time. They will be gone, and the metal
11147 in which they are now stored will be filled with nothing more
11151 <emphasis role='strong'
>Of all the
</emphasis> creative work produced
11152 by humans anywhere, a tiny fraction has continuing commercial
11153 value. For that tiny fraction, the copyright is a crucially important
11154 legal device. For that tiny fraction, the copyright creates incentives
11155 to produce and distribute the creative work. For that tiny fraction,
11156 the copyright acts as an
<quote>engine of free expression.
</quote>
11159 But even for that tiny fraction, the actual time during which the
11160 creative work has a commercial life is extremely short. As I've
11162 most books go out of print within one year. The same is true of
11163 music and film. Commercial culture is sharklike. It must keep moving.
11164 And when a creative work falls out of favor with the commercial
11166 the commercial life ends.
11169 Yet that doesn't mean the life of the creative work ends. We don't
11170 keep libraries of books in order to compete with Barnes
& Noble, and
11171 we don't have archives of films because we expect people to choose
11173 spending Friday night watching new movies and spending
11175 night watching a
1930 news documentary. The noncommercial life
11176 of culture is important and valuable
—for entertainment but also, and
11177 more importantly, for knowledge. To understand who we are, and
11178 where we came from, and how we have made the mistakes that we
11179 have, we need to have access to this history.
11182 Copyrights in this context do not drive an engine of free expression.
11184 <!-- PAGE BREAK 233 -->
11185 In this context, there is no need for an exclusive right. Copyrights in
11186 this context do no good.
11189 Yet, for most of our history, they also did little harm. For most of
11190 our history, when a work ended its commercial life, there was no
11191 <emphasis>copyright-related use
</emphasis> that would be inhibited by
11192 an exclusive right. When a book went out of print, you could not buy
11193 it from a publisher. But you could still buy it from a used book
11194 store, and when a used book store sells it, in America, at least,
11195 there is no need to pay the copyright owner anything. Thus, the
11196 ordinary use of a book after its commercial life ended was a use that
11197 was independent of copyright law.
11200 The same was effectively true of film. Because the costs of restoring
11201 a film
—the real economic costs, not the lawyer costs
—were
11202 so high, it was never at all feasible to preserve or restore
11203 film. Like the remains of a great dinner, when it's over, it's
11204 over. Once a film passed out of its commercial life, it may have been
11205 archived for a bit, but that was the end of its life so long as the
11206 market didn't have more to offer.
11209 In other words, though copyright has been relatively short for most
11210 of our history, long copyrights wouldn't have mattered for the works
11211 that lost their commercial value. Long copyrights for these works
11212 would not have interfered with anything.
11215 But this situation has now changed.
11217 <indexterm id='idxarchivesdigital2' class='startofrange'
>
11218 <primary>archives, digital
</primary>
11221 One crucially important consequence of the emergence of digital
11222 technologies is to enable the archive that Brewster Kahle dreams of.
11223 Digital technologies now make it possible to preserve and give access
11224 to all sorts of knowledge. Once a book goes out of print, we can now
11225 imagine digitizing it and making it available to everyone,
11226 forever. Once a film goes out of distribution, we could digitize it
11227 and make it available to everyone, forever. Digital technologies give
11228 new life to copyrighted material after it passes out of its commercial
11229 life. It is now possible to preserve and assure universal access to
11230 this knowledge and culture, whereas before it was not.
11233 <!-- PAGE BREAK 234 -->
11234 And now copyright law does get in the way. Every step of producing
11235 this digital archive of our culture infringes on the exclusive right
11236 of copyright. To digitize a book is to copy it. To do that requires
11237 permission of the copyright owner. The same with music, film, or any
11238 other aspect of our culture protected by copyright. The effort to make
11239 these things available to history, or to researchers, or to those who
11240 just want to explore, is now inhibited by a set of rules that were
11241 written for a radically different context.
11244 Here is the core of the harm that comes from extending terms: Now that
11245 technology enables us to rebuild the library of Alexandria, the law
11246 gets in the way. And it doesn't get in the way for any useful
11247 <emphasis>copyright
</emphasis> purpose, for the purpose of copyright
11248 is to enable the commercial market that spreads culture. No, we are
11249 talking about culture after it has lived its commercial life. In this
11250 context, copyright is serving no purpose
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis>
11251 related to the spread of knowledge. In this context, copyright is not
11252 an engine of free expression. Copyright is a brake.
11255 You may well ask,
<quote>But if digital technologies lower the costs for
11256 Brewster Kahle, then they will lower the costs for Random House, too.
11257 So won't Random House do as well as Brewster Kahle in spreading
11258 culture widely?
</quote>
11261 Maybe. Someday. But there is absolutely no evidence to suggest that
11262 publishers would be as complete as libraries. If Barnes
& Noble
11263 offered to lend books from its stores for a low price, would that
11264 eliminate the need for libraries? Only if you think that the only role
11265 of a library is to serve what
<quote>the market
</quote> would demand. But if you
11266 think the role of a library is bigger than this
—if you think its
11267 role is to archive culture, whether there's a demand for any
11268 particular bit of that culture or not
—then we can't count on the
11269 commercial market to do our library work for us.
11271 <indexterm startref='idxarchivesdigital2' class='endofrange'
/>
11273 I would be the first to agree that it should do as much as it can: We
11274 should rely upon the market as much as possible to spread and enable
11275 culture. My message is absolutely not antimarket. But where we see the
11276 market is not doing the job, then we should allow nonmarket forces the
11278 <!-- PAGE BREAK 235 -->
11279 freedom to fill the gaps. As one researcher calculated for American
11280 culture,
94 percent of the films, books, and music produced between
11281 and
1946 is not commercially available. However much you love the
11282 commercial market, if access is a value, then
6 percent is a failure
11283 to provide that value.
<footnote><para>
11285 Jason Schultz,
<quote>The Myth of the
1976 Copyright `Chaos' Theory,
</quote> 20
11286 December
2002, available at
11287 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
54</ulink>.
11292 <emphasis role='strong'
>In January
1999</emphasis>, we filed a lawsuit
11293 on Eric Eldred's behalf in federal district court in Washington, D.C.,
11294 asking the court to declare the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension
11295 Act unconstitutional. The two central claims that we made were (
1)
11296 that extending existing terms violated the Constitution's
11297 <quote>limited Times
</quote> requirement, and (
2) that extending terms
11298 by another twenty years violated the First Amendment.
11301 The district court dismissed our claims without even hearing an
11302 argument. A panel of the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit also
11303 dismissed our claims, though after hearing an extensive argument. But
11304 that decision at least had a dissent, by one of the most conservative
11305 judges on that court. That dissent gave our claims life.
11308 Judge David Sentelle said the CTEA violated the requirement that
11309 copyrights be for
<quote>limited Times
</quote> only. His argument was as elegant as
11310 it was simple: If Congress can extend existing terms, then there is no
11311 <quote>stopping point
</quote> to Congress's power under the Copyright Clause. The
11312 power to extend existing terms means Congress is not required to grant
11313 terms that are
<quote>limited.
</quote> Thus, Judge Sentelle argued, the court had
11314 to interpret the term
<quote>limited Times
</quote> to give it meaning. And the best
11315 interpretation, Judge Sentelle argued, would be to deny Congress the
11316 power to extend existing terms.
11319 We asked the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit as a whole to
11320 hear the case. Cases are ordinarily heard in panels of three, except for
11321 important cases or cases that raise issues specific to the circuit as a
11322 whole, where the court will sit
<quote>en banc
</quote> to hear the case.
11324 <indexterm><primary>Tatel, David
</primary></indexterm>
11326 The Court of Appeals rejected our request to hear the case en banc.
11327 This time, Judge Sentelle was joined by the most liberal member of the
11329 <!-- PAGE BREAK 236 -->
11330 D.C. Circuit, Judge David Tatel. Both the most conservative and the
11331 most liberal judges in the D.C. Circuit believed Congress had
11332 overstepped its bounds.
11335 It was here that most expected Eldred v. Ashcroft would die, for the
11336 Supreme Court rarely reviews any decision by a court of appeals. (It
11337 hears about one hundred cases a year, out of more than five thousand
11338 appeals.) And it practically never reviews a decision that upholds a
11339 statute when no other court has yet reviewed the statute.
11342 But in February
2002, the Supreme Court surprised the world by
11343 granting our petition to review the D.C. Circuit opinion. Argument
11344 was set for October of
2002. The summer would be spent writing
11345 briefs and preparing for argument.
11348 <emphasis role='strong'
>It is over
</emphasis> a year later as I write
11349 these words. It is still astonishingly hard. If you know anything at
11350 all about this story, you know that we lost the appeal. And if you
11351 know something more than just the minimum, you probably think there
11352 was no way this case could have been won. After our defeat, I received
11353 literally thousands of missives by well-wishers and supporters,
11354 thanking me for my work on behalf of this noble but doomed cause. And
11355 none from this pile was more significant to me than the e-mail from my
11356 client, Eric Eldred.
11359 But my client and these friends were wrong. This case could have
11360 been won. It should have been won. And no matter how hard I try to
11361 retell this story to myself, I can never escape believing that my own
11364 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11366 <emphasis role='strong'
>The mistake
</emphasis> was made early, though
11367 it became obvious only at the very end. Our case had been supported
11368 from the very beginning by an extraordinary lawyer, Geoffrey Stewart,
11369 and by the law firm he had moved to, Jones, Day, Reavis and
11370 Pogue. Jones Day took a great deal of heat
11371 <!-- PAGE BREAK 237 -->
11372 from its copyright-protectionist clients for supporting us. They
11373 ignored this pressure (something that few law firms today would ever
11374 do), and throughout the case, they gave it everything they could.
11376 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11377 <indexterm><primary>Bromberg, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
11378 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11380 There were three key lawyers on the case from Jones Day. Geoff
11381 Stewart was the first, but then Dan Bromberg and Don Ayer became
11382 quite involved. Bromberg and Ayer in particular had a common view
11383 about how this case would be won: We would only win, they repeatedly
11384 told me, if we could make the issue seem
<quote>important
</quote> to the Supreme
11385 Court. It had to seem as if dramatic harm were being done to free
11386 speech and free culture; otherwise, they would never vote against
<quote>the
11387 most powerful media companies in the world.
</quote>
11390 I hate this view of the law. Of course I thought the Sonny Bono Act
11391 was a dramatic harm to free speech and free culture. Of course I still
11392 think it is. But the idea that the Supreme Court decides the law based
11393 on how important they believe the issues are is just wrong. It might be
11394 <quote>right
</quote> as in
<quote>true,
</quote> I thought, but it is
<quote>wrong
</quote> as in
<quote>it just shouldn't be
11395 that way.
</quote> As I believed that any faithful interpretation of what the
11396 framers of our Constitution did would yield the conclusion that the
11397 CTEA was unconstitutional, and as I believed that any faithful
11399 of what the First Amendment means would yield the
11400 conclusion that the power to extend existing copyright terms is
11402 I was not persuaded that we had to sell our case like soap.
11403 Just as a law that bans the swastika is unconstitutional not because the
11404 Court likes Nazis but because such a law would violate the
11406 so too, in my view, would the Court decide whether Congress's
11407 law was constitutional based on the Constitution, not based on whether
11408 they liked the values that the framers put in the Constitution.
11411 In any case, I thought, the Court must already see the danger and
11412 the harm caused by this sort of law. Why else would they grant review?
11413 There was no reason to hear the case in the Supreme Court if they
11414 weren't convinced that this regulation was harmful. So in my view, we
11415 didn't need to persuade them that this law was bad, we needed to show
11416 why it was unconstitutional.
11419 There was one way, however, in which I felt politics would matter
11421 <!-- PAGE BREAK 238 -->
11422 and in which I thought a response was appropriate. I was convinced
11423 that the Court would not hear our arguments if it thought these were
11424 just the arguments of a group of lefty loons. This Supreme Court was
11425 not about to launch into a new field of judicial review if it seemed
11426 that this field of review was simply the preference of a small
11427 political minority. Although my focus in the case was not to
11428 demonstrate how bad the Sonny Bono Act was but to demonstrate that it
11429 was unconstitutional, my hope was to make this argument against a
11430 background of briefs that covered the full range of political
11431 views. To show that this claim against the CTEA was grounded in
11432 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> and not politics, then, we tried to gather
11433 the widest range of credible critics
—credible not because they
11434 were rich and famous, but because they, in the aggregate, demonstrated
11435 that this law was unconstitutional regardless of one's politics.
11438 The first step happened all by itself. Phyllis Schlafly's
11439 organization, Eagle Forum, had been an opponent of the CTEA from the
11440 very beginning. Mrs. Schlafly viewed the CTEA as a sellout by
11441 Congress. In November
1998, she wrote a stinging editorial attacking
11442 the Republican Congress for allowing the law to pass. As she wrote,
11443 <quote>Do you sometimes wonder why bills that create a financial windfall to
11444 narrow special interests slide easily through the intricate
11445 legislative process, while bills that benefit the general public seem
11446 to get bogged down?
</quote> The answer, as the editorial documented, was the
11447 power of money. Schlafly enumerated Disney's contributions to the key
11448 players on the committees. It was money, not justice, that gave Mickey
11449 Mouse twenty more years in Disney's control, Schlafly argued.
11450 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11451 <indexterm><primary>Schlafly, Phyllis
</primary></indexterm>
11454 In the Court of Appeals, Eagle Forum was eager to file a brief
11455 supporting our position. Their brief made the argument that became the
11456 core claim in the Supreme Court: If Congress can extend the term of
11457 existing copyrights, there is no limit to Congress's power to set
11458 terms. That strong conservative argument persuaded a strong
11459 conservative judge, Judge Sentelle.
11462 In the Supreme Court, the briefs on our side were about as diverse as
11463 it gets. They included an extraordinary historical brief by the Free
11465 <!-- PAGE BREAK 239 -->
11466 Software Foundation (home of the GNU project that made GNU/ Linux
11467 possible). They included a powerful brief about the costs of
11468 uncertainty by Intel. There were two law professors' briefs, one by
11469 copyright scholars and one by First Amendment scholars. There was an
11470 exhaustive and uncontroverted brief by the world's experts in the
11471 history of the Progress Clause. And of course, there was a new brief
11472 by Eagle Forum, repeating and strengthening its arguments.
11473 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
11474 <indexterm><primary>Intel
</primary></indexterm>
11475 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
11476 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11479 Those briefs framed a legal argument. Then to support the legal
11480 argument, there were a number of powerful briefs by libraries and
11481 archives, including the Internet Archive, the American Association of
11482 Law Libraries, and the National Writers Union.
11483 <indexterm><primary>American Association of Law Libraries
</primary></indexterm>
11484 <indexterm><primary>National Writers Union
</primary></indexterm>
11486 <indexterm><primary>Hal Roach Studios
</primary></indexterm>
11488 But two briefs captured the policy argument best. One made the
11489 argument I've already described: A brief by Hal Roach Studios argued
11490 that unless the law was struck, a whole generation of American film
11491 would disappear. The other made the economic argument absolutely
11494 <indexterm><primary>Akerlof, George
</primary></indexterm>
11495 <indexterm><primary>Arrow, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
11496 <indexterm><primary>Buchanan, James
</primary></indexterm>
11497 <indexterm><primary>Coase, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11498 <indexterm><primary>Friedman, Milton
</primary></indexterm>
11500 This economists' brief was signed by seventeen economists, including
11501 five Nobel Prize winners, including Ronald Coase, James Buchanan,
11502 Milton Friedman, Kenneth Arrow, and George Akerlof. The economists, as
11503 the list of Nobel winners demonstrates, spanned the political
11504 spectrum. Their conclusions were powerful: There was no plausible
11505 claim that extending the terms of existing copyrights would do
11506 anything to increase incentives to create. Such extensions were
11507 nothing more than
<quote>rent-seeking
</quote>—the fancy term economists use
11508 to describe special-interest legislation gone wild.
11511 The same effort at balance was reflected in the legal team we gathered
11512 to write our briefs in the case. The Jones Day lawyers had been with
11513 us from the start. But when the case got to the Supreme Court, we
11514 added three lawyers to help us frame this argument to this Court: Alan
11515 Morrison, a lawyer from Public Citizen, a Washington group that had
11516 made constitutional history with a series of seminal victories in the
11517 Supreme Court defending individual rights; my colleague and dean,
11518 Kathleen Sullivan, who had argued many cases in the Court, and
11520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 240 -->
11521 who had advised us early on about a First Amendment strategy; and
11522 finally, former solicitor general Charles Fried.
11523 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11524 <indexterm><primary>Morrison, Alan
</primary></indexterm>
11525 <indexterm><primary>Public Citizen
</primary></indexterm>
11526 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11529 Fried was a special victory for our side. Every other former solicitor
11530 general was hired by the other side to defend Congress's power to give
11531 media companies the special favor of extended copyright terms. Fried
11532 was the only one who turned down that lucrative assignment to stand up
11533 for something he believed in. He had been Ronald Reagan's chief lawyer
11534 in the Supreme Court. He had helped craft the line of cases that
11535 limited Congress's power in the context of the Commerce Clause. And
11536 while he had argued many positions in the Supreme Court that I
11537 personally disagreed with, his joining the cause was a vote of
11538 confidence in our argument.
11539 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11542 The government, in defending the statute, had its collection of
11543 friends, as well. Significantly, however, none of these
<quote>friends
</quote> included
11544 historians or economists. The briefs on the other side of the case were
11545 written exclusively by major media companies, congressmen, and
11549 The media companies were not surprising. They had the most to gain
11550 from the law. The congressmen were not surprising either
—they
11551 were defending their power and, indirectly, the gravy train of
11552 contributions such power induced. And of course it was not surprising
11553 that the copyright holders would defend the idea that they should
11554 continue to have the right to control who did what with content they
11558 Dr. Seuss's representatives, for example, argued that it was
11559 better for the Dr. Seuss estate to control what happened to
11560 Dr. Seuss's work
— better than allowing it to fall into the
11561 public domain
—because if this creativity were in the public
11562 domain, then people could use it to
<quote>glorify drugs or to create
11563 pornography.
</quote><footnote><para>
11565 Brief of Amici Dr. Seuss Enterprise et al.,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
11566 U.S. (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
19.
11568 That was also the motive of the Gershwin estate, which defended its
11569 <quote>protection
</quote> of the work of George Gershwin. They refuse, for example,
11570 to license
<citetitle>Porgy and Bess
</citetitle> to anyone who refuses to use African
11571 Americans in the cast.
<footnote><para>
11573 Dinitia Smith,
<quote>Immortal Words, Immortal Royalties? Even Mickey
11574 Mouse Joins the Fray,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
28 March
1998, B7.
11577 <!-- PAGE BREAK 241 -->
11578 their view of how this part of American culture should be controlled,
11579 and they wanted this law to help them effect that control.
11580 <indexterm><primary>Gershwin, George
</primary></indexterm>
11583 This argument made clear a theme that is rarely noticed in this
11584 debate. When Congress decides to extend the term of existing
11585 copyrights, Congress is making a choice about which speakers it will
11586 favor. Famous and beloved copyright owners, such as the Gershwin
11587 estate and Dr. Seuss, come to Congress and say,
<quote>Give us twenty years
11588 to control the speech about these icons of American culture. We'll do
11589 better with them than anyone else.
</quote> Congress of course likes to reward
11590 the popular and famous by giving them what they want. But when
11591 Congress gives people an exclusive right to speak in a certain way,
11592 that's just what the First Amendment is traditionally meant to block.
11595 We argued as much in a final brief. Not only would upholding the CTEA
11596 mean that there was no limit to the power of Congress to extend
11597 copyrights
—extensions that would further concentrate the market;
11598 it would also mean that there was no limit to Congress's power to play
11599 favorites, through copyright, with who has the right to speak.
11602 <emphasis role='strong'
>Between February
</emphasis> and October, there
11603 was little I did beyond preparing for this case. Early on, as I said,
11604 I set the strategy.
11606 <indexterm><primary>Rehnquist, William H.
</primary></indexterm>
11607 <indexterm><primary>O'Connor, Sandra Day
</primary></indexterm>
11609 The Supreme Court was divided into two important camps. One camp we
11610 called
<quote>the Conservatives.
</quote> The other we called
<quote>the Rest.
</quote> The
11611 Conservatives included Chief Justice Rehnquist, Justice O'Connor,
11612 Justice Scalia, Justice Kennedy, and Justice Thomas. These five had
11613 been the most consistent in limiting Congress's power. They were the
11614 five who had supported the
<citetitle>Lopez/Morrison
</citetitle> line
11615 of cases that said that an enumerated power had to be interpreted to
11616 assure that Congress's powers had limits.
11618 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11619 <indexterm id='idxginsburg' class='startofrange'
>
11620 <primary>Ginsburg, Ruth Bader
</primary>
11623 The Rest were the four Justices who had strongly opposed limits on
11624 Congress's power. These four
—Justice Stevens, Justice Souter,
11625 Justice Ginsburg, and Justice Breyer
—had repeatedly argued that
11627 <!-- PAGE BREAK 242 -->
11628 gives Congress broad discretion to decide how best to implement its
11629 powers. In case after case, these justices had argued that the Court's
11630 role should be one of deference. Though the votes of these four
11631 justices were the votes that I personally had most consistently agreed
11632 with, they were also the votes that we were least likely to get.
11635 In particular, the least likely was Justice Ginsburg's. In addition to
11636 her general view about deference to Congress (except where issues of
11637 gender are involved), she had been particularly deferential in the
11638 context of intellectual property protections. She and her daughter (an
11639 excellent and well-known intellectual property scholar) were cut from
11640 the same intellectual property cloth. We expected she would agree with
11641 the writings of her daughter: that Congress had the power in this
11642 context to do as it wished, even if what Congress wished made little
11645 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11647 Close behind Justice Ginsburg were two justices whom we also viewed as
11648 unlikely allies, though possible surprises. Justice Souter strongly
11649 favored deference to Congress, as did Justice Breyer. But both were
11650 also very sensitive to free speech concerns. And as we strongly
11651 believed, there was a very important free speech argument against
11652 these retrospective extensions.
11654 <indexterm startref='idxginsburg' class='endofrange'
/>
11656 The only vote we could be confident about was that of Justice
11657 Stevens. History will record Justice Stevens as one of the greatest
11658 judges on this Court. His votes are consistently eclectic, which just
11659 means that no simple ideology explains where he will stand. But he
11660 had consistently argued for limits in the context of intellectual property
11661 generally. We were fairly confident he would recognize limits here.
11664 This analysis of
<quote>the Rest
</quote> showed most clearly where our focus had to
11665 be: on the Conservatives. To win this case, we had to crack open these
11666 five and get at least a majority to go our way. Thus, the single
11667 overriding argument that animated our claim rested on the
11668 Conservatives' most important jurisprudential innovation
—the
11669 argument that Judge Sentelle had relied upon in the Court of Appeals,
11670 that Congress's power must be interpreted so that its enumerated
11671 powers have limits.
11674 This then was the core of our strategy
—a strategy for which I am
11675 responsible. We would get the Court to see that just as with the
11676 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
11677 <!-- PAGE BREAK 243 -->
11678 case, under the government's argument here, Congress would always have
11679 unlimited power to extend existing terms. If anything was plain about
11680 Congress's power under the Progress Clause, it was that this power was
11681 supposed to be
<quote>limited.
</quote> Our aim would be to get the Court to
11682 reconcile
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> with
11683 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>: If Congress's power to regulate commerce
11684 was limited, then so, too, must Congress's power to regulate copyright
11688 <emphasis role='strong'
>The argument
</emphasis> on the government's
11689 side came down to this: Congress has done it before. It should be
11690 allowed to do it again. The government claimed that from the very
11691 beginning, Congress has been extending the term of existing
11692 copyrights. So, the government argued, the Court should not now say
11693 that practice is unconstitutional.
11696 There was some truth to the government's claim, but not much. We
11697 certainly agreed that Congress had extended existing terms in
1831
11698 and in
1909. And of course, in
1962, Congress began extending
11700 terms regularly
—eleven times in forty years.
11703 But this
<quote>consistency
</quote> should be kept in perspective. Congress
11705 existing terms once in the first hundred years of the Republic.
11706 It then extended existing terms once again in the next fifty. Those rare
11707 extensions are in contrast to the now regular practice of extending
11709 terms. Whatever restraint Congress had had in the past, that
11711 was now gone. Congress was now in a cycle of extensions; there
11712 was no reason to expect that cycle would end. This Court had not
11714 to intervene where Congress was in a similar cycle of extension.
11715 There was no reason it couldn't intervene here.
11718 <emphasis role='strong'
>Oral argument
</emphasis> was scheduled for the
11719 first week in October. I arrived in D.C. two weeks before the
11720 argument. During those two weeks, I was repeatedly
11721 <quote>mooted
</quote> by lawyers who had volunteered to
11723 <!-- PAGE BREAK 244 -->
11724 help in the case. Such
<quote>moots
</quote> are basically practice rounds, where
11725 wannabe justices fire questions at wannabe winners.
11728 I was convinced that to win, I had to keep the Court focused on a
11729 single point: that if this extension is permitted, then there is no limit to
11730 the power to set terms. Going with the government would mean that
11731 terms would be effectively unlimited; going with us would give
11733 a clear line to follow: Don't extend existing terms. The moots
11734 were an effective practice; I found ways to take every question back to
11737 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11738 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11740 One moot was before the lawyers at Jones Day. Don Ayer was the
11741 skeptic. He had served in the Reagan Justice Department with Solicitor
11742 General Charles Fried. He had argued many cases before the Supreme
11743 Court. And in his review of the moot, he let his concern speak:
11744 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11747 <quote>I'm just afraid that unless they really see the harm, they won't be
11748 willing to upset this practice that the government says has been a
11749 consistent practice for two hundred years. You have to make them see
11750 the harm
—passionately get them to see the harm. For if they
11751 don't see that, then we haven't any chance of winning.
</quote>
11753 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11755 He may have argued many cases before this Court, I thought, but
11756 he didn't understand its soul. As a clerk, I had seen the Justices do the
11757 right thing
—not because of politics but because it was right. As a law
11758 professor, I had spent my life teaching my students that this Court
11759 does the right thing
—not because of politics but because it is right. As
11760 I listened to Ayer's plea for passion in pressing politics, I understood
11761 his point, and I rejected it. Our argument was right. That was enough.
11762 Let the politicians learn to see that it was also good.
11765 <emphasis role='strong'
>The night before
</emphasis> the argument, a
11766 line of people began to form in front of the Supreme Court. The case
11767 had become a focus of the press and of the movement to free
11768 culture. Hundreds stood in line
11770 <!-- PAGE BREAK 245 -->
11771 for the chance to see the proceedings. Scores spent the night on the
11772 Supreme Court steps so that they would be assured a seat.
11775 Not everyone has to wait in line. People who know the Justices can
11776 ask for seats they control. (I asked Justice Scalia's chambers for seats for
11777 my parents, for example.) Members of the Supreme Court bar can get
11778 a seat in a special section reserved for them. And senators and
11780 have a special place where they get to sit, too. And finally, of
11781 course, the press has a gallery, as do clerks working for the Justices on
11782 the Court. As we entered that morning, there was no place that was
11783 not taken. This was an argument about intellectual property law, yet
11784 the halls were filled. As I walked in to take my seat at the front of the
11785 Court, I saw my parents sitting on the left. As I sat down at the table,
11786 I saw Jack Valenti sitting in the special section ordinarily reserved for
11787 family of the Justices.
11790 When the Chief Justice called me to begin my argument, I began
11791 where I intended to stay: on the question of the limits on Congress's
11792 power. This was a case about enumerated powers, I said, and whether
11793 those enumerated powers had any limit.
11795 <indexterm><primary>O'Connor, Sandra Day
</primary></indexterm>
11797 Justice O'Connor stopped me within one minute of my opening.
11798 The history was bothering her.
11802 justice o'connor: Congress has extended the term so often
11803 through the years, and if you are right, don't we run the risk of
11804 upsetting previous extensions of time? I mean, this seems to be a
11805 practice that began with the very first act.
11809 She was quite willing to concede
<quote>that this flies directly in the face
11810 of what the framers had in mind.
</quote> But my response again and again
11811 was to emphasize limits on Congress's power.
11815 mr. lessig: Well, if it flies in the face of what the framers had in
11816 mind, then the question is, is there a way of interpreting their
11817 <!-- PAGE BREAK 246 -->
11818 words that gives effect to what they had in mind, and the answer
11823 There were two points in this argument when I should have seen
11824 where the Court was going. The first was a question by Justice
11825 Kennedy, who observed,
11829 justice kennedy: Well, I suppose implicit in the argument that
11830 the '
76 act, too, should have been declared void, and that we
11831 might leave it alone because of the disruption, is that for all these
11832 years the act has impeded progress in science and the useful arts.
11833 I just don't see any empirical evidence for that.
11837 Here follows my clear mistake. Like a professor correcting a
11843 mr. lessig: Justice, we are not making an empirical claim at all.
11844 Nothing in our Copyright Clause claim hangs upon the empirical
11845 assertion about impeding progress. Our only argument is this is a
11846 structural limit necessary to assure that what would be an effectively
11847 perpetual term not be permitted under the copyright laws.
11850 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11852 That was a correct answer, but it wasn't the right answer. The right
11853 answer was instead that there was an obvious and profound harm. Any
11854 number of briefs had been written about it. He wanted to hear it. And
11855 here was the place Don Ayer's advice should have mattered. This was a
11856 softball; my answer was a swing and a miss.
11859 The second came from the Chief, for whom the whole case had been
11860 crafted. For the Chief Justice had crafted the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> ruling,
11861 and we hoped that he would see this case as its second cousin.
11864 It was clear a second into his question that he wasn't at all
11865 sympathetic. To him, we were a bunch of anarchists. As he asked:
11867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 247 -->
11871 chief justice: Well, but you want more than that. You want the
11872 right to copy verbatim other people's books, don't you?
11875 mr. lessig: We want the right to copy verbatim works that
11876 should be in the public domain and would be in the public
11878 but for a statute that cannot be justified under ordinary First
11879 Amendment analysis or under a proper reading of the limits built
11880 into the Copyright Clause.
11883 <indexterm><primary>Olson, Theodore B.
</primary></indexterm>
11885 Things went better for us when the government gave its argument;
11886 for now the Court picked up on the core of our claim. As Justice Scalia
11887 asked Solicitor General Olson,
11891 justice scalia: You say that the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11892 time would be a violation [of the Constitution], but that's precisely
11893 the argument that's being made by petitioners here, that a limited
11894 time which is extendable is the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11899 When Olson was finished, it was my turn to give a closing rebuttal.
11900 Olson's flailing had revived my anger. But my anger still was directed
11901 to the academic, not the practical. The government was arguing as if
11902 this were the first case ever to consider limits on Congress's
11903 Copyright and Patent Clause power. Ever the professor and not the
11904 advocate, I closed by pointing out the long history of the Court
11905 imposing limits on Congress's power in the name of the Copyright and
11906 Patent Clause
— indeed, the very first case striking a law of
11907 Congress as exceeding a specific enumerated power was based upon the
11908 Copyright and Patent Clause. All true. But it wasn't going to move the
11912 <emphasis role='strong'
>As I left
</emphasis> the court that day, I
11913 knew there were a hundred points I wished I could remake. There were a
11914 hundred questions I wished I had
11916 <!-- PAGE BREAK 248 -->
11917 answered differently. But one way of thinking about this case left me
11921 The government had been asked over and over again, what is the limit?
11922 Over and over again, it had answered there is no limit. This was
11923 precisely the answer I wanted the Court to hear. For I could not
11924 imagine how the Court could understand that the government believed
11925 Congress's power was unlimited under the terms of the Copyright
11926 Clause, and sustain the government's argument. The solicitor general
11927 had made my argument for me. No matter how often I tried, I could not
11928 understand how the Court could find that Congress's power under the
11929 Commerce Clause was limited, but under the Copyright Clause,
11930 unlimited. In those rare moments when I let myself believe that we may
11931 have prevailed, it was because I felt this Court
—in particular,
11932 the Conservatives
—would feel itself constrained by the rule of
11933 law that it had established elsewhere.
11936 <emphasis role='strong'
>The morning
</emphasis> of January
15,
2003, I
11937 was five minutes late to the office and missed the
7:
00 A.M. call from
11938 the Supreme Court clerk. Listening to the message, I could tell in an
11939 instant that she had bad news to report.The Supreme Court had affirmed
11940 the decision of the Court of Appeals. Seven justices had voted in the
11941 majority. There were two dissents.
11944 A few seconds later, the opinions arrived by e-mail. I took the
11945 phone off the hook, posted an announcement to our blog, and sat
11946 down to see where I had been wrong in my reasoning.
11949 My
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. Here was a case that pitted all the
11950 money in the world against
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. And here
11951 was the last naïve law professor, scouring the pages, looking for
11955 I first scoured the opinion, looking for how the Court would
11956 distinguish the principle in this case from the principle in
11957 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The argument was nowhere to be found. The case was not even
11958 cited. The argument that was the core argument of our case did not
11959 even appear in the Court's opinion.
11961 <indexterm><primary>Ginsburg, Ruth Bader
</primary></indexterm>
11964 <!-- PAGE BREAK 249 -->
11965 Justice Ginsburg simply ignored the enumerated powers argument.
11966 Consistent with her view that Congress's power was not limited
11967 generally, she had found Congress's power not limited here.
11970 Her opinion was perfectly reasonable
—for her, and for Justice
11971 Souter. Neither believes in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. It would be too much to expect them
11972 to write an opinion that recognized, much less explained, the doctrine
11973 they had worked so hard to defeat.
11976 But as I realized what had happened, I couldn't quite believe what I
11977 was reading. I had said there was no way this Court could reconcile
11978 limited powers with the Commerce Clause and unlimited powers with the
11979 Progress Clause. It had never even occurred to me that they could
11980 reconcile the two simply
<emphasis>by not addressing the
11981 argument
</emphasis>. There was no inconsistency because they would not
11982 talk about the two together. There was therefore no principle that
11983 followed from the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case: In that context, Congress's power would
11984 be limited, but in this context it would not.
11987 Yet by what right did they get to choose which of the framers' values
11988 they would respect? By what right did they
—the silent
11989 five
—get to select the part of the Constitution they would
11990 enforce based on the values they thought important? We were right back
11991 to the argument that I said I hated at the start: I had failed to
11992 convince them that the issue here was important, and I had failed to
11993 recognize that however much I might hate a system in which the Court
11994 gets to pick the constitutional values that it will respect, that is
11995 the system we have.
11997 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11999 Justices Breyer and Stevens wrote very strong dissents. Stevens's
12000 opinion was crafted internal to the law: He argued that the tradition
12001 of intellectual property law should not support this unjustified
12002 extension of terms. He based his argument on a parallel analysis that
12003 had governed in the context of patents (so had we). But the rest of
12004 the Court discounted the parallel
—without explaining how the
12005 very same words in the Progress Clause could come to mean totally
12006 different things depending upon whether the words were about patents
12007 or copyrights. The Court let Justice Stevens's charge go unanswered.
12009 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
12011 <!-- PAGE BREAK 250 -->
12012 Justice Breyer's opinion, perhaps the best opinion he has ever
12013 written, was external to the Constitution. He argued that the term of
12014 copyrights has become so long as to be effectively unlimited. We had
12015 said that under the current term, a copyright gave an author
99.8
12016 percent of the value of a perpetual term. Breyer said we were wrong,
12017 that the actual number was
99.9997 percent of a perpetual term. Either
12018 way, the point was clear: If the Constitution said a term had to be
12019 <quote>limited,
</quote> and the existing term was so long as to be effectively
12020 unlimited, then it was unconstitutional.
12023 These two justices understood all the arguments we had made. But
12024 because neither believed in the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case, neither was willing to push
12025 it as a reason to reject this extension. The case was decided without
12026 anyone having addressed the argument that we had carried from Judge
12027 Sentelle. It was
<citetitle>Hamlet
</citetitle> without the Prince.
12030 <emphasis role='strong'
>Defeat brings depression
</emphasis>. They say
12031 it is a sign of health when depression gives way to anger. My anger
12032 came quickly, but it didn't cure the depression. This anger was of two
12035 <indexterm><primary>originalism
</primary></indexterm>
12037 It was first anger with the five
<quote>Conservatives.
</quote> It would have been
12038 one thing for them to have explained why the principle of
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> didn't
12039 apply in this case. That wouldn't have been a very convincing
12040 argument, I don't believe, having read it made by others, and having
12041 tried to make it myself. But it at least would have been an act of
12042 integrity. These justices in particular have repeatedly said that the
12043 proper mode of interpreting the Constitution is
<quote>originalism
</quote>—to
12044 first understand the framers' text, interpreted in their context, in
12045 light of the structure of the Constitution. That method had produced
12046 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> and many other
<quote>originalist
</quote> rulings. Where was their
12047 <quote>originalism
</quote> now?
12050 Here, they had joined an opinion that never once tried to explain
12051 what the framers had meant by crafting the Progress Clause as they
12052 did; they joined an opinion that never once tried to explain how the
12053 structure of that clause would affect the interpretation of Congress's
12055 <!-- PAGE BREAK 251 -->
12056 power. And they joined an opinion that didn't even try to explain why
12057 this grant of power could be unlimited, whereas the Commerce Clause
12058 would be limited. In short, they had joined an opinion that did not
12059 apply to, and was inconsistent with, their own method for interpreting
12060 the Constitution. This opinion may well have yielded a result that
12061 they liked. It did not produce a reason that was consistent with their
12065 My anger with the Conservatives quickly yielded to anger with
12067 For I had let a view of the law that I liked interfere with a view of
12070 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
12072 Most lawyers, and most law professors, have little patience for
12073 idealism about courts in general and this Supreme Court in particular.
12074 Most have a much more pragmatic view. When Don Ayer said that this
12075 case would be won based on whether I could convince the Justices that
12076 the framers' values were important, I fought the idea, because I
12077 didn't want to believe that that is how this Court decides. I insisted
12078 on arguing this case as if it were a simple application of a set of
12079 principles. I had an argument that followed in logic. I didn't need
12080 to waste my time showing it should also follow in popularity.
12083 As I read back over the transcript from that argument in October, I
12084 can see a hundred places where the answers could have taken the
12085 conversation in different directions, where the truth about the harm
12086 that this unchecked power will cause could have been made clear to
12087 this Court. Justice Kennedy in good faith wanted to be shown. I,
12088 idiotically, corrected his question. Justice Souter in good faith
12089 wanted to be shown the First Amendment harms. I, like a math teacher,
12090 reframed the question to make the logical point. I had shown them how
12091 they could strike this law of Congress if they wanted to. There were a
12092 hundred places where I could have helped them want to, yet my
12093 stubbornness, my refusal to give in, stopped me. I have stood before
12094 hundreds of audiences trying to persuade; I have used passion in that
12095 effort to persuade; but I
12096 <!-- PAGE BREAK 252 -->
12097 refused to stand before this audience and try to persuade with the
12098 passion I had used elsewhere. It was not the basis on which a court
12099 should decide the issue.
12101 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
12103 Would it have been different if I had argued it differently? Would it
12104 have been different if Don Ayer had argued it? Or Charles Fried? Or
12106 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
12109 My friends huddled around me to insist it would not. The Court
12110 was not ready, my friends insisted. This was a loss that was destined. It
12111 would take a great deal more to show our society why our framers were
12112 right. And when we do that, we will be able to show that Court.
12115 Maybe, but I doubt it. These Justices have no financial interest in
12116 doing anything except the right thing. They are not lobbied. They have
12117 little reason to resist doing right. I can't help but think that if I had
12118 stepped down from this pretty picture of dispassionate justice, I could
12122 And even if I couldn't, then that doesn't excuse what happened in
12123 January. For at the start of this case, one of America's leading
12124 intellectual property professors stated publicly that my bringing this
12125 case was a mistake.
<quote>The Court is not ready,
</quote> Peter Jaszi said; this
12126 issue should not be raised until it is.
12127 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12130 After the argument and after the decision, Peter said to me, and
12131 publicly, that he was wrong. But if indeed that Court could not have
12132 been persuaded, then that is all the evidence that's needed to know that
12133 here again Peter was right. Either I was not ready to argue this case in
12134 a way that would do some good or they were not ready to hear this case
12135 in a way that would do some good. Either way, the decision to bring
12136 this case
—a decision I had made four years before
—was wrong.
12139 <emphasis role='strong'
>While the reaction
</emphasis> to the Sonny
12140 Bono Act itself was almost unanimously negative, the reaction to the
12141 Court's decision was mixed. No one, at least in the press, tried to
12142 say that extending the term of copyright was a good idea. We had won
12143 that battle over ideas. Where
12145 <!-- PAGE BREAK 253 -->
12146 the decision was praised, it was praised by papers that had been
12147 skeptical of the Court's activism in other cases. Deference was a good
12148 thing, even if it left standing a silly law. But where the decision
12149 was attacked, it was attacked because it left standing a silly and
12150 harmful law.
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> wrote in its editorial,
12154 In effect, the Supreme Court's decision makes it likely that we are
12155 seeing the beginning of the end of public domain and the birth of
12156 copyright perpetuity. The public domain has been a grand experiment,
12157 one that should not be allowed to die. The ability to draw freely on
12158 the entire creative output of humanity is one of the reasons we live
12159 in a time of such fruitful creative ferment.
12163 The best responses were in the cartoons. There was a gaggle of
12164 hilarious images
—of Mickey in jail and the like. The best, from
12165 my view of the case, was Ruben Bolling's, reproduced on the next page
12166 (
<xref linkend=
"fig-18"/>). The
<quote>powerful and wealthy
</quote> line is a bit
12167 unfair. But the punch in the face felt exactly like that.
12168 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben
</primary></indexterm>
12170 <figure id=
"fig-18">
12171 <title>Tom the Dancing Bug cartoon
</title>
12172 <graphic fileref=
"images/18.png"></graphic>
12173 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben
</primary></indexterm>
12176 The image that will always stick in my head is that evoked by the
12177 quote from
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>. That
<quote>grand experiment
</quote> we call the
12178 <quote>public domain
</quote> is over? When I can make light of it, I think,
<quote>Honey,
12179 I shrunk the Constitution.
</quote> But I can rarely make light of it. We had
12180 in our Constitution a commitment to free culture. In the case that I
12181 fathered, the Supreme Court effectively renounced that commitment. A
12182 better lawyer would have made them see differently.
12184 <!-- PAGE BREAK 254 -->
12186 <chapter label=
"14" id=
"eldred-ii">
12187 <title>CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
</title>
12189 <emphasis role='strong'
>The day
</emphasis>
12190 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was decided, fate would have it that I
12191 was to travel to Washington, D.C. (The day the rehearing petition in
12192 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was denied
—meaning the case was
12193 really finally over
—fate would have it that I was giving a
12194 speech to technologists at Disney World.) This was a particularly
12195 long flight to my least favorite city. The drive into the city from
12196 Dulles was delayed because of traffic, so I opened up my computer and
12197 wrote an op-ed piece.
12199 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
12201 It was an act of contrition. During the whole of the flight from San
12202 Francisco to Washington, I had heard over and over again in my head
12203 the same advice from Don Ayer: You need to make them see why it is
12204 important. And alternating with that command was the question of
12205 Justice Kennedy:
<quote>For all these years the act has impeded progress in
12206 science and the useful arts. I just don't see any empirical evidence for
12207 that.
</quote> And so, having failed in the argument of constitutional principle,
12208 finally, I turned to an argument of politics.
12211 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> published the piece. In it, I proposed a simple
12212 fix: Fifty years after a work has been published, the copyright owner
12213 <!-- PAGE BREAK 256 -->
12214 would be required to register the work and pay a small fee. If he paid
12215 the fee, he got the benefit of the full term of copyright. If he did not,
12216 the work passed into the public domain.
12219 We called this the Eldred Act, but that was just to give it a name.
12220 Eric Eldred was kind enough to let his name be used once again, but as
12221 he said early on, it won't get passed unless it has another name.
12224 Or another two names. For depending upon your perspective, this
12225 is either the
<quote>Public Domain Enhancement Act
</quote> or the
<quote>Copyright
12226 Term Deregulation Act.
</quote> Either way, the essence of the idea is clear
12227 and obvious: Remove copyright where it is doing nothing except
12228 blocking access and the spread of knowledge. Leave it for as long as
12229 Congress allows for those works where its worth is at least $
1. But for
12230 everything else, let the content go.
12232 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
12234 The reaction to this idea was amazingly strong. Steve Forbes endorsed
12235 it in an editorial. I received an avalanche of e-mail and letters
12236 expressing support. When you focus the issue on lost creativity,
12237 people can see the copyright system makes no sense. As a good
12238 Republican might say, here government regulation is simply getting in
12239 the way of innovation and creativity. And as a good Democrat might
12240 say, here the government is blocking access and the spread of
12241 knowledge for no good reason. Indeed, there is no real difference
12242 between Democrats and Republicans on this issue. Anyone can recognize
12243 the stupid harm of the present system.
12246 Indeed, many recognized the obvious benefit of the registration
12247 requirement. For one of the hardest things about the current system
12248 for people who want to license content is that there is no obvious
12249 place to look for the current copyright owners. Since registration is
12250 not required, since marking content is not required, since no
12251 formality at all is required, it is often impossibly hard to locate
12252 copyright owners to ask permission to use or license their work. This
12253 system would lower these costs, by establishing at least one registry
12254 where copyright owners could be identified.
12256 <indexterm><primary>Berlin Act (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12257 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12259 <!-- PAGE BREAK 257 -->
12260 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
12261 linkend=
"property-i"/>, formalities in copyright law were
12262 removed in
1976, when Congress followed the Europeans by abandoning
12263 any formal requirement before a copyright is granted.
<footnote><para>
12265 <indexterm><primary>German copyright law
</primary></indexterm>
12266 Until the
1908 Berlin Act of the Berne Convention, national copyright
12267 legislation sometimes made protection depend upon compliance with
12268 formalities such as registration, deposit, and affixation of notice of
12269 the author's claim of copyright. However, starting with the
1908 act,
12270 every text of the Convention has provided that
<quote>the enjoyment and the
12271 exercise
</quote> of rights guaranteed by the Convention
<quote>shall not be subject
12272 to any formality.
</quote> The prohibition against formalities is presently
12273 embodied in Article
5(
2) of the Paris Text of the Berne
12274 Convention. Many countries continue to impose some form of deposit or
12275 registration requirement, albeit not as a condition of
12276 copyright. French law, for example, requires the deposit of copies of
12277 works in national repositories, principally the National Museum.
12278 Copies of books published in the United Kingdom must be deposited in
12279 the British Library. The German Copyright Act provides for a Registrar
12280 of Authors where the author's true name can be filed in the case of
12281 anonymous or pseudonymous works. Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>International
12282 Intellectual Property Law, Cases and Materials
</citetitle> (New York: Foundation
12283 Press,
2001),
153–54.
</para></footnote>
12284 The Europeans are said to view copyright as a
<quote>natural right.
</quote> Natural
12285 rights don't need forms to exist. Traditions, like the Anglo-American
12286 tradition that required copyright owners to follow form if their
12287 rights were to be protected, did not, the Europeans thought, properly
12288 respect the dignity of the author. My right as a creator turns on my
12289 creativity, not upon the special favor of the government.
12292 That's great rhetoric. It sounds wonderfully romantic. But it is
12293 absurd copyright policy. It is absurd especially for authors, because
12294 a world without formalities harms the creator. The ability to spread
12295 <quote>Walt Disney creativity
</quote> is destroyed when there is no simple way to
12296 know what's protected and what's not.
12298 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12300 The fight against formalities achieved its first real victory in
12301 Berlin in
1908. International copyright lawyers amended the Berne
12302 Convention in
1908, to require copyright terms of life plus fifty
12303 years, as well as the abolition of copyright formalities. The
12304 formalities were hated because the stories of inadvertent loss were
12305 increasingly common. It was as if a Charles Dickens character ran all
12306 copyright offices, and the failure to dot an
<citetitle>i
</citetitle> or cross a
12307 <citetitle>t
</citetitle> resulted in the loss of widows' only income.
12310 These complaints were real and sensible. And the strictness of the
12311 formalities, especially in the United States, was absurd. The law
12312 should always have ways of forgiving innocent mistakes. There is no
12313 reason copyright law couldn't, as well. Rather than abandoning
12314 formalities totally, the response in Berlin should have been to
12315 embrace a more equitable system of registration.
12318 Even that would have been resisted, however, because registration
12319 in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries was still expensive. It was
12320 also a hassle. The abolishment of formalities promised not only to save
12321 the starving widows, but also to lighten an unnecessary regulatory
12323 imposed upon creators.
12326 In addition to the practical complaint of authors in
1908, there was
12327 a moral claim as well. There was no reason that creative property
12329 <!-- PAGE BREAK 258 -->
12330 should be a second-class form of property. If a carpenter builds a
12331 table, his rights over the table don't depend upon filing a form with
12332 the government. He has a property right over the table
<quote>naturally,
</quote>
12333 and he can assert that right against anyone who would steal the table,
12334 whether or not he has informed the government of his ownership of the
12338 This argument is correct, but its implications are misleading. For the
12339 argument in favor of formalities does not depend upon creative
12340 property being second-class property. The argument in favor of
12341 formalities turns upon the special problems that creative property
12342 presents. The law of formalities responds to the special physics of
12343 creative property, to assure that it can be efficiently and fairly
12347 No one thinks, for example, that land is second-class property just
12348 because you have to register a deed with a court if your sale of land
12349 is to be effective. And few would think a car is second-class property
12350 just because you must register the car with the state and tag it with
12351 a license. In both of those cases, everyone sees that there is an
12352 important reason to secure registration
—both because it makes
12353 the markets more efficient and because it better secures the rights of
12354 the owner. Without a registration system for land, landowners would
12355 perpetually have to guard their property. With registration, they can
12356 simply point the police to a deed. Without a registration system for
12357 cars, auto theft would be much easier. With a registration system, the
12358 thief has a high burden to sell a stolen car. A slight burden is
12359 placed on the property owner, but those burdens produce a much better
12360 system of protection for property generally.
12363 It is similarly special physics that makes formalities important in
12364 copyright law. Unlike a carpenter's table, there's nothing in nature that
12365 makes it relatively obvious who might own a particular bit of creative
12366 property. A recording of Lyle Lovett's latest album can exist in a billion
12367 places without anything necessarily linking it back to a particular
12368 owner. And like a car, there's no way to buy and sell creative property
12369 with confidence unless there is some simple way to authenticate who is
12370 the author and what rights he has. Simple transactions are destroyed in
12372 <!-- PAGE BREAK 259 -->
12373 a world without formalities. Complex, expensive,
12374 <emphasis>lawyer
</emphasis> transactions take their place.
12375 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
12378 This was the understanding of the problem with the Sonny Bono
12379 Act that we tried to demonstrate to the Court. This was the part it
12380 didn't
<quote>get.
</quote> Because we live in a system without formalities, there is no
12381 way easily to build upon or use culture from our past. If copyright
12382 terms were, as Justice Story said they would be,
<quote>short,
</quote> then this
12383 wouldn't matter much. For fourteen years, under the framers' system, a
12384 work would be presumptively controlled. After fourteen years, it would
12385 be presumptively uncontrolled.
12388 But now that copyrights can be just about a century long, the
12389 inability to know what is protected and what is not protected becomes
12390 a huge and obvious burden on the creative process. If the only way a
12391 library can offer an Internet exhibit about the New Deal is to hire a
12392 lawyer to clear the rights to every image and sound, then the
12393 copyright system is burdening creativity in a way that has never been
12394 seen before
<emphasis>because there are no formalities
</emphasis>.
12397 The Eldred Act was designed to respond to exactly this problem. If
12398 it is worth $
1 to you, then register your work and you can get the
12399 longer term. Others will know how to contact you and, therefore, how
12400 to get your permission if they want to use your work. And you will get
12401 the benefit of an extended copyright term.
12404 If it isn't worth it to you to register to get the benefit of an extended
12405 term, then it shouldn't be worth it for the government to defend your
12406 monopoly over that work either. The work should pass into the public
12407 domain where anyone can copy it, or build archives with it, or create a
12408 movie based on it. It should become free if it is not worth $
1 to you.
12411 Some worry about the burden on authors. Won't the burden of
12412 registering the work mean that the $
1 is really misleading? Isn't the
12413 hassle worth more than $
1? Isn't that the real problem with
12417 It is. The hassle is terrible. The system that exists now is awful. I
12418 completely agree that the Copyright Office has done a terrible job (no
12419 doubt because they are terribly funded) in enabling simple and cheap
12421 <!-- PAGE BREAK 260 -->
12422 registrations. Any real solution to the problem of formalities must
12423 address the real problem of
<emphasis>governments
</emphasis> standing
12424 at the core of any system of formalities. In this book, I offer such a
12425 solution. That solution essentially remakes the Copyright Office. For
12426 now, assume it was Amazon that ran the registration system. Assume it
12427 was one-click registration. The Eldred Act would propose a simple,
12428 one-click registration fifty years after a work was published. Based
12429 upon historical data, that system would move up to
98 percent of
12430 commercial work, commercial work that no longer had a commercial life,
12431 into the public domain within fifty years. What do you think?
12433 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
12435 <emphasis role='strong'
>When Steve Forbes
</emphasis> endorsed the
12436 idea, some in Washington began to pay attention. Many people contacted
12437 me pointing to representatives who might be willing to introduce the
12438 Eldred Act. And I had a few who directly suggested that they might be
12439 willing to take the first step.
12442 One representative, Zoe Lofgren of California, went so far as to get
12443 the bill drafted. The draft solved any problem with international
12444 law. It imposed the simplest requirement upon copyright owners
12445 possible. In May
2003, it looked as if the bill would be
12446 introduced. On May
16, I posted on the Eldred Act blog,
<quote>we are
12447 close.
</quote> There was a general reaction in the blog community that
12448 something good might happen here.
12449 <indexterm><primary>Lofgren, Zoe
</primary></indexterm>
12452 But at this stage, the lobbyists began to intervene. Jack Valenti and
12453 the MPAA general counsel came to the congresswoman's office to give
12454 the view of the MPAA. Aided by his lawyer, as Valenti told me, Valenti
12455 informed the congresswoman that the MPAA would oppose the Eldred
12456 Act. The reasons are embarrassingly thin. More importantly, their
12457 thinness shows something clear about what this debate is really about.
12460 The MPAA argued first that Congress had
<quote>firmly rejected the central
12461 concept in the proposed bill
</quote>—that copyrights be renewed. That
12462 was true, but irrelevant, as Congress's
<quote>firm rejection
</quote> had occurred
12463 <!-- PAGE BREAK 261 -->
12464 long before the Internet made subsequent uses much more likely.
12465 Second, they argued that the proposal would harm poor copyright
12466 owners
—apparently those who could not afford the $
1 fee. Third,
12467 they argued that Congress had determined that extending a copyright
12468 term would encourage restoration work. Maybe in the case of the small
12469 percentage of work covered by copyright law that is still commercially
12470 valuable, but again this was irrelevant, as the proposal would not cut
12471 off the extended term unless the $
1 fee was not paid. Fourth, the MPAA
12472 argued that the bill would impose
<quote>enormous
</quote> costs, since a
12473 registration system is not free. True enough, but those costs are
12474 certainly less than the costs of clearing the rights for a copyright
12475 whose owner is not known. Fifth, they worried about the risks if the
12476 copyright to a story underlying a film were to pass into the public
12477 domain. But what risk is that? If it is in the public domain, then the
12478 film is a valid derivative use.
12481 Finally, the MPAA argued that existing law enabled copyright owners to
12482 do this if they wanted. But the whole point is that there are
12483 thousands of copyright owners who don't even know they have a
12484 copyright to give. Whether they are free to give away their copyright
12485 or not
—a controversial claim in any case
—unless they know
12486 about a copyright, they're not likely to.
12489 <emphasis role='strong'
>At the beginning
</emphasis> of this book, I
12490 told two stories about the law reacting to changes in technology. In
12491 the one, common sense prevailed. In the other, common sense was
12492 delayed. The difference between the two stories was the power of the
12493 opposition
—the power of the side that fought to defend the
12494 status quo. In both cases, a new technology threatened old
12495 interests. But in only one case did those interest's have the power to
12496 protect themselves against this new competitive threat.
12499 I used these two cases as a way to frame the war that this book has
12500 been about. For here, too, a new technology is forcing the law to react.
12501 And here, too, we should ask, is the law following or resisting common
12502 sense? If common sense supports the law, what explains this common
12507 <!-- PAGE BREAK 262 -->
12508 When the issue is piracy, it is right for the law to back the
12509 copyright owners. The commercial piracy that I described is wrong and
12510 harmful, and the law should work to eliminate it. When the issue is
12511 p2p sharing, it is easy to understand why the law backs the owners
12512 still: Much of this sharing is wrong, even if much is harmless. When
12513 the issue is copyright terms for the Mickey Mouses of the world, it is
12514 possible still to understand why the law favors Hollywood: Most people
12515 don't recognize the reasons for limiting copyright terms; it is thus
12516 still possible to see good faith within the resistance.
12518 <indexterm><primary>Kelly, Kevin
</primary></indexterm>
12520 But when the copyright owners oppose a proposal such as the Eldred
12521 Act, then, finally, there is an example that lays bare the naked
12522 selfinterest driving this war. This act would free an extraordinary
12523 range of content that is otherwise unused. It wouldn't interfere with
12524 any copyright owner's desire to exercise continued control over his
12525 content. It would simply liberate what Kevin Kelly calls the
<quote>Dark
12526 Content
</quote> that fills archives around the world. So when the warriors
12527 oppose a change like this, we should ask one simple question:
12530 What does this industry really want?
12533 With very little effort, the warriors could protect their content. So
12534 the effort to block something like the Eldred Act is not really about
12535 protecting
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> content. The effort to block the
12536 Eldred Act is an effort to assure that nothing more passes into the
12537 public domain. It is another step to assure that the public domain
12538 will never compete, that there will be no use of content that is not
12539 commercially controlled, and that there will be no commercial use of
12540 content that doesn't require
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> permission
12544 The opposition to the Eldred Act reveals how extreme the other side
12545 is. The most powerful and sexy and well loved of lobbies really has as
12546 its aim not the protection of
<quote>property
</quote> but the rejection of a
12547 tradition. Their aim is not simply to protect what is
12548 theirs.
<emphasis>Their aim is to assure that all there is is what is
12552 It is not hard to understand why the warriors take this view. It is not
12553 hard to see why it would benefit them if the competition of the public
12555 <!-- PAGE BREAK 263 -->
12556 domain tied to the Internet could somehow be quashed. Just as RCA
12557 feared the competition of FM, they fear the competition of a public
12558 domain connected to a public that now has the means to create with it
12559 and to share its own creation.
12561 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12562 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12564 What is hard to understand is why the public takes this view. It is
12565 as if the law made airplanes trespassers. The MPAA stands with the
12566 Causbys and demands that their remote and useless property rights be
12567 respected, so that these remote and forgotten copyright holders might
12568 block the progress of others.
12571 All this seems to follow easily from this untroubled acceptance of the
12572 <quote>property
</quote> in intellectual property. Common sense supports it, and so
12573 long as it does, the assaults will rain down upon the technologies of
12574 the Internet. The consequence will be an increasing
<quote>permission
12575 society.
</quote> The past can be cultivated only if you can identify the
12576 owner and gain permission to build upon his work. The future will be
12577 controlled by this dead (and often unfindable) hand of the past.
12579 <!-- PAGE BREAK 264 -->
12582 <chapter label=
"15" id=
"c-conclusion">
12583 <title>CONCLUSION
</title>
12584 <indexterm id=
"idxantiretroviraldrugs" class='startofrange'
>
12585 <primary>antiretroviral drugs
</primary>
12587 <indexterm id=
"idxhivaidstherapies" class='startofrange'
>
12588 <primary>HIV/AIDS therapies
</primary>
12590 <indexterm id=
"idxafricahivmed" class='startofrange'
>
12591 <primary>Africa, medications for HIV patients in
</primary>
12594 <emphasis role='strong'
>There are more
</emphasis> than
35 million
12595 people with the AIDS virus worldwide. Twenty-five million of them live
12596 in sub-Saharan Africa. Seventeen million have already died. Seventeen
12597 million Africans is proportional percentage-wise to seven million
12598 Americans. More importantly, it is seventeen million Africans.
12601 There is no cure for AIDS, but there are drugs to slow its
12602 progression. These antiretroviral therapies are still experimental,
12603 but they have already had a dramatic effect. In the United States,
12604 AIDS patients who regularly take a cocktail of these drugs increase
12605 their life expectancy by ten to twenty years. For some, the drugs make
12606 the disease almost invisible.
12609 These drugs are expensive. When they were first introduced in the
12610 United States, they cost between $
10,
000 and $
15,
000 per person per
12611 year. Today, some cost $
25,
000 per year. At these prices, of course, no
12612 African nation can afford the drugs for the vast majority of its
12614 $
15,
000 is thirty times the per capita gross national product of
12615 Zimbabwe. At these prices, the drugs are totally unavailable.
<footnote><para>
12616 <!-- f1. --> Commission on Intellectual Property Rights,
<quote>Final Report: Integrating
12617 Intellectual Property Rights and Development Policy
</quote> (London,
2002),
12619 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
55</ulink>. According to a World Health Organization press
12621 issued
9 July
2002, only
230,
000 of the
6 million who need drugs in
12622 the developing world receive them
—and half of them are in Brazil.
12626 <!-- PAGE BREAK 265 -->
12627 These prices are not high because the ingredients of the drugs are
12628 expensive. These prices are high because the drugs are protected by
12629 patents. The drug companies that produced these life-saving mixes
12630 enjoy at least a twenty-year monopoly for their inventions. They use
12631 that monopoly power to extract the most they can from the market. That
12632 power is in turn used to keep the prices high.
12635 There are many who are skeptical of patents, especially drug
12636 patents. I am not. Indeed, of all the areas of research that might be
12637 supported by patents, drug research is, in my view, the clearest case
12638 where patents are needed. The patent gives the drug company some
12639 assurance that if it is successful in inventing a new drug to treat a
12640 disease, it will be able to earn back its investment and more. This is
12641 socially an extremely valuable incentive. I am the last person who
12642 would argue that the law should abolish it, at least without other
12646 But it is one thing to support patents, even drug patents. It is
12647 another thing to determine how best to deal with a crisis. And as
12648 African leaders began to recognize the devastation that AIDS was
12649 bringing, they started looking for ways to import HIV treatments at
12650 costs significantly below the market price.
12653 In
1997, South Africa tried one tack. It passed a law to allow the
12654 importation of patented medicines that had been produced or sold in
12655 another nation's market with the consent of the patent owner. For
12656 example, if the drug was sold in India, it could be imported into
12657 Africa from India. This is called
<quote>parallel importation,
</quote> and it is
12658 generally permitted under international trade law and is specifically
12659 permitted within the European Union.
<footnote>
12662 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism: Who
12663 Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The New Press,
2003),
37.
12664 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12665 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12669 However, the United States government opposed the bill. Indeed, more
12670 than opposed. As the International Intellectual Property Association
12671 characterized it,
<quote>The U.S. government pressured South Africa
…
12672 not to permit compulsory licensing or parallel
12673 imports.
</quote><footnote><para>
12675 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12676 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12677 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12678 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
14, available at
12679 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
56</ulink>. For a
12680 firsthand account of the struggle over South Africa, see Hearing
12681 Before the Subcommittee on Criminal Justice, Drug Policy, and Human
12682 Resources, House Committee on Government Reform, H. Rep.,
1st sess.,
12683 Ser. No.
106-
126 (
22 July
1999),
150–57 (statement of James
12686 Through the Office of the United States Trade Representative, the
12687 government asked South Africa to change the law
—and to add
12688 pressure to that request, in
1998, the USTR listed South Africa for
12689 possible trade sanctions.
12690 <!-- PAGE BREAK 266 -->
12691 That same year, more than forty pharmaceutical companies began
12692 proceedings in the South African courts to challenge the government's
12693 actions. The United States was then joined by other governments from
12694 the EU. Their claim, and the claim of the pharmaceutical companies,
12695 was that South Africa was violating its obligations under
12696 international law by discriminating against a particular kind of
12697 patent
— pharmaceutical patents. The demand of these governments,
12698 with the United States in the lead, was that South Africa respect
12699 these patents as it respects any other patent, regardless of any
12700 effect on the treatment of AIDS within South Africa.
<footnote><para>
12702 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12703 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12704 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12705 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
15.
</para></footnote>
12708 We should place the intervention by the United States in context. No
12709 doubt patents are not the most important reason that Africans don't
12710 have access to drugs. Poverty and the total absence of an effective
12711 health care infrastructure matter more. But whether patents are the
12712 most important reason or not, the price of drugs has an effect on
12713 their demand, and patents affect price. And so, whether massive or
12714 marginal, there was an effect from our government's intervention to
12715 stop the flow of medications into Africa.
12718 By stopping the flow of HIV treatment into Africa, the United
12719 States government was not saving drugs for United States citizens.
12720 This is not like wheat (if they eat it, we can't); instead, the flow that the
12721 United States intervened to stop was, in effect, a flow of knowledge:
12722 information about how to take chemicals that exist within Africa, and
12723 turn those chemicals into drugs that would save
15 to
30 million lives.
12726 Nor was the intervention by the United States going to protect the
12727 profits of United States drug companies
—at least, not substantially. It
12728 was not as if these countries were in the position to buy the drugs for
12729 the prices the drug companies were charging. Again, the Africans are
12730 wildly too poor to afford these drugs at the offered prices. Stopping the
12731 parallel import of these drugs would not substantially increase the sales
12735 Instead, the argument in favor of restricting this flow of
12736 information, which was needed to save the lives of millions, was an
12738 <!-- PAGE BREAK 267 -->
12739 about the sanctity of property.
<footnote><para>
12741 See Sabin Russell,
<quote>New Crusade to Lower AIDS Drug Costs: Africa's
12742 Needs at Odds with Firms' Profit Motive,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24
12743 May
1999, A1, available at
12744 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
57</ulink>
12745 (
<quote>compulsory licenses and gray markets pose a threat to the entire
12746 system of intellectual property protection
</quote>); Robert Weissman,
<quote>AIDS
12747 and Developing Countries: Democratizing Access to Essential
12748 Medicines,
</quote> <citetitle>Foreign Policy in Focus
</citetitle> 4:
23 (August
1999), available at
12749 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
58</ulink>
12750 (describing U.S. policy); John A. Harrelson,
<quote>TRIPS, Pharmaceutical
12751 Patents, and the HIV/AIDS Crisis: Finding the Proper Balance Between
12752 Intellectual Property Rights and Compassion, a Synopsis,
</quote> <citetitle>Widener Law
12753 Symposium Journal
</citetitle> (Spring
2001):
175.
12754 <!-- PAGE BREAK 333 -->
12756 It was because
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> would be violated that these
12757 drugs should not flow into Africa. It was a principle about the
12758 importance of
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> that led these government actors
12759 to intervene against the South African response to AIDS.
12762 Now just step back for a moment. There will be a time thirty years
12763 from now when our children look back at us and ask, how could we have
12764 let this happen? How could we allow a policy to be pursued whose
12765 direct cost would be to speed the death of
15 to
30 million Africans,
12766 and whose only real benefit would be to uphold the
<quote>sanctity
</quote> of an
12767 idea? What possible justification could there ever be for a policy
12768 that results in so many deaths? What exactly is the insanity that
12769 would allow so many to die for such an abstraction?
12772 Some blame the drug companies. I don't. They are corporations.
12773 Their managers are ordered by law to make money for the corporation.
12774 They push a certain patent policy not because of ideals, but because it is
12775 the policy that makes them the most money. And it only makes them the
12776 most money because of a certain corruption within our political system
—
12777 a corruption the drug companies are certainly not responsible for.
12780 The corruption is our own politicians' failure of integrity. For the
12781 drug companies would love
—they say, and I believe them
—to
12782 sell their drugs as cheaply as they can to countries in Africa and
12783 elsewhere. There are issues they'd have to resolve to make sure the
12784 drugs didn't get back into the United States, but those are mere
12785 problems of technology. They could be overcome.
12788 A different problem, however, could not be overcome. This is the
12789 fear of the grandstanding politician who would call the presidents of
12790 the drug companies before a Senate or House hearing, and ask,
<quote>How
12791 is it you can sell this HIV drug in Africa for only $
1 a pill, but the same
12792 drug would cost an American $
1,
500?
</quote> Because there is no
<quote>sound
12793 bite
</quote> answer to that question, its effect would be to induce regulation
12794 of prices in America. The drug companies thus avoid this spiral by
12795 avoiding the first step. They reinforce the idea that property should be
12796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 268 -->
12797 sacred. They adopt a rational strategy in an irrational context, with the
12798 unintended consequence that perhaps millions die. And that rational
12799 strategy thus becomes framed in terms of this ideal
—the sanctity of an
12800 idea called
<quote>intellectual property.
</quote>
12803 So when the common sense of your child confronts you, what will
12804 you say? When the common sense of a generation finally revolts
12805 against what we have done, how will we justify what we have done?
12806 What is the argument?
12809 A sensible patent policy could endorse and strongly support the patent
12810 system without having to reach everyone everywhere in exactly the same
12811 way. Just as a sensible copyright policy could endorse and strongly
12812 support a copyright system without having to regulate the spread of
12813 culture perfectly and forever, a sensible patent policy could endorse
12814 and strongly support a patent system without having to block the
12815 spread of drugs to a country not rich enough to afford market prices
12816 in any case. A sensible policy, in other words, could be a balanced
12817 policy. For most of our history, both copyright and patent policies
12818 were balanced in just this sense.
12821 But we as a culture have lost this sense of balance. We have lost the
12822 critical eye that helps us see the difference between truth and
12823 extremism. A certain property fundamentalism, having no connection to
12824 our tradition, now reigns in this culture
—bizarrely, and with
12825 consequences more grave to the spread of ideas and culture than almost
12826 any other single policy decision that we as a democracy will make.
12828 <indexterm startref=
"idxafricahivmed" class='endofrange'
/>
12829 <indexterm startref=
"idxhivaidstherapies" class='endofrange'
/>
12830 <indexterm startref=
"idxantiretroviraldrugs" class='endofrange'
/>
12832 <emphasis role='strong'
>A simple idea
</emphasis> blinds us, and under
12833 the cover of darkness, much happens that most of us would reject if
12834 any of us looked. So uncritically do we accept the idea of property in
12835 ideas that we don't even notice how monstrous it is to deny ideas to a
12836 people who are dying without them. So uncritically do we accept the
12837 idea of property in culture that we don't even question when the
12838 control of that property removes our
12839 <!-- PAGE BREAK 269 -->
12840 ability, as a people, to develop our culture democratically. Blindness
12841 becomes our common sense. And the challenge for anyone who would
12842 reclaim the right to cultivate our culture is to find a way to make
12843 this common sense open its eyes.
12846 So far, common sense sleeps. There is no revolt. Common sense
12847 does not yet see what there could be to revolt about. The extremism
12848 that now dominates this debate fits with ideas that seem natural, and
12849 that fit is reinforced by the RCAs of our day. They wage a frantic war
12850 to fight
<quote>piracy,
</quote> and devastate a culture for creativity. They defend
12851 the idea of
<quote>creative property,
</quote> while transforming real creators into
12852 modern-day sharecroppers. They are insulted by the idea that rights
12853 should be balanced, even though each of the major players in this
12854 content war was itself a beneficiary of a more balanced ideal. The
12855 hypocrisy reeks. Yet in a city like Washington, hypocrisy is not even
12856 noticed. Powerful lobbies, complex issues, and MTV attention spans
12857 produce the
<quote>perfect storm
</quote> for free culture.
12859 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
12860 <indexterm id='idxbiomedicalresearch' class='startofrange'
>
12861 <primary>biomedical research
</primary>
12863 <indexterm><primary>Wellcome Trust
</primary></indexterm>
12865 <emphasis role='strong'
>In August
2003</emphasis>, a fight broke out
12866 in the United States about a decision by the World Intellectual
12867 Property Organization to cancel a meeting.
<footnote><para>
12868 <!-- f6. --> Jonathan Krim,
<quote>The Quiet War over Open-Source,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
12869 August
2003, E1, available at
12870 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
59</ulink>; William New,
<quote>Global Group's
12871 Shift on `Open Source' Meeting Spurs Stir,
</quote> <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12872 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12873 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
60</ulink>; William New,
<quote>U.S. Official
12874 Opposes `Open Source' Talks at WIPO,
</quote> <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12875 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12876 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
61</ulink>.
12878 At the request of a wide range of interests, WIPO had decided to hold
12879 a meeting to discuss
<quote>open and collaborative projects to create public
12880 goods.
</quote> These are projects that have been successful in producing
12881 public goods without relying exclusively upon a proprietary use of
12882 intellectual property. Examples include the Internet and the World
12883 Wide Web, both of which were developed on the basis of protocols in
12884 the public domain. It included an emerging trend to support open
12885 academic journals, including the Public Library of Science project
12886 that I describe in the Afterword. It included a project to develop
12887 single nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs), which are thought to have
12888 great significance in biomedical research. (That nonprofit project
12889 comprised a consortium of the Wellcome Trust and pharmaceutical and
12890 technological companies, including Amersham Biosciences, AstraZeneca,
12891 <!-- PAGE BREAK 270 -->
12892 Aventis, Bayer, Bristol-Myers Squibb, Hoffmann-La Roche,
12893 Glaxo-SmithKline, IBM, Motorola, Novartis, Pfizer, and Searle.) It
12894 included the Global Positioning System, which Ronald Reagan set free
12895 in the early
1980s. And it included
<quote>open source and free software.
</quote>
12896 <indexterm><primary>academic journals
</primary></indexterm>
12897 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
12898 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
12900 <indexterm startref='idxbiomedicalresearch' class='endofrange'
/>
12902 The aim of the meeting was to consider this wide range of projects
12903 from one common perspective: that none of these projects relied upon
12904 intellectual property extremism. Instead, in all of them, intellectual
12905 property was balanced by agreements to keep access open or to impose
12906 limitations on the way in which proprietary claims might be used.
12909 From the perspective of this book, then, the conference was ideal.
<footnote><para>
12910 <!-- f7. --> I should disclose that I was one of the people who asked WIPO for the
12913 The projects within its scope included both commercial and
12914 noncommercial work. They primarily involved science, but from many
12915 perspectives. And WIPO was an ideal venue for this discussion, since
12916 WIPO is the preeminent international body dealing with intellectual
12920 Indeed, I was once publicly scolded for not recognizing this fact
12921 about WIPO. In February
2003, I delivered a keynote address to a
12922 preparatory conference for the World Summit on the Information Society
12923 (WSIS). At a press conference before the address, I was asked what I
12924 would say. I responded that I would be talking a little about the
12925 importance of balance in intellectual property for the development of
12926 an information society. The moderator for the event then promptly
12927 interrupted to inform me and the assembled reporters that no question
12928 about intellectual property would be discussed by WSIS, since those
12929 questions were the exclusive domain of WIPO. In the talk that I had
12930 prepared, I had actually made the issue of intellectual property
12931 relatively minor. But after this astonishing statement, I made
12932 intellectual property the sole focus of my talk. There was no way to
12933 talk about an
<quote>Information Society
</quote> unless one also talked about the
12934 range of information and culture that would be free. My talk did not
12935 make my immoderate moderator very happy. And she was no doubt correct
12936 that the scope of intellectual property protections was ordinarily the
12938 <!-- PAGE BREAK 271 -->
12939 WIPO. But in my view, there couldn't be too much of a conversation
12940 about how much intellectual property is needed, since in my view, the
12941 very idea of balance in intellectual property had been lost.
12944 So whether or not WSIS can discuss balance in intellectual property, I
12945 had thought it was taken for granted that WIPO could and should. And
12946 thus the meeting about
<quote>open and collaborative projects to create
12947 public goods
</quote> seemed perfectly appropriate within the WIPO agenda.
12950 But there is one project within that list that is highly
12951 controversial, at least among lobbyists. That project is
<quote>open source
12952 and free software.
</quote> Microsoft in particular is wary of discussion of
12953 the subject. From its perspective, a conference to discuss open source
12954 and free software would be like a conference to discuss Apple's
12955 operating system. Both open source and free software compete with
12956 Microsoft's software. And internationally, many governments have begun
12957 to explore requirements that they use open source or free software,
12958 rather than
<quote>proprietary software,
</quote> for their own internal uses.
12961 I don't mean to enter that debate here. It is important only to
12962 make clear that the distinction is not between commercial and
12963 noncommercial software. There are many important companies that depend
12964 fundamentally upon open source and free software, IBM being the most
12965 prominent. IBM is increasingly shifting its focus to the GNU/Linux
12966 operating system, the most famous bit of
<quote>free software
</quote>—and IBM
12967 is emphatically a commercial entity. Thus, to support
<quote>open source and
12968 free software
</quote> is not to oppose commercial entities. It is, instead,
12969 to support a mode of software development that is different from
12970 Microsoft's.
<footnote><para>
12972 Microsoft's position about free and open source software is more
12973 sophisticated. As it has repeatedly asserted, it has no problem with
12974 <quote>open source
</quote> software or software in the public domain. Microsoft's
12975 principal opposition is to
<quote>free software
</quote> licensed under a
<quote>copyleft
</quote>
12976 license, meaning a license that requires the licensee to adopt the
12977 same terms on any derivative work. See Bradford L. Smith,
<quote>The Future
12978 of Software: Enabling the Marketplace to Decide,
</quote> <citetitle>Government Policy
12979 Toward Open Source Software
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.: AEI-Brookings Joint
12980 Center for Regulatory Studies, American Enterprise Institute for
12981 Public Policy Research,
2002),
69, available at
12982 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
62</ulink>. See also
12983 Craig Mundie, Microsoft senior vice president,
<citetitle>The Commercial Software
12984 Model
</citetitle>, discussion at New York University Stern School of Business (
3
12985 May
2001), available at
12986 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
63</ulink>.
12988 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
12989 <indexterm><primary><quote>copyleft
</quote> licenses
</primary></indexterm>
12990 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
12991 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
12994 More important for our purposes, to support
<quote>open source and free
12995 software
</quote> is not to oppose copyright.
<quote>Open source and free software
</quote>
12996 is not software in the public domain. Instead, like Microsoft's
12997 software, the copyright owners of free and open source software insist
12998 quite strongly that the terms of their software license be respected
13000 <!-- PAGE BREAK 272 -->
13001 adopters of free and open source software. The terms of that license
13002 are no doubt different from the terms of a proprietary software
13003 license. Free software licensed under the General Public License
13004 (GPL), for example, requires that the source code for the software be
13005 made available by anyone who modifies and redistributes the
13006 software. But that requirement is effective only if copyright governs
13007 software. If copyright did not govern software, then free software
13008 could not impose the same kind of requirements on its adopters. It
13009 thus depends upon copyright law just as Microsoft does.
13012 It is therefore understandable that as a proprietary software
13013 developer, Microsoft would oppose this WIPO meeting, and
13014 understandable that it would use its lobbyists to get the United
13015 States government to oppose it, as well. And indeed, that is just what
13016 was reported to have happened. According to Jonathan Krim of the
13017 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>, Microsoft's lobbyists succeeded in getting the United
13018 States government to veto the meeting.
<footnote><para>
13020 Krim,
<quote>The Quiet War over Open-Source,
</quote> available at
<ulink
13021 url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
64</ulink>.
13023 And without U.S. backing, the meeting was canceled.
13024 <indexterm><primary>Krim, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
13027 I don't blame Microsoft for doing what it can to advance its own
13028 interests, consistent with the law. And lobbying governments is
13029 plainly consistent with the law. There was nothing surprising about
13030 its lobbying here, and nothing terribly surprising about the most
13031 powerful software producer in the United States having succeeded in
13032 its lobbying efforts.
13034 <indexterm><primary>Boland, Lois
</primary></indexterm>
13036 What was surprising was the United States government's reason for
13037 opposing the meeting. Again, as reported by Krim, Lois Boland, acting
13038 director of international relations for the U.S. Patent and Trademark
13039 Office, explained that
<quote>open-source software runs counter to the
13040 mission of WIPO, which is to promote intellectual-property rights.
</quote>
13041 She is quoted as saying,
<quote>To hold a meeting which has as its purpose
13042 to disclaim or waive such rights seems to us to be contrary to the
13043 goals of WIPO.
</quote>
13046 These statements are astonishing on a number of levels.
13048 <!-- PAGE BREAK 273 -->
13050 First, they are just flat wrong. As I described, most open source and
13051 free software relies fundamentally upon the intellectual property
13052 right called
<quote>copyright
</quote>. Without it, restrictions imposed by those
13053 licenses wouldn't work. Thus, to say it
<quote>runs counter
</quote> to the mission
13054 of promoting intellectual property rights reveals an extraordinary gap
13055 in understanding
—the sort of mistake that is excusable in a
13056 first-year law student, but an embarrassment from a high government
13057 official dealing with intellectual property issues.
13059 <indexterm><primary>generic drugs
</primary></indexterm>
13061 Second, who ever said that WIPO's exclusive aim was to
<quote>promote
</quote>
13062 intellectual property maximally? As I had been scolded at the
13063 preparatory conference of WSIS, WIPO is to consider not only how best
13064 to protect intellectual property, but also what the best balance of
13065 intellectual property is. As every economist and lawyer knows, the
13066 hard question in intellectual property law is to find that
13067 balance. But that there should be limits is, I had thought,
13068 uncontested. One wants to ask Ms. Boland, are generic drugs (drugs
13069 based on drugs whose patent has expired) contrary to the WIPO mission?
13070 Does the public domain weaken intellectual property? Would it have
13071 been better if the protocols of the Internet had been patented?
13073 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
13075 Third, even if one believed that the purpose of WIPO was to maximize
13076 intellectual property rights, in our tradition, intellectual property
13077 rights are held by individuals and corporations. They get to decide
13078 what to do with those rights because, again, they are
13079 <emphasis>their
</emphasis> rights. If they want to
<quote>waive
</quote> or
13080 <quote>disclaim
</quote> their rights, that is, within our tradition, totally
13081 appropriate. When Bill Gates gives away more than $
20 billion to do
13082 good in the world, that is not inconsistent with the objectives of the
13083 property system. That is, on the contrary, just what a property system
13084 is supposed to be about: giving individuals the right to decide what
13085 to do with
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> property.
13087 <indexterm id='idxboland' class='startofrange'
>
13088 <primary>Boland, Lois
</primary>
13091 When Ms. Boland says that there is something wrong with a meeting
13092 <quote>which has as its purpose to disclaim or waive such rights,
</quote> she's
13093 saying that WIPO has an interest in interfering with the choices of
13094 <!-- PAGE BREAK 274 -->
13095 the individuals who own intellectual property rights. That somehow,
13096 WIPO's objective should be to stop an individual from
<quote>waiving
</quote> or
13097 <quote>disclaiming
</quote> an intellectual property right. That the interest of
13098 WIPO is not just that intellectual property rights be maximized, but
13099 that they also should be exercised in the most extreme and restrictive
13103 There is a history of just such a property system that is well known
13104 in the Anglo-American tradition. It is called
<quote>feudalism.
</quote> Under
13105 feudalism, not only was property held by a relatively small number of
13106 individuals and entities. And not only were the rights that ran with
13107 that property powerful and extensive. But the feudal system had a
13108 strong interest in assuring that property holders within that system
13109 not weaken feudalism by liberating people or property within their
13110 control to the free market. Feudalism depended upon maximum control
13111 and concentration. It fought any freedom that might interfere with
13114 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
13115 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
13117 As Peter Drahos and John Braithwaite relate, this is precisely the
13118 choice we are now making about intellectual property.
<footnote><para>
13120 See Drahos with Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism
</citetitle>,
210–20.
13121 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
13123 We will have an information society. That much is certain. Our only
13124 choice now is whether that information society will be
13125 <emphasis>free
</emphasis> or
<emphasis>feudal
</emphasis>. The trend is
13129 When this battle broke, I blogged it. A spirited debate within the
13130 comment section ensued. Ms. Boland had a number of supporters who
13131 tried to show why her comments made sense. But there was one comment
13132 that was particularly depressing for me. An anonymous poster wrote,
13136 George, you misunderstand Lessig: He's only talking about the world as
13137 it should be (
<quote>the goal of WIPO, and the goal of any government,
13138 should be to promote the right balance of intellectual property rights,
13139 not simply to promote intellectual property rights
</quote>), not as it is. If
13140 we were talking about the world as it is, then of course Boland didn't
13141 say anything wrong. But in the world
13142 <!-- PAGE BREAK 275 -->
13143 as Lessig would have it, then of course she did. Always pay attention
13144 to the distinction between Lessig's world and ours.
13148 I missed the irony the first time I read it. I read it quickly and
13149 thought the poster was supporting the idea that seeking balance was
13150 what our government should be doing. (Of course, my criticism of Ms.
13151 Boland was not about whether she was seeking balance or not; my
13152 criticism was that her comments betrayed a first-year law student's
13153 mistake. I have no illusion about the extremism of our government,
13154 whether Republican or Democrat. My only illusion apparently is about
13155 whether our government should speak the truth or not.)
13157 <indexterm startref='idxboland' class='endofrange'
/>
13159 Obviously, however, the poster was not supporting that idea. Instead,
13160 the poster was ridiculing the very idea that in the real world, the
13161 <quote>goal
</quote> of a government should be
<quote>to promote the right balance
</quote> of
13162 intellectual property. That was obviously silly to him. And it
13163 obviously betrayed, he believed, my own silly utopianism.
<quote>Typical for
13164 an academic,
</quote> the poster might well have continued.
13167 I understand criticism of academic utopianism. I think utopianism is
13168 silly, too, and I'd be the first to poke fun at the absurdly
13169 unrealistic ideals of academics throughout history (and not just in
13170 our own country's history).
13173 But when it has become silly to suppose that the role of our
13174 government should be to
<quote>seek balance,
</quote> then count me with the silly,
13175 for that means that this has become quite serious indeed. If it should
13176 be obvious to everyone that the government does not seek balance, that
13177 the government is simply the tool of the most powerful lobbyists, that
13178 the idea of holding the government to a different standard is absurd,
13179 that the idea of demanding of the government that it speak truth and
13180 not lies is just na
ïve, then who have we, the most powerful
13181 democracy in the world, become?
13184 It might be crazy to expect a high government official to speak
13185 the truth. It might be crazy to believe that government policy will be
13186 something more than the handmaiden of the most powerful interests.
13187 <!-- PAGE BREAK 276 -->
13188 It might be crazy to argue that we should preserve a tradition that has
13189 been part of our tradition for most of our history
—free culture.
13191 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
13192 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
13193 <indexterm><primary>Turner, Ted
</primary></indexterm>
13195 If this is crazy, then let there be more crazies. Soon.
13198 <emphasis role='strong'
>There are moments
</emphasis> of hope in this
13199 struggle. And moments that surprise. When the FCC was considering
13200 relaxing ownership rules, which would thereby further increase the
13201 concentration in media ownership, an extraordinary bipartisan
13202 coalition formed to fight this change. For perhaps the first time in
13203 history, interests as diverse as the NRA, the ACLU, Moveon.org,
13204 William Safire, Ted Turner, and CodePink Women for Peace organized to
13205 oppose this change in FCC policy. An astonishing
700,
000 letters were
13206 sent to the FCC, demanding more hearings and a different result.
13209 This activism did not stop the FCC, but soon after, a broad coalition
13210 in the Senate voted to reverse the FCC decision. The hostile hearings
13211 leading up to that vote revealed just how powerful this movement had
13212 become. There was no substantial support for the FCC's decision, and
13213 there was broad and sustained support for fighting further
13214 concentration in the media.
13217 But even this movement misses an important piece of the puzzle.
13218 Largeness as such is not bad. Freedom is not threatened just because
13219 some become very rich, or because there are only a handful of big
13220 players. The poor quality of Big Macs or Quarter Pounders does not
13221 mean that you can't get a good hamburger from somewhere else.
13224 The danger in media concentration comes not from the concentration,
13225 but instead from the feudalism that this concentration, tied to the
13226 change in copyright, produces. It is not just that there are a few
13227 powerful companies that control an ever expanding slice of the
13228 media. It is that this concentration can call upon an equally bloated
13229 range of rights
—property rights of a historically extreme
13230 form
—that makes their bigness bad.
13232 <!-- PAGE BREAK 277 -->
13234 It is therefore significant that so many would rally to demand
13235 competition and increased diversity. Still, if the rally is understood
13236 as being about bigness alone, it is not terribly surprising. We
13237 Americans have a long history of fighting
<quote>big,
</quote> wisely or not. That
13238 we could be motivated to fight
<quote>big
</quote> again is not something new.
13241 It would be something new, and something very important, if an equal
13242 number could be rallied to fight the increasing extremism built within
13243 the idea of
<quote>intellectual property.
</quote> Not because balance is alien to
13244 our tradition; indeed, as I've argued, balance is our tradition. But
13245 because the muscle to think critically about the scope of anything
13246 called
<quote>property
</quote> is not well exercised within this tradition anymore.
13249 If we were Achilles, this would be our heel. This would be the place
13252 <indexterm><primary>Dylan, Bob
</primary></indexterm>
13254 <emphasis role='strong'
>As I write
</emphasis> these final words, the
13255 news is filled with stories about the RIAA lawsuits against almost
13256 three hundred individuals.
<footnote><para>
13258 John Borland,
<quote>RIAA Sues
261 File Swappers,
</quote> CNET News.com, September
13260 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
65</ulink>; Paul
13261 R. La Monica,
<quote>Music Industry Sues Swappers,
</quote> CNN/Money,
8 September
13263 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
66</ulink>; Soni
13264 Sangha and Phyllis Furman with Robert Gearty,
<quote>Sued for a Song,
13265 N.Y.C.
12-Yr-Old Among
261 Cited as Sharers,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Daily News
</citetitle>,
9
13266 September
2003,
3; Frank Ahrens,
<quote>RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised
13267 Targets; Single Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among
13268 Defendants,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Katie Dean,
13269 <quote>Schoolgirl Settles with RIAA,
</quote> <citetitle>Wired News
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003,
13271 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
67</ulink>.
13273 Eminem has just been sued for
<quote>sampling
</quote> someone else's
13274 music.
<footnote><para>
13276 Jon Wiederhorn,
<quote>Eminem Gets Sued
… by a Little Old Lady,
</quote>
13277 mtv.com,
17 September
2003, available at
13278 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
68</ulink>.
13280 The story about Bob Dylan
<quote>stealing
</quote> from a Japanese author has just
13281 finished making the rounds.
<footnote><para>
13283 Kenji Hall, Associated Press,
<quote>Japanese Book May Be Inspiration for
13284 Dylan Songs,
</quote> Kansascity.com,
9 July
2003, available at
13285 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
69</ulink>.
13286 <!-- PAGE BREAK 334 -->
13288 An insider from Hollywood
—who insists he must remain
13289 anonymous
—reports
<quote>an amazing conversation with these studio
13290 guys. They've got extraordinary [old] content that they'd love to use
13291 but can't because they can't begin to clear the rights. They've got
13292 scores of kids who could do amazing things with the content, but it
13293 would take scores of lawyers to clean it first.
</quote> Congressmen are
13294 talking about deputizing computer viruses to bring down computers
13295 thought to violate the law. Universities are threatening expulsion for
13296 kids who use a computer to share content.
13298 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
13299 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
13300 <indexterm><primary>Creative Commons
</primary></indexterm>
13301 <indexterm><primary>Gil, Gilberto
</primary></indexterm>
13302 <indexterm><primary>BBC
</primary></indexterm>
13303 <indexterm><primary>Brazil, free culture in
</primary></indexterm>
13305 Yet on the other side of the Atlantic, the BBC has just announced
13306 that it will build a
<quote>Creative Archive,
</quote> from which British citizens can
13307 download BBC content, and rip, mix, and burn it.
<footnote><para>
13308 <!-- f14. --> <quote>BBC Plans to Open Up Its Archive to the Public,
</quote> BBC press release,
13309 24 August
2003, available at
13310 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
70</ulink>.
13312 And in Brazil, the culture minister, Gilberto Gil, himself a folk hero
13313 of Brazilian music, has joined with Creative Commons to release
13314 content and free licenses in that Latin American
13315 country.
<footnote><para>
13317 <quote>Creative Commons and Brazil,
</quote> Creative Commons Weblog,
6 August
2003,
13319 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
71</ulink>.
13321 <!-- PAGE BREAK 278 -->
13322 I've told a dark story. The truth is more mixed. A technology has
13323 given us a new freedom. Slowly, some begin to understand that this
13324 freedom need not mean anarchy. We can carry a free culture into the
13325 twenty-first century, without artists losing and without the potential of
13326 digital technology being destroyed. It will take some thought, and
13327 more importantly, it will take some will to transform the RCAs of our
13328 day into the Causbys.
13331 Common sense must revolt. It must act to free culture. Soon, if this
13332 potential is ever to be realized.
13334 <!-- PAGE BREAK 279 -->
13338 <chapter label=
"16" id=
"c-afterword">
13339 <title>AFTERWORD
</title>
13342 <!-- PAGE BREAK 280 -->
13343 <emphasis role='strong'
>At least some
</emphasis> who have read this
13344 far will agree with me that something must be done to change where we
13345 are heading. The balance of this book maps what might be done.
13348 I divide this map into two parts: that which anyone can do now,
13349 and that which requires the help of lawmakers. If there is one lesson
13350 that we can draw from the history of remaking common sense, it is that
13351 it requires remaking how many people think about the very same issue.
13354 That means this movement must begin in the streets. It must recruit a
13355 significant number of parents, teachers, librarians, creators,
13356 authors, musicians, filmmakers, scientists
—all to tell this
13357 story in their own words, and to tell their neighbors why this battle
13361 Once this movement has its effect in the streets, it has some hope of
13362 having an effect in Washington. We are still a democracy. What people
13363 think matters. Not as much as it should, at least when an RCA stands
13364 opposed, but still, it matters. And thus, in the second part below, I
13365 sketch changes that Congress could make to better secure a free culture.
13367 <!-- PAGE BREAK 281 -->
13369 <section id=
"usnow">
13370 <title>US, NOW
</title>
13372 <emphasis role='strong'
>Common sense
</emphasis> is with the copyright
13373 warriors because the debate so far has been framed at the
13374 extremes
—as a grand either/or: either property or anarchy,
13375 either total control or artists won't be paid. If that really is the
13376 choice, then the warriors should win.
13379 The mistake here is the error of the excluded middle. There are
13380 extremes in this debate, but the extremes are not all that there
13381 is. There are those who believe in maximal copyright
—<quote>All Rights
13382 Reserved
</quote>— and those who reject copyright
—<quote>No Rights
13383 Reserved.
</quote> The
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts believe that you should ask
13384 permission before you
<quote>use
</quote> a copyrighted work in any way. The
<quote>No
13385 Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts believe you should be able to do with content
13386 as you wish, regardless of whether you have permission or not.
13389 When the Internet was first born, its initial architecture effectively
13390 tilted in the
<quote>no rights reserved
</quote> direction. Content could be copied
13391 perfectly and cheaply; rights could not easily be controlled. Thus,
13392 regardless of anyone's desire, the effective regime of copyright under
13395 <!-- PAGE BREAK 282 -->
13396 original design of the Internet was
<quote>no rights reserved.
</quote> Content was
13397 <quote>taken
</quote> regardless of the rights. Any rights were effectively
13401 This initial character produced a reaction (opposite, but not quite
13402 equal) by copyright owners. That reaction has been the topic of this
13403 book. Through legislation, litigation, and changes to the network's
13404 design, copyright holders have been able to change the essential
13405 character of the environment of the original Internet. If the original
13406 architecture made the effective default
<quote>no rights reserved,
</quote> the
13407 future architecture will make the effective default
<quote>all rights
13408 reserved.
</quote> The architecture and law that surround the Internet's
13409 design will increasingly produce an environment where all use of
13410 content requires permission. The
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> world that defines
13411 the Internet today will become a
<quote>get permission to cut and paste
</quote>
13412 world that is a creator's nightmare.
13415 What's needed is a way to say something in the middle
—neither
13416 <quote>all rights reserved
</quote> nor
<quote>no rights reserved
</quote> but
<quote>some rights
13417 reserved
</quote>— and thus a way to respect copyrights but enable
13418 creators to free content as they see fit. In other words, we need a
13419 way to restore a set of freedoms that we could just take for granted
13423 <section id=
"examples">
13424 <title>Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
</title>
13426 If you step back from the battle I've been describing here, you will
13427 recognize this problem from other contexts. Think about
13428 privacy. Before the Internet, most of us didn't have to worry much
13429 about data about our lives that we broadcast to the world. If you
13430 walked into a bookstore and browsed through some of the works of Karl
13431 Marx, you didn't need to worry about explaining your browsing habits
13432 to your neighbors or boss. The
<quote>privacy
</quote> of your browsing habits was
13436 What made it assured?
13438 <!-- PAGE BREAK 283 -->
13440 Well, if we think in terms of the modalities I described in chapter
13441 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>, your
13442 privacy was assured because of an inefficient architecture for
13443 gathering data and hence a market constraint (cost) on anyone who
13444 wanted to gather that data. If you were a suspected spy for North
13445 Korea, working for the CIA, no doubt your privacy would not be
13446 assured. But that's because the CIA would (we hope) find it valuable
13447 enough to spend the thousands required to track you. But for most of
13448 us (again, we can hope), spying doesn't pay. The highly inefficient
13449 architecture of real space means we all enjoy a fairly robust amount
13450 of privacy. That privacy is guaranteed to us by friction. Not by law
13451 (there is no law protecting
<quote>privacy
</quote> in public places), and in many
13452 places, not by norms (snooping and gossip are just fun), but instead,
13453 by the costs that friction imposes on anyone who would want to spy.
13455 <indexterm><primary>Amazon
</primary></indexterm>
13457 Enter the Internet, where the cost of tracking browsing in particular
13458 has become quite tiny. If you're a customer at Amazon, then as you
13459 browse the pages, Amazon collects the data about what you've looked
13460 at. You know this because at the side of the page, there's a list of
13461 <quote>recently viewed
</quote> pages. Now, because of the architecture of the Net
13462 and the function of cookies on the Net, it is easier to collect the
13463 data than not. The friction has disappeared, and hence any
<quote>privacy
</quote>
13464 protected by the friction disappears, too.
13465 <indexterm><primary>cookies, Internet
</primary></indexterm>
13468 Amazon, of course, is not the problem. But we might begin to worry
13469 about libraries. If you're one of those crazy lefties who thinks that
13470 people should have the
<quote>right
</quote> to browse in a library without the
13471 government knowing which books you look at (I'm one of those lefties,
13472 too), then this change in the technology of monitoring might concern
13473 you. If it becomes simple to gather and sort who does what in
13474 electronic spaces, then the friction-induced privacy of yesterday
13478 It is this reality that explains the push of many to define
<quote>privacy
</quote>
13479 on the Internet. It is the recognition that technology can remove what
13480 friction before gave us that leads many to push for laws to do what
13481 friction did.
<footnote><para>
13484 See, for example, Marc Rotenberg,
<quote>Fair Information Practices and the
13485 Architecture of Privacy (What Larry Doesn't Get),
</quote> <citetitle>Stanford Technology
13486 Law Review
</citetitle> 1 (
2001): par.
6–18, available at
13488 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>
13489 (describing examples in which technology defines privacy policy). See
13490 also Jeffrey Rosen,
<citetitle>The Naked Crowd: Reclaiming Security and Freedom
13491 in an Anxious Age
</citetitle> (New York: Random House,
2004) (mapping tradeoffs
13492 between technology and privacy).
</para></footnote>
13493 And whether you're in favor of those laws or not, it is the pattern
13494 that is important here. We must take affirmative steps to secure a
13496 <!-- PAGE BREAK 284 -->
13497 kind of freedom that was passively provided before. A change in
13498 technology now forces those who believe in privacy to affirmatively
13499 act where, before, privacy was given by default.
13502 A similar story could be told about the birth of the free software
13503 movement. When computers with software were first made available
13504 commercially, the software
—both the source code and the
13505 binaries
— was free. You couldn't run a program written for a
13506 Data General machine on an IBM machine, so Data General and IBM didn't
13507 care much about controlling their software.
13508 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
13510 <indexterm><primary>Stallman, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
13512 That was the world Richard Stallman was born into, and while he was a
13513 researcher at MIT, he grew to love the community that developed when
13514 one was free to explore and tinker with the software that ran on
13515 machines. Being a smart sort himself, and a talented programmer,
13516 Stallman grew to depend upon the freedom to add to or modify other
13520 In an academic setting, at least, that's not a terribly radical
13521 idea. In a math department, anyone would be free to tinker with a
13522 proof that someone offered. If you thought you had a better way to
13523 prove a theorem, you could take what someone else did and change
13524 it. In a classics department, if you believed a colleague's
13525 translation of a recently discovered text was flawed, you were free to
13526 improve it. Thus, to Stallman, it seemed obvious that you should be
13527 free to tinker with and improve the code that ran a machine. This,
13528 too, was knowledge. Why shouldn't it be open for criticism like
13532 No one answered that question. Instead, the architecture of revenue
13533 for computing changed. As it became possible to import programs from
13534 one system to another, it became economically attractive (at least in
13535 the view of some) to hide the code of your program. So, too, as
13536 companies started selling peripherals for mainframe systems. If I
13537 could just take your printer driver and copy it, then that would make
13538 it easier for me to sell a printer to the market than it was for you.
13541 Thus, the practice of proprietary code began to spread, and by the
13542 early
1980s, Stallman found himself surrounded by proprietary code.
13543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 285 -->
13544 The world of free software had been erased by a change in the
13545 economics of computing. And as he believed, if he did nothing about
13546 it, then the freedom to change and share software would be
13547 fundamentally weakened.
13549 <indexterm><primary>Torvalds, Linus
</primary></indexterm>
13551 Therefore, in
1984, Stallman began a project to build a free operating
13552 system, so that at least a strain of free software would survive. That
13553 was the birth of the GNU project, into which Linus Torvalds's
<quote>Linux
</quote>
13554 kernel was added to produce the GNU/Linux operating system.
13555 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
13556 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
13559 Stallman's technique was to use copyright law to build a world of
13560 software that must be kept free. Software licensed under the Free
13561 Software Foundation's GPL cannot be modified and distributed unless
13562 the source code for that software is made available as well. Thus,
13563 anyone building upon GPL'd software would have to make their buildings
13564 free as well. This would assure, Stallman believed, that an ecology of
13565 code would develop that remained free for others to build upon. His
13566 fundamental goal was freedom; innovative creative code was a
13570 Stallman was thus doing for software what privacy advocates now
13571 do for privacy. He was seeking a way to rebuild a kind of freedom that
13572 was taken for granted before. Through the affirmative use of licenses
13573 that bind copyrighted code, Stallman was affirmatively reclaiming a
13574 space where free software would survive. He was actively protecting
13575 what before had been passively guaranteed.
13578 Finally, consider a very recent example that more directly resonates
13579 with the story of this book. This is the shift in the way academic and
13580 scientific journals are produced.
13582 <indexterm id=
"idxacademocjournals" class='startofrange'
>
13583 <primary>academic journals
</primary>
13586 As digital technologies develop, it is becoming obvious to many that
13587 printing thousands of copies of journals every month and sending them
13588 to libraries is perhaps not the most efficient way to distribute
13589 knowledge. Instead, journals are increasingly becoming electronic, and
13590 libraries and their users are given access to these electronic
13591 journals through password-protected sites. Something similar to this
13592 has been happening in law for almost thirty years: Lexis and Westlaw
13593 have had electronic versions of case reports available to subscribers
13594 to their service. Although a Supreme Court opinion is not
13595 copyrighted, and anyone is free to go to a library and read it, Lexis
13596 and Westlaw are also free
13597 <!-- PAGE BREAK 286 -->
13598 to charge users for the privilege of gaining access to that Supreme
13599 Court opinion through their respective services.
13602 There's nothing wrong in general with this, and indeed, the ability to
13603 charge for access to even public domain materials is a good incentive
13604 for people to develop new and innovative ways to spread knowledge.
13605 The law has agreed, which is why Lexis and Westlaw have been allowed
13606 to flourish. And if there's nothing wrong with selling the public
13607 domain, then there could be nothing wrong, in principle, with selling
13608 access to material that is not in the public domain.
13611 But what if the only way to get access to social and scientific data
13612 was through proprietary services? What if no one had the ability to
13613 browse this data except by paying for a subscription?
13616 As many are beginning to notice, this is increasingly the reality with
13617 scientific journals. When these journals were distributed in paper
13618 form, libraries could make the journals available to anyone who had
13619 access to the library. Thus, patients with cancer could become cancer
13620 experts because the library gave them access. Or patients trying to
13621 understand the risks of a certain treatment could research those risks
13622 by reading all available articles about that treatment. This freedom
13623 was therefore a function of the institution of libraries (norms) and
13624 the technology of paper journals (architecture)
—namely, that it
13625 was very hard to control access to a paper journal.
13628 As journals become electronic, however, the publishers are demanding
13629 that libraries not give the general public access to the
13630 journals. This means that the freedoms provided by print journals in
13631 public libraries begin to disappear. Thus, as with privacy and with
13632 software, a changing technology and market shrink a freedom taken for
13636 This shrinking freedom has led many to take affirmative steps to
13637 restore the freedom that has been lost. The Public Library of Science
13638 (PLoS), for example, is a nonprofit corporation dedicated to making
13639 scientific research available to anyone with a Web connection. Authors
13640 <!-- PAGE BREAK 287 -->
13641 of scientific work submit that work to the Public Library of Science.
13642 That work is then subject to peer review. If accepted, the work is
13643 then deposited in a public, electronic archive and made permanently
13644 available for free. PLoS also sells a print version of its work, but
13645 the copyright for the print journal does not inhibit the right of
13646 anyone to redistribute the work for free.
13647 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
13650 This is one of many such efforts to restore a freedom taken for
13651 granted before, but now threatened by changing technology and markets.
13652 There's no doubt that this alternative competes with the traditional
13653 publishers and their efforts to make money from the exclusive
13654 distribution of content. But competition in our tradition is
13655 presumptively a good
—especially when it helps spread knowledge
13658 <indexterm startref=
"idxacademocjournals" class='endofrange'
/>
13661 <section id=
"oneidea">
13662 <title>Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
</title>
13663 <indexterm id=
"idxcc" class='startofrange'
>
13664 <primary>Creative Commons
</primary>
13667 The same strategy could be applied to culture, as a response to the
13668 increasing control effected through law and technology.
13670 <indexterm><primary>Stanford University
</primary></indexterm>
13672 Enter the Creative Commons. The Creative Commons is a nonprofit
13673 corporation established in Massachusetts, but with its home at
13674 Stanford University. Its aim is to build a layer of
13675 <emphasis>reasonable
</emphasis> copyright on top of the extremes that
13676 now reign. It does this by making it easy for people to build upon
13677 other people's work, by making it simple for creators to express the
13678 freedom for others to take and build upon their work. Simple tags,
13679 tied to human-readable descriptions, tied to bulletproof licenses,
13680 make this possible.
13683 <emphasis>Simple
</emphasis>—which means without a middleman, or
13684 without a lawyer. By developing a free set of licenses that people
13685 can attach to their content, Creative Commons aims to mark a range of
13686 content that can easily, and reliably, be built upon. These tags are
13687 then linked to machine-readable versions of the license that enable
13688 computers automatically to identify content that can easily be
13689 shared. These three expressions together
—a legal license, a
13690 human-readable description, and
13691 <!-- PAGE BREAK 288 -->
13692 machine-readable tags
—constitute a Creative Commons license. A
13693 Creative Commons license constitutes a grant of freedom to anyone who
13694 accesses the license, and more importantly, an expression of the ideal
13695 that the person associated with the license believes in something
13696 different than the
<quote>All
</quote> or
<quote>No
</quote> extremes. Content is marked with the
13697 CC mark, which does not mean that copyright is waived, but that
13698 certain freedoms are given.
13701 These freedoms are beyond the freedoms promised by fair use. Their
13702 precise contours depend upon the choices the creator makes. The
13703 creator can choose a license that permits any use, so long as
13704 attribution is given. She can choose a license that permits only
13705 noncommercial use. She can choose a license that permits any use so
13706 long as the same freedoms are given to other uses (
<quote>share and share
13707 alike
</quote>). Or any use so long as no derivative use is made. Or any use
13708 at all within developing nations. Or any sampling use, so long as full
13709 copies are not made. Or lastly, any educational use.
13712 These choices thus establish a range of freedoms beyond the default of
13713 copyright law. They also enable freedoms that go beyond traditional
13714 fair use. And most importantly, they express these freedoms in a way
13715 that subsequent users can use and rely upon without the need to hire a
13716 lawyer. Creative Commons thus aims to build a layer of content,
13717 governed by a layer of reasonable copyright law, that others can build
13718 upon. Voluntary choice of individuals and creators will make this
13719 content available. And that content will in turn enable us to rebuild
13723 This is just one project among many within the Creative Commons. And
13724 of course, Creative Commons is not the only organization pursuing such
13725 freedoms. But the point that distinguishes the Creative Commons from
13726 many is that we are not interested only in talking about a public
13727 domain or in getting legislators to help build a public domain. Our
13728 aim is to build a movement of consumers and producers
13729 <!-- PAGE BREAK 289 -->
13730 of content (
<quote>content conducers,
</quote> as attorney Mia Garlick calls them)
13731 who help build the public domain and, by their work, demonstrate the
13732 importance of the public domain to other creativity.
13733 <indexterm><primary>Garlick, Mia
</primary></indexterm>
13736 The aim is not to fight the
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts. The aim is to
13737 complement them. The problems that the law creates for us as a culture
13738 are produced by insane and unintended consequences of laws written
13739 centuries ago, applied to a technology that only Jefferson could have
13740 imagined. The rules may well have made sense against a background of
13741 technologies from centuries ago, but they do not make sense against
13742 the background of digital technologies. New rules
—with different
13743 freedoms, expressed in ways so that humans without lawyers can use
13744 them
—are needed. Creative Commons gives people a way effectively
13745 to begin to build those rules.
13747 <indexterm id='idxbooksfreeonline2' class='startofrange'
>
13748 <primary>books
</primary>
13749 <secondary>free on-line releases of
</secondary>
13752 Why would creators participate in giving up total control? Some
13753 participate to better spread their content. Cory Doctorow, for
13754 example, is a science fiction author. His first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
13755 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, was released on-line and for free, under a Creative
13756 Commons license, on the same day that it went on sale in bookstores.
13759 Why would a publisher ever agree to this? I suspect his publisher
13760 reasoned like this: There are two groups of people out there: (
1)
13761 those who will buy Cory's book whether or not it's on the Internet,
13762 and (
2) those who may never hear of Cory's book, if it isn't made
13763 available for free on the Internet. Some part of (
1) will download
13764 Cory's book instead of buying it. Call them bad-(
1)s. Some part of (
2)
13765 will download Cory's book, like it, and then decide to buy it. Call
13766 them (
2)-goods. If there are more (
2)-goods than bad-(
1)s, the
13767 strategy of releasing Cory's book free on-line will probably
13768 <emphasis>increase
</emphasis> sales of Cory's book.
13771 Indeed, the experience of his publisher clearly supports that
13772 conclusion. The book's first printing was exhausted months before the
13773 publisher had expected. This first novel of a science fiction author
13774 was a total success.
13776 <indexterm><primary>Free for All (Wayner)
</primary></indexterm>
13777 <indexterm><primary>Wayner, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
13779 The idea that free content might increase the value of nonfree content
13780 was confirmed by the experience of another author. Peter Wayner,
13781 <!-- PAGE BREAK 290 -->
13782 who wrote a book about the free software movement titled
<citetitle>Free for All
</citetitle>,
13783 made an electronic version of his book free on-line under a Creative
13784 Commons license after the book went out of print. He then monitored
13785 used book store prices for the book. As predicted, as the number of
13786 downloads increased, the used book price for his book increased, as
13789 <indexterm startref='idxbooksfreeonline2' class='endofrange'
/>
13790 <indexterm><primary>Public Enemy
</primary></indexterm>
13791 <indexterm><primary>rap music
</primary></indexterm>
13792 <indexterm><primary>Leaphart, Walter
</primary></indexterm>
13794 These are examples of using the Commons to better spread proprietary
13795 content. I believe that is a wonderful and common use of the
13796 Commons. There are others who use Creative Commons licenses for other
13797 reasons. Many who use the
<quote>sampling license
</quote> do so because anything
13798 else would be hypocritical. The sampling license says that others are
13799 free, for commercial or noncommercial purposes, to sample content from
13800 the licensed work; they are just not free to make full copies of the
13801 licensed work available to others. This is consistent with their own
13802 art
—they, too, sample from others. Because the
13803 <emphasis>legal
</emphasis> costs of sampling are so high (Walter
13804 Leaphart, manager of the rap group Public Enemy, which was born
13805 sampling the music of others, has stated that he does not
<quote>allow
</quote>
13806 Public Enemy to sample anymore, because the legal costs are so
13807 high
<footnote><para>
13809 <citetitle>Willful Infringement: A Report from the Front Lines of the Real
13810 Culture Wars
</citetitle> (
2003), produced by Jed Horovitz, directed by Greg
13811 Hittelman, a Fiat Lucre production, available at
13812 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>.
13813 </para></footnote>),
13814 these artists release into the creative environment content
13815 that others can build upon, so that their form of creativity might grow.
13818 Finally, there are many who mark their content with a Creative Commons
13819 license just because they want to express to others the importance of
13820 balance in this debate. If you just go along with the system as it is,
13821 you are effectively saying you believe in the
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote>
13822 model. Good for you, but many do not. Many believe that however
13823 appropriate that rule is for Hollywood and freaks, it is not an
13824 appropriate description of how most creators view the rights
13825 associated with their content. The Creative Commons license expresses
13826 this notion of
<quote>Some Rights Reserved,
</quote> and gives many the chance to
13830 In the first six months of the Creative Commons experiment, over
13831 1 million objects were licensed with these free-culture licenses. The next
13832 step is partnerships with middleware content providers to help them
13833 build into their technologies simple ways for users to mark their content
13835 <!-- PAGE BREAK 291 -->
13836 with Creative Commons freedoms. Then the next step is to watch and
13837 celebrate creators who build content based upon content set free.
13840 These are first steps to rebuilding a public domain. They are not
13841 mere arguments; they are action. Building a public domain is the first
13842 step to showing people how important that domain is to creativity and
13843 innovation. Creative Commons relies upon voluntary steps to achieve
13844 this rebuilding. They will lead to a world in which more than voluntary
13845 steps are possible.
13848 Creative Commons is just one example of voluntary efforts by
13849 individuals and creators to change the mix of rights that now govern
13850 the creative field. The project does not compete with copyright; it
13851 complements it. Its aim is not to defeat the rights of authors, but to
13852 make it easier for authors and creators to exercise their rights more
13853 flexibly and cheaply. That difference, we believe, will enable
13854 creativity to spread more easily.
13856 <indexterm startref=
"idxcc" class='endofrange'
/>
13858 <!-- PAGE BREAK 292 -->
13861 <section id=
"themsoon">
13862 <title>THEM, SOON
</title>
13864 <emphasis role='strong'
>We will
</emphasis> not reclaim a free culture
13865 by individual action alone. It will also take important reforms of
13866 laws. We have a long way to go before the politicians will listen to
13867 these ideas and implement these reforms. But that also means that we
13868 have time to build awareness around the changes that we need.
13871 In this chapter, I outline five kinds of changes: four that are general,
13872 and one that's specific to the most heated battle of the day, music. Each
13873 is a step, not an end. But any of these steps would carry us a long way
13877 <section id=
"formalities">
13878 <title>1. More Formalities
</title>
13880 If you buy a house, you have to record the sale in a deed. If you buy land
13881 upon which to build a house, you have to record the purchase in a deed.
13882 If you buy a car, you get a bill of sale and register the car. If you buy an
13883 airplane ticket, it has your name on it.
13886 <!-- PAGE BREAK 293 -->
13887 These are all formalities associated with property. They are
13888 requirements that we all must bear if we want our property to be
13892 In contrast, under current copyright law, you automatically get a
13893 copyright, regardless of whether you comply with any formality. You
13894 don't have to register. You don't even have to mark your content. The
13895 default is control, and
<quote>formalities
</quote> are banished.
13901 As I suggested in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
13902 linkend=
"property-i"/>, the motivation to abolish formalities was a
13903 good one. In the world before digital technologies, formalities
13904 imposed a burden on copyright holders without much benefit. Thus, it
13905 was progress when the law relaxed the formal requirements that a
13906 copyright owner must bear to protect and secure his work. Those
13907 formalities were getting in the way.
13910 But the Internet changes all this. Formalities today need not be a
13911 burden. Rather, the world without formalities is the world that
13912 burdens creativity. Today, there is no simple way to know who owns
13913 what, or with whom one must deal in order to use or build upon the
13914 creative work of others. There are no records, there is no system to
13915 trace
— there is no simple way to know how to get permission. Yet
13916 given the massive increase in the scope of copyright's rule, getting
13917 permission is a necessary step for any work that builds upon our
13918 past. And thus, the
<emphasis>lack
</emphasis> of formalities forces
13919 many into silence where they otherwise could speak.
13922 The law should therefore change this requirement
<footnote><para>
13924 The proposal I am advancing here would apply to American works only.
13925 Obviously, I believe it would be beneficial for the same idea to be
13926 adopted by other countries as well.
</para></footnote>—but it
13927 should not change it by going back to the old, broken system. We
13928 should require formalities, but we should establish a system that will
13929 create the incentives to minimize the burden of these formalities.
13932 The important formalities are three: marking copyrighted work,
13933 registering copyrights, and renewing the claim to
13934 copyright. Traditionally, the first of these three was something the
13935 copyright owner did; the second two were something the government
13936 did. But a revised system of formalities would banish the government
13937 from the process, except for the sole purpose of approving standards
13938 developed by others.
13941 <!-- PAGE BREAK 294 -->
13943 <section id=
"registration">
13944 <title>REGISTRATION AND RENEWAL
</title>
13946 Under the old system, a copyright owner had to file a registration
13947 with the Copyright Office to register or renew a copyright. When
13948 filing that registration, the copyright owner paid a fee. As with most
13949 government agencies, the Copyright Office had little incentive to
13950 minimize the burden of registration; it also had little incentive to
13951 minimize the fee. And as the Copyright Office is not a main target of
13952 government policymaking, the office has historically been terribly
13953 underfunded. Thus, when people who know something about the process
13954 hear this idea about formalities, their first reaction is
13955 panic
—nothing could be worse than forcing people to deal with
13956 the mess that is the Copyright Office.
13959 Yet it is always astonishing to me that we, who come from a tradition
13960 of extraordinary innovation in governmental design, can no longer
13961 think innovatively about how governmental functions can be designed.
13962 Just because there is a public purpose to a government role, it
13963 doesn't follow that the government must actually administer the
13964 role. Instead, we should be creating incentives for private parties to
13965 serve the public, subject to standards that the government sets.
13968 In the context of registration, one obvious model is the Internet.
13969 There are at least
32 million Web sites registered around the world.
13970 Domain name owners for these Web sites have to pay a fee to keep their
13971 registration alive. In the main top-level domains (.com, .org, .net),
13972 there is a central registry. The actual registrations are, however,
13973 performed by many competing registrars. That competition drives the
13974 cost of registering down, and more importantly, it drives the ease
13975 with which registration occurs up.
13978 We should adopt a similar model for the registration and renewal of
13979 copyrights. The Copyright Office may well serve as the central
13980 registry, but it should not be in the registrar business. Instead, it
13981 should establish a database, and a set of standards for registrars. It
13982 should approve registrars that meet its standards. Those registrars
13983 would then compete with one another to deliver the cheapest and
13984 simplest systems for registering and renewing copyrights. That
13985 competition would substantially lower the burden of this
13986 formality
—while producing a database
13987 <!-- PAGE BREAK 295 -->
13988 of registrations that would facilitate the licensing of content.
13992 <section id=
"marking">
13993 <title>MARKING
</title>
13995 It used to be that the failure to include a copyright notice on a
13996 creative work meant that the copyright was forfeited. That was a harsh
13997 punishment for failing to comply with a regulatory rule
—akin to
13998 imposing the death penalty for a parking ticket in the world of
13999 creative rights. Here again, there is no reason that a marking
14000 requirement needs to be enforced in this way. And more importantly,
14001 there is no reason a marking requirement needs to be enforced
14002 uniformly across all media.
14005 The aim of marking is to signal to the public that this work is
14006 copyrighted and that the author wants to enforce his rights. The mark
14007 also makes it easy to locate a copyright owner to secure permission to
14011 One of the problems the copyright system confronted early on was
14012 that different copyrighted works had to be differently marked. It wasn't
14013 clear how or where a statue was to be marked, or a record, or a film. A
14014 new marking requirement could solve these problems by recognizing
14015 the differences in media, and by allowing the system of marking to
14016 evolve as technologies enable it to. The system could enable a special
14017 signal from the failure to mark
—not the loss of the copyright, but the
14018 loss of the right to punish someone for failing to get permission first.
14021 Let's start with the last point. If a copyright owner allows his work
14022 to be published without a copyright notice, the consequence of that
14023 failure need not be that the copyright is lost. The consequence could
14024 instead be that anyone has the right to use this work, until the
14025 copyright owner complains and demonstrates that it is his work and he
14026 doesn't give permission.
<footnote><para>
14028 There would be a complication with derivative works that I have not
14029 solved here. In my view, the law of derivatives creates a more complicated
14030 system than is justified by the marginal incentive it creates.
14032 The meaning of an unmarked work would therefore be
<quote>use unless someone
14033 complains.
</quote> If someone does complain, then the obligation would be to
14034 stop using the work in any new
14035 <!-- PAGE BREAK 296 -->
14036 work from then on though no penalty would attach for existing uses.
14037 This would create a strong incentive for copyright owners to mark
14041 That in turn raises the question about how work should best be
14042 marked. Here again, the system needs to adjust as the technologies
14043 evolve. The best way to ensure that the system evolves is to limit the
14044 Copyright Office's role to that of approving standards for marking
14045 content that have been crafted elsewhere.
14048 For example, if a recording industry association devises a method for
14049 marking CDs, it would propose that to the Copyright Office. The
14050 Copyright Office would hold a hearing, at which other proposals could
14051 be made. The Copyright Office would then select the proposal that it
14052 judged preferable, and it would base that choice
14053 <emphasis>solely
</emphasis> upon the consideration of which method
14054 could best be integrated into the registration and renewal system. We
14055 would not count on the government to innovate; but we would count on
14056 the government to keep the product of innovation in line with its
14057 other important functions.
14060 Finally, marking content clearly would simplify registration
14061 requirements. If photographs were marked by author and year, there
14062 would be little reason not to allow a photographer to reregister, for
14063 example, all photographs taken in a particular year in one quick
14064 step. The aim of the formality is not to burden the creator; the
14065 system itself should be kept as simple as possible.
14068 The objective of formalities is to make things clear. The existing
14069 system does nothing to make things clear. Indeed, it seems designed to
14070 make things unclear.
14073 If formalities such as registration were reinstated, one of the most
14074 difficult aspects of relying upon the public domain would be removed.
14075 It would be simple to identify what content is presumptively free; it
14076 would be simple to identify who controls the rights for a particular
14077 kind of content; it would be simple to assert those rights, and to renew
14078 that assertion at the appropriate time.
14081 <!-- PAGE BREAK 297 -->
14084 <section id=
"shortterms">
14085 <title>2. Shorter Terms
</title>
14087 The term of copyright has gone from fourteen years to ninety-five
14088 years for corporate authors, and life of the author plus seventy years for
14092 In
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>, I proposed a seventy-five-year term,
14093 granted in five-year increments with a requirement of renewal every
14094 five years. That seemed radical enough at the time. But after we lost
14095 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, the proposals became even more
14096 radical.
<citetitle>The Economist
</citetitle> endorsed a proposal for a fourteen-year
14097 copyright term.
<footnote><para>
14100 <quote>A Radical Rethink,
</quote> <citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
366:
8308 (
25 January
2003):
15,
14102 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
74</ulink>.
14104 Others have proposed tying the term to the term for patents.
14107 I agree with those who believe that we need a radical change in
14108 copyright's term. But whether fourteen years or seventy-five, there
14109 are four principles that are important to keep in mind about copyright
14112 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
14115 <emphasis>Keep it short:
</emphasis> The term should be as long as
14116 necessary to give incentives to create, but no longer. If it were tied
14117 to very strong protections for authors (so authors were able to
14118 reclaim rights from publishers), rights to the same work (not
14119 derivative works) might be extended further. The key is not to tie the
14120 work up with legal regulations when it no longer benefits an author.
14124 <emphasis>Keep it simple:
</emphasis> The line between the public
14125 domain and protected content must be kept clear. Lawyers like the
14126 fuzziness of
<quote>fair use,
</quote> and the distinction between
<quote>ideas
</quote> and
14127 <quote>expression.
</quote> That kind of law gives them lots of work. But our
14128 framers had a simpler idea in mind: protected versus unprotected. The
14129 value of short terms is that there is little need to build exceptions
14130 into copyright when the term itself is kept short. A clear and active
14131 <quote>lawyer-free zone
</quote> makes the complexities of
<quote>fair use
</quote> and
14132 <quote>idea/expression
</quote> less necessary to navigate.
14133 <!-- PAGE BREAK 298 -->
14137 <emphasis>Keep it alive:
</emphasis> Copyright should have to be
14138 renewed. Especially if the maximum term is long, the copyright owner
14139 should be required to signal periodically that he wants the protection
14140 continued. This need not be an onerous burden, but there is no reason
14141 this monopoly protection has to be granted for free. On average, it
14142 takes ninety minutes for a veteran to apply for a
14143 pension.
<footnote><para>
14145 Department of Veterans Affairs, Veteran's Application for Compensation
14146 and/or Pension, VA Form
21-
526 (OMB Approved No.
2900-
0001),
14148 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
75</ulink>.
14150 If we make veterans suffer that burden, I don't see why we couldn't
14151 require authors to spend ten minutes every fifty years to file a
14153 <indexterm><primary>veterans' pensions
</primary></indexterm>
14157 <emphasis>Keep it prospective:
</emphasis> Whatever the term of
14158 copyright should be, the clearest lesson that economists teach is that
14159 a term once given should not be extended. It might have been a mistake
14160 in
1923 for the law to offer authors only a fifty-six-year term. I
14161 don't think so, but it's possible. If it was a mistake, then the
14162 consequence was that we got fewer authors to create in
1923 than we
14163 otherwise would have. But we can't correct that mistake today by
14164 increasing the term. No matter what we do today, we will not increase
14165 the number of authors who wrote in
1923. Of course, we can increase
14166 the reward that those who write now get (or alternatively, increase
14167 the copyright burden that smothers many works that are today
14168 invisible). But increasing their reward will not increase their
14169 creativity in
1923. What's not done is not done, and there's nothing
14170 we can do about that now.
</para></listitem>
14173 These changes together should produce an
<emphasis>average
</emphasis>
14174 copyright term that is much shorter than the current term. Until
1976,
14175 the average term was just
32.2 years. We should be aiming for the
14179 No doubt the extremists will call these ideas
<quote>radical.
</quote> (After all, I
14180 call them
<quote>extremists.
</quote>) But again, the term I recommended was longer
14181 than the term under Richard Nixon. How
<quote>radical
</quote> can it be to ask for
14182 a more generous copyright law than Richard Nixon presided over?
14185 <!-- PAGE BREAK 299 -->
14188 <section id=
"freefairuse">
14189 <title>3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
</title>
14190 <indexterm><primary>land ownership, air traffic and
</primary></indexterm>
14192 <primary>property rights
</primary>
14193 <secondary>air traffic vs.
</secondary>
14196 As I observed at the beginning of this book, property law originally
14197 granted property owners the right to control their property from the
14198 ground to the heavens. The airplane came along. The scope of property
14199 rights quickly changed. There was no fuss, no constitutional
14200 challenge. It made no sense anymore to grant that much control, given
14201 the emergence of that new technology.
14204 Our Constitution gives Congress the power to give authors
<quote>exclusive
14205 right
</quote> to
<quote>their writings.
</quote> Congress has given authors an exclusive
14206 right to
<quote>their writings
</quote> plus any derivative writings (made by
14207 others) that are sufficiently close to the author's original
14208 work. Thus, if I write a book, and you base a movie on that book, I
14209 have the power to deny you the right to release that movie, even
14210 though that movie is not
<quote>my writing.
</quote>
14213 Congress granted the beginnings of this right in
1870, when it
14214 expanded the exclusive right of copyright to include a right to
14215 control translations and dramatizations of a work.
<footnote><para>
14217 Benjamin Kaplan,
<citetitle>An Unhurried View of Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Columbia
14218 University Press,
1967),
32.
14220 The courts have expanded it slowly through judicial interpretation
14221 ever since. This expansion has been commented upon by one of the law's
14222 greatest judges, Judge Benjamin Kaplan.
14223 <indexterm><primary>Kaplan, Benjamin
</primary></indexterm>
14227 So inured have we become to the extension of the monopoly to a
14228 large range of so-called derivative works, that we no longer sense
14229 the oddity of accepting such an enlargement of copyright while
14230 yet intoning the abracadabra of idea and expression.
<footnote><para>
14231 <!-- f6. --> Ibid.,
56.
14236 I think it's time to recognize that there are airplanes in this field and
14237 the expansiveness of these rights of derivative use no longer make
14238 sense. More precisely, they don't make sense for the period of time that
14239 a copyright runs. And they don't make sense as an amorphous grant.
14240 Consider each limitation in turn.
14243 <emphasis>Term:
</emphasis> If Congress wants to grant a derivative
14244 right, then that right should be for a much shorter term. It makes
14245 sense to protect John
14247 <!-- PAGE BREAK 300 -->
14248 Grisham's right to sell the movie rights to his latest novel (or at least
14249 I'm willing to assume it does); but it does not make sense for that right
14250 to run for the same term as the underlying copyright. The derivative
14251 right could be important in inducing creativity; it is not important long
14252 after the creative work is done.
14253 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
14256 <emphasis>Scope:
</emphasis> Likewise should the scope of derivative
14257 rights be narrowed. Again, there are some cases in which derivative
14258 rights are important. Those should be specified. But the law should
14259 draw clear lines around regulated and unregulated uses of copyrighted
14260 material. When all
<quote>reuse
</quote> of creative material was within the control
14261 of businesses, perhaps it made sense to require lawyers to negotiate
14262 the lines. It no longer makes sense for lawyers to negotiate the
14263 lines. Think about all the creative possibilities that digital
14264 technologies enable; now imagine pouring molasses into the
14265 machines. That's what this general requirement of permission does to
14266 the creative process. Smothers it.
14268 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
14270 This was the point that Alben made when describing the making of the
14271 Clint Eastwood CD. While it makes sense to require negotiation for
14272 foreseeable derivative rights
—turning a book into a movie, or a
14273 poem into a musical score
—it doesn't make sense to require
14274 negotiation for the unforeseeable. Here, a statutory right would make
14278 In each of these cases, the law should mark the uses that are
14279 protected, and the presumption should be that other uses are not
14280 protected. This is the reverse of the recommendation of my colleague
14281 Paul Goldstein.
<footnote>
14284 Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>Copyright's Highway: From Gutenberg to the Celestial
14285 Jukebox
</citetitle> (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
2003),
187–216.
14286 <indexterm><primary>Goldstein, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
14288 His view is that the law should be written so that
14289 expanded protections follow expanded uses.
14292 Goldstein's analysis would make perfect sense if the cost of the legal
14293 system were small. But as we are currently seeing in the context of
14294 the Internet, the uncertainty about the scope of protection, and the
14295 incentives to protect existing architectures of revenue, combined with
14296 a strong copyright, weaken the process of innovation.
14299 The law could remedy this problem either by removing protection
14300 <!-- PAGE BREAK 301 -->
14301 beyond the part explicitly drawn or by granting reuse rights upon
14302 certain statutory conditions. Either way, the effect would be to free
14303 a great deal of culture to others to cultivate. And under a statutory
14304 rights regime, that reuse would earn artists more income.
14308 <section id=
"liberatemusic">
14309 <title>4. Liberate the Music
—Again
</title>
14311 The battle that got this whole war going was about music, so it
14312 wouldn't be fair to end this book without addressing the issue that
14313 is, to most people, most pressing
—music. There is no other
14314 policy issue that better teaches the lessons of this book than the
14315 battles around the sharing of music.
14318 The appeal of file-sharing music was the crack cocaine of the
14319 Internet's growth. It drove demand for access to the Internet more
14320 powerfully than any other single application. It was the Internet's
14321 killer app
—possibly in two senses of that word. It no doubt was
14322 the application that drove demand for bandwidth. It may well be the
14323 application that drives demand for regulations that in the end kill
14324 innovation on the network.
14327 The aim of copyright, with respect to content in general and music in
14328 particular, is to create the incentives for music to be composed,
14329 performed, and, most importantly, spread. The law does this by giving
14330 an exclusive right to a composer to control public performances of his
14331 work, and to a performing artist to control copies of her performance.
14334 File-sharing networks complicate this model by enabling the spread of
14335 content for which the performer has not been paid. But of course,
14336 that's not all the file-sharing networks do. As I described in chapter
14337 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"piracy"/>, they enable
14338 four different kinds of sharing:
14340 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
14343 There are some who are using sharing networks as substitutes
14344 for purchasing CDs.
14348 There are also some who are using sharing networks to sample,
14349 on the way to purchasing CDs.
14352 <!-- PAGE BREAK 302 -->
14354 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
14355 content that is no longer sold but is still under copyright or that
14356 would have been too cumbersome to buy off the Net.
14360 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
14361 content that is not copyrighted or to get access that the copyright
14362 owner plainly endorses.
14366 Any reform of the law needs to keep these different uses in focus. It
14367 must avoid burdening type D even if it aims to eliminate type A. The
14368 eagerness with which the law aims to eliminate type A, moreover,
14369 should depend upon the magnitude of type B. As with VCRs, if the net
14370 effect of sharing is actually not very harmful, the need for regulation is
14371 significantly weakened.
14374 As I said in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
14375 linkend=
"piracy"/>, the actual harm caused by sharing is
14376 controversial. For the purposes of this chapter, however, I assume
14377 the harm is real. I assume, in other words, that type A sharing is
14378 significantly greater than type B, and is the dominant use of sharing
14382 Nonetheless, there is a crucial fact about the current technological
14383 context that we must keep in mind if we are to understand how the law
14387 Today, file sharing is addictive. In ten years, it won't be. It is
14388 addictive today because it is the easiest way to gain access to a
14389 broad range of content. It won't be the easiest way to get access to
14390 a broad range of content in ten years. Today, access to the Internet
14391 is cumbersome and slow
—we in the United States are lucky to have
14392 broadband service at
1.5 MBs, and very rarely do we get service at
14393 that speed both up and down. Although wireless access is growing, most
14394 of us still get access across wires. Most only gain access through a
14395 machine with a keyboard. The idea of the always on, always connected
14396 Internet is mainly just an idea.
14399 But it will become a reality, and that means the way we get access to
14400 the Internet today is a technology in transition. Policy makers should
14401 not make policy on the basis of technology in transition. They should
14402 <!-- PAGE BREAK 303 -->
14403 make policy on the basis of where the technology is going. The
14404 question should not be, how should the law regulate sharing in this
14405 world? The question should be, what law will we require when the
14406 network becomes the network it is clearly becoming? That network is
14407 one in which every machine with electricity is essentially on the Net;
14408 where everywhere you are
—except maybe the desert or the
14409 Rockies
—you can instantaneously be connected to the
14410 Internet. Imagine the Internet as ubiquitous as the best cell-phone
14411 service, where with the flip of a device, you are connected.
14413 <indexterm><primary>cell phones, music streamed over
</primary></indexterm>
14415 In that world, it will be extremely easy to connect to services that
14416 give you access to content on the fly
—such as Internet radio,
14417 content that is streamed to the user when the user demands. Here,
14418 then, is the critical point: When it is
<emphasis>extremely
</emphasis>
14419 easy to connect to services that give access to content, it will be
14420 <emphasis>easier
</emphasis> to connect to services that give you
14421 access to content than it will be to download and store content
14422 <emphasis>on the many devices you will have for playing
14423 content
</emphasis>. It will be easier, in other words, to subscribe
14424 than it will be to be a database manager, as everyone in the
14425 download-sharing world of Napster-like technologies essentially
14426 is. Content services will compete with content sharing, even if the
14427 services charge money for the content they give access to. Already
14428 cell-phone services in Japan offer music (for a fee) streamed over
14429 cell phones (enhanced with plugs for headphones). The Japanese are
14430 paying for this content even though
<quote>free
</quote> content is available in the
14431 form of MP3s across the Web.
<footnote><para>
14433 See, for example,
<quote>Music Media Watch,
</quote> The J@pan Inc. Newsletter,
3
14434 April
2002, available at
14435 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
76</ulink>.
14440 This point about the future is meant to suggest a perspective on the
14441 present: It is emphatically temporary. The
<quote>problem
</quote> with file
14442 sharing
—to the extent there is a real problem
—is a problem
14443 that will increasingly disappear as it becomes easier to connect to
14444 the Internet. And thus it is an extraordinary mistake for policy
14445 makers today to be
<quote>solving
</quote> this problem in light of a technology
14446 that will be gone tomorrow. The question should not be how to
14447 regulate the Internet to eliminate file sharing (the Net will evolve
14448 that problem away). The question instead should be how to assure that
14449 artists get paid, during
14451 <!-- PAGE BREAK 304 -->
14452 this transition between twentieth-century models for doing business
14453 and twenty-first-century technologies.
14456 The answer begins with recognizing that there are different
<quote>problems
</quote>
14457 here to solve. Let's start with type D content
—uncopyrighted
14458 content or copyrighted content that the artist wants shared. The
14459 <quote>problem
</quote> with this content is to make sure that the technology that
14460 would enable this kind of sharing is not rendered illegal. You can
14461 think of it this way: Pay phones are used to deliver ransom demands,
14462 no doubt. But there are many who need to use pay phones who have
14463 nothing to do with ransoms. It would be wrong to ban pay phones in
14464 order to eliminate kidnapping.
14467 Type C content raises a different
<quote>problem.
</quote> This is content that was,
14468 at one time, published and is no longer available. It may be
14469 unavailable because the artist is no longer valuable enough for the
14470 record label he signed with to carry his work. Or it may be
14471 unavailable because the work is forgotten. Either way, the aim of the
14472 law should be to facilitate the access to this content, ideally in a
14473 way that returns something to the artist.
14476 <primary>books
</primary>
14477 <secondary>out of print
</secondary>
14480 Again, the model here is the used book store. Once a book goes out of
14481 print, it may still be available in libraries and used book
14482 stores. But libraries and used book stores don't pay the copyright
14483 owner when someone reads or buys an out-of-print book. That makes
14484 total sense, of course, since any other system would be so burdensome
14485 as to eliminate the possibility of used book stores' existing. But
14486 from the author's perspective, this
<quote>sharing
</quote> of his content without
14487 his being compensated is less than ideal.
14490 The model of used book stores suggests that the law could simply deem
14491 out-of-print music fair game. If the publisher does not make copies of
14492 the music available for sale, then commercial and noncommercial
14493 providers would be free, under this rule, to
<quote>share
</quote> that content,
14494 even though the sharing involved making a copy. The copy here would be
14495 incidental to the trade; in a context where commercial publishing has
14496 ended, trading music should be as free as trading books.
14500 <!-- PAGE BREAK 305 -->
14501 Alternatively, the law could create a statutory license that would
14502 ensure that artists get something from the trade of their work. For
14503 example, if the law set a low statutory rate for the commercial
14504 sharing of content that was not offered for sale by a commercial
14505 publisher, and if that rate were automatically transferred to a trust
14506 for the benefit of the artist, then businesses could develop around
14507 the idea of trading this content, and artists would benefit from this
14511 This system would also create an incentive for publishers to keep
14512 works available commercially. Works that are available commercially
14513 would not be subject to this license. Thus, publishers could protect
14514 the right to charge whatever they want for content if they kept the
14515 work commercially available. But if they don't keep it available, and
14516 instead, the computer hard disks of fans around the world keep it
14517 alive, then any royalty owed for such copying should be much less than
14518 the amount owed a commercial publisher.
14521 The hard case is content of types A and B, and again, this case is
14522 hard only because the extent of the problem will change over time, as
14523 the technologies for gaining access to content change. The law's
14524 solution should be as flexible as the problem is, understanding that
14525 we are in the middle of a radical transformation in the technology for
14526 delivering and accessing content.
14529 So here's a solution that will at first seem very strange to both sides
14530 in this war, but which upon reflection, I suggest, should make some sense.
14533 Stripped of the rhetoric about the sanctity of property, the basic
14534 claim of the content industry is this: A new technology (the Internet)
14535 has harmed a set of rights that secure copyright. If those rights are to
14536 be protected, then the content industry should be compensated for that
14537 harm. Just as the technology of tobacco harmed the health of millions
14538 of Americans, or the technology of asbestos caused grave illness to
14539 thousands of miners, so, too, has the technology of digital networks
14540 harmed the interests of the content industry.
14543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 306 -->
14544 I love the Internet, and so I don't like likening it to tobacco or
14545 asbestos. But the analogy is a fair one from the perspective of the
14546 law. And it suggests a fair response: Rather than seeking to destroy
14547 the Internet, or the p2p technologies that are currently harming
14548 content providers on the Internet, we should find a relatively simple
14549 way to compensate those who are harmed.
14552 The idea would be a modification of a proposal that has been
14553 floated by Harvard law professor William Fisher.
<footnote>
14556 <indexterm id='idxartistspayments3' class='startofrange'
>
14557 <primary>artists
</primary>
14558 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
14560 William Fisher,
<citetitle>Digital Music: Problems and Possibilities
</citetitle> (last
14561 revised:
10 October
2000), available at
14562 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
77</ulink>; William
14563 Fisher,
<citetitle>Promises to Keep: Technology, Law, and the Future of
14564 Entertainment
</citetitle> (forthcoming) (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
14565 2004), ch.
6, available at
14566 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
78</ulink>. Professor
14567 Netanel has proposed a related idea that would exempt noncommercial
14568 sharing from the reach of copyright and would establish compensation
14569 to artists to balance any loss. See Neil Weinstock Netanel,
<quote>Impose a
14570 Noncommercial Use Levy to Allow Free P2P File Sharing,
</quote> available at
14571 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
79</ulink>. For other proposals, see Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>Who's Holding Back
14572 Broadband?
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
8 January
2002, A17; Philip S. Corwin on
14573 behalf of Sharman Networks, A Letter to Senator Joseph R. Biden, Jr.,
14574 Chairman of the Senate Foreign Relations Committee,
26 February
2002,
14576 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
80</ulink>; Serguei Osokine,
<citetitle>A Quick Case for Intellectual Property
14577 Use Fee (IPUF)
</citetitle>,
3 March
2002, available at
14578 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
81</ulink>; Jefferson Graham,
14579 <quote>Kazaa, Verizon Propose to Pay Artists Directly,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
13 May
14581 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
82</ulink>; Steven M. Cherry,
<quote>Getting Copyright Right,
</quote>
14582 IEEE Spectrum Online,
1 July
2002, available at
14583 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
83</ulink>; Declan
14584 McCullagh,
<quote>Verizon's Copyright Campaign,
</quote> CNET News.com,
27 August
14586 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
84</ulink>.
14587 Fisher's proposal is very similar to Richard Stallman's proposal for
14588 DAT. Unlike Fisher's, Stallman's proposal would not pay artists directly
14589 proportionally, though more popular artists would get more than the less
14590 popular. As is typical with Stallman, his proposal predates the current
14591 debate by about a decade. See
14592 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
85</ulink>.
14593 <indexterm><primary>Fisher, William
</primary></indexterm>
14594 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
14595 <indexterm><primary>Promises to Keep (Fisher)
</primary></indexterm>
14596 <indexterm startref='idxartistspayments3' class='endofrange'
/>
14598 Fisher suggests a very clever way around the current impasse of the
14599 Internet. Under his plan, all content capable of digital transmission
14600 would (
1) be marked with a digital watermark (don't worry about how
14601 easy it is to evade these marks; as you'll see, there's no incentive
14602 to evade them). Once the content is marked, then entrepreneurs would
14603 develop (
2) systems to monitor how many items of each content were
14604 distributed. On the basis of those numbers, then (
3) artists would be
14605 compensated. The compensation would be paid for by (
4) an appropriate
14608 <indexterm><primary>Promises to Keep (Fisher)
</primary></indexterm>
14610 Fisher's proposal is careful and comprehensive. It raises a million
14611 questions, most of which he answers well in his upcoming book,
14612 <citetitle>Promises to Keep
</citetitle>. The modification that I would make is relatively
14613 simple: Fisher imagines his proposal replacing the existing copyright
14614 system. I imagine it complementing the existing system. The aim of
14615 the proposal would be to facilitate compensation to the extent that
14616 harm could be shown. This compensation would be temporary, aimed at
14617 facilitating a transition between regimes. And it would require
14618 renewal after a period of years. If it continues to make sense to
14619 facilitate free exchange of content, supported through a taxation
14620 system, then it can be continued. If this form of protection is no
14621 longer necessary, then the system could lapse into the old system of
14622 controlling access.
14625 <primary>artists
</primary>
14626 <secondary>recording industry payments to
</secondary>
14629 Fisher would balk at the idea of allowing the system to lapse. His aim
14630 is not just to ensure that artists are paid, but also to ensure that
14631 the system supports the widest range of
<quote>semiotic democracy
</quote>
14632 possible. But the aims of semiotic democracy would be satisfied if the
14633 other changes I described were accomplished
—in particular, the
14634 limits on derivative
14636 <!-- PAGE BREAK 307 -->
14637 uses. A system that simply charges for access would not greatly burden
14638 semiotic democracy if there were few limitations on what one was
14639 allowed to do with the content itself.
14641 <indexterm><primary>Real Networks
</primary></indexterm>
14643 No doubt it would be difficult to calculate the proper measure of
14644 <quote>harm
</quote> to an industry. But the difficulty of making that calculation
14645 would be outweighed by the benefit of facilitating innovation. This
14646 background system to compensate would also not need to interfere with
14647 innovative proposals such as Apple's MusicStore. As experts predicted
14648 when Apple launched the MusicStore, it could beat
<quote>free
</quote> by being
14649 easier than free is. This has proven correct: Apple has sold millions
14650 of songs at even the very high price of
99 cents a song. (At
99 cents,
14651 the cost is the equivalent of a per-song CD price, though the labels
14652 have none of the costs of a CD to pay.) Apple's move was countered by
14653 Real Networks, offering music at just
79 cents a song. And no doubt
14654 there will be a great deal of competition to offer and sell music
14657 <indexterm><primary>Asia, commercial piracy in
</primary></indexterm>
14659 This competition has already occurred against the background of
<quote>free
</quote>
14660 music from p2p systems. As the sellers of cable television have known
14661 for thirty years, and the sellers of bottled water for much more than
14662 that, there is nothing impossible at all about
<quote>competing with free.
</quote>
14663 Indeed, if anything, the competition spurs the competitors to offer
14664 new and better products. This is precisely what the competitive market
14665 was to be about. Thus in Singapore, though piracy is rampant, movie
14666 theaters are often luxurious
—with
<quote>first class
</quote> seats, and meals
14667 served while you watch a movie
—as they struggle and succeed in
14668 finding ways to compete with
<quote>free.
</quote>
14671 This regime of competition, with a backstop to assure that artists
14672 don't lose, would facilitate a great deal of innovation in the
14673 delivery of content. That competition would continue to shrink type A
14674 sharing. It would inspire an extraordinary range of new
14675 innovators
—ones who would have a right to the content, and would
14676 no longer fear the uncertain and barbarically severe punishments of
14680 In summary, then, my proposal is this:
14684 <!-- PAGE BREAK 308 -->
14685 The Internet is in transition. We should not be regulating a
14686 technology in transition. We should instead be regulating to minimize
14687 the harm to interests affected by this technological change, while
14688 enabling, and encouraging, the most efficient technology we can
14692 We can minimize that harm while maximizing the benefit to innovation
14695 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
14698 guaranteeing the right to engage in type D sharing;
14702 permitting noncommercial type C sharing without liability,
14703 and commercial type C sharing at a low and fixed rate set by
14708 while in this transition, taxing and compensating for type A
14709 sharing, to the extent actual harm is demonstrated.
14713 But what if
<quote>piracy
</quote> doesn't disappear? What if there is a competitive
14714 market providing content at a low cost, but a significant number of
14715 consumers continue to
<quote>take
</quote> content for nothing? Should the law do
14719 Yes, it should. But, again, what it should do depends upon how the
14720 facts develop. These changes may not eliminate type A sharing. But the
14721 real issue is not whether it eliminates sharing in the abstract. The
14722 real issue is its effect on the market. Is it better (a) to have a
14723 technology that is
95 percent secure and produces a market of size
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>,
14724 or (b) to have a technology that is
50 percent secure but produces a
14725 market of five times
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>? Less secure might produce more unauthorized
14726 sharing, but it is likely to also produce a much bigger market in
14727 authorized sharing. The most important thing is to assure artists'
14728 compensation without breaking the Internet. Once that's assured, then
14729 it may well be appropriate to find ways to track down the petty
14733 But we're a long way away from whittling the problem down to this
14734 subset of type A sharers. And our focus until we're there should not
14735 be on finding ways to break the Internet. Our focus until we're there
14737 <!-- PAGE BREAK 309 -->
14738 should be on how to make sure the artists are paid, while protecting
14739 the space for innovation and creativity that the Internet is.
14743 <section id=
"firelawyers">
14744 <title>5. Fire Lots of Lawyers
</title>
14746 I'm a lawyer. I make lawyers for a living. I believe in the law. I believe
14747 in the law of copyright. Indeed, I have devoted my life to working in
14748 law, not because there are big bucks at the end but because there are
14749 ideals at the end that I would love to live.
14752 Yet much of this book has been a criticism of lawyers, or the role
14753 lawyers have played in this debate. The law speaks to ideals, but it
14754 is my view that our profession has become too attuned to the
14755 client. And in a world where the rich clients have one strong view,
14756 the unwillingness of the profession to question or counter that one
14757 strong view queers the law.
14760 The evidence of this bending is compelling. I'm attacked as a
14761 <quote>radical
</quote> by many within the profession, yet the positions that I am
14762 advocating are precisely the positions of some of the most moderate
14763 and significant figures in the history of this branch of the
14764 law. Many, for example, thought crazy the challenge that we brought to
14765 the Copyright Term Extension Act. Yet just thirty years ago, the
14766 dominant scholar and practitioner in the field of copyright, Melville
14767 Nimmer, thought it obvious.
<footnote><para>
14769 Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>Copyright's First Amendment
</quote> (Melville B. Nimmer
14770 Memorial Lecture),
<citetitle>UCLA Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
2001):
1057,
1069–70.
14775 However, my criticism of the role that lawyers have played in this
14776 debate is not just about a professional bias. It is more importantly
14777 about our failure to actually reckon the costs of the law.
14780 Economists are supposed to be good at reckoning costs and benefits.
14781 But more often than not, economists, with no clue about how the legal
14782 system actually functions, simply assume that the transaction costs of
14783 the legal system are slight.
<footnote><para>
14785 A good example is the work of Professor Stan Liebowitz. Liebowitz is
14786 to be commended for his careful review of data about infringement,
14787 leading him to question his own publicly stated
14788 position
—twice. He initially predicted that downloading would
14789 substantially harm the industry. He then revised his view in light of
14790 the data, and he has since revised his view again. Compare Stan
14791 J. Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy: The True Forces That
14792 Drive the Digital Marketplace
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002), (reviewing his
14793 original view but expressing skepticism) with Stan J. Liebowitz,
14794 <quote>Will MP3s Annihilate the Record Industry?
</quote> working paper, June
2003,
14796 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
86</ulink>.
14797 Liebowitz's careful analysis is extremely valuable in estimating the
14798 effect of file-sharing technology. In my view, however, he
14799 underestimates the costs of the legal system. See, for example,
14800 <citetitle>Rethinking
</citetitle>,
174–76.
14801 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
14803 They see a system that has been around for hundreds of years, and they
14804 assume it works the way their elementary school civics class taught
14808 <!-- PAGE BREAK 310 -->
14809 But the legal system doesn't work. Or more accurately, it doesn't work
14810 for anyone except those with the most resources. Not because the
14811 system is corrupt. I don't think our legal system (at the federal
14812 level, at least) is at all corrupt. I mean simply because the costs of
14813 our legal system are so astonishingly high that justice can
14814 practically never be done.
14817 These costs distort free culture in many ways. A lawyer's time is
14818 billed at the largest firms at more than $
400 per hour. How much time
14819 should such a lawyer spend reading cases carefully, or researching
14820 obscure strands of authority? The answer is the increasing reality:
14821 very little. The law depended upon the careful articulation and
14822 development of doctrine, but the careful articulation and development
14823 of legal doctrine depends upon careful work. Yet that careful work
14824 costs too much, except in the most high-profile and costly cases.
14827 The costliness and clumsiness and randomness of this system mock
14828 our tradition. And lawyers, as well as academics, should consider it
14829 their duty to change the way the law works
—or better, to change the
14830 law so that it works. It is wrong that the system works well only for the
14831 top
1 percent of the clients. It could be made radically more efficient,
14832 and inexpensive, and hence radically more just.
14835 But until that reform is complete, we as a society should keep the law
14836 away from areas that we know it will only harm. And that is precisely
14837 what the law will too often do if too much of our culture is left to
14840 <indexterm><primary>Brezhnev, Leonid
</primary></indexterm>
14842 Think about the amazing things your kid could do or make with digital
14843 technology
—the film, the music, the Web page, the blog. Or think
14844 about the amazing things your community could facilitate with digital
14845 technology
—a wiki, a barn raising, activism to change something.
14846 Think about all those creative things, and then imagine cold molasses
14847 poured onto the machines. This is what any regime that requires
14848 permission produces. Again, this is the reality of Brezhnev's Russia.
14851 The law should regulate in certain areas of culture
—but it should
14852 regulate culture only where that regulation does good. Yet lawyers
14854 <!-- PAGE BREAK 311 -->
14855 rarely test their power, or the power they promote, against this
14856 simple pragmatic question:
<quote>Will it do good?
</quote> When challenged about
14857 the expanding reach of the law, the lawyer answers,
<quote>Why not?
</quote>
14860 We should ask,
<quote>Why?
</quote> Show me why your regulation of culture is
14861 needed. Show me how it does good. And until you can show me both,
14862 keep your lawyers away.
14864 <!-- PAGE BREAK 312 -->
14868 <chapter label=
"17" id=
"c-notes">
14869 <title>NOTES
</title>
14871 Throughout this text, there are references to links on the World Wide
14872 Web. As anyone who has tried to use the Web knows, these links can be
14873 highly unstable. I have tried to remedy the instability by redirecting
14874 readers to the original source through the Web site associated with
14875 this book. For each link below, you can go to
14876 http://free-culture.cc/notes and locate the original source by
14877 clicking on the number after the # sign. If the original link remains
14878 alive, you will be redirected to that link. If the original link has
14879 disappeared, you will be redirected to an appropriate reference for
14882 <!--PAGE BREAK 336-->
14885 <chapter label=
"18" id=
"c-acknowledgments">
14886 <title>ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
</title>
14888 This book is the product of a long and as yet unsuccessful struggle that
14889 began when I read of Eric Eldred's war to keep books free. Eldred's
14890 work helped launch a movement, the free culture movement, and it is
14891 to him that this book is dedicated.
14893 <indexterm><primary>Rose, Mark
</primary></indexterm>
14895 I received guidance in various places from friends and academics,
14896 including Glenn Brown, Peter DiCola, Jennifer Mnookin, Richard Posner,
14897 Mark Rose, and Kathleen Sullivan. And I received correction and
14898 guidance from many amazing students at Stanford Law School and
14899 Stanford University. They included Andrew B. Coan, John Eden, James
14900 P. Fellers, Christopher Guzelian, Erica Goldberg, Robert Hallman,
14901 Andrew Harris, Matthew Kahn, Brian Link, Ohad Mayblum, Alina Ng, and
14902 Erica Platt. I am particularly grateful to Catherine Crump and Harry
14903 Surden, who helped direct their research, and to Laura Lynch, who
14904 brilliantly managed the army that they assembled, and provided her own
14905 critical eye on much of this.
14908 Yuko Noguchi helped me to understand the laws of Japan as well as
14909 its culture. I am thankful to her, and to the many in Japan who helped
14910 me prepare this book: Joi Ito, Takayuki Matsutani, Naoto Misaki,
14911 Michihiro Sasaki, Hiromichi Tanaka, Hiroo Yamagata, and Yoshihiro
14912 <!--PAGE BREAK 337-->
14913 Yonezawa. I am thankful as well as to Professor Nobuhiro Nakayama,
14914 and the Tokyo University Business Law Center, for giving me the
14915 chance to spend time in Japan, and to Tadashi Shiraishi and Kiyokazu
14916 Yamagami for their generous help while I was there.
14919 These are the traditional sorts of help that academics regularly draw
14920 upon. But in addition to them, the Internet has made it possible to
14921 receive advice and correction from many whom I have never even
14922 met. Among those who have responded with extremely helpful advice to
14923 requests on my blog about the book are Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli, David
14924 Gerstein, and Peter DiMauro, as well as a long list of those who had
14925 specific ideas about ways to develop my argument. They included
14926 Richard Bondi, Steven Cherry, David Coe, Nik Cubrilovic, Bob Devine,
14927 Charles Eicher, Thomas Guida, Elihu M. Gerson, Jeremy Hunsinger,
14928 Vaughn Iverson, John Karabaic, Jeff Keltner, James Lindenschmidt,
14929 K. L. Mann, Mark Manning, Nora McCauley, Jeffrey McHugh, Evan
14930 McMullen, Fred Norton, John Pormann, Pedro A. D. Rezende, Shabbir
14931 Safdar, Saul Schleimer, Clay Shirky, Adam Shostack, Kragen Sitaker,
14932 Chris Smith, Bruce Steinberg, Andrzej Jan Taramina, Sean Walsh, Matt
14933 Wasserman, Miljenko Williams,
<quote>Wink,
</quote> Roger Wood,
<quote>Ximmbo da Jazz,
</quote>
14934 and Richard Yanco. (I apologize if I have missed anyone; with
14935 computers come glitches, and a crash of my e-mail system meant I lost
14936 a bunch of great replies.)
14939 Richard Stallman and Michael Carroll each read the whole book in
14940 draft, and each provided extremely helpful correction and advice.
14941 Michael helped me to see more clearly the significance of the
14942 regulation of derivitive works. And Richard corrected an
14943 embarrassingly large number of errors. While my work is in part
14944 inspired by Stallman's, he does not agree with me in important places
14945 throughout this book.
14948 Finally, and forever, I am thankful to Bettina, who has always
14949 insisted that there would be unending happiness away from these
14950 battles, and who has always been right. This slow learner is, as ever,
14951 grateful for her perpetual patience and love.
14953 <!--PAGE BREAK 338-->